2019
OWNER’S MANUAL
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 0 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
3 WARNING
California Proposition 65 Warning
Operating, servicing and maintaining a
passenger vehicle or off-highway motor
vehicle can expose you to chemicals including
engine exhaust, carbon monoxide,
phthalates, and lead, which are known to the
State of California to cause cancer and birth
defects or other reproductive harm. To
minimize exposure, avoid breathing exhaust,
do not idle the engine except as necessary,
service your vehicle in a well-ventilated area
and wear gloves or wash your hands
frequently when servicing your vehicle. For
more information go to
www.P65Warnings.ca.gov/passenger-vehicle.
Event Data Recorders
This vehicle is equipped with an event data recorder (EDR).
The main purpose of an EDR is to record, in certain crash or near
crash-like situations, such as an air bag deployment or hitting a
road obstacle, data that will assist in understanding how a vehicle’s
systems performed. The EDR is designed to record data related
to vehicle dynamics and safety systems for a short period of
time, typically 30 seconds or less. The EDR in this vehicle is
designed to record such data as:
• How various systems in your vehicle were operating;
• Whether or not the driver and passenger safety belts were
buckled/fastened;
• How far (if at all) the driver was depressing the accelerator
and/or brake pedal; and,
• How fast the vehicle was traveling.
These data can help provide a better understanding of the
circumstances in which crashes and injuries occur. NOTE: EDR data
are recorded by your vehicle only if a non-trivial crash situation
occurs; no data are recorded by the EDR under normal driving
conditions and no personal data (e.g., name, gender, age, and
crash location) are recorded. However, other parties, such as law
enforcement, could combine the EDR data with the type of
personally identifying data routinely acquired during a crash
investigation.
To read data recorded by an EDR, special equipment is required,
and access to the vehicle or the EDR is needed. In addition to the
vehicle manufacturer, other parties, such as law enforcement, that
have the special equipment, can read the information if they have
access to the vehicle or the EDR.
The data belongs to the vehicle owner and may not be accessed by
anyone else except as legally required or with the permission of the
vehicle owner.
Service Diagnostic Recorders
This vehicle is equipped with service-related devices that record
information about powertrain performance. The data can be used
to verify emissions law requirements and/or help technicians
diagnose and solve service problems. It may also be combined with
data from other sources for research purposes, but it remains
confidential. Some diagnostic and maintenance information is
uploaded to Honda upon vehicle start up.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 1 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
California Perchlorate Contamination Prevention Act
The airbags, seat belt tensioners, and CR type batteries in this
vehicle may contain perchlorate materials - special handling may
apply. See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate/
To help you make informed decisions about safety, we have
provided operating procedures and other information on labels and
in this manual. This information alerts you to potential hazards that
could hurt you or others.
As you read this manual, you will find information that is preceded
by a NOTICE symbol. This information is intended to help you avoid
damage to your vehicle, other property, or the environment.
Of course, it is not practical or possible to warn you about all the
hazards associated with operating or maintaining your vehicle. You
must use your own good judgment.
Software End User License Agreement
You will find this important safety information in a variety of forms,
including:
Your vehicle comes equipped with software, which is governed by
the End User License Agreement in Owner’s Manual, and which
contains a binding arbitration clause. Please refer to the End User
License Agreement for the terms and conditions governing your
use of the installed software, as well as the applications, services,
functions, and content provided through the software. Your use of
the installed software will serve as your consent to the terms and
conditions of the End User License Agreement.
You may opt out within 30 days of your initial use of the Software
by sending a signed, written notice to HONDA at American Honda
Motor Co., Inc. Honda Automobile Customer Services Mail Stop
100-5E-8A, 1919 Torrance Blvd. Torrance, CA 90501-2746.
Privacy Notice
This vehicle may share location and usage information. To manage
this setting, visit www.hondalink.com/vehicle-data-choices.
A Few Words About Safety
Your safety, and the safety of others, is very important. And
operating this vehicle safely is an important responsibility.
● Safety Labels - on the vehicle.
● Safety Messages - preceded by a safety alert symbol 3 and
one of three signal words: DANGER, WARNING, or CAUTION.
These signal words mean:
3DANGER
You WILL be KILLED or SERIOUSLY HURT if
you don't follow instructions.
3WARNING
You CAN be KILLED or SERIOUSLY HURT if
you don't follow instructions.
3CAUTION
You CAN be HURT if you don't follow
instructions.
● Safety Headings - such as Important Safety Precautions.
● Safety Section - such as Safe Driving.
● Instructions - how to use this vehicle correctly and safely.
This entire book is filled with important safety information - please
read it carefully.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 2 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Contents
This owner’s manual should be considered a permanent part of the
vehicle and should remain with the vehicle when it is sold.
This owner’s manual covers all models of your vehicle. You may find
descriptions of equipment and features that are not on your
particular model.
Images throughout this owner’s manual (including the front cover)
represent features and equipment that are available on some, but
not all, models. Your particular model may not have some of these
features.
This owner’s manual is for vehicles sold in the United States and
Canada.
2 Safe Driving P. 31
For Safe Driving P. 32
Seat Belts P. 37
Airbags P. 45
2 Instrument Panel P. 75
Indicators P. 76
Gauges and Displays P. 104
2 Controls P. 129
Clock P. 130
Locking and Unlocking the Doors P. 133
Operating the Switches Around the Steering Wheel P. 165
Moonroof * P. 164
Interior Lights/Interior Convenience Items P. 198
2 Features P. 225
Audio System P. 226
General Information on the Audio System P. 330
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® P. 381, 406
2 Driving P. 433
Before Driving P. 434
Towing a Trailer P. 440
Parking Your Vehicle P. 539 Multi-View Rear Camera P. 550
The information and specifications included in this publication were
in effect at the time of approval for printing. Honda Motor Co., Ltd.
reserves the right, however, to discontinue or change specifications
or design at any time without notice and without incurring any
obligation.
2 Maintenance P. 557
Before Performing Maintenance P. 558
Maintenance MinderTM P. 561
Checking and Maintaining Wiper Blades P. 584
Remote Transmitter Care P. 599
Accessories and Modifications P. 607
2 Handling the Unexpected P. 609
Tools P. 610
If a Tire Goes Flat P. 611
Indicator, Coming On/Blinking P. 627
Fuses P. 631
Refueling P. 638
When You Cannot Open the Tailgate P. 639
2 Information P. 641
Specifications P. 642
Emissions Testing P. 647
Identification Numbers P. 644
Warranty Coverages P. 649
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 3 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Contents
Quick Reference Guide
Child Safety P. 58
Exhaust Gas Hazard P. 73
Opening and Closing the Tailgate P. 148
Adjusting the Mirrors P. 186
Climate Control System P. 217
Security System P. 158
Opening and Closing the Windows P. 161
Adjusting the Seats P. 188
Audio System Basic Operation P. 233, 251
Customized Features P. 352, 359
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines P. 450
Refueling P. 552
Audio Error Messages P. 327
HomeLink® Universal Transceiver * P. 378
When Driving P. 452
Honda Sensing® P. 490
Fuel Economy and CO2 Emissions P. 555
Maintenance Under the Hood P. 567
Checking and Maintaining Tires P. 588
Climate Control System Maintenance P. 600
Engine Does Not Start P. 619
Emergency Towing P. 636
Devices that Emit Radio Waves P. 645
Authorized Manuals P. 651
Braking P. 535
Replacing Light Bulbs P. 579
Battery P. 597
Cleaning P. 602
Jump Starting P. 622
Overheating P. 625
When You Cannot Unlock the Fuel Fill Door P. 637
Reporting Safety Defects P. 646
Customer Service Information P. 652
P. 4
Safety Labels P. 74
Safe Driving
P. 31
Instrument Panel
P. 75
Controls
P. 129
Features
P. 225
Driving
P. 433
Maintenance
P. 557
Handling the Unexpected
P. 609
Information
P. 641
Index
P. 653
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 4 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Quick Reference Guide
Visual Index
Quick Reference Guide
❚ ECON Button (P474)
❚ System Indicators (P76)
❚ Gauges (P104)
❚ Driver Information
Interface (P105)
❚
(Vehicle Stability Assist® (VSA®)
System OFF) Button (P478)
❚ Parking Sensor System Button * (P542)
❚ Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM
(CMBSTM) OFF Button (P496)
❚ Heated Windshield Button * (P181)
❚ Road Departure Mitigation (RDM)
Button (P529)
❚ Audio System (P233, 251)
❚ Navigation System *
() See the Navigation System Manual
❚ Audio/Information Screen (P234, 252)
❚ Hazard Warning Button
❚ Climate Control System (P217)
❚ Rear Defogger/Heated Door Mirror *
Button (P180)
❚ Front Seat Heater Buttons * (P211)
❚ Front Seat Heaters and Seat
Ventilation Buttons * (P212)
❚ ENGINE START/STOP Button (P165)
❚ Steering Wheel Adjustments (P185)
4
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 5 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Quick Reference Guide
❚ Headlights/Turn Signals (P168, 169)
❚ Fog Lights * (P172)
❚ LaneWatchTM* (P483)
❚ Paddle Shifter (Shift down) (P467)
❚ Audio Remote Control Buttons (P230)
❚ 3 / 4 Button (P107, 230)
❚ Brightness Control (P182)
❚ Paddle Shifter (Shift up) (P467)
❚ Wipers/Washers (P177)
❚ Heated Steering Wheel Button * (P214)
❚ Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) Buttons
(P505)
❚ Interval Button (P513)
❚ Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) Button
(P520)
❚ Horn (Press an area around
.)
❚ Navigation System Voice Control Buttons * () See the Navigation System Manual
❚ Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® System Voice Control Buttons (P381, 406)
❚ (home) Button (P107, 230)
❚ ENTER Button (P107, 230)
* Not available on all models
5
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 6 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Visual Index
Quick Reference Guide
❚ Power Window Switches (P161)
❚ Master Door Lock Switch (P146)
❚ Memory Buttons * (P184)
❚ SET Button * (P184)
(P553)
❚ Rearview Mirror (P186)
❚ HomeLink® Buttons * (P379)
❚ Door Mirror Controls (P187)
❚ Driver’s Front Airbag (P48)
❚ Passenger’s Front Airbag (P48)
❚ Accessory Power Socket (P205)
❚ USB Port (P227)
❚ Glove Box (P201)
❚ Interior Fuse Box (P634)
❚ Parking Brake (P535)
❚ Interior Fuse Box (P633)
❚ Hood Release Handle (P568)
6
❚ Power Tailgate Button * (P152)
❚ Fuel Fill Door Release Button
❚ Shift Button (P460)
❚ Mode Button * (P475)
❚ Snow Button * (P475)
❚ Auto Idle Stop OFF Button (P469)
❚ Accessory Power Socket (P205)
❚ Auxiliary Input Jack (P228)
❚ USB Port (P227)
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 7 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Quick Reference Guide
❚ Accessory Power Socket * (P206)
❚ Seat Belt with Detachable Anchor (P42)
❚ Seat Belts (P40)
❚ Sun Visors
❚ Vanity Mirrors
❚ Moonroof Switch * (P164)
❚ Map Lights (P199)
❚ Sunglasses Holder (P210)
❚ Grab Handle
❚ Coat Hook (P209)
❚ Front Seat (P188)
❚ Side Airbags (P52)
❚ AC Power Outlet * (P206)
❚ USB Ports * (P228)
❚ Rear Seat Heater Buttons * (P213)
❚ Rear Seat (P192)
❚ Side Curtain Airbags (P54)
❚ Seat Belt (Installing a Child Seat) (P66)
❚ Seat Belt to Secure a Child Seat (P69)
❚ LATCH to Secure a Child Seat (P63)
❚ Cargo Area Light (P200)
* Not available on all models
7
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 8 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Visual Index
Quick Reference Guide
❚ Maintenance Under the Hood (P567)
❚ Windshield Wipers (P177, 584)
❚ Power Door Mirrors (P187)
❚ Side Turn Signal Lights * (P168, 582)
❚ Door Lock/Unlock Control (P136)
❚ Headlights (P169, 579)
❚ Front Side Marker Lights (P169, 580)
❚ Daytime Running Lights /Parking Lights
(P169, 173, 580)
❚ Front Turn Signal Lights (P168, 581)
❚ Tires (P588, 611)
❚ Fog Lights * (P172, 581)
❚ How to Refuel (P553)
❚ High-Mount Brake Light (P583)
❚ Rear Wiper (P179, 586)
❚ Rear License Plate Lights (P583)
❚ Opening/Closing the Tailgate (P148)
❚ Multi-View Rear Camera (P550)
❚ Tailgate Outer Handle (P153)
❚ Back-Up Lights (P583)
❚ Brake/Taillights (P582)
❚ Rear Side Marker Lights (P582)
❚ Rear Turn Signal Lights (P582)
8
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 9 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Auto Idle Stop Function
At
Deceleration
Automatic transmission
Engine status
Stop the vehicle and depress the brake
pedal.
Quick Reference Guide
To improve fuel economy, the engine stops and then restarts as detailed below. When Auto Idle Stop is on, the Auto Idle Stop indicator
(green) comes on. (P468)
On
Stop
Keep the brake pedal depressed.
Off
Start-up
Release the brake pedal.
Restarting
* Not available on all models
9
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 10 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Eco Assist® System
Quick Reference Guide
Ambient Meter
● The color of the ambient meter changes
to green to indicate that the vehicle is
being driven in a fuel efficient manner.
ECON Button (P474 )
Helps maximize fuel economy.
ECON Mode Indicator (P84 )
Comes on when the ECON button is pressed.
10
The message is displayed for a few seconds when the
ECON button is pressed.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 11 ページ
2020年2月20日
Safe Driving
木曜日
午後3時29分
(P31)
● Your vehicle is fitted with airbags to help protect you and
your passengers during a moderate-to-severe collision.
Child Safety (P58)
● All children 12 and younger should be seated in the rear seat.
● Smaller children should be properly restrained in a forward-facing child seat.
● Infants must be properly restrained in a rear-facing child seat.
Quick Reference Guide
Airbags (P45)
Exhaust Gas Hazard (P73)
● Your vehicle emits dangerous exhaust gases that contain carbon
monoxide. Do not run the engine in confined spaces where carbon
monoxide gas can accumulate.
Seat Belts (P37)
Before Driving Checklist (P434)
● Fasten your seat belt and sit upright well
back in the seat.
● Check that your passengers are wearing
their seat belts correctly.
● Before driving, check that the front seats, head restraints,
steering wheel, and mirrors have been properly adjusted.
Fasten your lap belt as
low as possible.
11
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 12 ページ
2020年2月20日
Instrument Panel
木曜日
午後3時29分
(P75)
Quick Reference Guide
Gauges (P104)/Driver Information Interface (P105)/System
Indicators (P76)
M (Sequential mode) Indicator/
Immobilizer System
Sequential Mode Gear Selection Indicator Indicator/Security
System Alarm Indicator
Temperature Gauge
Tachometer
System Indicators
Intelligent Traction
Speedometer
Management
Malfunction Indicator
Lamp
Indicator
System Indicators
Turn Signal and
Hazard Warning
Indicators
Low Tire Pressure/
TPMS Indicator
Parking Brake and
Brake System Indicator
Canada (Red)
U.S.
Charging System
Indicator
Electric Power Steering
(EPS) System Indicator
Seat Belt Reminder
Indicator
Low Fuel Indicator
Supplemental
Restraint System
Indicator
Vehicle Stability Assist®
(VSA®) System
Indicator
Econ Mode Indicator
VSA® OFF Indicator
U.S.
Parking Brake and
Brake System Indicator
(Amber)
Gear Position Indicator/
Transmission System
Indicator
Driver Information Interface
Fuel Gauge
System Message
Indicator
Canada
Anti-lock Brake System
(ABS) Indicator
Blind spot information
System Indicator *
Adaptive Cruise
Control (ACC)
Indicator (Green/
Amber)
12
Lights Indicators
System Indicators
Lane Keeping Assist
System (LKAS)
Indicator (Green/
Amber)
Auto Idle Stop System
Indicator (Amber)/
Auto Idle Stop
Indicator (Green)
Lights On Indicator
High Beam Indicator
Fog Light Indicator
Auto High-Beam
Indicator
Road Departure
Mitigation (RDM)
Indicator
Collision Mitigation
Braking SystemTM
(CMBSTM) Indicator
All-wheel drive
system (AWD)
Indicator *
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 13 ページ
Controls
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
(P129)
These indications are used to show how to
operate the selector knob.
● Rotate
to select.
● Press
to enter.
Models with color audio system
Models with Display Audio
d
Select Automatic Date & Time, then
select OFF.
e
Select Set Date or Set Time.
f
Adjust the dates, hours and minutes by
selecting 3 / 4 .
g
Select Save to set the time.
To adjust time
Quick Reference Guide
Clock (P130)
Models with navigation system
The navigation system receives signals from
GPS satellites, updating the clock
automatically.
a
Press and hold the MENU/CLOCK
button for two seconds.
To adjust date
b
Select Adjust Clock, then press
c
Rotate
d
Press
to switch to minute
adjustment.
e
Rotate
f
Press
to switch to Set.
a
Select
g
Press
to complete clock adjustment.
b
Select System, then Date & Time.
c
Select Set Date & Time.
.
ENGINE START/STOP
Button (P165)
Press the button to change the vehicle’s
power mode.
to adjust the hours.
to adjust the minutes.
, then select Settings.
* Not available on all models
13
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 14 ページ
2020年2月20日
Turn Signals (P168)
Turn Signal Control Lever
Quick Reference Guide
Right
Left
木曜日
午後3時29分
Wipers and Washers
(P177)
Wiper/Washer Control Lever
MIST
OFF
AUTO*1: Wiper speed varies
automatically
INT*2: Low speed with
intermittent
LO: Low speed wipe
HI: High speed wipe
Lights (P169)
Pull toward
you to spray
washer fluid.
Light Control Switches
High Beam
Low Beam
Adjustment Ring
Flashing
(- : Low Sensitivity*1
(- : Lower speed, fewer sweeps*2
(+ : High Sensitivity*1
(+ : Higher speed, more sweeps*2
*1:Models with automatic intermittent
operation
*2:Models with manual intermittent
operation
14
Models with automatic intermittent wipers
AUTO should always be turned OFF before
the following situations in order to prevent
severe damage to the wiper system:
● Cleaning the windshield
● Driving through a car wash
● No rain present
Steering Wheel (P185)
● To adjust, push the adjustment lever
down, adjust to the desired position, then
pull up the lever back in place.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 15 ページ
2020年2月20日
Unlocking the Front
Doors from the Inside
木曜日
午後3時29分
Tailgate (P148)
● Pull either front door inner handle to
unlock and open it at the same time.
Outer Handle
Models with Hands Free Access
Use a forward and back kicking motion
under the center of the rear bumper to
open or close the power tailgate while
carrying the smart entry remote.
● Press the tailgate outer handle to unlock
and open the tailgate when you carry the
smart entry remote.
Quick Reference Guide
(P145)
Models with power tailgate
● Press the power tailgate button on the
driver’s door or the remote transmitter to
open and close the power tailgate.
1 sec.
15
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 16 ページ
2020年2月20日
Power Door Mirrors
(P187)
Quick Reference Guide
● With the power mode in ON, move the
selector switch to L or R.
● Push the appropriate edge of the
adjustment switch to adjust the mirror.
● Press the folding button * to fold in and
out the door mirrors.
Folding Button *
Selector Switch
木曜日
午後3時29分
Power Windows (P161)
● With the power mode in ON, open and
close the power windows.
● If the power window lock button is in the
off position, each passenger’s window
can be opened and closed with its own
switch.
● If the power window lock button is in the
on position (indicator is on), each
passenger’s window switch is disabled.
Power Window Lock Button
Indicator
Adjustment Switch
Window Switch
16
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 17 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Climate Control System * (P217)
Rear Climate Control * (P222)
AUTO Button
Driver’s Side
Temperature
Control Switch
(Recirculation)
Button
Rear Temperature
Control Buttons
Passenger’s Side
Temperature
Control Switch
/
(Rear Fan
Control) Buttons
Quick Reference Guide
● Press the AUTO button to activate the
rear climate control system.
● Press the
button to turn the system
on or off.
● Press the AUTO button to activate the climate control system.
● Press the
button to turn the system on or off.
● Press the
button to defrost the windshield.
(On/Off) Button
SYNC
(Synchronization) Button
Mode Control Button
Air flows from dashboard
vents.
Air flows from floor and
dashboard vents.
Air flows from floor vents.
Air flows from floor and
windshield defroster vents.
(Windshield
Defroster) Button
Rear AUTO
Button
A/C (Air
Conditioning)
Button
(Rear On/
Off) Button
Fan Control
Button
Mode Control Button
Air flows from the rear console vents.
Air flow from the rear console
vents and floor vents.
Air flows from the rear floor vents.
* Not available on all models
17
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 18 ページ
Features
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
(P225)
Quick Reference Guide
Audio system (P226)
Models with color audio system (P233)
(Day/Night) Button
Audio/Information Screen
(Phone) Button
RADIO Button
(Sound) Button
MEDIA Button
VOL /
Knob
Selector Knob
(Volume/Power)
MENU/CLOCK Button
/
(Skip/Seek) Buttons
(Back) Button
Preset Buttons (1-6)
18
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 19 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Models with Display Audio (P 251)
For navigation system operation () See the Navigation System Manual
Quick Reference Guide
(Home) Icon
(Back) Icon
(Day/Night) Icon
VOL/
AUDIO (Volume/Power) Knob
Audio/Information Screen
19
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 20 ページ
2020年2月20日
Audio Remote Controls
午後3時29分
Models with Display Audio
/
3 / 4 /
(+ / (- Bar
(P230)
Buttons
Quick Reference Guide
Models with color audio system
/
Buttons
(+ / (- Bar
ENTER Button
SOURCE
Button
● (+ / (- Bar
Press to adjust the volume up/down.
● SOURCE Button
Press to change the audio mode:
FM1/FM2/AM/USB/iPod/
Bluetooth® Audio/AUX
●
/
Buttons
Radio: Press to change the preset station.
Press and hold to select the next or
previous strong station.
USB device/Bluetooth® Audio:
Press to skip to the beginning of
the next song or return to the
beginning of the current song.
Press and hold to change a folder.
20
木曜日
● (+ / (- Bar
Press to adjust the volume up/down.
● 3 / 4 /
/
/ENTER Buttons
Press 3 or 4 to select Now Playing on
the home screen of the driver
information interface, and then press the
ENTER button.
Press 3 or 4 to cycle through the audio
mode as follows:
Android Auto/Apple CarPlay/SiriusXM® */
AUX Input/AM/Bluetooth® Audio/Social
Playlist/FM/My Honda Music/USB/iPod
Radio: Press
/
to change the
preset station.
USB device/My Honda Music/Bluetooth®
Audio:
Press
/
to skip to the
beginning of the next song or
return to the beginning of the
current song.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 21 ページ
Driving
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
(P433)
Quick Reference Guide
Automatic Transmission (P460)
● Select (P and depress the brake pedal when starting the engine.
● Gear selection
Gear Position Indicator
The gear position indicator and the
shift button indicator indicate the
current gear selection.
Shift Button
Indicator
Gear Position Indicator
Park
Press the (P button.
Used when parking or before
turning off or starting the
engine.
Transmission is locked.
Intelligent Traction
Management Button
Reverse
Pull back the (R button.
Used when reversing.
Neutral
Press the (N button.
Transmission is not locked.
Drive/S Position
Each time you press the D/S button, the mode
switches between Drive and S position mode.
Used for:
Drive
● Normal driving (gears change between 1st and
9th automatically)
● Temporarily driving in the sequential mode
S Position
● Automatically changing gears between 1st and
8th (8th gear is used only at high speed)
● Driving in the sequential mode
* Not available on all models
21
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 22 ページ
2020年2月20日
Paddle Shifters (P467)
午後3時29分
Quick Reference Guide
● Paddle shifters allow you to shift gears much like a manual
transmission (1st through 9th). This is useful for engine braking.
When the transmission is in (D
●
The transmission will shift back
Gear Position Indicator
to automatic mode once the
M (sequential
system detects that the vehicle
mode)
is cruising.
Indicator
When the transmission is in (S
● Holds the selected gear, and
the M (sequential mode)
indicator comes on.
Sequential Mode Gear
●
The sequential mode gear
Selection Indicator
selection is shown in the
instrument panel.
Shift Down (Paddle Shifter
22
木曜日
Shift Up (+
Paddle Shifter
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 23 ページ
2020年2月20日
VSA® On and Off (P478)
CMBSTM On and Off
午後3時29分
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) with Tire
Fill Assist (P486, 630)
● The TPMS monitors tire pressure.
● TPMS is turned on automatically every time you start the engine.
● TPMS fill assist provides audible and visual guidance during tire pressure adjustment.
Refueling (P552)
Fuel recommendation: Unleaded gasoline, pump octane number 87 or
higher
Fuel tank capacity: 19.5 US gal (73.8 L)
a
Press the fuel fill door
release button.
b
After refueling, wait for
about five seconds
before removing the
filler nozzle.
(P496)
● When a possible collision is likely
unavoidable, the CMBSTM can help you to
reduce the vehicle speed and the severity
of the collision.
● The CMBSTM is turned on every time you
start the engine.
● To turn the CMBSTM on or off, press and
hold the button until you hear a beep.
Quick Reference Guide
● The Vehicle Stability Assist® (VSA®) system
helps stabilize the vehicle during
cornering, and helps maintain traction
while accelerating on loose or slippery
road surfaces.
● VSA® comes on automatically every time
you start the engine.
● To partially disable or fully restore VSA®
function, press and hold the button until
you hear a beep.
木曜日
23
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 24 ページ
2020年2月20日
Honda Sensing®
Quick Reference Guide
Honda Sensing® is a driver support system
which employs the use of two distinctly
different kinds of sensors, a radar sensor
located behind the emblem and a front
sensor camera mounted to the interior side
of the windshield, behind the rear view
mirror.
The camera is located
behind the rearview
mirror.
Front Sensor
Camera
木曜日
午後3時29分
(P490)
Collision Mitigation
Braking SystemTM
(CMBSTM) (P493)
Can assist you when there is a possibility of
your vehicle colliding with a vehicle or a
pedestrian detected in front of yours. The
CMBSTM is designed to alert you when a
potential collision is determined, as well as
to reduce your vehicle speed to help
minimize collision severity when a collision is
deemed unavoidable.
Adaptive Cruise Control
(ACC) (P505)
Helps maintain a constant vehicle speed and
a set following-interval behind a vehicle
detected ahead of yours, without you
having to keep your foot on the brake or
the accelerator.
Radar Sensor
The radar sensor is
behind the emblem.
24
Lane Keeping Assist
System (LKAS) (P518)
Provides steering input to help keep the
vehicle in the middle of a detected lane and
provides tactile and visual alerts if the
vehicle is detected drifting out of its lane.
Road Departure
Mitigation (RDM) System
(P527)
Alerts and helps to assist you when the
system detects a possibility of your vehicle
unintentionally crossing over detected lane
markings and/or leaving the roadway
altogether.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 25 ページ
2020年2月20日
Maintenance
木曜日
午後3時29分
(P557)
● Check engine oil, engine coolant, and windshield washer
fluid. Add when necessary.
● Check brake fluid.
● Check the battery condition monthly.
a
Pull the hood release handle under the corner of the
dashboard.
b
Locate the hood latch lever, pull it up, and then raise the
hood. Once you have raised the hood slightly, you can
release the lever.
c
Quick Reference Guide
Under the Hood (P567)
Wiper Blades (P584)
● Replace blades if they leave streaks
across the windshield.
Tires (P588)
Lights (P579)
● Inspect tires and wheels regularly.
● Check tire pressures regularly.
● Install snow tires for winter
driving.
● Inspect all lights regularly.
When finished, close the hood and make sure it is firmly
locked in place.
25
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 26 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Handling the Unexpected
Quick Reference Guide
Flat Tire (P611)
Engine Won’t Start (P619)
Overheating (P625)
● Park in a safe location and replace the
flat tire with the compact spare tire
located in the cargo area.
● If the battery is dead, jump start using a
booster battery.
● Park in a safe location. If you do not see
steam under the hood, open the hood,
and let the engine cool down.
Indicators Come On (P627)
Blown Fuse (P631)
Emergency Towing (P636)
● Identify the indicator and consult the
owner’s manual.
26
(P609)
● Check for a blown fuse if an electrical
device does not operate.
● Call a professional towing service if you
need to tow your vehicle.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 27 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
What to Do If
●
●
The steering wheel may be locked.
Move the steering wheel left and right
after pressing the ENGINE START/STOP
button.
Why does the brake pedal
pulsate slightly when
applying the brakes?
This can occur when the ABS activates and does not indicate a
problem. Apply firm, steady pressure on the brake pedal. Never
pump the brake pedal.
u Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) (P537)
The rear door cannot be
opened from inside the
vehicle. Why?
Check if the childproof lock is in
the lock position. If so, open the
rear door with the outside door
handle.
To cancel this function, slide the
lever up to the unlock position.
Quick Reference Guide
Canadian models
The power mode does not
change from VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK) to ACCESSORY.
Why?
27
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 28 ページ
2020年2月20日
午後3時29分
Quick Reference Guide
Why do the doors lock
after I unlocked the doors?
If you do not open the doors within 30 seconds, the doors are
relocked automatically for security.
Why does the beeper
sound when I open the
driver’s door?
The beeper sounds when:
● The power mode is in ACCESSORY.
● The exterior lights are left on.
● The Auto Idle Stop is in operation.
Models with walk away auto lock®
Why does a beeper sound
when I walk away from the
vehicle after I close the
door?
28
木曜日
The beeper sounds if you move outside the walk away auto lock
operating range before the door completely closes.
u Locking the doors and tailgate (Walk away auto lock®) *
(P139)
Why does the beeper
sound when I start driving?
The beeper sounds when:
● Driver and/or front passenger are not wearing their seat belts.
● The parking brake pedal is not fully released.
Why do I hear a screeching
sound when I apply the
brake pedal?
The brake pads may need to be replaced. Have your vehicle
inspected by a dealer.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 29 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
●
I'm seeing an amber
indicator of a tire with an
exclamation point. What is
that?
The Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) needs
attention.Check tire pressure.
u If the Low Tire Pressure/Tire Pressure Monitoring System
(TPMS) Indicator Comes On or Blinks (P630)
●
Fasten the driver’s seat belt.
Close the driver’s door and manually change the gear
position.
u When opening the driver’s door (P463)
* Not available on all models
Quick Reference Guide
Why does the gear position
automatically change to (P
when I open the driver’s
door to check for parking
space lines when
reversing?
29
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 30 ページ
30
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 31 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Safe Driving
You can find many safety recommendations throughout this chapter, and throughout this manual.
For Safe Driving
Important Safety Precautions.............. 32
Important Handling Information......... 34
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features............ 35
Safety Checklist ................................. 36
Seat Belts
About Your Seat Belts ........................ 37
Fastening a Seat Belt .......................... 40
Seat Belt Inspection............................ 44
Airbags
Airbag System Components............... 45
Types of Airbags ................................ 48
Front Airbags (SRS) ............................ 48
Side Airbags....................................... 52
Side Curtain Airbags .......................... 54
Airbag System Indicators.................... 55
Airbag Care ....................................... 57
Child Safety
Protecting Child Passengers ............... 58
Safety of Infants and Small Children .. 60
Safety of Larger Children ................... 71
Exhaust Gas Hazard
Carbon Monoxide Gas....................... 73
Safety Labels
Label Locations .................................. 74
31
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 32 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
For Safe Driving
The following pages explain your vehicle’s safety features and how to use them
properly. The safety precautions below are ones that we consider to be among the
most important.
Safe Driving
Important Safety Precautions
■ Always wear your seat belt
A seat belt is your best protection in all types of collisions. Airbags are designed to
supplement seat belts, not replace them. So even though your vehicle is equipped
with airbags, make sure you and your passengers always wear your seat belts, and
wear them properly.
■ Restrain all children
Children ages 12 and under should ride properly restrained in a back seat, not the
front seat. Infants and small children should be restrained in a child seat. Larger
children should use a booster seat and a lap/shoulder seat belt until they can use the
belt properly without a booster seat.
■ Be aware of airbag hazards
While airbags can save lives, they can cause serious or fatal injuries to occupants
who sit too close to them, or are not properly restrained. Infants, young children,
and short adults are at the greatest risk. Be sure to follow all instructions and
warnings in this manual.
■ Don’t drink and drive
Alcohol and driving don’t mix. Even one drink can reduce your ability to respond to
changing conditions, and your reaction time gets worse with every additional drink.
So don’t drink and drive, and don’t let your friends drink and drive, either.
32
1Important Safety Precautions
Some states, provinces and territories prohibit the use
of cell phones other than hands-free devices by the
driver while driving.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 33 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuFor Safe DrivinguImportant Safety Precautions
■ Control your speed
Excessive speed is a major factor in crash injuries and deaths. Generally, the higher
the speed, the greater the risk, but serious injuries can also occur at lower speeds.
Never drive faster than is safe for current conditions, regardless of the maximum
speed posted.
Safe Driving
■ Pay appropriate attention to the task of driving safely
Engaging in cell phone conversation or other activities that keep you from paying
close attention to the road, other vehicles, and pedestrians could lead to a crash.
Remember, situations can change quickly, and only you can decide when it is safe to
divert some attention away from driving.
■ Keep your vehicle in safe condition
Having a tire blowout or a mechanical failure can be extremely hazardous.
To reduce the possibility of such problems, check your tire pressures and condition
frequently, and perform all regularly scheduled maintenance.
■ Do not leave children unattended in the vehicle
Children, pets and people needing assistance left unattended in the vehicle may be
injured if they activate one or more of the vehicle controls. They may also cause the
vehicle to move, resulting in a crash in which they and/or another person(s) can be
injured or killed. Also, depending on the ambient temperature, the temperature of
the interior may reach extreme levels, which can result in harm or death. Even if the
climate control system is on, never leave them in the vehicle unattended as the
climate control system can shut off at any time.
33
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 34 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuFor Safe DrivinguImportant Handling Information
Important Handling Information
Safe Driving
34
Your vehicle has higher ground clearance than a passenger vehicle designed for use
only on pavement. Higher ground clearance has many advantages for off-highway
driving. It allows you to travel over bumps, obstacles, and rough terrain. It also
provides good visibility so you can anticipate problems earlier.
These advantages come at some cost. Because your vehicle is taller and rides higher
off the ground, it has a higher center gravity making it more susceptible to tipping
or roll over if you make abrupt turns. Utility vehicles have a significantly higher
rollover rate than other types of vehicles. In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is
significantly more likely to die than a person wearing a seat belt. As a reminder,
make sure you and your passengers always wear seat belts.
1Important Handling Information
For information on how to reduce the risk of rollover,
read:
2 Driving Guidelines for Your Utility Vehicle
P. 458
2 Off-Highway Driving Guidelines P. 450
Failure to operate your vehicle correctly might result
in a crash or a rollover.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 35 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuFor Safe DrivinguYour Vehicle’s Safety Features
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
1Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
Some features do not require any action on your part.
These include a strong steel framework that forms a
safety cage around the passenger compartment,
front and rear crush zones, a collapsible steering
column, and tensioners that tighten the front seat
belts in a sufficient crash.
Safety Cage
Crush Zones
Seats and Seat-Backs
Head Restraints
Collapsible Steering Column
Seat Belts
Front Airbags
Side Airbags
Side Curtain Airbags
Door Locks
Seat Belt Tensioners
Safe Driving
Your vehicle is equipped with many features that
work together to help protect you and your
passengers during a crash.
However, you and your passengers cannot take full
advantage of these features unless you remain seated
in the correct position and always wear your seat
belts. In fact, some safety features can contribute to
injuries if they are not used properly.
The following checklist will help you take an active role in protecting yourself and
your passengers.
35
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 36 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuFor Safe DrivinguSafety Checklist
Safety Checklist
Safe Driving
For the safety of you and your passengers, make a habit of checking these items
each time before you drive.
• After everyone has entered the vehicle, be sure all doors and the tailgate are
closed and locked. Locking the doors and the tailgate helps prevent an occupant
from being ejected and an outsider from unexpectedly opening a door or the
tailgate.
2 Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside P. 144
• Adjust your seat to a position suitable for driving. Be sure the front seats are
adjusted as far to the rear as possible while allowing the driver to control the
vehicle. Sitting too close to a front airbag can result in serious or fatal injury in a
crash.
2 Adjusting the Seats P. 188
• Adjust head restraints to the proper position. Head restraints are most effective
when the center of the head restraint aligns with the center of your head. Taller
persons should adjust their head restraint to the highest position.
2 Adjusting the Front and Rear Outer Seat Head Restraint Positions P. 194
• Always wear your seat belt, and make sure you wear it properly. Confirm that any
passengers are properly belted as well.
2 Fastening a Seat Belt P. 40
• Protect children by using seat belts or child seats according to a child’s age, height
and weight.
2 Child Safety P. 58
36
1Safety Checklist
If the door and/or tailgate open message appears on
the driver information interface, a door and/or the
tailgate is not completely closed. Close all doors and
the tailgate tightly until the message disappears.
2 Driver Information Interface Warning and
Information Messages P. 91
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 37 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Seat Belts
About Your Seat Belts
In addition, seat belts help protect you in almost every type of crash, including:
- frontal impacts
- side impacts
- rear impacts
- rollovers
■ Lap/shoulder seat belts
All five seating positions are equipped with lap/shoulder seat belts with emergency
locking retractors. In normal driving the retractor lets you move freely while keeping
some tension on the belt. During a collision or sudden stop the retractor locks to
restrain your body.
The front passenger’s and rear seat belts also have a lockable retractor for use with
child seats.
1About Your Seat Belts
3 WARNING
Not wearing a seat belt properly increases
the chance of serious injury or death in a
crash, even though your vehicle has
airbags.
Safe Driving
Seat belts are the single most effective safety device because they keep you
connected to the vehicle so that you can take advantage of many built-in safety
features. They also help keep you from being thrown against the inside of the
vehicle, against any passengers, or out of the vehicle. When worn properly, seat
belts also keep your body properly positioned in a crash so that you can take full
advantage of the additional protection provided by the airbags.
Be sure you and your passengers always
wear seat belts and wear them properly.
Seat belts cannot completely protect you in every
crash. But in most cases, seat belts can reduce your
risk of serious injury.
Most states and all Canadian provinces and territories
require you to wear seat belts.
If you extend the seat belt too quickly, it will lock in
place. If this happens, slightly retract the seat belt,
then extend it slowly.
2 Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt P. 66
Continued
37
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 38 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuSeat BeltsuAbout Your Seat Belts
■ Proper use of seat belts
1About Your Seat Belts
Safe Driving
Follow these guidelines for proper use:
• All occupants should sit upright, well back in the seat, and remain in that position
for the duration of the trip. Slouching and leaning reduce the effectiveness of the
belt and can increase the chance of serious injury in a crash.
• Never place the shoulder part of a lap/shoulder seat belt under your arm or
behind your back. This could cause very serious injuries in a crash.
• Two people should never use the same seat belt. If they do, they could be very
seriously injured in a crash.
• Do not put any accessories on the seat belts. Devices intended to improve comfort
or reposition the shoulder part of a seat belt can reduce the protective capability
and increase the chance of serious injury in a crash.
■ Seat Belt Reminder
1Seat Belt Reminder
The seat belt system includes an indicator on
the instrument panel to remind the driver or a
front passenger or both to fasten their seat
belts.
If you set the power mode to ON and a seat
belt is not fastened, a beeper will sound and
the indicator will blink. After a few seconds,
the beeper will stop and the indicator will
come on and remain illuminated until the seat
belt is fastened.
38
If a rear seat passenger moves around and extends
the seat belt, the lockable retractor may activate. If
this happens, release the retractor by unfastening the
seat belt and allow the belt to retract completely.
Then refasten the belt.
The indicator will also come on if a front passenger
does not fasten their seat belt within six seconds after
the power mode is set to ON.
When no one is sitting in the front passenger’s seat,
the indicator will not come on and the beeper will not
sound.
The indicator also may not come on and the beeper
may not sound when the occupant is not heavy
enough to trigger the weight sensor. Such occupants
(e.g., infants and smaller children) should be moved
to the rear seat as a deploying front airbag likely will
injure or kill them.
2 Protecting Child Passengers P. 58
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 39 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuSeat BeltsuAbout Your Seat Belts
■ Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners
The tensioners automatically tighten the front
seat belts during a moderate-to-severe frontal
collision, sometimes even if the collision is not
severe enough to inflate the front airbags.
The seat belt tensioners can only operate once.
If a tensioner is activated, the SRS indicator will come
on. Have a dealer replace the tensioner and
thoroughly inspect the seat belt system as it may not
offer protection in a subsequent crash.
During a moderate-to-severe side impact, the
tensioner on that side of the vehicle also activates.
Safe Driving
The front seats are equipped with automatic
seat belt tensioners to enhance safety.
1Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners
39
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 40 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuSeat BeltsuFastening a Seat Belt
Fastening a Seat Belt
After adjusting a front seat to the proper position, and while sitting upright and well
back in the seat:
2 Adjusting the Seats P. 188
Safe Driving
Pull out slowly.
Correct
Seated
Posture.
Buckle
No one should sit in a seat with an inoperative seat
belt or one that does not appear to be working
correctly. Using a seat belt that is not working
properly may not protect the occupant in a crash.
Have a dealer check the belt as soon as possible.
Never insert any foreign objects into the buckle or
retractor mechanism.
2. Insert the latch plate into the buckle, then
tug on the belt to make sure the buckle is
secure.
u Make sure that the belt is not twisted or
caught on anything.
Latch
Plate
40
1. Pull the seat belt out slowly.
1Fastening a Seat Belt
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 41 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuSeat BeltsuFastening a Seat Belt
■ Adjusting the Shoulder Anchor
1Fastening a Seat Belt
3 WARNING
Improperly positioning the seat belts can
cause serious injury or death in a crash.
Make sure all seat belts are properly
positioned before driving.
Safe Driving
Lap belt
as low as
possible
3. Position the lap part of the belt as low as
possible across your hips, then pull up on
the shoulder part of the belt so the lap part
fits snugly. This lets your strong pelvic
bones take the force of a crash and reduces
the chance of internal injuries.
4. If necessary, pull up on the belt again to
remove any slack, then check that the belt
rests across the center of your chest and
over your shoulder. This spreads the forces
of a crash over the strongest bones in your
upper body.
To release the belt, push the red PRESS button and
then guide the belt by hand until it has retracted
completely.
When exiting the vehicle, be sure the belt is properly
stowed so that it will not get caught in the closing
door.
1Adjusting the Shoulder Anchor
The front seats have adjustable shoulder anchors to accommodate taller and shorter
occupants.
1. Move the anchor up and down while
holding the release button.
Push
2. Position the anchor so that the belt rests
Push
across the center of your chest and over
your shoulder.
Continued
The shoulder anchor height can be adjusted to four
levels. If the belt contacts your neck, lower the height
one level at a time.
After an adjustment, make sure that the shoulder
anchor position is secure.
41
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 42 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuSeat BeltsuFastening a Seat Belt
■ Seat Belt with Detachable Anchor
1. Pull out the seat belt’s small latch plate and
the latch plate from each holding slot in the
ceiling.
Small Latch Plate
1Seat Belt with Detachable Anchor
3 WARNING
Safe Driving
Using the seat belt with the detachable
anchor unlatched increases the chance of
serious injury or death in a crash.
Before using the seat belt, make sure the
detachable anchor is correctly latched.
Latch Plate
2. Line up the triangle marks on the small
latch plate and anchor buckle. Make sure
the seat belt is not twisted. Attach the belt
to the anchor buckle.
Small Latch Plate
To unlatch the detachable anchor, insert the latch
plate into the slot on the side of the anchor buckle.
Latch Plate
Anchor Buckle
3. Insert the latch plate into the buckle.
Properly fasten the seat belt the same way
you fasten the lap/shoulder seat belt.
Latch Plate
Buckle
42
Small Latch Plate
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 43 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuSeat BeltsuFastening a Seat Belt
■ Advice for Pregnant Women
Wear the shoulder belt
across the chest avoiding
the abdomen.
Each time you have a checkup, ask your doctor if it is
okay for you to drive.
To reduce the risk of injuries to both you and your
unborn child that can be caused by an inflating front
airbag:
• When driving, sit upright and adjust the seat as far
back as possible while allowing full control of the
vehicle.
• When sitting in the front passenger’s seat, adjust
the seat as far back as possible.
Safe Driving
If you are pregnant, the best way to protect yourself and your unborn child when
driving or riding in a vehicle is to always wear a seat belt and keep the lap part of the
belt as low as possible across the hips.
1Advice for Pregnant Women
Wear the lap part of the
belt as low as possible
across the hips.
43
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 44 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuSeat BeltsuSeat Belt Inspection
Seat Belt Inspection
Regularly check the condition of your seat belts as follows:
Safe Driving
• Pull each belt out fully, and look for frays, cuts, burns, and wear.
• Check that the latch plates and buckles work smoothly and the belts retract
easily.
u If a belt does not retract easily, cleaning the belt may correct the problem. Only
use a mild soap and warm water. Do not use bleach or cleaning solvents. Make
sure the belt is completely dry before allowing it to retract.
Any belt that is not in good condition or working properly will not provide proper
protection and should be replaced as soon as possible.
A belt that has been worn during a crash may not provide the same level of
protection in a subsequent crash. Have your seat belts inspected by a dealer after
any collision.
44
1Seat Belt Inspection
3 WARNING
Not checking or maintaining seat belts can
result in serious injury or death if the seat
belts do not work properly when needed.
Check your seat belts regularly and have
any problem corrected as soon as possible.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 45 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Airbags
Airbag System Components
Safe Driving
Continued
45
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 46 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAirbagsuAirbag System Components
Safe Driving
The front, front side, and side curtain
airbags are deployed according to the
direction and severity of impact. Both side
curtain airbags are deployed in a rollover.
The airbag system includes:
a Two SRS (Supplemental Restraint System)
front airbags. The driver’s airbag is stored
in the center of the steering wheel; the
front passenger’s airbag is stored in the
dashboard. Both are marked SRS
AIRBAG.
b Two
side airbags, one for the driver and
one for a front passenger. The airbags are
stored in the outer edges of the seatbacks. Both are marked SIDE AIRBAG.
side curtain airbags, one for each
side of the vehicle. The airbags are stored
in the ceiling, above the side windows.
The front and rear pillars are marked
SIDE CURTAIN AIRBAG.
d An
electronic control unit that, when the
power mode is in ON, continually
monitors information about the various
impact sensors, seat and buckle sensors,
rollover sensor, airbag activators, seat
belt tensioners and other vehicle
information. During a crash event the
unit can record such information.
e Automatic
front seat belt tensioners. In
addition, the driver's and front
passenger's seat belt buckles incorporate
sensors that detect whether or not the
belts are fastened.
fA
driver's seat position sensor. This
sensor determines the optimal force at
which the airbag will deploy in a crash.
c Two
46
g Weight
sensors in the front passenger’s
seat. The front passenger’s airbag will be
turned off if the weight on the seat is
approximately 65 lbs (29 kg) or less (the
weight of an infant or small child).
h Impact
sensors that can detect a
moderate-to-severe front or side impact.
i An indicator on the dashboard that alerts
you that the front passenger’s front
airbag has been turned off.
j An indicator on the instrument panel that
alerts you to a possible problem with your
airbag system or seat belt tensioners.
k Safing
lA
Sensor
rollover sensor that can detect if your
vehicle is about to roll over and signal the
control unit to deploy both side curtain
airbags.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 47 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAirbagsuAirbag System Components
■ Important Facts About Your Airbags
What you should do: Always wear your seat belt properly, and sit upright and as
far back from the steering wheel as possible while allowing full control of the
vehicle. A front passenger should move their seat as far back from the dashboard as
possible.
Do not attempt to deactivate your airbags. Together,
airbags and seat belts provide the best protection.
When driving, keep hands and arms out of the
deployment path of the front airbag by holding each
side of the steering wheel. Do not cross an arm over
the airbag cover.
Safe Driving
Airbags can pose serious hazards. To do their job, airbags must inflate with
tremendous force. So, while airbags help save lives, they can cause burns, bruises,
and other minor injuries, sometimes even fatal ones if occupants are not wearing
their seat belts properly and sitting correctly.
1Important Facts About Your Airbags
Remember, however, that no safety system can prevent all injuries or deaths that
can occur in a severe crash, even when seat belts are properly worn and the airbags
deploy.
Do not place hard or sharp objects between yourself and a front airbag.
Carrying hard or sharp objects on your lap, or driving with a pipe or other sharp
object in your mouth, can result in injuries if your front airbag inflates.
Do not attach or place objects on the front airbag covers. Objects on the
covers marked SRS AIRBAG could interfere with the proper operation of the airbags
or be propelled inside the vehicle and hurt someone if the airbags inflate.
47
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 48 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAirbagsuTypes of Airbags
Types of Airbags
Safe Driving
Your vehicle is equipped with three types of airbags:
• Front airbags: Airbags in front of the driver’s and front passenger’s seats.
• Side airbags: Airbags in the driver’s and front passenger’s seat-backs.
• Side curtain airbags: Airbags above the side windows.
Each is discussed in the following pages.
1Types of Airbags
The airbags can inflate whenever the power mode is
in ON.
After an airbag inflates in a crash, you may see a
small amount of smoke. This is from the combustion
process of the inflator material and is not harmful.
People with respiratory problems may experience
some temporary discomfort. If this occurs, get out of
the vehicle as soon as it is safe to do so.
Front Airbags (SRS)
The front SRS airbags inflate in a moderate-to-severe frontal collision to help protect
the head and chest of the driver and/or front passenger.
SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) indicates that the airbags are designed to
supplement seat belts, not replace them. Seat belts are the occupant’s primary
restraint system.
■ Housing Locations
The front airbags are housed in the center of the steering wheel for the driver, and
in the dashboard for the front passenger. Both airbags are marked SRS AIRBAG.
48
1Front Airbags (SRS)
During a frontal crash severe enough to cause one or
both front airbags to deploy, the airbags can inflate
at different rates, depending on the severity of the
crash, whether or not the seat belts are latched, and/
or other factors. Frontal airbags are designed to
supplement the seat belts to help reduce the
likelihood of head and chest injuries in frontal
crashes.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 49 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAirbagsuFront Airbags (SRS)
■ Operation
Safe Driving
Front airbags are designed to inflate during moderate-to-severe frontal collisions.
When the vehicle decelerates suddenly, the sensors send information to the control
unit which signals one or both front airbags to inflate.
A frontal collision can be either head-on or angled between two vehicles, or when a
vehicle crashes into a stationary object, such as a concrete wall.
■ How the Front Airbags Work
1How the Front Airbags Work
While your seat belt restrains your torso, the
front airbag provides supplemental protection
for your head and chest.
The front airbags deflate immediately so that
they won’t interfere with the driver’s visibility
or the ability to steer or operate other
controls.
Although the driver’s and front passenger’s airbags
normally inflate within a split second of each other, it
is possible for only one airbag to deploy. This can
happen if the severity of a collision is at the margin,
or threshold that determines whether or not the
airbags will deploy. In such cases, the seat belt will
provide sufficient protection, and the supplemental
protection offered by the airbag would be minimal.
The total time for inflation and deflation is so fast that most occupants are not
aware that the airbags deployed until they see them lying in front of them.
Continued
49
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 50 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAirbagsuFront Airbags (SRS)
■ When front airbags should not deploy
Safe Driving
50
Minor frontal crashes: Front airbags were designed to supplement seat belts and
help save lives, not to prevent minor scrapes, or even broken bones that might occur
during a less than moderate-to-severe frontal crash.
Side impacts: Front airbags can provide protection when a sudden deceleration
causes a driver or front passenger to move toward the front of the vehicle. Side
airbags and side curtain airbags have been specifically designed to help reduce the
severity of injuries that can occur during a moderate-to-severe side impact which
can cause the driver or passenger to move toward the side of the vehicle.
Rear impacts: Head restraints and seat belts are your best protection during a rear
impact. Front airbags cannot provide any significant protection and are not designed
to deploy in such collisions.
Rollovers: In a rollover, your best form of protection is a seat belt or, if your vehicle
is equipped with a rollover sensor, both a seat belt and a side curtain airbag. Front
airbags, however, are not designed to deploy in a rollover as they would provide
little if any protection.
■ When front airbags deploy with little or no visible damage
Because the airbag system senses sudden deceleration, a strong impact to the
vehicle framework or suspension might cause one or more of the airbags to deploy.
Examples include running into a curb, the edge of a hole, or other low fixed object
that causes a sudden deceleration in the vehicle chassis. Since the impact is
underneath the vehicle, damage may not be readily apparent.
■ When front airbags may not deploy, even though exterior damage
appears severe
Since crushable body parts absorb crash energy during an impact, the amount of
visible damage does not always indicate proper airbag operation. In fact, some
collisions can result in severe damage but no airbag deployment because the airbags
would not have been needed or would not have provided protection even if they
had deployed.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 51 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAirbagsuFront Airbags (SRS)
■ Advanced Airbags
1Advanced Airbags
If there is a problem with the driver's seat position
sensor, the SRS indicator will come on, and in the
event of a crash, the airbag will deploy (regardless of
the driver's seating position) with a force
corresponding to the severity of the impact.
Based on information from this sensor and the
severity of the impact, the advanced airbag
system determines the optimal deployment of
the driver's airbag.
• Do not spill any liquid on or under the seats.
• Do not put any object under the passenger’s seat.
• Make sure any objects are positioned properly on
Driver’s
Seat
Position
Sensor
The front passenger's advanced airbag system
has weight sensors.
Passenger’s
Seat
Weight
Sensors
We advise against allowing a child age 12 or
under to ride in the front passenger's seat.
However, if you do allow a child age 12 or
under to ride in the front passenger's
seat, note that the system will automatically
turn off the front passenger's airbag if the
sensors detect that the child is approximately
65 lbs (29 kg) or less.
For the advanced airbags to work properly:
Safe Driving
The airbags have advanced features to help reduce the likelihood of airbag related
injuries to smaller occupants.
The driver’s advanced airbag system includes a
seat position sensor.
the floor. Improperly positioned objects can
interfere with the advanced airbag sensors.
• All occupants should sit upright and wear their seat
belts properly.
• Do not cover the passenger's side dashboard with
a cloth, towel, cover, etc.
2 Passenger Front Airbag Off Indicator P. 56
Make sure the floor mat behind the front passenger’s
seat is hooked to the floor mat anchor. An improperly
placed mat can interfere with the advanced airbag
sensors.
2 Floor Mats P. 603
51
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 52 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAirbagsuSide Airbags
Side Airbags
The side airbags help protect the torso and pelvis of the driver or a front passenger
during a moderate-to-severe side impact.
Safe Driving
■ Housing Locations
The side airbags are housed in the outside
edge of the driver’s and passenger’s seatbacks.
Both are marked SIDE AIRBAG.
Housing
Location
■ Operation
When
inflated
Side
Airbag
52
When the sensors detect a moderate-tosevere side impact, the control unit signals the
side airbag on the impact side to immediately
inflate.
1Side Airbags
Make sure you and your front seat passenger always
sit upright. Leaning into the path of a side airbag can
prevent the airbag from deploying properly and
increases your risk of serious injury.
Do not attach accessories on or near the side airbags.
They can interfere with the proper operation of the
airbags, or hurt someone if an airbag inflates.
Do not cover or replace the front seat-back covers
without consulting a dealer. Improperly replacing or
covering front seat-back covers can prevent your side
airbags from properly deploying during a side impact.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 53 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAirbagsuSide Airbags
■ When a side airbag may not deploy, even though visible damage appears
severe
It is possible for a side airbag not to deploy during an impact that results in
apparently severe damage. This can occur when the point of impact was toward the
far front or rear of the vehicle, or when the vehicle’s crushable body parts absorbed
most of the crash energy. In either case, the side airbag would not have been
needed nor provided protection even if it had deployed.
Safe Driving
■ When a side airbag deploys with little or no visible damage
Because the airbag system senses sudden acceleration, a strong impact to the side
of the vehicle’s framework can cause a side airbag to deploy. In such cases, there
may be little or no damage, but the side impact sensors detected a severe enough
impact to deploy the airbag.
53
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 54 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAirbagsuSide Curtain Airbags
Side Curtain Airbags
Safe Driving
The side curtain airbags help protect the heads of the driver and passengers in the
outer seating positions during a moderate-to-severe side impact. The side curtain
airbags equipped in this vehicle are also designed to help reduce the likelihood of
partial and complete ejection of vehicle occupants through side windows in crashes,
particularly rollover crashes.
■ Housing Locations
The side curtain airbags are located in the
ceiling above the side windows on both sides
of the vehicle.
1Side Curtain Airbags
To get the best protection from the side curtain
airbags, occupants should wear their seat belts
properly and sit upright and well back in their seats.
Do not attach any objects to the side windows or roof
pillars as they can interfere with the proper operation
of the side curtain airbags.
If the SRS control unit senses that your vehicle is
about to rollover, it immediately deploys both side
curtain airbags and activates both front seat belt
tensioners.
If the impact is on the passenger's side, the
passenger's side curtain airbag deploys even if there
are no occupants on that side of the vehicle.
Side Curtain Airbag Storage
■ Operation
The side curtain airbag is designed to deploy
in a rollover or a moderate-to-severe side
impact.
Deployed Side Curtain Airbag
54
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 55 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAirbagsuAirbag System Indicators
■ When side curtain airbags deploy in a frontal collision
One or both side curtain airbags may also inflate in a moderate-to-severe angled
frontal collision.
Safe Driving
Airbag System Indicators
If a problem occurs in the airbag system, the SRS indicator will come on and a
message appears on the driver information interface.
■ Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Indicator
1Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Indicator
■ When the power mode is set to ON
The indicator comes on for a few seconds,
then goes off. This tells you the system is
working properly.
If the indicator comes on at any other time, or
does not come on at all, have the system
checked by a dealer as soon as possible. If you
don’t, your airbags and seat belt tensioners
may not work properly when they are needed.
Continued
3 WARNING
Ignoring the SRS indicator can result in
serious injury or death if the airbag systems
or tensioners do not work properly.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer as
soon as possible if the SRS indicator alerts
you to a possible problem.
55
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 56 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAirbagsuAirbag System Indicators
■ Passenger Front Airbag Off Indicator
U.S.
Canada
■ When the passenger front airbag off
Safe Driving
indicator comes on
The indicator comes on to alert you that the
passenger's front airbag has been turned off.
This occurs when the weight sensors detect
about 65 lbs (29 kg) or less, the weight of an
infant or small child, on the seat.
Children age 12 or under should always ride properly restrained in a back seat.
1Passenger Front Airbag Off Indicator
If the indicator comes on with no front passenger and
no objects on the passenger's seat, or with an adult
riding there, something may be interfering with the
weight sensor, such as:
• An object hanging on the seat or in the seat-back
pocket.
• A child seat or other object pressing against the
rear of the seat-back.
• A rear passenger pushing or pulling on the back of
the front passenger's seat.
• The front seat or seat-back is forced back against
an object on the seat or floor behind it.
• An object placed under the front passenger's seat.
2 Child Safety P. 58
Objects placed on the seat can also cause the indicator to come on.
If the front passenger's seat is empty, the passenger's front airbag will not deploy
and the indicator will not come on.
56
If none of these conditions exist, have your vehicle
checked by a dealer as soon as possible.
The passenger front airbag off indicator may come
on and go off repeatedly if the total weight on the
seat is near the airbag cutoff threshold.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 57 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAirbagsuAirbag Care
Airbag Care
You do not need to, and should not, perform any maintenance on or replace any
airbag system components yourself. However, you should have your vehicle
inspected by a dealer in the following situations:
We recommend against the use of salvaged airbag
system components, including the airbag, tensioners,
sensors, and control unit.
Safe Driving
■ When the airbags have deployed
If an airbag has inflated, the control unit and other related parts must be replaced.
Similarly, once an automatic seat belt tensioner has been activated, it must be
replaced.
1Airbag Care
■ When the vehicle has been in a moderate-to-severe collision
Even if the airbags did not inflate, have your dealer inspect the following: the driver’s
seat position sensor, weight sensors in the passenger’s seat, front seat belt
tensioners, and each seat belt that was worn during the crash.
■ Do not remove or modify a front seat without consulting a dealer
This would likely disable or affect the proper operation of the driver’s seat position
sensor or the weight sensors in the passenger’s seat. If it is necessary to remove or
modify a front seat to accommodate a person with disabilities, contact a Honda
dealer, or for U.S. vehicles, American Honda Automobile Customer Service at 1-800999-1009 and for Canadian vehicles, Honda Canada Customer Relations at 1-8889-HONDA-9.
57
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 58 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Child Safety
Protecting Child Passengers
Each year, many children are injured or killed in vehicle crashes because they are
either unrestrained or not properly restrained. In fact, vehicle crashes are the
number one cause of death of children ages 12 and under.
Safe Driving
To reduce the number of child deaths and injuries, every state, Canadian province
and territory requires that infants and children be properly restrained when they ride
in a vehicle.
Children should sit properly restrained in a rear seat. This is because:
• An inflating front or side airbag can injure
or kill a child sitting in the front seat.
• A child in the front seat is more likely to
interfere with the driver’s ability to safely
control the vehicle.
• Statistics show that children of all sizes and
ages are safer when they are properly
restrained in a rear seat.
58
1Protecting Child Passengers
3 WARNING
Children who are unrestrained or
improperly restrained can be seriously
injured or killed in a crash.
Any child too small for a seat belt should be
properly restrained in a child seat. A larger
child should be properly restrained with a
seat belt, using a booster seat if necessary.
The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration
and Transport Canada recommend that all children
ages 12 and under be properly restrained in a rear
seat. Some states or provinces/territories have laws
restricting where children may ride.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 59 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuChild SafetyuProtecting Child Passengers
• Never hold a child on your lap because it is impossible to protect them in the
event of a collision.
• Never let two children use the same seat belt. Both children could be very
seriously injured in a crash.
• Any child who is too small to wear a seat belt correctly must be restrained in an
approved child seat that is properly secured to the vehicle using either the seat
belt or the lower anchors of the LATCH system.
• Do not allow children to operate the doors, windows or seat adjustments.
• Do not leave children in the vehicle unattended, especially in hot weather when
the inside of the vehicle can get hot enough to kill them. They could also activate
vehicle controls causing it to move unexpectedly.
3 WARNING
Allowing a child to play with a seat belt or
wrap one around their neck can result in
serious injury or death.
Instruct children not to play with any seat
belt and make sure any unused seat belt a
child can reach is buckled, fully retracted,
and locked.
Safe Driving
• Never put a seat belt over yourself and a child. During a crash, the belt would
likely press deep into the child and cause serious or fatal injuries.
1Protecting Child Passengers
To deactivate a lockable retractor, release the buckle
and allow the seat belt to wind up all the way.
To remind you of the passenger’s front airbag
hazards and child safety, your vehicle has warning
labels on the dashboard (U.S. models) and on the
front visors. Please read and follow the instructions
on these labels.
2 Safety Labels P. 74
59
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 60 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
Safety of Infants and Small Children
■ Protecting Infants
Safe Driving
An infant must be properly restrained in a rear-facing, reclining child seat until the
infant reaches the seat manufacturer’s weight or height limit for the seat, and the
infant is at least one year old.
■ Positioning a rear-facing child seat
Child seats must be placed and secured in a
rear seating position.
1Protecting Infants
3 WARNING
Placing a rear-facing child seat in the front
seat can result in serious injury or death
during a crash.
Always place a rear-facing child seat in the
rear seat, not the front.
Many experts recommend use of a rear-facing seat
for a child up to two years old if the child’s height and
weight are appropriate for a rear-facing seat.
When properly installed, a rear-facing child seat may prevent the driver or a front
passenger from moving their seat all the way back, or from locking their seat-back
in the desired position. Make sure that there is no contact between the child seat
and the seat in front of it.
It can also interfere with proper operation of the passenger’s advanced front airbag
system.
2 Airbags P. 45
If this occurs, we recommend that you install the child seat directly behind the front
passenger’s seat, move the seat as far forward as needed, and leave it unoccupied.
Or, you may wish to get a smaller rear-facing child seat.
60
Rear-facing child seats should never be installed in a
forward-facing position.
Always refer to the child seat manufacturer’s
instructions before installation.
Do not allow a front seat to rest against a child seat
installed in a rear seating position:
The weight sensor in the front seat may not correctly
detect the actual weight of the occupant.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 61 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Protecting Smaller Children
1Protecting Smaller Children
3 WARNING
Placing a forward-facing child seat in the
front seat can result in serious injury or
death if the front airbag inflates.
If you must place a forward-facing child
seat in front, move the vehicle seat as far
back as possible, and properly restrain the
child.
Safe Driving
If a child is at least one year old and has exceeded the weight and height limitations
of a rearward-facing child seat, the child should be properly restrained in a firmly
secured forward-facing child seat until they exceed the weight and height
limitations for the forward-facing child seat.
■ Forward-facing child seat placement
We strongly recommend placing a forwardfacing child seat in a rear seating position.
Educate yourself about the laws and regulations
regarding child seat use where you are driving, and
follow the child seat manufacturer’s instructions.
Placing a forward-facing child seat in the front seat can be hazardous, even with
advanced front airbags that automatically turn the passenger’s front airbag off. A
rear seat is the safest place for a child.
Continued
61
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 62 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Selecting a Child Seat
Safe Driving
Most child seats are LATCH-compatible (Lower Anchors and Tethers for CHildren).
Some have a rigid-type connector while others have a flexible-type connector. Both
are equally easy to use. Some existing and previously owned child seats can only be
installed using the seat belt. Whichever type you choose, follow the child seat
manufacturer’s use and care instructions including recommended expiration dates
as well as the instructions in this manual. Proper installation is key to maximizing
your child’s safety.
In seating positions and vehicles not equipped with LATCH, a LATCH-compatible
child seat can be installed using the seat belt and a top tether for added security.
This is because all child seats are required to be designed so that they can be secured
with a lap belt or the lap part of a lap/shoulder belt. In addition, the child seat
manufacturer may advise that a seat belt be used to attach a LATCH-compatible seat
once a child reaches a specified weight. Please read the child seat owner’s manual
for proper installation instructions.
■ Important consideration when selecting a child seat
Make sure the child seat meets the following three requirements:
• The child seat is the correct type and size for the child.
• The child seat is the correct type for the seating position.
• The child seat is compliant with Federal Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213 or
Canadian Motor Vehicle Safety Standard 213.
62
1Selecting a Child Seat
Installation of a LATCH-compatible child seat is
simple.
LATCH-compatible child seats have been developed
to simplify the installation process and reduce the
likelihood of injuries caused by incorrect installation.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 63 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Installing a LATCH-Compatible Child Seat
Safe Driving
A LATCH-compatible child seat can be installed in the rear seats. A child seat is
attached to the lower anchors with either the rigid or flexible type of connectors.
1. Locate the lower anchors under the marks.
Marks
Continued
63
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 64 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
Lower
Anchors
Safe Driving
Rigid Type
Lower
Anchors
Flexible Type
64
2. Place the child seat on the vehicle seat, then
attach the child seat to the lower anchors
according to the instructions that came
with the child seat.
u When installing the child seat, make sure
that the lower anchors are not
obstructed by the seat belt or any other
object.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 65 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
Tether Strap Hook
Outer positions
1Installing a LATCH-Compatible Child Seat
Anchor
3 WARNING
Never attach two child seats to the same
anchor. In a collision, one anchor may not
be strong enough to hold two child seat
attachments and may break, causing
serious injury or death.
Safe Driving
3. Slide the seat forward.
4. Put the outer head restraint to it's
uppermost position, then route the tether
strap between the head restraint legs, and
secure the tether strap hook onto the
anchor.
Make sure the strap is not twisted.
Center position
3. Slide the seat forward.
4. Put the center head restraint to it's lowest
position, then route the tether strap over
the top of the head restraint and secure the
tether strap hook onto the anchor.
Make sure the strap is not twisted.
For your child’s safety, when using a child seat
installed using the LATCH system, make sure that the
child seat is properly secured to the vehicle. A child
seat that is not properly secured will not adequately
protect a child in a crash and may cause injury to the
child or other vehicle occupants.
All positions
5. Tighten the tether strap as instructed by the
child seat manufacturer.
6. Slide the seat backward.
7. Make sure the child seat is firmly secured by
rocking it forward and back and side to
side; little movement should be felt.
8. Make sure any unused seat belt that a child
can reach is buckled, the lockable retractor
is activated, and the belt is fully retracted
and locked.
2 Protecting Child Passengers P. 58
Continued
65
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 66 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt
Safe Driving
A child seat can be installed with a lap/shoulder belt in any rear seat or, if absolutely
necessary, the front passenger seat.
1. Place the child seat on the vehicle seat.
Outer positions
2. Slide the seat forward.
3. Put the outer head restraint to it's
uppermost position, then route the tether
strap between the head restraint legs, and
secure the tether strap hook onto the
anchor.
Make sure the strap is not twisted.
Center position
Tether Strap Hook
2. Slide the seat forward.
3. Put the center head restraint to it's lowest
position, then route the tether strap over
the top of the head restraint and secure
the tether strap hook onto the anchor.
Make sure the strap is not twisted.
All positions
Anchor
66
4. Tighten the tether strap as instructed by
the child seat manufacturer.
1Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt
A child seat that is not properly secured will not
adequately protect a child in a crash and may cause
injury to the child or other vehicle occupants.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 67 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
Continued
Safe Driving
5. Slide the seat backward.
6. Route the seat belt through the child seat
according to the seat manufacturer’s
instructions, and insert the latch plate into
the buckle.
u Insert the latch plate fully until it clicks.
7. Slowly pull the shoulder part of the belt all
the way out until it stops. This activates
the lockable retractor.
8. Let the seat belt retract a few inches and
check that the retractor has switched
modes by pulling on the webbing. It
should not pull out again until it is reset by
removing the latch plate from the buckle.
u If you are able to pull the shoulder belt
out, the lockable retractor is not
activated. Slowly pull the seat belt all
the way out, and repeat steps 7-8.
67
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 68 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
Safe Driving
9. Grab the shoulder part of the seat belt
near the buckle, and pull up to remove
any slack from the lap part of the belt.
u When doing this, place your weight on
the child seat and push it into the
vehicle seat.
10. Make sure the child seat is firmly secured
by rocking it forward and back and side to
side; less than one inch of movement
should occur near the seat belt.
11. Make sure any unused seat belt that a
child can reach is buckled, the lockable
retractor is activated, and the belt is fully
retracted and locked.
2 Protecting Child Passengers P. 58
68
1Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Seat Belt
To deactivate a lockable retractor, release the buckle
and allow the seat belt to wind up all the way.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 69 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
■ Adding Security with a Tether
A tether anchorage point is provided behind
each rear seating position.
If you have a child seat that comes with a
tether but can be installed with a seat belt, the
tether may be used for additional security.
Continued
Always use a tether for forward facing child seats
when using the seat belt or lower anchors.
Safe Driving
Tether Anchorage Points
1Adding Security with a Tether
69
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 70 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Infants and Small Children
Tether Strap Hook
Safe Driving
Anchor
■ Using an outer anchor
1. Slide the seat forward.
2. Put the head restraint to it's upper-most
position, then route the tether strap
through the head restraint legs. Make sure
the strap is not twisted.
3. Secure the tether strap hook to the anchor.
4. Tighten the tether strap as instructed by the
child seat manufacturer.
5. Slide the seat backward, then confirm that
the tether strap is not loose.
■ Using the center anchor
1. Slide the seat forward.
2. Lower the head restraint to its lowest
position.
3. Route the tether strap over the head
restraint. Make sure the strap is not twisted.
4. Secure the tether strap hook to the anchor.
5. Tighten the tether strap as instructed by the
child seat manufacturer.
6. Slide the seat backward, then confirm that
the tether strap is not loose.
70
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 71 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Larger Children
Safety of Larger Children
■ Protecting Larger Children
1Safety of Larger Children
■ Checking Seat Belt Fit
When a child is too big for a child seat, secure the child in a rear seat using the lap/
shoulder seat belt. Have the child sit upright and all the way back, then answer the
following questions.
■ Checklist
• Do the child’s knees bend comfortably over
the edge of the seat?
• Does the shoulder belt cross between the
child’s neck and arm?
• Is the lap part of the seat belt as low as
possible, touching the child’s thighs?
• Will the child be able to stay seated like this
for the whole trip?
If you answer yes to all these questions, the child is ready to wear the lap/shoulder
seat belt correctly. If you answer no to any question, the child needs to ride on a
booster seat until the seat belt fits properly without a booster seat.
Continued
3 WARNING
Allowing a child age 12 or under to sit in
front can result in injury or death if the
passenger’s front airbag inflates.
If a larger child must ride in front, move the
vehicle seat as far to the rear as possible,
have the child sit up properly and wear the
seat belt properly, using a booster seat if
needed.
Safe Driving
The following pages give instructions on how to check proper seat belt fit, what kind
of booster seat to use if one is needed, and important precautions for a child who
must sit in front.
71
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 72 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuChild SafetyuSafety of Larger Children
■ Booster Seats
1Booster Seats
Safe Driving
If a lap/shoulder seat belt cannot be used
properly, position the child in a booster seat in
the rear seat. For the child’s safety, check that
the child meets the booster seat
manufacturer’s recommendations.
■ Protecting Larger Children - Final Checks
Your vehicle has a rear seat where children can be properly restrained. If you ever
have to carry a group of children, and a child must ride in front:
• Make sure you read and fully understand the instructions and safety information
in this manual.
• Move the front passenger seat as far back as possible.
• Have the child sit upright and well back in the seat.
• Check that the seat belt is properly positioned so that the child is secure in the
seat.
■ Monitoring child passengers
We strongly recommend that you keep an eye on child passengers. Even older, more
mature children sometimes need to be reminded to fasten their seat belts and sit up
properly.
72
When installing a booster seat, make sure to read the
instructions that came with it, and install the seat
accordingly.
There are high- and low-type booster seats. Choose a
booster seat that allows the child to wear the seat
belt correctly.
Some U.S. states and Canadian provinces and
territories require children to use a booster seat until
they reach a given age or weight (e.g. 6 years or 60
lbs). Be sure to check current laws in the state or
province, or territory where you intend to drive.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 73 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Exhaust Gas Hazard
Carbon Monoxide Gas
The engine exhaust from this vehicle contains carbon monoxide, a colorless,
odorless, and highly toxic gas. As long as you properly maintain your vehicle, carbon
monoxide gas will not get into the interior.
• The exhaust system is making an unusual noise.
• The exhaust system may have been damaged.
• The vehicle is raised for an oil change.
When you operate a vehicle with the tailgate open, airflow can pull exhaust gas into
the interior and create a hazardous condition. If you must drive with the tailgate
open, open all the windows and set the climate control system as shown below.
1. Select the fresh air mode.
2. Select the
mode.
3. Set the fan speed to high.
4. Set the temperature control to a comfortable setting.
3 WARNING
Carbon monoxide gas is toxic.
Breathing it can cause unconsciousness and
even kill you.
Avoid any enclosed areas or activities that
expose you to carbon monoxide.
Safe Driving
■ Have the exhaust system inspected for leaks whenever
1Carbon Monoxide Gas
An enclosed area such as a garage can quickly fill up
with carbon monoxide gas.
Do not run the engine with the garage door closed.
Even when the garage door is open, drive out of the
garage immediately after starting the engine.
Adjust the climate control system in the same manner if you sit in your parked
vehicle with the engine running.
73
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 74 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Safety Labels
Label Locations
These labels are in the locations shown. They warn you of potential hazards that can cause serious injury or death. Read these labels
carefully.
Safe Driving
If a label comes off or becomes hard to read (except for the U.S. dashboard label which may be removed by the owner), contact a dealer
for a replacement.
Sun Visor
U.S. models
Canadian models
Sun Visor
U.S. models only
Dashboard
U.S. models only
Radiator Cap
Air Conditioner System
U.S. models
74
Canadian models
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 75 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Instrument Panel
This chapter describes the buttons, indicators, and gauges that are used while driving.
Indicators ............................................ 76
Driver Information Interface Warning and
Information Messages...................... 91
Gauges and Displays
Gauges............................................ 104
Driver Information Interface ............. 105
75
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 76 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Indicators
Indicator
Instrument Panel
U.S.
Canada
(Red)
U.S.
Canada
(Amber)
76
Name
On/Blinking
Explanation
Message
• Comes on for a few seconds when • Comes on while driving - Make sure
you set the power mode to ON,
the parking brake is released. Check the
then goes off if the parking brake
brake fluid level.
2 What to do when the indicator
has been released.
comes on while driving P. 629
• Comes on when the parking brake
is applied, and goes off when it is • Comes on along with the ABS
Parking Brake
indicator - Have your vehicle checked
released.
and Brake
by a dealer.
• Comes on when the brake fluid
System Indicator
2 If the Brake System Indicator (Red)
level is low.
(Red)
Comes On P. 629
• Comes on if there is a problem
with the brake system.
• The beeper sounds and the
indicator comes on if you drive
with the parking brake not fully
released.
• Comes on for a few seconds when • Stays on constantly - Have your
you set the power mode to ON,
vehicle checked by a dealer.
then
goes
off.
•
With this indicator on, your vehicle still
Parking Brake
• Comes on if there is a problem
has normal braking ability.
and Brake
with
a
system
related
to
braking
System Indicator
other than the conventional brake
(Amber)
system.
U.S.
Canada
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 77 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
Explanation
Message
• Comes on when you set the
• Readiness codes are part of the on board
power mode to ON, and goes off
diagnostics for the emissions control
when the engine starts, or after
systems.
2 Testing of Readiness Codes P. 647
several seconds if the engine did
• Comes on while driving - Have your
not start. If “readiness codes”
vehicle checked by a dealer.
have not been set, it blinks five
• Blinks while driving - Stop in a safe
times before it goes off.
place where there are no flammable
• Comes on if there is a problem
objects. Stop the engine for 10 minutes
with the emissions control system.
or more, and wait for it to cool down.
• Blinks when a misfire in the
Then, take your vehicle to a dealer.
engine’s cylinders is detected.
Instrument Panel
Malfunction
Indicator Lamp
On/Blinking
2 If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp
Comes On or Blinks P. 628
• Comes on when you set the
• Comes on while driving - Turn off the
power mode to ON, and goes off
climate control system and rear defogger
Charging System
when the engine starts.
in order to reduce electricity
Indicator
• Comes on when the battery is not
consumption.
2 If the Charging System Indicator
charging.
Comes On P. 627
Gear Position
Indicator
• Indicates the current gear
selection.
M (sequential
• Comes on when the manual
mode) Indicator/
sequential shift mode is applied.
Sequential Mode
Gear Selection
Indicator
2 Shifting P. 460
—
2 Sequential Mode P. 466
—
Continued
77
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 78 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
Explanation
Instrument Panel
●
The indicated current gear selection
blinks if there is a problem with the
transmission system.
●
Avoid sudden start and acceleration, and
stop in a safe place immediately.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
●
All the gear positions may light for
several seconds, and go off.
●
When all the gear positions light,
immediately stop your vehicle in a safe
place.
Indicators go off if there is no problem.
However, even if they go off, take your
vehicle to a dealer for inspection.
●
Transmission
System
Indicator
●
●
The indicated current gear selection
or all the gear positions blink if
there is a problem with the
transmission system, and the
vehicle no longer moves.
●
Immediately stop in a safe place.
●
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
The indicated current gear selection
or all the gear positions blink if you
cannot select (P due to the
transmission system failure.
●
The engine can be activated as a
temporary measure.
2 Emergency Towing P. 636
2 If the Transmission Indicator Blinks
along with the Warning Message
P. 630
●
●
78
Set the parking brake when parking.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer
immediately.
Message
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 79 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
Explanation
Low Fuel
Indicator
• Comes on when the fuel reserve is • Comes on - Refuel your vehicle as soon
running low (approximately 2.5
as possible.
U.S. gal./9.5 Liter left).
• Blinks - Have your vehicle checked by a
• Blinks if there is a problem with
dealer.
the fuel gauge.
Anti-lock Brake
System (ABS)
Indicator
• Comes on for a few seconds when • Stays on constantly - Have your
you set the power mode to ON,
vehicle checked by a dealer. With this
then goes off.
indicator on, your vehicle still has normal
• If it comes on at any other time,
braking ability but no anti-lock function.
2 Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) P. 537
there is a problem with the ABS.
Instrument Panel
Seat Belt
Reminder
Indicator
• Comes on and the beeper sounds • The beeper stops and the indicator goes
if you are not wearing a seat belt
off when you and the front passenger
when you set the power mode to
fasten their seat belts.
ON.
• Stays on after you and/or the front
• If the front passenger is not
passenger has fastened the seat
wearing a seat belt, the indicator
belt(s) - A detection error may have
comes on a few seconds later.
occurred in the sensor. Have your vehicle
• Blinks while driving if either you
checked by a dealer.
2 Seat Belt Reminder P. 38
and/or the front passenger has not
fastened a seat belt. The beeper
sounds and the indicator blinks at
regular intervals.
Message
Continued
79
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 80 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
Message
Instrument Panel
• Comes on for a few seconds when • Stays on constantly or does not come
you set the power mode to ON,
on at all - Have your vehicle checked by
then goes off.
a dealer.
Supplemental
• Comes on if a problem with any of
Restraint System
the following is detected:
Indicator
- Supplemental restraint system
- Side airbag system
- Side curtain airbag system
- Seat belt tensioner
• Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON,
then goes off.
Auto High-Beam
• Comes on when all the operating
Indicator
conditions of the Auto high-beam
are met.
●
Vehicle Stability
Assist® (VSA®)
System Indicator
80
Explanation
●
●
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON,
then goes off.
Blinks when VSA®, or trailer
stability assist is active.
Comes on if there is a problem
with the VSA®, hill start assist,
trailer stability assist or brake
lighting system.
2 Auto High-Beam P. 174
●
Stays on constantly - Have your vehicle
checked by a dealer.
2 Vehicle Stability Assist® (VSA®), aka
Electronic Stability Control (ESC),
System P. 477
2 Trailer Stability Assist P. 447
2 Hill start assist system P. 457
●
When Trailer Stability Assist Problem
is displayed on the Driver Information
Interface, the VSA® does not activate.
—
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 81 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
●
Comes on when VSA® OFF switch
is pressed.
●
Message
—
—
Appears when Normal or Snow mode is
selected.
Instrument Panel
●
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON,
then goes off.
Explanation
2 VSA® On and Off P. 478
Vehicle Stability
Assist® (VSA®)
OFF Indicator
AWD models
●
Comes on when Mud/Sand mode
is selected by pressing Intelligent
Traction Management System
switch.
AWD models
●
•
Electric Power
Steering (EPS)
System Indicator •
* Not available on all models
Comes on when VSA® OFF switch
is pressed.
Comes on when you set the
power mode to ON, and goes off
when the engine starts.
Comes on if there is a problem
with the EPS system.
●
Appears when Mud mode is selected.
2 Intelligent Traction Management *
P. 475
●
Appears when Sand mode is selected.
2 Intelligent Traction Management *
P. 475
●
Appears when Mud or Sand mode is
selected.
2 VSA® On and Off P. 478
• Stays on constantly or does not
come on at all - Have your vehicle
checked by a dealer.
2 If the Electric Power Steering (EPS)
System Indicator Comes On P. 629
Continued
81
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 82 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
Instrument Panel
Low Tire
Pressure/TPMS
Indicator
On/Blinking
Message
• Comes on for a few seconds when • Comes on while driving - Stop in a
you set the power mode to ON,
safe place, check tire pressures, and
then goes off.
inflate the tire(s) if necessary.
• Comes on if the tire pressure of
any of the tires becomes
significantly low.
• Blinks for about one minute, and • Blinks and remains on - Have your
then stays on if there is a problem
vehicle checked by a dealer. If the vehicle
with the TPMS with Tire Fill Assist,
is fitted with a compact spare, get your
or when a compact spare tire is
regular tire repaired or replaced and put
temporarily installed.
back on your vehicle as soon as you can.
• Blinks when you operate the turn
Turn Signal and
signal lever.
Hazard Warning • Blink along with all turn signals
when you press the hazard
Indicators
warning button.
82
Explanation
• Does not blink or blinks rapidly
2 Replacing Light Bulbs P. 581, 582
—
High Beam
Indicator
• Comes on when the high beam
headlights are on.
Lights On
Indicator
• Comes on when the light switch in • If you set the power mode to
a position other than OFF or when
ACCESSORY or VEHICLE OFF while the
the switch is set to AUTO and the
exterior lights are on, a chime sounds
exterior lights come on.
when the driver’s door is opened.
—
—
—
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 83 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
Fog Light
Indicator
Explanation
Message
• Comes on when the fog lights are
on.
—
—
• Comes on briefly when you set the • Blinks - You cannot start the engine. Set
power mode to ON, then goes off.
the power mode to VEHICLE OFF*1, then
select the ON mode again.
• Blinks if the immobilizer system
• Repeatedly blinks - The system may be
cannot recognize the key
Immobilizer
malfunctioning. Have your vehicle
information.
System Indicator
checked by a dealer.
• Do not attempt to alter this system or
add other devices to it. Electrical
problems can occur.
Indicator
Security System
Alarm Indicator
• Comes on briefly when you set the
power mode to ON, then goes off.
• Blinks when the security system
alarm has been set.
2 Security System Alarm P. 158
—
Instrument Panel
Indicator
On/Blinking
—
*1:Canadian models only: Apply and hold the brake pedal before selecting the ON mode.
Continued
83
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 84 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
Instrument Panel
• Comes on along with a beep
when a problem is detected. A
system message on the driver
information interface appears at
the same time.
System Message
Indicator
Econ Mode
Indicator
*1
*1
Intelligent
Traction
Management
Indicator
*1:AWD models
84
On/Blinking
* Not available on all models
• Comes on when the Econ mode is
on.
Explanation
Message
• While the indicator is on, press the
(home) button, select Warnings, then
press the ENTER button to see the
message again.
• Refer to the Indicators information in this
chapter when a system message appears
on the driver information interface. Take
the appropriate action for the message.
• The driver information interface does not
return to the normal screen unless the
warning is canceled, or the ENTER
button is pressed repeatedly.
—
2 ECON Mode P. 474
• Comes on when pressing the
Intelligent Traction Management
button.
2WD models
2 Intelligent Traction Management *
P. 475
AWD models
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 85 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
Auto Idle Stop
Indicator (Green)
• Comes on when Auto Idle Stop is
in operation. The engine
automatically shuts off.
2 Auto Idle Stop P. 468
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON,
then goes off.
—
Auto Idle Stop
• Comes on when Auto Idle Stop
System Indicator
system has been turned off by the
(Amber)
Auto Idle Stop OFF button.
• Blinks if there is a problem with
the Auto Idle Stop system.
●
●
All-wheel drive
(AWD)
Indicator *
●
Comes on for a few seconds when
you set the power mode to ON,
then goes off.
Comes on if there is a problem
with the AWD system.
Blinks when the differential
temperature is too high.
Message
—
—
2 Auto Idle Stop System ON/OFF
P. 469
Instrument Panel
●
Explanation
• Blinks - Have your vehicle checked by a
dealer.
●
Stays on constantly - The engine drives
the front wheels only in this state. Have
your vehicle checked by a dealer.
●
Blinks while driving - Stop in a safe
place, change to (P , and idle the engine
until the indicator goes off. If the
indicator does not stop blinking, take
your vehicle to a dealer.
2 Intelligent Variable Torque
Management (i-VTM4TM) AWD
System * P. 485
* Not available on all models
Continued
85
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 86 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Instrument Panel
86
Name
•
Lane Keeping
Assist System
(LKAS) Indicator
•
(Amber)
On/Blinking
Explanation
Message
Comes on for a few seconds when • Stays on constantly - Have your
you set the power mode to ON,
vehicle checked by a dealer.
then goes off.
Comes on if there is a problem
with the LKAS.
Lane Keeping
• Comes on when you press the
Assist System
MAIN button.
(LKAS) Indicator
(Green)
2 Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
P. 518
—
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 87 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
Explanation
Message
• Comes on when the RDM system
shuts itself off.
Road Departure
Mitigation
(RDM) Indicator
Instrument Panel
• Comes on for a few seconds when • Stays on constantly - Have your
you change the power mode to
vehicle checked by a dealer.
ON, then goes off.
• Comes on if there is a problem
with the RDM system.
• Stays on - The temperature inside the
camera is too high.
Use the climate control system to cool
down the camera.
The system activates when the
temperature inside the camera cools
down.
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 532
• Stays on - The area around the camera
is blocked by dirt, mud, etc. Stop your
vehicle in a safe place, and wipe it off
with a soft cloth.
• Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if
the indicator and message come back on
after you cleaned the area around the
camera.
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 532
Continued
87
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 88 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
Instrument Panel
Adaptive Cruise
Control (ACC)
Indicator
(Amber)
Explanation
Message
• Comes on for a few seconds when • Comes on while driving - Have your
you set the power mode to ON,
vehicle checked by a dealer.
then goes off.
• Comes on if there is a problem
with ACC.
Adaptive Cruise • Comes on when you press the
Control (ACC)
MAIN button.
Indicator (Green)
Collision
Mitigation
Braking
SystemTM
(CMBSTM)
Indicator
88
On/Blinking
2 Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
P. 505
• Comes on for a few seconds when • Stays on constantly without the
you change the power mode to
CMBSTM off - Have your vehicle checked
ON, then goes off.
by a dealer.
2 Collision Mitigation Braking
• Comes on when you deactivate
SystemTM (CMBSTM) P. 493
the CMBSTM. A driver information
interface message appears for five
seconds.
• Comes on if there is a problem
with the CMBSTM.
—
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 89 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsu
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
• Comes on when the CMBS
system shuts itself off.
Explanation
TM
Message
Instrument Panel
• Stays on - The temperature inside the
camera is too high. Use the climate
control system to cool down the camera.
The system activates when the
temperature inside the camera cools
down.
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 532
Collision
Mitigation
Braking
SystemTM
(CMBSTM)
Indicator
• Stays on - The area around the camera
is blocked by dirt, mud, etc. Stop your
vehicle in a safe place, and wipe it off
with a soft cloth.
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 532
• When the radar sensor gets dirty, stop
your vehicle in a safe place, and wipe off
dirt using a soft cloth.
• Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if
the indicator does not go off even after
you clean the sensor cover.
2 Radar Sensor P. 534
Continued
89
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 90 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsu
Models with Blind spot information System
Indicator
Name
On/Blinking
Explanation
• Stays on while blind spot
information system is turned off.
Instrument Panel
90
Blind spot
information
System Indicator
• Comes on when mud, snow, or ice • Comes on while driving - Remove the
accumulates in the vicinity of
obstacle in the vicinity of the sensor.
2 Blind spot information System *
sensor.
P. 480
• Comes on if there is a problem
with the system.
* Not available on all models
—
• Comes on while driving - Have your
vehicle checked by a dealer.
Message
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 91 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsuDriver Information Interface Warning and Information Messages
Driver Information Interface Warning and Information Messages
The following messages appear only on the driver information interface. Press the
ENTER button to see the message again with the system message indicator on.
Message
(home) button, select Warnings, then press the
Condition
Explanation
• Appears if any door or the tailgate is not completely • Goes off when all doors and the tailgate are closed.
closed.
Instrument Panel
• Appears when the hood is opened.
• Close the hood.
• Appears when the engine oil pressure is low.
• Appears while driving - Immediately stop in a safe
place.
2 If the Low Oil Pressure Warning Appears P. 627
• Appears when the washer fluid is low *.
• Refill the washer fluid.
2 Refilling Window Washer Fluid P. 578
Models with color audio system
• Appears while you are customizing the settings and
the transmission is in other than (P .
* Not available on all models
2 Vehicle Customization P. 119
Continued
91
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 92 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsuDriver Information Interface Warning and Information Messages
Message
Condition
Explanation
Instrument Panel
• Appears when the temperature of the transmission
is starting to get too hot.
• The performance of the vehicle may be reduced.
• Until the message disappears, reduce your speed and
allow the system to cool down.
• Appears if the battery charge becomes low.
• Charge the battery.
• Appears when there is a problem with the sensor on • Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
2 Checking the Battery P. 597
the battery.
• Appears along with the charging system indicator
when the battery is not charging.
• Turn off the climate control system and rear defogger
to reduce electricity consumption.
2 If the Charging System Indicator Comes On P. 627
92
• Appears when the scheduled maintenance is due
soon.
• Consequently, Maintenance Due Now and
Maintenance Past Due follow.
2 Maintenance Minder Messages on the Driver
Information Interface P. 563
• Appears when the engine coolant temperature gets
abnormally high.
2 Overheating P. 625
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 93 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsuDriver Information Interface Warning and Information Messages
Message
U.S.
Condition
Models with power tailgate
• Appears when there is a problem with the power
tailgate system.
Explanation
• Manually open or close the power tailgate.
• Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
U.S.
• Appears when the starter system has a problem.
• As a temporary measure, press and hold the ENGINE
START/STOP button for up to 15 seconds while
pressing the brake pedal and manually start the engine.
• Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
• Appears when the steering wheel is locked.
• Move the steering wheel left and right while pressing
the ENGINE START/STOP button.
Instrument Panel
Canada
Canada
Canada
• Appears when the power mode is in ACCESSORY.
—
Continued
93
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 94 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsuDriver Information Interface Warning and Information Messages
Message
Condition
Explanation
Instrument Panel
• Appears after the driver’s door is opened when the
power mode is in ACCESSORY.
• Change the power mode to VEHICLE OFF.
• Appears when you close the door with the power
mode in ON without the remote inside the vehicle.
• Disappears when you bring the remote back inside the
vehicle and close the door.
2 ENGINE START/STOP Button P. 165
2 Smart Entry Remote Reminder P. 167
• Appears when the remote battery becomes weak.
• Replace the battery as soon as possible.
2 Replacing the Button Battery P. 599
• Appears if the remote battery is too weak to start the • Bring the remote in front of the ENGINE START/STOP
engine or the key is not within operating range to
button to be touched with.
2 If the Smart Entry Remote Battery is Weak P. 620
start the engine.
A beeper sounds six times.
●
Appears three seconds after the To Start, Hold
Remote Near Start Button, then To Start Engine
messages appeared sequentially.
●
Unless you bring the smart entry remote in front of the
ENGINE START/STOP button, this message does not
appear.
2 If the Smart Entry Remote Battery is Weak P. 620
• Appears if there is a problem with the cooling
system.
Models with LED headlights
• Appears if there is a problem with the headlights.
94
• Drive slowly to prevent overheating and have your
vehicle checked by a dealer as soon as possible.
• Appears while driving - The headlights may not be
on. When conditions allow you to drive safety, have
your vehicle checked by a dealer as soon as possible.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 95 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsuDriver Information Interface Warning and Information Messages
Message
Condition
Models with parking sensor system
• Appears if there is a problem with the parking sensor
system.
Explanation
• Check if the area around the sensor(s) is covered with
mud, ice, snow, etc. If the indicator(s) stays on or the
beeper does not stop even after you clean the area,
have the system checked by a dealer.
• Check for obstacles near your vehicle to make sure it is
safe to park.
• Appears as soon as a problem is detected in the
smart entry system.
• Appears constantly - Have your vehicle checked by a
dealer.
Models with parking sensor system
Instrument Panel
• Appears if there are obstacles around the sensors.
• Appears as soon as a problem is detected in the push • Appears constantly - Have your vehicle checked by a
button starting system.
dealer.
●
Appears if you press the ENGINE START/STOP
button while the vehicle is moving.
• Appears if there is a problem with the Auto highbeam.
2 Emergency Engine Stop P. 621
• Manually operate the headlight switch.
• If you are driving with the high-beam headlights when
this happens, the headlights are changed to low beams.
• Appears when the area around the camera is
• Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if the message
blocked by dirt, mud, etc. Stop your vehicle in a safe
comes back on after you cleaned the area around the
place, and wipe it off with a soft cloth.
camera.
• May appear when driving in bad weather (rain,
snow, fog, etc.)
Continued
95
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 96 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsuDriver Information Interface Warning and Information Messages
Message
Condition
Explanation
• Flashes when the system senses a likely collision with • Take the appropriate means to prevent a collision (apply
a vehicle in front of you.
the brakes, change lanes, etc.)
Instrument Panel
2 Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
P. 493
2 Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) P. 505
• Appears when ACC has been automatically
canceled.
• You can resume the set speed after the condition that
caused ACC to cancel improves. Press the RES/+
button.
2 Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) P. 505
• Appears when pressing the –/SET button while the
vehicle is moving and the brake pedal is depressed.
• ACC cannot be set.
• Appears if the VSA® or traction control function
operates while ACC is in operation.
• ACC has been automatically canceled.
• Appears when the speed of the vehicle is too high
for you to set ACC.
• Reduce the speed, then set ACC.
• Appears when ACC is canceled due to excessive
vehicle speed.
• Reduce the speed, then reset ACC.
2 Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) P. 505
2 Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) P. 505
2 Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) P. 505
2 Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) P. 505
• Appears when the speed of the vehicle is too low for • Raise the speed, then set ACC.
2 Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) P. 505
you to set ACC.
96
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 97 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsuDriver Information Interface Warning and Information Messages
Message
Condition
Explanation
• Appears when ACC is canceled due to excessive low • Raise the speed, then reset ACC.
2 Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) P. 505
vehicle speed.
Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
• Keep the vehicle within the lane you are driving.
2 Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) P. 518
Road Departure Mitigation (RDM) System
• Keep the vehicle within the lane you are driving.
2 Road Departure Mitigation (RDM) System P. 527
• Appears when the vehicle is driving out of a detected
• You can change the setting for the road departure
lane.
mitigation system. Normal, Wide, and Warning Only
When you selected Warning Only
can be selected.
- The steering wheel vibrates rapidly when the
vehicle is drifting out of a detected lane.
When you selected Normal or Wide
- The steering wheel vibrates rapidly when the
vehicle is drifting out of a detected line. The system
also steers the vehicle to help you remain within
your driving lane.
Instrument Panel
• Appears when the vehicle is driving out of a detected
lane. The steering wheel vibrates rapidly.
Models with color audio system
2 Vehicle Customization P. 119
Models with Display Audio
2 Customized Features P. 359
• Blinks when you fail to steer the vehicle. The beeper • Operate the steering wheel to resume the LKAS.
sounds simultaneously.
Continued
97
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 98 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsuDriver Information Interface Warning and Information Messages
Message
Condition
Explanation
Instrument Panel
• Appears when the LKAS is in operation, or the LKAS • If any other system indicators come on, such as the
button is pressed, but there is a problem with a
VSA®, ABS and brake system, take appropriate action.
2 Indicators P. 76
system related to the LKAS. The LKAS cancels
automatically. The beeper sounds simultaneously if
selected by customization.
• Appears if the temperature inside the camera is too • Use the climate control system to cool down the
high and some driver assist systems cannot be
camera.
activated.
• Disappears - The camera has been cooled down and
the systems are activated normally.
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 532
• Appears if the area around the front sensor camera • When the front window gets dirty, stop your vehicle in
is blocked by dirt, mud, etc. and be prevented from
a safe place, and wipe it off with a soft cloth.
detecting a vehicle in front.
• Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if the message
• May appear when driving in bad weather (rain,
does not disappear even after you cleaned the area
snow, fog, etc.)
around the camera.
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 532
●
●
Appears if anything covers the radar sensor cover
and prevents the sensor from detecting a vehicle in
front.
May appear when driving in bad weather (rain,
snow, fog, etc.)
●
●
When the radar sensor gets dirty, stop your vehicle in a
safe place, and wipe off dirt using a soft cloth.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if the message
does not disappear even after you clean the sensor
cover.
2 Radar Sensor P. 534
98
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 99 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsuDriver Information Interface Warning and Information Messages
Message
Condition
●
Appears when the transmission system temperature
is too high. The vehicle does not operate properly.
Explanation
●
●
2 Starting the Engine P. 452
• Appears when the engine does not restart
automatically due to the following reason:
• The hood is open.
• There is a problem in the system that disables Auto
Idle Stop.
• Follow the normal procedure to start the engine.
• Appears when you attempt to change to another
gear position with the transmission in (P and the
engine OFF.
• To select another gear position while in (P , the engine
must be ON.
2 Starting the Engine P. 452
Instrument Panel
• Appears when you set the power mode to
ACCESSORY or ON.
Stop in a safe place in (P .
Let the engine idle until the message disappears.
• Appears when you set the power mode to OFF while • Immediately stop in a safe place, set the parking brake,
driving.
then restart the engine. If the message disappears,
continue driving.
●
Appears when you try to change the gear position
after the position has automatically been changed to
(P with the driver’s door open and the driver’s seat
belt unfastened.
●
Press the park button if you leave the vehicle.
Continued
99
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 100 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsuDriver Information Interface Warning and Information Messages
Message
Condition
Explanation
• Appears if the vehicle is stationary and the
• Press the (P button before releasing the brake pedal
transmission is put into (N , the driver's seatbelt is
when idling, parking or exiting the vehicle.
2 Shift Operation P. 462
unfastened, and the brake pedal is released, as there
is a risk that the vehicle might roll unexpectedly.
Instrument Panel
• Appears when the engine stops without the
transmission in (P , and does not restart
automatically.
• Appears if you open the hood while Auto Idle Stop
activates.
• Appears when you change to (N , then release the
(N button.
• Appears when you press and hold (N button for
more than two seconds.
• If you want to set the power mode to ON, change the
gear position to (P .
• If you want to start the engine, follow the normal
procedure.
2 Starting the Engine P. 452
2 If you want to keep the transmission in (N
position [car wash mode] P. 464
• Disappears when you set the gear position to other
than (N .
2 If you want to keep the transmission in (N
position [car wash mode] P. 464
100
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 101 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsuDriver Information Interface Warning and Information Messages
Message
Condition
Explanation
• Appears when car wash mode is not available due to • When transmission is too hot, car wash mode may not
hot transmission.
be available. Let the engine idle and cool down
transmission.
2 If you want to keep the transmission in (N
• Appears when you try to change the gear position
without depressing the brake pedal.
• Depress the brake pedal, then select a shift button.
• Appears when you try to change the gear position • Release your foot off the accelerator pedal, then select
without releasing your foot off the accelerator pedal.
a shift button.
Instrument Panel
position [car wash mode] P. 464
• Appears when the (P button is pressed while the
• Make sure that the vehicle comes to a stop before
vehicle is moving.
operating the select button.
• Appears if you change the gear position to (R while
the vehicle is moving forward, or to (D while the
vehicle is reversing.
• Appears when you set the power mode to ON
• Fasten the seat belt properly before you start to drive.
2 Shift Operation P. 462
without fastening the driver’s seat belt.
• Appears when you change the gear position after
(P has been automatically selected with the driver’s
door open, the driver’s seat belt unfastened, then
the brake pedal is released.
• Appears when you press the (P button but it is not • Depress the brake pedal until this message disappear.
engaged due to low ATF temperature.
Continued
101
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 102 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsuDriver Information Interface Warning and Information Messages
Message
Condition
• Appears when depressing the accelerator pedal
while the gear position is in (N .
Instrument Panel
• Appears when Auto Engine Idle Stop Guidance
Screens*1 or Auto Idle Stop Display ON*2 has
been selected from the customization menu.
• Appears when Auto Idle Stop does not activate for
some reason.
• Appears when the engine restarts automatically.
• Appears when the battery temperature is around
14°F (−10°C) or lower.
• Appears when Auto Idle Stop does not activate
because the climate control system is in use, and the
difference between the set temperature and actual
interior temperature becomes significant.
• Appears when Auto Idle Stop does not activate
because the engine coolant temperature is too low
or high.
• Appears when Auto Idle Stop does not activate
because the battery charge level is low.
*1:Models with color audio system
*2:Models with Display Audio
102
Explanation
• Remove your foot from the accelerator pedal. When
driving, depress the brake pedal and change the gear
position.
2 Auto Idle Stop P. 468
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 103 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicatorsuDriver Information Interface Warning and Information Messages
Message
Condition
Explanation
• Depress the brake pedal firmly.
• Appears when Auto Engine Idle Stop Guidance
Screens*1 or Auto Idle Stop Display ON*2 has
been selected from the customization menu.
• Appears when the system is under the following
conditions while Auto Idle Stop activates:
• The battery charge level is low.
• The battery temperature is around 14°F (−10°C)
or lower.
• The climate control system is in use, and the
difference between the set temperature and
actual interior temperature becomes significant.
• The humidity in the interior is high.
• The engine restarts automatically in a few seconds.
• Appears when you unlock and open the driver’s
door while the engine is running by remote engine
start.
2 Starting the Engine P. 452
Instrument Panel
• Appears when Auto Idle Stop does not activate
because the pressure to the brake pedal is not
enough.
2 Remote Engine Start P. 454
*1:Models with color audio system
*2:Models with Display Audio
103
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 104 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Gauges and Displays
Gauges
Gauges include the fuel gauge, temperature gauge, and related indicators. They are
displayed when the power mode is set to ON.
■ Fuel Gauge
Displays the amount of fuel left in the fuel tank.
Instrument Panel
104
1Fuel Gauge
NOTICE
You should refuel when the reading approaches E .
Running out of fuel can cause the engine to misfire,
damaging the catalytic converter.
The actual amount of remaining fuel may differ from
the fuel gauge reading.
■ Temperature Gauge
Displays the temperature of the engine coolant.
1Temperature Gauge
NOTICE
Driving with the temperature gauge pointer in the
upper zone can cause serious engine damage. Pull
safely to the side of the road and allow engine
temperature to return to normal.
2 Overheating P. 625
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 105 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGauges and DisplaysuDriver Information Interface
Driver Information Interface
The driver information interface displays the speedometer, tachometer, odometer,
trip computer, outside temperature, and other gauges. It also displays important
messages such as warnings and other helpful information.
■ Speedometer
1Speedometer
■ Tachometer
1Tachometer
You can turn on or off the tachometer display.
2 Show Tachometer P. 118
Shows the number of engine revolutions per minute.
Continued
Instrument Panel
You can set the speedometer and the displayed
measurements to read in either mph and km/h.
2 Units P. 114
Displays your driving speed in mph or km/h.
105
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 106 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGauges and DisplaysuDriver Information Interface
■ Odometer
Shows the total number of miles or kilometers
that your vehicle has accumulated.
Instrument Panel
Odometer
■ Outside Temperature
1Outside Temperature
Shows the outside temperature in Fahrenheit
(U.S.) or Celsius (Canada).
Outside Temperature
Adjusting the outside temperature
display
Adjust the temperature reading by up to ±5°F
or ±3°C if the temperature reading seems
incorrect.
Use the driver information interface * or audio/
information screen * to correct the
temperature.
Models with color audio system
2 Vehicle Customization P. 119
Models with Display Audio
2 Customized Features P. 359
106
* Not available on all models
The temperature sensor is in the front bumper.
Road heat and exhaust from another vehicle can
affect the temperature reading when your vehicle
speed is less than 19 mph (30 km/h).
It may take several minutes for the display to be
updated after the temperature reading has stabilized.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 107 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGauges and DisplaysuDriver Information Interface
■ Accessing Content
1Accessing Content
Press the
(home) button, then press the 3 / 4 button to scroll to the content
you want to see. Press the ENTER button to see detailed information.
To go back to the previous screen, press the
*1
*2
/
(back) button.
Instrument Panel
You can edit, add, or delete the meter contents using
the driver information interface.
2 Arrange Apps P. 117
2 Show/Hide Apps P. 116
*1: Models with color audio system
*2: Models with Display Audio
Continued
107
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 108 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGauges and DisplaysuDriver Information Interface
*
P. 111
P. 115
Instrument Panel
P. 116
Models with color audio system
3 / 4 Button
P. 109
P. 114
*
(Home) Button
Models with Display Audio
3 / 4 Button
P. 113
P. 117
*
P. 113
P. 112
(Home) Button
*
Press 3 or 4 .
108
* Not available on all models
P. 111
*
P. 114
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 109 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGauges and DisplaysuDriver Information Interface
■ Trip Computer
Press the ENTER button to switch between trip computer A and trip computer B.
Instrument Panel
Trip Computer A
Distance
Average Fuel
Economy
Range
Models with color audio system
Instant Fuel
Economy
ENTER
Trip Computer B
ENTER Button
Models with Display Audio
ENTER Button
Continued
109
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 110 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGauges and DisplaysuDriver Information Interface
■ Distance
Shows the total number of miles or kilometers driven since the last reset. Meters A
and B can be used to measure two separate trips.
1Distance
Switch between Distance A and Distance B by
pressing the ENTER button.
Instrument Panel
Resetting distance
To reset the Distance, display it and then press and hold the ENTER button until the
Distance is reset to 0.0.
■ Average fuel economy (Avg. Fuel)
Shows the estimated average fuel economy of each Distance in mpg or l/100 km.
The display is updated at set intervals. When a Distance is reset, the average fuel
economy is also reset.
1Average fuel economy (Avg. Fuel)
You can change when the average fuel economy is
reset.
Models with color audio system
2 Vehicle Customization P. 119
■ Instant fuel economy
Shows the instant fuel economy as a bar graph in mpg or l/100 km.
■ Range
Shows the estimated distance you can travel on the remaining fuel. This estimated
distance is based on the vehicle’s current fuel economy.
110
Models with Display Audio
2 Customized Features P. 359
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 111 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGauges and DisplaysuDriver Information Interface
■ Navigation
1Navigation
Models with Display Audio
Models with Display Audio
Display Audio shows you turn-by-turn
directions to your destination.
When the navigation system is not providing
driving guidance, an image of a compass
appears in the driver information interface.
You can select whether to have the turn-by-turn
display come on or not during the route guidance.
2 Customized Features P. 359
2 Refer to the navigation system
Instrument Panel
Models with navigation system
Turn-By-Turn Driving Directions
Turn-by-turn directions will be shown on the driver
information interface only when your android phone
is connected to Android AutoTM.
Compass
■ Warnings
1Warnings
2 Driver Information Interface Warning and
Information Messages P. 91
The Warnings app is dynamic and will only appear
when there are active warnings. If there are no
Warnings, this app will not be shown.
(Example)
Continued
111
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 112 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGauges and DisplaysuDriver Information Interface
■ Maintenance
Shows the current condition of the tire
pressure and the remaining oil life.
Instrument Panel
■ Tire Pressure
Shows the tire pressure of each tire.
2 Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
with Tire Fill Assist P. 486
■ Oil Life
Shows the remaining oil life and Maintenance
MinderTM.
2 Maintenance MinderTM P. 561
112
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 113 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGauges and DisplaysuDriver Information Interface
■ AWD Torque *
The indicators on the display show the
amount of torque being transferred to the
right front, left front, right rear, and left rear
wheels.
■ Phone *
Instrument Panel
2 Intelligent Variable Torque Management
(i-VTM4TM) AWD System * P. 485
Shows the current phone information.
2 Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® P. 381
* Not available on all models
Continued
113
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 114 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGauges and DisplaysuDriver Information Interface
■ Units
Enables you to set the speedometer and the
displayed measurements to read in either mph
or km/h.
Instrument Panel
Press and hold the ENTER button. Each time
you do this, the unit will change from mph to
km/h or vice versa. After this, a confirmation
screen will appear for a few seconds.
■ Now Playing *
Shows the current audio information.
2 Audio System Basic Operation P. 233
114
* Not available on all models
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 115 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGauges and DisplaysuDriver Information Interface
■ Audio Source *
Shows the current audio source.
2 Audio System Basic Operation P. 233
Instrument Panel
(Example)
* Not available on all models
Continued
115
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 116 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGauges and DisplaysuDriver Information Interface
■ Show/Hide Apps
Instrument Panel
You can show or hide the meter contents.
Select the content you wish to show or hide,
Shown
then press the ENTER button.
u Repeat it if you want to show or hide
more than one app.
Press ENTER
Hidden
116
* Not available on all models
1Show/Hide Apps
You cannot hide apps with the
side.
icon on the right
Selecting Default All in Vehicle Customization
does not restore these settings to their original state.
Models with Display Audio
You can also add the Android Auto, Apple
CarPlay, Sirius XM *, My Honda Music, USB, AM,
FM, Bluetooth Audio, Social Playlist and AUX
Input apps.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 117 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGauges and DisplaysuDriver Information Interface
■ Settings
Change the settings to your liking.
1Arrange Apps
Instrument Panel
■ Arrange Apps
You can change the order of the apps on the home screen.
1. Press the 3 / 4 button to select Arrange
Apps, then press the ENTER button.
2. Press the 3 / 4 button to select the icon
you want to move, then press the ENTER
button.
Selecting Default All in Vehicle Customization
does not restore these settings to their original state.
3. Press the 3 / 4 button repeatedly to move
the icon to your desired position, then press
the ENTER button.
Continued
117
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 118 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGauges and DisplaysuDriver Information Interface
■ Show Tachometer
You can show or hide the tachometer.
Press the 3 / 4 button to select Show
Tachometer, then press the ENTER button.
u The tachometer appears when the check
box is checked.
Instrument Panel
118
1Show Tachometer
Selecting Default All in Vehicle Customization
does not restore these settings to their original state.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 119 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGauges and DisplaysuDriver Information Interface
Models with color audio system
1Vehicle Customization
■ Vehicle Customization
Use the driver information interface to customize certain vehicle features.
Driver Information Interface:
Goes to Settings.
3 / 4 Button
Scroll through the menu
or items.
ENTER Button
Enters the selected
item.
Button
Goes back to the previous
screen.
Button
Goes to home
screen.
Continued
Change to (P before you attempt to change a
customized setting.
Instrument Panel
How to customize
First, make sure the vehicle is at a complete stop and that the power mode is set to
ON. Next, press the
(home) button, then press the 3 / 4 button to select
Settings. Finally, press the ENTER button.
To customize other features, press the 3 / 4 button.
2 List of customizable options P. 122
2 Example of how to customize a setting
P. 126
119
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 120 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGauges and DisplaysuDriver Information Interface
■ Customization flow
Press the
(home) button.
Settings
ENTER
3
4
Arrange Apps
P. 117
Show Tachometer
P. 118
Instrument Panel
Vehicle Customization
ENTER
Meter Setup
ENTER
3
4
Language Selection
Adjust Outside Temp. Display
“Trip A” Reset Timing
“Trip B” Reset Timing
3
4
Adjust Alarm Volume
Reverse Alert Tone
Fuel Efficiency Backlight
Auto Engine Idle Stop Guidance Screens
Door Unlock Mode
Keyless Access Setup
ENTER
3
4
Keyless Access Beep
Remote Start System ON/OFF
3
4
Driver Assist System
Setup
Keyless Access Light Flash
Forward Collision Warning Distance
ENTER
3
4
ACC Forward Vehicle Detect Beep
Road Departure Mitigation Setting
Lane Keeping Assist Suspend Beep
ENTER
120
3
4
3
4
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 121 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGauges and DisplaysuDriver Information Interface
3
4
Interior Light Dimming Time
Lighting Setup
ENTER
Auto Light Sensitivity
Auto Interior Illumination Sensitivity
Auto Headlight ON With Wiper ON
3
4
Instrument Panel
Headlight Auto OFF Timer
3
4
Auto Door Lock
Auto Door Unlock
Door Setup
ENTER
3
4
Key And Remote Unlock Mode
Keyless Lock Answer Back
ENTER
3
4
3
4
Security Relock Timer
Default All
3
4
Exit
Continued
121
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 122 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGauges and DisplaysuDriver Information Interface
■ List of customizable options
Setup Group
Instrument Panel
Meter Setup
Customizable Features
Selectable settings
Language Selection
Changes the displayed language.
Adjust Outside Temp.
Display
Adjusts the temperature reading by a few degrees.
“Trip A” Reset Timing
Changes the setting of how the distance and
average fuel economy of trip computer A is reset.
When Fully Refueled/IGN OFF/
Manually Reset*1
“Trip B” Reset Timing
Changes the setting of how the distance and
average fuel economy of trip computer B is reset.
When Fully Refueled/IGN OFF/
Manually Reset*1
Adjust Alarm Volume
Changes the volume setting for buzzers, warnings,
turn signals, and other alerting systems.
High/Mid*1/Low
Reverse Alert Tone
Causes the beeper to sound once when the gear
position is changed to (R .
ON*1/OFF
Fuel Efficiency
Backlight
Turns the ambient meter feature on and off.
ON*1/OFF
Auto Engine Idle Stop
Guidance Screens
Turns the engine idle-stop guidance displayed in the
meter display on and off during the auto engine idlestop system is in operation.
ON/OFF*1
*1:Default Setting
122
Description
English*1/Français/Español
−5°F ~ ±0°F*1 ~ +5°F (U.S.)
−3°C ~ ±0°C*1 ~ +3°C (Canada)
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 123 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGauges and DisplaysuDriver Information Interface
Setup Group
Driver Assist
System
Setup
Description
Selectable settings
Door Unlock Mode
Changes which doors unlock when you grab the
driver’s door handle.
Driver’s Door Only*1/All Doors
Keyless Access Light
Flash
Causes some exterior lights to flash when you unlock/
lock the doors.
ON*1/OFF
Keyless Access Beep
Causes the beeper to sound when you unlock/lock
the doors.
ON*1/OFF
Remote Start System
ON/OFF
Turns the remote engine start feature on and off.
ON*1/OFF
Forward Collision
Warning Distance
Changes the distance at which CMBSTM alerts.
Long/Normal*1/Short
ACC Forward Vehicle
Detect Beep
Causes the system to beep when the system detects a
vehicle, or when the vehicle goes out of ACC range.
ON/OFF*1
Road Departure
Mitigation Setting
Changes the setting for the road departure
mitigation system.
Normal*1/Wide/Warning Only
Lane Keeping Assist
Suspend Beep
Causes the system to beep when the LKAS is
suspended.
ON/OFF*1
Instrument Panel
Keyless
Access
Setup
Customizable Features
Continued
123
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 124 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGauges and DisplaysuDriver Information Interface
Setup Group
Instrument Panel
Lighting
Setup
Customizable Features
Selectable settings
Interior Light
Dimming Time
Changes the length of time the interior lights stay on
after you close the doors.
60sec/30sec*1/15sec
Headlight Auto OFF
Timer
Changes the length of time the exterior lights stay
on after you close the driver’s door.
60sec/30sec/15sec*1/0sec
Auto Light Sensitivity
Changes the timing for the headlights to come on.
Max/High/Mid*1/Low/Min
Auto Interior
Illumination
Sensitivity
Changes the sensitivity of the brightness of the
instrument panel when the headlight switch is in the
AUTO position.
Max/High/Mid*1/Low/Min
Auto Headlight ON
With Wiper ON
Changes the settings for the wiper operation when
the headlights automatically come on while the
headlight switch is in the AUTO position.
ON*1/OFF
*1:Default Setting
124
Description
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 125 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGauges and DisplaysuDriver Information Interface
Setup Group
Description
Selectable settings
Auto Door Lock
Changes the setting for when the doors
automatically lock.
With Vehicle Speed*1/Shift
From P/OFF
Auto Door Unlock
Changes the setting for when the doors
automatically unlock.
All Doors When Driver’s Door
Opens*1/All Doors When
Shifted To Park/All Doors When
Ignition Switched OFF/OFF
Key And Remote
Unlock Mode
Sets up either the driver’s door or all doors to unlock
on the first operation of the remote or built-in key.
Driver Door*1/All Doors
Keyless Lock Answer
Back
LOCK/UNLOCK - The exterior lights flash.
LOCK (2nd push)- The beeper sounds.
ON*1/OFF
Security Relock Timer
Changes the time it takes for the doors to relock and
the security system to set after you unlock the
vehicle without opening a door.
90sec/60sec/30sec*1
Cancels customized changes you have made or
restores them to their default setting.
Cancel/Set
Default All
—
Instrument Panel
Door Setup
Customizable Features
*1:Default Setting
Continued
125
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 126 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGauges and DisplaysuDriver Information Interface
■ Example of how to customize a setting
Instrument Panel
Below are steps that explain how to change the reset timing for trip A from the
default setting (manual) so that it resets automatically when the vehicle is fully
refueled.
1. Press the
(home) button and then the
3 / 4 button to select Settings, then
press the ENTER button.
2. Press the 3 / 4 button to select Vehicle
Customization, then press the ENTER
button.
126
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 127 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGauges and DisplaysuDriver Information Interface
3. Press the 3 / 4 button to select Meter
Setup, then press the ENTER button.
u Language Selection appears first in the
display.
Instrument Panel
4. Press the 3 / 4 button to select “Trip A”
Reset Timing, then press the ENTER
button.
u The display switches to the
customization setup screen, where you
can select When Fully Refueled, IGN
OFF, Manually Reset, or Exit.
5. Press the 3 / 4 button to select When
Fully Refueled, then press the ENTER
button.
u The SETUP “When Fully Refueled”
screen appears, then the display returns
to the customization menu screen.
Continued
127
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 128 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGauges and DisplaysuDriver Information Interface
Instrument Panel
128
6. Press the 3 / 4 button until Exit appears
on the display, then press the ENTER
button.
7. Repeat Step 6 until you return to the
Vehicle Customization screen, then press
the
(home) or
(back) button to
return to the home screen.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 129 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Controls
This chapter explains how to operate the various controls necessary for driving.
Clock .................................................. 130
Locking and Unlocking the Doors
Key Types and Functions .................. 133
Low Smart Entry Remote Signal Strength ..... 135
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the
Outside .......................................... 136
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the
Inside ............................................. 144
Childproof Door Locks ..................... 146
Auto Door Locking/Unlocking .......... 147
Opening and Closing the Tailgate... 148
Security System ................................ 158
Opening and Closing the Windows..... 161
* Not available on all models
Moonroof * ........................................ 164
Operating the Switches Around the
Steering Wheel
ENGINE START/STOP Button............. 165
Turn Signals ..................................... 168
Light Switches.................................. 169
Fog Lights * ...................................... 172
Daytime Running Lights ................... 173
Auto High-Beam .............................. 174
Wipers and Washers ........................ 177
Rear Defogger/Heated Door Mirror *
Button ........................................... 180
Brightness Control ........................... 182
Driving Position Memory System * .... 183
Adjusting the Steering Wheel .......... 185
Adjusting the Mirrors
Interior Rearview Mirror ................... 186
Power Door Mirrors ......................... 187
Adjusting the Seats
Front Seats ...................................... 188
Rear Seats........................................ 192
Armrest ........................................... 197
Interior Lights/Interior Convenience
Items
Interior Lights .................................. 198
Interior Convenience Items .............. 201
Climate Control System ................... 217
129
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 130 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Clock
Adjusting the Clock
Models without navigation system
1Clock
You can adjust the time manually in the audio/information screen, with the power
mode in ON.
■ Adjusting the Time
Models with navigation system
The clock is automatically updated through the
navigation system, so the time does not need to be
adjusted.
Models with color audio system
■ Using the MENU/CLOCK button
Controls
130
1. Press and hold the MENU/CLOCK button
for two seconds.
2. Select Adjust Clock, then press .
3. Rotate
to adjust the hours.
4. Press
to switch to minute adjustment.
5. Rotate
to adjust the minutes.
6. Press
to switch to Set.
7. Press
to complete clock adjustment.
1Using the MENU/CLOCK button
Models with color audio system
These indications are used to show how to operate
the selector knob.
Rotate
to select.
Press
to enter.
You can customize the clock display to show the 12
hour clock or 24 hour clock.
2 Customized Features P. 352
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 131 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuClockuAdjusting the Clock
Models with Display Audio
■ Using the Settings menu on the audio/
information screen
1. Select
, then select Settings.
2. Select System.
3. Select Date & Time.
4. Select Set Date & Time.
5. Select Automatic Date & Time, then
select OFF.
Models with Display Audio
You can also adjust the clock by touching the clock
displayed on the upper right corner of the display or
the Clock icon on the home screen.
1. Touch the clock on the display.
The clock screen of the select face-type appears.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Date & Time Settings.
4. Select Set Date & Time.
5. Select Automatic Date & Time, then select OFF.
6. Select Set Date or Set Time.
7. Adjusting the dates, hours and minutes by
selecting 3 / 4 .
8. Select Save to set the time.
Controls
To adjust time:
6. Select Set Time.
7. Selecting 3 / 4 .
u AM/PM icon can be switched to each
other either by selecting 3 / 4 , or by
directly touching the icon.
u When you customize the clock display to
24 hour clock, AM/PM icon is not
displayed.
1Using the Settings menu on the audio/information screen
You can customize the clock display to show the 12
hour clock or 24 hour clock.
2 Customized Features P. 359
2 Customized Features P. 359
8. Select Save to set the time.
Continued
131
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 132 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuClockuAdjusting the Clock
To adjust date:
6. Select Set Date.
7. Selecting 3 / 4 .
8. Select Save to set the date.
Controls
132
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 133 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Locking and Unlocking the Doors
Key Types and Functions
This vehicle comes with the following keys:
Use the keys to start and stop the engine, and
Smart Entry Remote
to lock and unlock all the doors and tailgate.
You can also use the remote transmitter to
lock and unlock all the doors and tailgate.
All the keys have an immobilizer system. The
immobilizer system helps to protect against vehicle
theft.
2 Immobilizer System P. 158
Built-in Key
The built-in key can be used to lock/unlock the
doors when the smart entry remote battery
becomes weak and the power door lock/
unlock operation is disabled.
To remove the built-in key, slide the release
knob and then pull out the key. To reinstall
the built-in key, push the built-in key into the
smart entry remote until it clicks.
Continued
Controls
Follow the advice below to prevent damage to the
keys:
• Do not leave the keys in direct sunlight, or in
locations with high temperature or high humidity.
• Do not drop the keys or set heavy objects on them.
• Keep the keys away from liquids, dust and sand.
• Do not take the keys apart except for replacing the
battery.
■ Built-in Key
Release Knob
1Key Types and Functions
If the circuits in the keys are damaged, the engine
may not start, and the remote transmitter may not
work.
If the keys do not work properly, have them
inspected by a dealer.
You can remotely start the engine using the smart
entry remote.
2 Remote Engine Start P. 454
133
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 134 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuKey Types and Functions
■ Key Number Tag
1Key Number Tag
Contains a number that you will need if you
purchase a replacement key.
Keep the key number tag separate from the key in a
safe place outside of your vehicle.
If you wish to purchase an additional key, contact a
dealer.
If you lose your key and you cannot start the engine,
contact a dealer.
Controls
134
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 135 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLow Smart Entry Remote Signal Strength
Low Smart Entry Remote Signal Strength
The vehicle transmits radio waves to locate the smart entry remote when locking/
unlocking the doors and tailgate, or to start the engine.
In the following cases, locking/unlocking the doors and tailgate, or starting the
engine may be inhibited or operation may be unstable:
• Strong radio waves are being transmitted by nearby equipment.
• You are carrying the smart entry remote together with telecommunications
equipment, laptop computers, cell phones, or wireless devices.
• A metallic object is touching or covering the smart entry remote.
1Low Smart Entry Remote Signal Strength
Communication between the smart entry remote and
the vehicle consumes the smart entry remote’s
battery.
Battery life is about two years, but this varies
depending on regularity of use.
The battery is consumed whenever the smart entry
remote is receiving strong radio waves. Avoid placing
it near electrical appliances such as televisions and
personal computers.
Controls
135
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 136 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Using the Smart Entry with Push Button Start System
When you carry the smart entry remote, you
can lock/unlock the doors and the tailgate.
You can lock/unlock the doors and the
tailgate within a radius of about 32 inches (80
cm) of the outside door handle or tailgate
outer handle.
1Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
If the interior light switch is in the door activated
position, the interior lights come on when you unlock
the doors and tailgate.
No doors opened: The lights fade out after 30
seconds.
Doors and tailgate relocked: The lights go off
immediately.
2 Interior Lights P. 198
Controls
1Using the Smart Entry with Push Button Start System
If you do not open a door or the tailgate within 30
seconds of unlocking the vehicle with the smart entry
system, the doors and tailgate will automatically
relock.
You can lock or unlock doors using the smart entry
system only when the power mode is in VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK).
136
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 137 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Locking the doors and tailgate
Door Lock Button
1Using the Smart Entry with Push Button Start System
Press the door lock button on a front door or
the tailgate.
u Some exterior lights flash; the beeper
sounds; all the doors and tailgate lock;
and the security system sets.
• Do not leave the smart entry remote in the vehicle
when you get out. Carry it with you.
• Even if you are not carrying the smart entry remote,
•
•
Door
Lock
Button
•
•
•
Continued
Controls
•
you can lock/unlock the doors and tailgate while
someone else with the remote is within range.
The door may be unlocked if the door handle is
covered with water in heavy rain or in a car wash if
the smart entry remote is within range.
If you grip a door handle wearing gloves, the door
sensor may be slow to respond or may not respond
by unlocking the doors.
After locking the door, you have up to 2 seconds
during which you can pull the door handle to
confirm whether the door is locked. If you need to
unlock the door immediately after locking it, wait
at least 2 seconds before gripping the handle,
otherwise the door will not unlock.
The door might not open if you pull it immediately
after gripping the door handle. Grip the handle
again and confirm that the door is unlocked before
pulling the handle.
Even within the 32 inches (80 cm) radius, you may
not be able to lock/unlock the doors with the smart
entry remote if it is above or below the outside
handle.
The smart entry remote may not operate if it is too
close to the door and door glass.
137
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 138 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Unlocking the doors and tailgate
1Using the Smart Entry with Push Button Start System
Grab the driver’s door handle:
u The driver’s door unlocks.
u Some exterior lights flash twice and the
beeper sounds twice.
Grab the front passenger’s door handle:
u All doors and the tailgate unlock.
u Some exterior lights flash twice and the
beeper sounds twice.
Controls
Press the tailgate outer handle:
u The tailgate unlocks and opens.
u Some exterior lights flash twice and the
beeper sounds twice.
2 Using the Tailgate Outer Handle P. 153
Outer
Handle
138
* Not available on all models
The light flash, beeper, and unlock settings can be
customized using the audio/information screen.
Models without Display Audio
2 Vehicle Customization P. 119
Models with Display Audio
2 Customized Features P. 359
You can also unlock and open with the power
tailgate *.
2 Using the Tailgate Outer Handle P. 153
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 139 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Locking the doors and tailgate (Walk away auto lock®) *
1. While within about 5 feet (1.5 m) radius of
the vehicle.
u The beeper sounds; the auto lock
function will be activated.
2. Carry the smart entry remote beyond about
5 feet (1.5 m) from the vehicle and remain
outside this range for 2 or more seconds.
u Some exterior lights flash; the beeper
sounds; all doors and tailgate will then
lock.
* Not available on all models
Continued
The auto lock function is set to OFF as the factory
default setting. The auto lock function can be set to
ON using the audio/information screen.
Turning ON auto lock function using the audio/
information screen, shall only activate the function in
remote transmitter that was used to unlock the
driver's door.
2 Customized Features P. 359
After the auto lock function has been activated, when
you stay within the locking/unlocking operation range,
the indicator on the smart entry remote will continue to
flash until the doors are locked.
Controls
The activation range of
the auto lock function is
about 5 feet (1.5 m)
1Locking the doors and tailgate (Walk away auto lock®) *
When you walk away from the vehicle while
carrying the smart entry remote, the doors will
automatically lock.
The auto lock function activates when all
doors and tailgate are closed, and the smart
entry remote is within about 5 feet (1.5 m)
radius of the outside door handle.
Exit vehicle while carrying smart entry remote
and close door(s).
When you stay beside the vehicle within the
operation range, the doors will automatically lock
approximately 30 seconds after the auto lock
function activating beeper sounds.
When you open a door after the auto lock function
activating beeper sounds, the auto lock function will
be delayed until all doors and tailgate are closed.
Under the following circumstances, the auto-lock
function will not activate:
• The remote is inside the vehicle.
uThe buzzer will not sound.
• The remote is taken out of its operational range
before all the doors are closed.
uThe buzzer will sound.
139
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 140 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
To temporarily deactivate the function:
1. Set the power mode to OFF.
2. Open the driver's door.
3. Using the master door lock switch, operate
the lock as follows:
Lock Unlock Lock Unlock.
u The beeper sounds and the function is
deactivated.
Controls
To restore the function:
• Set the power mode to ON.
• Lock the vehicle without using the auto lock
function.
• With the smart entry remote on you, move
out of the auto lock function operation
range.
• Open any door.
1Locking the doors and tailgate (Walk away auto lock®) *
Models with power tailgate
If equipped, the user must wait until the power
tailgate fully closes before the auto lock function will
be activated.
The auto lock function does not operate when any of
the following conditions are met.
• The smart entry remote is inside the vehicle.
• A door or the hood is not closed.
• The power mode is set to any mode other than
OFF.
• The smart entry remote is not located within a
radius of about 5 feet (1.5 m) from the vehicle
when you get out of the vehicle and close the
doors.
Auto lock function operation stop beeper
After the auto lock function has been activated, the
auto lock operation stop beeper sounds for
approximately two seconds in the following cases.
• The smart entry remote is put inside the vehicle
through a window.
• You are located too close to the vehicle.
• The smart entry remote is put inside the tailgate.
If the warning beeper sounds, check that you are
carrying the smart entry remote. Then, open/close a
door and confirm the auto lock activation beeper
sounds once.
140
* Not available on all models
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 141 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Using the Remote Transmitter
■ Locking the doors and tailgate
LED
Unlock
Button
1Locking the doors and tailgate (Walk away auto lock®) *
Lock
Button
1Using the Remote Transmitter
If you do not open a door or the tailgate within
30 seconds of unlocking the vehicle with the remote
transmitter, the doors and tailgate will automatically
relock.
You can change the relock timer setting.
Models without Display Audio
2 Vehicle Customization P. 119
■ Unlocking the doors and tailgate
Press the unlock button.
Once:
u Some exterior lights flash twice, and the
driver’s door unlocks.
Twice:
u The remaining doors and tailgate unlock.
Controls
Press the lock button.
Once:
u Some exterior lights flash, all the doors
and tailgate lock, and the security system
sets.
Twice (within five seconds after the first
push):
u The beeper sounds and verifies the
security system is set.
In the case that the smart entry remote is out of
operating range when you close a door or the boot,
a beeper will sound to indicate that the auto lock
function has been canceled.
Models with Display Audio
2 Customized Features P. 359
You can lock or unlock doors using the remote
transmitter only when the power mode is in VEHICLE
OFF (LOCK).
The remote transmitter uses low-power signals, so
the operating range may vary depending on the
surroundings.
The remote will not lock the vehicle when a door is
open.
If the distance at which the remote transmitter works
varies, the battery is probably low.
If the LED does not come on when you press a
button, the battery is dead.
2 Replacing the Button Battery P. 599
* Not available on all models
Continued
141
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 142 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
1Using the Remote Transmitter
You can customize the door unlock mode setting.
Models without Display Audio
2 Vehicle Customization P. 119
Models with Display Audio
2 Customized Features P. 359
■ Locking/Unlocking the Doors Using a Key
Controls
If the lock or unlock button of the smart entry remote does not work, use the key
instead.
Fully insert the key and turn it.
Lock
1Locking/Unlocking the Doors Using a Key
When you lock the driver’s door with a key, all the
other doors and tailgate lock at the same time. When
unlocking, the driver’s door unlocks first. Turn the
key a second time within a few seconds to unlock the
remaining doors and the tailgate.
You can customize the door unlock mode setting.
Models without Display Audio
2 Vehicle Customization P. 119
Models with Display Audio
Unlock
142
2 Customized Features P. 359
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 143 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Outside
■ Locking a Door Without Using a Key
If you do not have the key on you, or if for some reason you cannot lock a door using
the key, you can lock the door without it.
■ Locking the front doors
Push the lock tab forward a or push the
master door lock switch in the lock direction
b, and close the door.
■ Lockout prevention system
The doors and tailgate cannot be locked when
the smart entry remote is inside the vehicle.
When you lock the driver’s door, all the other doors
and tailgate lock at the same time.
Before locking a door, make sure that the key is not
inside the vehicle.
Controls
■ Locking the rear doors
Push the lock tab forward and close the door.
1Locking a Door Without Using a Key
143
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 144 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside
■ Using the Lock Tab
To Lock
Lock Tab
1Using the Lock Tab
■ Locking a door
Push the lock tab forward.
■ Unlocking a door
To Unlock
Controls
144
Pull the lock tab rearward.
When you lock the door using the lock tab on the
driver’s door, all of the other doors and the tailgate
lock at the same time.
When you unlock the door using the lock tab on the
driver’s door, only the driver’s door will unlock.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 145 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuLocking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside
■ Unlocking Using the Front Door Inner Handle
Inner Handle
1Unlocking Using the Front Door Inner Handle
Pull the front door inner handle.
u The door unlocks and opens in one
motion.
The front door inner handles are designed to allow
front seat occupants to open the door in one motion.
However this feature requires that front seat
occupants never pull a front door inner handle while
the vehicle is in motion.
Children should always ride in a rear seat where
childproof door locks are provided.
2 Childproof Door Locks P. 146
Controls
Unlocking and opening the driver’s door from the inner handle unlocks all the other
doors.
To avoid all the doors to be unlocked, use the lock tab on the driver’s door to unlock,
then lock again before opening the door.
u This setting works for one time only. If you do not want all the doors to be
unlocked all the time, customize the Auto Door Unlock setting to OFF using
the driver information interface or audio/information screen *.
Models without Display Audio
2 Vehicle Customization P. 119
Models with Display Audio
2 Customized Features P. 359
* Not available on all models
Continued
145
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 146 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuChildproof Door Locks
■ Using the Master Door Lock Switch
Press the master door lock switch in as shown
to lock or unlock all doors and the tailgate.
Master Door Lock Switch
1Using the Master Door Lock Switch
When you lock/unlock either of the front doors using
the master door lock switch, all the other doors and
the tailgate lock/unlock at the same time.
To Lock
To Unlock
Controls
Childproof Door Locks
The childproof door locks prevent the rear doors from being opened from the inside
regardless of the position of the lock tab.
■ Setting the Childproof Door Locks
Slide the lever in the rear door to the lock
position, and close the door.
■ When opening the door
Open the door using the outside door handle.
Unlock
Lock
146
1Childproof Door Locks
To open the door from the inside when the
childproof door lock is on, put the lock tab in the
unlock position, lower the rear window, put your
hand out of the window, and pull the outside door
handle.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 147 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuLocking and Unlocking the DoorsuAuto Door Locking/Unlocking
Auto Door Locking/Unlocking
Your vehicle locks or unlocks all doors automatically when a certain condition is met.
■ Auto Door Locking
■ Drive lock mode
All doors and tailgate lock when the vehicle’s speed reaches about 10 mph (15
km/h).
1Auto Door Locking/Unlocking
Models without Display Audio
You can turn off or change to another auto door
locking/unlocking setting using the driver
information interface.
2 Vehicle Customization P. 119
Models with Display Audio
■ Auto Door Unlocking
Controls
■ Driver’s door open mode
All doors and tailgate unlock when the driver’s door is opened.
You can turn off or change to another auto door
locking/unlocking setting using the audio/
information screen.
2 Customized Features P. 359
147
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 148 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Opening and Closing the Tailgate
Precautions for Opening/Closing the Tailgate
Always make sure individuals and objects are clear of the tailgate before opening or
closing it.
Models without power tailgate
• Open the tailgate all the way.
u If it is not fully opened, the tailgate may begin to close under its own weight.
• Be careful when it is windy. The wind may cause the tailgate to close.
All models
Controls
Keep the tailgate closed while driving to:
u Avoid possible damage.
u Prevent exhaust gas from leaking into the vehicle.
2 Carbon Monoxide Gas P. 73
1Precautions for Opening/Closing the Tailgate
3 WARNING
Anyone caught in the path of a tailgate
that is being opened or closed can be
seriously injured.
Make sure that all people are clear of the
tailgate before opening or closing it.
Be careful not to hit your head on the tailgate or to
put your hands between the tailgate and the cargo
area when closing the tailgate.
When you are storing or picking up cargo from the
cargo area, or by using a forward and back kicking
motion under the center of the rear bumper for
hands free access *, while the engine is idling, do not
stand in front of the exhaust pipe. You may get
burned.
Do not allow any passenger in the cargo space. They
may get hurt during hard braking, a sudden
acceleration, or a crash.
148
* Not available on all models
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 149 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOpening and Closing the TailgateuPrecautions for Opening/Closing the Tailgate
Models with power tailgate
The power tailgate can be operated by pressing the power tailgate button on the
remote transmitter, pressing the power tailgate button in the driver side control
panel, pressing the button on the tailgate, or by raising and lowering your foot
under the center of the rear bumper for hands free access *.
The power tailgate can be opened/closed when the transmission is in (P .
1Precautions for Opening/Closing the Tailgate
Models with power tailgate
3 WARNING
Closing a power tailgate while anyone is in
the path of the tailgate can cause serious
injury.
NOTICE
Controls
Make sure everyone is clear before closing
the power tailgate.
Do not push or pull on the power tailgate when it is
being automatically opened or closed.
Forcibly opening or closing the power tailgate while
in operation can deform the tailgate frame.
When operating the power tailgate, make sure there
is enough space around your vehicle. People near the
tailgate may be seriously hurt if the tailgate hits or
closes on their heads. Be especially cautious if
children are around.
The power tailgate may not open or close under the
following conditions:
• You start the engine while the tailgate is
automatically opening or closing.
• The vehicle is parked on a steep hill.
• The vehicle is swayed in a strong wind.
• The tailgate or the roof is covered with snow or ice.
* Not available on all models
149
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 150 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOpening and Closing the TailgateuOpening/Closing the Power Tailgate *
Opening/Closing the Power Tailgate *
■ Using the Hands Free Access *
Use a forward and back kicking motion under
the center of the rear bumper to open or close
the power tailgate while carrying the smart
entry remote.
u Some exterior lights flash twice and a
beeper sounds once, then the tailgate
begins to move.
1Using the Hands Free Access *
During rain or in other instances when the vehicle
becomes wet, the sensor may not properly detect
your foot motion.
Controls
When performing work on or around the rear section
of the vehicle, you may inadvertently open or close
the tailgate.
To prevent this from happening, select Customized
Features on the audio/information screen and then
select OFF for the feature.
2 Customized Features P. 359
If you hold your foot under the bumper for too long,
the power tailgate does not open or close.
1 sec.
This function will not operate if you don't have the
smart entry remote on you. Please make sure you
have the smart entry remote on you.
The duration of the kicking motion should be
approximately one second.
150
* Not available on all models
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 151 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOpening and Closing the TailgateuOpening/Closing the Power Tailgate *
■ Using the Remote Transmitter
1Opening/Closing the Power Tailgate *
Press the power tailgate button for more than
one second to operate when the power mode
is in VEHICLE OFF (LOCK).
u Some exterior lights flash and the beeper
sounds.
If you press the button again while the power
tailgate is moving, it will reverse direction.
■ Customizing when to open the tailgate
Anytime: The power tailgate unlocks and opens at the same time. This is the
default setting.
When Unlocked: The tailgate opens when all doors are unlocked.
2 Customized Features P. 359
If you replace the battery or the power tailgate fuse
while the tailgate is open, the power tailgate may be
disabled. The power tailgate resumes once you
manually close the tailgate.
Installing aftermarket components other than
genuine Honda accessories on the power tailgate
may prevent it from fully opening or closing.
Controls
Power
Tailgate
Button
If you close the power tailgate when all the doors are
locked, the power tailgate locks automatically.
Make sure the power tailgate is fully open before you
get your cargo in and out.
Make sure the power tailgate is fully closed before
you start the vehicle.
The beeper sounds when you start driving while the
power tailgate is still open, or closing.
* Not available on all models
Continued
151
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 152 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOpening and Closing the TailgateuOpening/Closing the Power Tailgate *
■ Using the Power Tailgate Button
To open or close the power tailgate, press the
power tailgate button for about one second.
u Some exterior lights flash and the beeper
sounds.
If you press the button again while the power
tailgate is moving, it will reverse direction.
Controls
Power Tailgate Button
1Opening/Closing the Power Tailgate *
If the power tailgate meets resistance while opening
or closing, the auto reverse feature reverses the
direction. The beeper sounds three times.
The auto reverse function stops sensing when the
tailgate is almost closed to make sure that it fully
closes.
Do not touch the sensors located on both sides of the
tailgate. The power tailgate does not close if you
touch either sensor when you are trying to close the
tailgate.
Be careful not to scratch the sensors with a sharp
object. If scratched, they can be damaged, and the
power tailgate closing feature malfunctions.
152
* Not available on all models
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 153 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOpening and Closing the TailgateuOpening/Closing the Power Tailgate *
■ Using the Tailgate Outer Handle
1Opening/Closing the Power Tailgate *
If you press the outer handle of the tailgate for
no longer than one second, the tailgate opens
automatically.
u The beeper sounds.
u If you want to open the tailgate
manually, press the button for more than
one second.
2 Opening and Closing the Tailgate
P. 148
Even if you are not carrying the smart entry remote,
you can lock/unlock the tailgate while someone else
with the remote is within range.
You can change the power tailgate operation setting
on and off.
2 Customized Features P. 359
Controls
Outer
Handle
Do not leave the key, remote transmitter, or smart
entry remote in the cargo area before closing the
tailgate.
If you are carrying the smart entry remote, you
do not have to unlock the tailgate before
opening it.
To close the tailgate, press the outer handle
again while the tailgate is opening.
If you press the outer handle again while the
power tailgate is moving, it will reverse
direction.
* Not available on all models
Continued
153
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 154 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOpening and Closing the TailgateuOpening/Closing the Power Tailgate *
■ Using the Tailgate Inner Button
Press the button on the tailgate to close the
power tailgate.
u The beeper sounds.
If you press the button again while the power
tailgate is moving, it will reverse direction.
Controls
154
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 155 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOpening and Closing the TailgateuOpening/Closing the Power Tailgate *
■ Auto-Closer
If you manually close the power tailgate, it latches automatically.
1Auto-Closer
The auto-closer feature does not activate if you press
the tailgate outer handle while the power tailgate is
closing.
Do not put any force on the tailgate while the power
tailgate is latching.
■ Power Tailgate Fall Detection
Automatically lowers the power tailgate when there is a possibility that the fully
opened power tailgate can fall down by its own weight (for example, by snow on
the tailgate). The beeper sounds while the power tailgate lowers.
Controls
Keep your hands away from the tailgate when you
manually close the tailgate and let it latch
automatically. It is dangerous to put your hands
around the tailgate as it starts to latch itself.
1Power Tailgate Fall Detection
If you try to manually close the power tailgate
immediately after it fully opens, the power tailgate
fall detection may be activated.
Once the power tailgate fall detection activates, wait
until the power tailgate fully closes. Keep away from
the power tailgate when it is in motion.
If the power tailgate fall detection constantly
activates, consult at a dealer.
155
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 156 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOpening and Closing the TailgateuOpening/Closing the Tailgate
Opening/Closing the Tailgate
■ Using the Tailgate Outer Handle
When all the doors are unlocked or press the
tailgate unlock button on the remote
transmitter, the tailgate is unlocked.
Press the tailgate outer handle and lift open
the tailgate.
Controls
Outer
Handle
If you are carrying the smart entry remote, you
do not have to unlock the tailgate before
opening it.
To close the tailgate, grab the inner handle,
pull the tailgate down, and push it closed
from outside.
Inner Handle
156
1Using the Tailgate Outer Handle
Do not leave the key, remote transmitter, or smart
entry remote in the cargo area before closing the
tailgate.
Even if you are not carrying the smart entry remote,
you can lock/unlock the tailgate while someone else
with the remote is within range.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 157 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOpening and Closing the TailgateuOpening/Closing the Tailgate
■ Using the Remote Transmitter
Press the tailgate unlock button to unlock the
tailgate.
1Using the Remote Transmitter
If you have unlocked and opened the tailgate using
the remote transmitter or smart entry remote, when
closing, the tailgate locks automatically.
Tailgate
Unlock
Button
Controls
157
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 158 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Security System
Immobilizer System
The immobilizer system prevents a key that has not been pre-registered from
starting the engine. Each key contains electronic transmitters that use electronic
signals to verify the key.
Controls
Pay attention to the following when pressing the ENGINE START/STOP button:
• Do not allow objects that emit strong radio waves near the ENGINE START/
STOP button.
• Make sure the key is not covered by or touching a metal object.
• Do not bring a key from another vehicle’s immobilizer system near the ENGINE
START/STOP button.
• Do not put the key near magnetic items. Electronic device, such as televisions and
audio systems emit strong magnetic fields. Note that even a key chain can
become magnetic.
1Immobilizer System
NOTICE
Leaving the key in the vehicle can result in theft or
accidental movement of the vehicle.
Always take the key with you whenever you leave the
vehicle unattended.
Do not alter the system or add other devices to it.
Doing so may damage the system and make your
vehicle inoperable.
Security System Alarm
The security system alarm activates when the tailgate, hood or doors are forcibly
opened. The alarm does not activate if the tailgate or doors are opened with the key,
remote transmitter or smart entry system.
However, the alarm activates if a door is opened with the key and then the hood is
opened before the power mode is set to ON.
158
1Security System Alarm
Do not alter the system or add other devices to it.
Doing so may damage the system and make your
vehicle inoperable.
The security alarm continues for a maximum of two
minutes until the security system alarm deactivates.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 159 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuSecurity SystemuSecurity System Alarm
■ When the security system alarm activates
The horn sounds intermittently, and some exterior lights flash.
1Security System Alarm
■ To deactivate the security system alarm
Unlock the vehicle using the key, remote transmitter or smart entry system. The
system, along with the horn and flashing lights, is deactivated.
■ Setting the security system alarm
If the battery goes dead after you have set the
security system alarm, the security alarm may go off
once the battery is recharged or replaced.
If this occurs, deactivate the security system alarm by
unlocking a door using the key, remote transmitter or
smart entry system.
Controls
The security system alarm automatically sets when the following conditions have
been met:
• The power mode is set to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK).
• The hood is closed.
• All doors and the tailgate are locked from outside with the key, remote
transmitter, or smart entry system.
Do not set the security system alarm when someone
is in the vehicle or a window is open. The system can
accidentally activate when:
• Unlocking the door with the lock tab.
• Opening the hood with the hood release.
■ When the security system alarm sets
The security system alarm indicator in the instrument panel blinks and the blinking
interval changes after about 15 seconds.
■ To cancel the security system alarm
The security system alarm is canceled when the vehicle is unlocked using the remote
transmitter or smart entry system, or when the power mode is set to ON. The
security system alarm indicator goes off at the same time.
Continued
159
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 160 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuSecurity SystemuSecurity System Alarm
■ Panic Mode
■ The panic button on the remote
Panic
Button
Controls
160
transmitter
If you press the panic button for
approximately one second, the following will
occur for about 30 seconds:
• The horn sounds.
• Some exterior lights flash.
■ Canceling panic mode
Press any button on the remote transmitter, or
set the power mode to ON.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 161 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Opening and Closing the Windows
Opening/Closing the Power Windows
The power windows can be opened and closed when the power mode is in ON,
using the switches on the doors.
The driver’s side switches can be used to open and close all the windows. The power
window lock button on the driver’s side must be switched off (not pushed in,
indicator off) to open and close the windows from anywhere other than the driver’s
seat.
■ Opening/Closing Windows with Auto-Open/Close Function
ON
OFF
Power Window
Lock Button
3 WARNING
Closing a power window on someone’s
hands or fingers can cause serious injury.
Make sure your passengers are away from
the windows before closing them.
The power windows can be operated for up to 10
minutes after you set the power mode to VEHICLE
OFF (LOCK).
Opening either front door cancels this function.
■ Manual operation
To open: Push the switch down lightly, and
hold it until the desired position is reached.
To close: Pull the switch up lightly, and hold it
until the desired position is reached.
Auto Reverse
If a power window senses resistance when closing
automatically, it stops closing and reverse direction.
■ Automatic operation
To open: Push the switch down firmly.
To close: Pull the switch up firmly.
The auto reverse function stops sensing when the
window is almost closed to ensure that it fully closes.
Controls
When the power window lock button is pushed in, the indicator comes on and you
can only operate the driver’s window. Turn the power window lock button on if a
child is in the vehicle.
1Opening/Closing the Power Windows
The driver’s window auto reverse function is disabled
when you continuously pull up the switch.
Indicator
Driver’s Window
Switch
Front Passenger’s
Window Switch
The window opens or closes completely. To
stop the window at any time, push or pull the
switch briefly.
Continued
161
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 162 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOpening and Closing the WindowsuOpening/Closing the Power Windows
■ Opening/Closing the Windows without Auto-Open/Close Function
To open: Push the switch down.
To close: Pull the switch up.
Close
Release the switch when the window reaches
the desired position.
Open
Controls
■ Opening the Windows and the Moonroof * with the Remote
To open: Press the unlock button, and then
within 10 seconds, press it again and hold it.
Unlock
Button
162
* Not available on all models
If the windows and moonroof * stop midway,
repeat the procedure.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 163 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOpening and Closing the WindowsuOpening/Closing the Power Windows
■ Opening/Closing the Windows and the Moonroof * with the Key
To open: Unlock the driver’s door with the
key. Within 10 seconds of returning the key to
the central position, turn the key in the unlock
direction and hold it there.
Close
Open
Controls
To close: Lock the driver’s door with the key.
Within 10 seconds of returning the key to the
central position, turn the key in the lock
direction and hold it there.
Release the key to stop the windows/
moonroof * at the desired position. If you want
further adjustment, repeat the same
operation.
* Not available on all models
163
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 164 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Moonroof *
Opening and Closing the Moonroof
You can operate the moonroof when the power mode is in ON. Use the switch in
the front of the ceiling to open and close the moonroof.
■ Using the Moonroof Switch
■ Automatic operation
To open: Pull the switch back firmly.
To close: Push the switch forward firmly.
Open
Controls
The moonroof will automatically open or close
all the way. To stop the moonroof midway,
push the switch briefly.
Close
Tilt
Opening or closing the moonroof on
someone’s hands or fingers can cause
serious injury.
Make sure all hands and fingers are clear of
the moonroof before opening or closing it.
NOTICE
■ Manual operation
To open: Pull the switch back lightly, and
hold it until the desired position is reached.
To close: Push the switch forward lightly, and
hold it until the desired position is reached.
The moonroof can be operated for up to 10 minutes
after you set the power mode to OFF (LOCK).
Opening either front door cancels this function.
To tilt: Push on the center of the moonroof
switch.
To close: Push the switch forward firmly, then
release.
* Not available on all models
3 WARNING
Opening the moonroof in below freezing
temperature or when it is covered with snow or ice
can damage the moonroof panel or motor.
■ Tilting the moonroof up
164
1Opening and Closing the Moonroof
When resistance is detected, the auto reverse function
causes the moonroof to change directions, then stop.
Auto reverse stops sensing when the moonroof is
almost closed to ensure that it fully closes.
You can use the remote transmitter or the key to
operate the moonroof.
2 Opening the Windows and the Moonroof *
with the Remote P. 162
2 Opening/Closing the Windows and the
Moonroof * with the Key P. 163
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 165 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Operating the Switches Around the Steering Wheel
ENGINE START/STOP Button
■ Changing the Power Mode
1ENGINE START/STOP Button
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK)
The button is off.
The steering wheel is locked*1.
The power to all electrical components is turned off.
ENGINE START/STOP Button Operating Range
You can start the engine when the smart entry
remote is inside the vehicle.
Operating Range
Controls
ACCESSORY
The button blinks (in red).
Operate the audio system and other accessories
in this position.
If the battery of the smart entry remote is getting
low, the engine may not start when you push the
ENGINE START/STOP button. If the engine does not
start, refer to the following link.
2 If the Smart Entry Remote Battery is Weak
P. 620
The engine may also run if the smart entry remote is
close to the door or window, even if it is outside the
vehicle.
ON
The button blinks (in red).
All electrical components can be used.
ON mode:
The ENGINE START/STOP button is on (in red), if the
engine is running.
Without pressing the brake pedal
Press the button.
Canadian models
*1: Canadian models
If the power mode does not change from VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK) to ACCESSORY, press the ENGINE START/
STOP button while moving the steering wheel left and
right. The steering wheel will unlock, allowing the mode
to change.
Continued
165
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 166 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluENGINE START/STOP Button
■ Automatic Power Off
If you leave the vehicle for 30 to 60 minutes with the transmission in (P and the
power mode in ACCESSORY, the vehicle automatically goes into the mode similar to
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) to avoid draining the battery.
Canadian models
Controls
When in this mode:
The steering wheel does not lock.
You cannot lock or unlock doors with the remote transmitter or the smart entry
system.
Press the ENGINE START/STOP button to switch the mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK).
■ Power Mode Reminder
If you open the driver’s door when the power mode is set to ACCESSORY, a warning
beeper sounds.
166
1ENGINE START/STOP Button
Do not leave the power mode in ACCESSORY or ON
when you get out.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 167 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluENGINE START/STOP Button
■ Smart Entry Remote Reminder
Warning buzzers may sound from inside and/
or outside the vehicle to remind you that the
smart entry remote is out of the vehicle. If the
buzzer continues even after the remote is put
back inside, place it to be within its
operational range.
■ When the power mode is in
ACCESSORY
If the smart entry remote is taken out of the
vehicle, and all the doors are closed, a
warning buzzer sounds from outside the
vehicle.
When the smart entry remote is within the system’s
operational range, and the driver’s door is closed, the
warning function cancels.
If the smart entry remote is taken out of the vehicle
after the engine has been started, you can no longer
change the ENGINE START/STOP button mode or
restart the engine. Always make sure if the remote is
in your vehicle when you operate the ENGINE
START/STOP button.
Removing the smart entry remote from the vehicle
through a window does not activate the warning
buzzer.
Controls
■ When the power mode is in ON
If the smart entry remote is taken out of the
vehicle, and the driver’s door is closed, a
warning buzzer sounds from both inside and
outside the vehicle. A warning message on
the driver information interface notifies the
driver inside that the remote is outside of the
vehicle.
1Smart Entry Remote Reminder
Do not put the smart entry remote on the dashboard
or in the glove box. It may cause the warning buzzer
to go off. Under some other conditions that can
prevent the vehicle from locating the remote, the
warning buzzer may also go off even if the remote is
within the system’s operational range.
167
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 168 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluTurn Signals
Turn Signals
Right Turn
The turn signals can be used when the power
mode is in ON.
■ One-touch turn signal
Left Turn
Controls
168
When you lightly push up or down and release
the turn signal lever, the exterior turn signals
and turn signal indicator blink three times.
This feature can be used when signaling for a
lane change.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 169 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluLight Switches
Light Switches
■ Manual Operation
U.S. models
High Beams
Canadian models
Rotating the light switch turns the lights on
and off, regardless of the power mode
setting.
■ High beams
Push the lever forward until you hear a click.
■ Low beams
When in high beams, pull the lever back to
return to low beams.
■ Flashing the high beams
Pull the lever back, and release it.
When the lights are on, the lights on indicator in the
instrument panel will be on.
2 Lights On Indicator P. 82
Do not leave the lights on when the engine is off
because it will cause the battery to discharge.
Models without automatic headlight adjusting system
If you sense that the level of the headlights is
abnormal, have your vehicle inspected by a dealer.
Canadian models
■ Lights off
Turns on parking, side marker,
tail, and rear license plate lights
Turns on headlights, parking,
side marker, tail, and rear
license plate lights
If you leave the power mode in VEHICLE OFF (LOCK)
while the lights are on, a chime sounds when the
driver’s door is opened.
Turn the lever to OFF either when:
• The transmission is in (P .
• The parking brake is applied.
To turn the lights on again, turn the lever to
OFF to cancel the lights off mode. Even if you
do not cancel the lights off mode, the lights
come on automatically when:
• The transmission is taken out of (P and the
parking brake is released.
• The vehicle starts to move.
Continued
Controls
Flashing the high beams
Low Beams
1Light Switches
Models with automatic headlight adjusting system
Your vehicle is equipped with the automatic
headlight adjusting system that automatically adjusts
the vertical angle of the high/low beam headlights. If
you find a significant change in the vertical angle of
the headlights, there may be a problem with the
system. Have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
169
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 170 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluLight Switches
■ Automatic Operation (automatic lighting control)
U.S. models
1Automatic Operation (automatic lighting control)
Automatic lighting control can be used when
the power mode is in ON.
We recommend that you turn on the lights manually
when driving at night, in a dense fog, or in dark areas
such as long tunnels or parking facilities.
When the light switch is in AUTO, the
headlights and other exterior lights will switch
on and off automatically depending on the
ambient brightness.
The light sensor is in the location shown below.
Do not cover this light sensor with anything;
otherwise, the automatic lighting system may not
work properly.
Controls
Models with automatic
intermittent wipers
Canadian models
The headlights come on when you unlock a
door in dark areas with the headlight switch in
AUTO.
u Once you lock the door, the headlights
will go off.
Light Sensor
Models without Automatic
Intermittent Wipers
Light Sensor
170
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 171 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluLight Switches
1Automatic Operation (automatic lighting control)
You can adjust the auto light sensitivity as follows:
Setting
Max
High
Mid
Low
Min
The exterior lights come on
when the ambient light is at
Bright
Dark
2 Vehicle Customization P. 119
Models with Display Audio
Controls
Models without Display Audio
2 Customized Features P. 359
■ Headlight Integration with Wipers
1Headlight Integration with Wipers
The headlights automatically come on when the wipers are used several times within
a certain number of intervals with the headlight switch in AUTO.
The headlights automatically go off a few minutes later if the wipers are stopped.
■ Automatic Lighting Off Feature
The headlights, all other exterior lights, and the instrument panel lights turn off 15
seconds after you set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK), take the remote with
you, and close the driver’s door.
If you set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) with the headlight switch on, but
do not open the door, the lights turn off after 10 minutes (three minutes, if the
switch is in the AUTO position).
Continued
This feature activates while the headlights are off in
AUTO.
The instrument panel brightness does not change
when the headlights come on.
At dark ambient light levels, the automatic lighting
control feature turns on the headlights, regardless of
the number of wiper sweeps.
1Automatic Lighting Off Feature
You can change the headlight auto off timer setting.
Models without Display Audio
2 Vehicle Customization P. 119
Models with Display Audio
2 Customized Features P. 359
171
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 172 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluFog Lights *
The lights turn on again when you unlock or open the driver’s door. If you unlock
the door, but do not open it within 15 seconds, the lights go off. If you open the
driver’s door, you will hear a lights on reminder chime.
Fog Lights *
When the parking lights or the headlights are
on, turn the fog light switch on to use the fog
lights.
Controls
Fog Light Switch
172
* Not available on all models
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 173 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluDaytime Running Lights
Daytime Running Lights
The parking/daytime running lights come on when the following conditions have
been met:
• The power mode is in ON.
• The headlight switch is AUTO or OFF.
• The parking brake is released.
The lights remain on even if you set the parking brake. Setting the power mode to
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK) will turn off the daytime running lights.
Controls
The daytime running lights are off once the headlight switch is turned on, or when
the head light switch is in AUTO and it is getting darker outside.
173
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 174 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluAuto High-Beam
Auto High-Beam
The front sensor camera detects the light sources ahead of the vehicle such as the
lights of a preceding or oncoming vehicle, or street lights. When you are driving at
night, the system automatically switches the headlights between low beam and high
beam depending on the situation.
Front Sensor Camera
1Auto High-Beam
The auto high-beam system does not always operate
in every situation. This system is just for assisting the
driver. Always observe your surroundings and switch
the headlights between high beam and low beam
manually if necessary.
If you find the timing of beam changes inconvenient
for driving, change the headlight beams manually.
Controls
The range and the distance at which the camera can
recognize varies depending on conditions
surrounding your vehicle.
■ How to Use the Auto High-Beam
When all of the following conditions have been met, the auto high-beam indicator
comes on and the auto high-beam is activated.
• The power mode is in ON.
Auto High-Beam
• The light switch is in AUTO.
Indicator
• The lever is in the low beam position.
• The headlights have been automatically
activated.
• It is dark outside the vehicle.
Light Switch
If the auto high-beam indicator does not come on even when all the conditions have
been met, carry out the following procedure and the indicator will come on.
• Pull the lever toward you for flashing the high beams then release it while driving.
174
Regarding the handling of the camera mounted to
the inside of the windshield, refer to the following.
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 532
For the auto high-beam to work properly:
• Do not place an object that reflects light on the
dashboard.
• Keep the windshield around the camera clean.
• When cleaning the windshield, be careful not to
apply the windshield cleanser to the camera lens.
• Do not attach an object, sticker or film to the area
around the camera.
• Do not touch the camera lens.
If the camera receives a strong impact, or repairing of
the area near the camera is required, consult a dealer.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 175 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluAuto High-Beam
■ Automatic switching between high-beam and low-beam
1How to Use the Auto High-Beam
When auto-high beam is active, the headlights switch between high beam and low
beam based on the following conditions.
Switching to low beam:
All of the following conditions must
be met before the high beams turn
on.
● Your vehicle speed is 45mph
(72 km/h) or more.
● There are no preceding or
oncoming vehicle with headlights
or taillights turned on.
● There are few street lights on the
road ahead.
One of the following conditions
must be met before the low beams
turn on.
● Your vehicle speed is 30 mph
(48 km/h) or less.
● There is a preceding or oncoming
vehicle with headlights or
taillights turned on.
● There are many street lights on
the road ahead.
■ Manual switching between high-beam and low-beam
If you want to manually switch the headlights between high beam and low beam,
follow either of the procedures below. Note that when you do this, the auto highbeam indicator will turn off and the auto high-beam will be deactivated.
Using the lever:
Pull the lever toward you for flashing the high beams then release it within about
one second while driving.
u To reactivate the auto high-beam, pull the lever toward you for flashing the
high beams then release it while driving. The auto high-beam indicator will
come on.
Using the light switch:
Turn the light switch to
.
u To reactivate the auto high-beam, turn the light switch to AUTO when the
lever is in the low beam position, the auto high-beam indicator will come on.
Continued
• The brightness of the lights from the preceding or
oncoming vehicle is intense or poor.
• Visibility is poor due to the weather (rain, snow,
fog, windshield frost, etc.).
• Surrounding light sources, such as street lights,
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
electric billboards and traffic lights are illuminating
the road ahead.
The brightness level of the road ahead constantly
changes.
The road is bumpy or has many curves.
A vehicle suddenly appears in front of you, or a
vehicle in front of you is not in the preceding or
oncoming direction.
Your vehicle is tilted with a heavy load in the rear.
A traffic sign, mirror, or other reflective object
ahead is reflecting strong light toward the vehicle.
The oncoming vehicle frequently disappears under
roadside trees or behind median barriers.
The preceding or oncoming vehicle is a motorcycle,
bicycle, mobility scooter, or other small vehicle.
Controls
Switching to high beam:
In the following cases, the auto high-beam system
may not switch the headlights properly or the
switching timing may be changed. In case of the
automatic switching operation does not fit for your
driving habits, please switch the headlights manually.
The auto high-beam system keeps the headlight low
beam when:
• Windshield wipers are operating.
• The camera has been detected a dense fog.
175
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 176 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluAuto High-Beam
■ How to Turn Off the Auto High-Beam
Controls
You can turn the auto high-beam system off. If you want to turn the system off or
on, set the power mode to ON, then carry out the following procedures while the
vehicle is stationary.
To turn the system off:
AUTO Position
With the light switch is in AUTO, pull the lever
toward you and hold it for at least 40 seconds.
After the auto high-beam indicator light blinks
twice, release the lever.
To turn the system on:
With the light switch is in AUTO, pull the lever
toward you and hold it for at least 30 seconds.
After the auto high-beam indicator light blinks
once, release the lever.
1How to Use the Auto High-Beam
If the Some Driver Assist Systems Cannot
Operate: Camera Temperature Too High message
appears:
• Use the climate control system to cool down the
interior and, if necessary, also use defroster mode
with the airflow directed toward the camera.
• Start driving the vehicle to lower the windshield
temperature, which cools down the area around
the camera.
If the Some Driver Assist Systems Cannot
Operate: Clean Front Windshield or Auto HighBeam Cannot Operate: Clean Windshield
message appears:
• Park your vehicle in a safe place, and clean the
windshield. If the message does not disappear after
you have cleaned the windshield and driven for a
while, have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
1How to Turn Off the Auto High-Beam
If you turn the auto high-beam system off, the system
does not operate until you turn the system on.
Park in a safe place before turning the system off or
on.
176
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 177 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluWipers and Washers
Wipers and Washers
■ Windshield Wipers/Washers
1Wipers and Washers
The windshield wipers and washers can be
used when the power mode is in ON.
■ MIST
The wipers run at high speed until you release
the lever.
Pull to
use
washer.
MIST
OFF
HI)
Move the lever up or down to change the
wiper settings.
■ Adjusting wiper operation *
Turn the adjustment ring to adjust wiper
operation.
Lower speed, fewer sweeps
INT*1/AUTO*2
LO: Low speed wipe
HI: High speed wipe
Turn the washers off if no washer fluid comes out.
The pump may get damaged.
The wiper motor may stop motor operation
temporarily to prevent an overload. Wiper operation
will return to normal within a few minutes, once the
circuit has returned to normal.
Controls
Intermittent Time
Adjustment Ring *
■ Wiper switch (OFF, INT*1/AUTO*2, LO,
NOTICE
Do not use the wipers when the windshield is dry.
The windshield will get scratched, or the rubber
blades will get damaged.
Models with intermittent time adjustment ring
If the vehicle speeds up while the wipers are
operating intermittently, the length of the wipe
interval shortens.
When the vehicle speeds up, the wiper operation’s
shortest delay setting (+) and the LO setting become
the same.
Higher speed, more sweeps
NOTICE
■ Washer
Sprays while you pull the lever toward you.
When you release the lever for more than one
second, the spray stops, the wipers sweep two
or three more times to clear the windshield,
then stop.
In cold weather, the blades may freeze to the
windshield.
Operating the wipers in this condition may damage
the wipers. Use the defogger or heated windshield *
to warm the windshield, then turn the wipers on.
*1: Models with manual intermittent operation
*2: Models with automatic intermittent operation
* Not available on all models
Continued
177
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 178 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluWipers and Washers
■ Automatic Intermittent Wipers *
1Wipers and Washers
When you push the lever down to AUTO, the
windshield wipers sweep once, and go into
the automatic mode.
Controls
The wipers operate intermittently, at low
speed, or at high speed and stops in
accordance with the amount of rainfall the
rainfall sensor detects.
■ Auto sensitivity adjustment
If the wipers stop operating due to an obstacle such
as the build-up of snow, park the vehicle in a safe
place.
Rotate the wiper switch to OFF, and set the power
mode to ACCESSORY or VEHICLE OFF (LOCK), then
remove the obstacle.
1Automatic Intermittent Wipers *
The rainfall sensor is in the location shown below.
Rainfall Sensor
When the wiper function is set to AUTO, you
can adjust the sensitivity of the rainfall sensor
(using the adjustment ring) so that wipers will
operate in accordance with your preference.
Sensor sensitivity
Low sensitivity
NOTICE
High sensitivity
178
* Not available on all models
AUTO should always be turned OFF before the
following situations in order to prevent severe
damage to the wiper system:
• Cleaning the windshield
• Driving through a car wash
• No rain present
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 179 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluWipers and Washers
■ Rear Wiper/Washer
The rear wiper and washer can be used when
the power mode is in ON.
■ Wiper switch (OFF, INT, ON)
Change the wiper switch setting according to
the amount of rain.
ON
OFF
Washer
Controls
INT: Intermittent
■ Washer (
)
Sprays on the rear window while you rotate
the switch to this position.
Hold it to activate the rear wiper and to spray
the washer. Once released, the washer spray
will stop and the rear wiper will return to its
selected switch setting after a few more
sweeps.
■ Operating in reverse
When you shift the transmission to (R with the windshield wiper activated, the rear
wiper operates automatically as follows even if its switch is off.
Front Wiper Operation
Rear Wiper Operation
INT (Intermittent)
Intermittent
LO (Low speed wipe)
HI (High speed wipe)
Continuous
179
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 180 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluRear Defogger/Heated Door Mirror * Button
Rear Defogger/Heated Door Mirror * Button
Press the rear defogger and heated door
mirror button to defog the rear window and
mirrors when the power mode is in ON.
Models with heated door mirror
Controls
The rear defogger and heated door mirrors
automatically switch off after 10-30 minutes
depending on the outside temperature.
However, if the outside temperature is 32°F
(0°C) or below, they do not automatically
switch off.
Models without heated door mirror
The rear defogger automatically switches off
after 10-30 minutes depending on the outside
temperature. However, if the outside
temperature is 32°F (0°C) or below, it does
not automatically switch off.
180
* Not available on all models
1Rear Defogger/Heated Door Mirror * Button
This system consumes a lot of power, so turn it off
when the window has been defogged.
Also, do not use the system for a long time while the
engine is idling. This may weaken the battery, making
it difficult to start the engine.
Models with heated door mirror
When the power mode is set to ON and the outside
temperature is below 41°F (5°C), the heated door
mirror may automatically activate for 10 minutes.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 181 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluHeated Windshield Button
Canadian models
Heated Windshield Button
Press the heated windshield button to deice
the windshield when the power mode is in
ON.
1Heated Windshield Button
This system consumes a lot of power, so turn it off
when the window has been deiced. Also, do not use
the system for a long period when the engine is
idling. This may weaken the battery, making it
difficult to start the engine.
Controls
When the outside temperate is below 39°F (4°C), the
heated windshield may automatically activate. The
system deactivates itself once the outside temperate
reaches 43°F (6°C).
181
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 182 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluBrightness Control
Brightness Control
(+ Button
(- Button
When the power mode is in ON, you can use
the (+ or (- button to adjust instrument
panel brightness.
Brighten: Press the (+ button.
Dim: Press the (- button.
Controls
You will hear a beeper when the brightness
reaches minimum or maximum. Several
seconds after you have adjusted the
brightness, you will be returned to the
previous screen.
■ Brightness level indicator
The brightness level is shown on the display
while you are adjusting it.
182
1Brightness Control
Instrument panel brightness varies, depending on
whether the exterior lights are on or off. The
instrument panel dims to reduce glare when they are
on.
When it is bright outside and the headlight
integration with the wiper is activated, the
instrument panel brightness does not change.
To cancel the reduced instrument panel brightness
when the exterior lights are on, press the (+ button
until the brightness display is up to max, the beeper
sounds.
The brightness can be set differently for when the
exterior lights are on, and when they are off.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 183 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluDriving Position Memory System *
Driving Position Memory System *
You can store two driver's seat (except for power lumbar) and outside mirrors
position with the driving position memory system.
When you unlock and open the driver’s door with a remote transmitter, or smart
entry system, door mirrors adjust to one of the two preset positions and the seat
adjusts to retracted positions of one of the two preset positions automatically.
The seat will move to the stored position when you set the power mode to
ACCESSORY.
DRIVER 1
DRIVER 2
* Not available on all models
The driver’s seat moves rearward depending
on the set seating position once you
• Stop the vehicle.
• Put the transmission in (P .
• Turn the engine off.
• Then open the driver’s door.
Once the power mode is in the ACCESSORY
position, the driver’s seat moves to the
DRIVER 1 or 2 preset position.
Continued
Using the audio/information screen, you can disable
the automatic seat and door mirrors adjustment
function.
2 Customized Features P. 359
The driver’s seat easy exit feature can be turned ON/
OFF.
2 Customized Features P. 359
System Operation
The system will not operate if:
• The vehicle speed is above 3 mph (5 km/h).
• Either memory position button is pressed while the
seat is in motion.
• The seat position is adjusted while in operation.
• The memory 1 or 2 position is set fully to the rear.
Controls
When you enter the vehicle, the driver information interface briefly shows you which
remote transmitter you used to unlock the vehicle.
• DRIVER 1 transmitter is linked to memory button 1.
• DRIVER 2 transmitter is linked to memory button 2.
1Driving Position Memory System *
183
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 184 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluDriving Position Memory System *
■ Storing a Position in Memory
Memory Button 1
Controls
SET Button
Memory Button 2
1. Set the power mode to ON. Adjust the
driver’s seat and the door mirrors to the
desired position.
2. Press the SET button.
u You will hear a beep, and the memory
button indicator light will blink.
3. Press and hold memory button (1 or (2
within five seconds of pressing the SET
button.
u You will hear two beeps, and the
indicator light on the button you pressed
stays on once the seat and the outside
mirror positions have been memorized.
■ Recalling the Stored Position
Memory Buttons
1. Put the transmission into (P .
2. Apply the parking brake.
3. Press a memory button ( (1 or (2 ).
u You will hear a beep, and the indicator
light will blink.
The seat and the door mirrors will
automatically move to the memorized
positions. When it has finished moving, you
will hear the beep, and the indicator light
stays on.
184
1Storing a Position in Memory
After you press the SET button, the storing operation
will be canceled when:
• You do not press the memory button within five
seconds.
• You readjust the seat position and door mirror
before the double-beep.
• You set the power mode to any position except
ON.
1Recalling the Stored Position
The seat and the door mirrors will stop moving if you:
• Press the SET button or memory button (1 or (2 .
• Adjust the seat position or door mirrors.
• Put the transmission into a position other than (P .
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 185 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOperating the Switches Around the Steering WheeluAdjusting the Steering Wheel
Adjusting the Steering Wheel
1Adjusting the Steering Wheel
3 WARNING
Adjusting the steering wheel position while
driving may cause you to lose control of the
vehicle and be seriously injured in a crash.
Adjust the steering wheel only when the
vehicle is stopped.
Controls
The steering wheel height and distance from your body can be adjusted so that you
can comfortably grip the steering wheel in an appropriate driving posture.
1. Push the steering wheel adjustment lever
down.
u The steering wheel adjustment lever is
under the steering column.
2. Move the steering wheel up or down, and
To lock
in or out.
u Make sure you can see the instrument
panel gauges and indicators.
Lever
To adjust
3. Pull the steering wheel adjustment lever up
to lock the steering wheel in position.
u After adjusting the position, make sure
you have securely locked the steering
wheel in place by trying to move it up,
down, in, and out.
185
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 186 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Adjusting the Mirrors
Interior Rearview Mirror
Adjust the angle of the rearview mirror when you are sitting in the correct driving
position.
■ Rearview Mirror with Day and Night Positions *
Up
Tab
Flip the tab to switch the position.
The night position will help to reduce the glare
from headlights behind you when driving
after dark.
Keep the inside and outside mirrors clean and
adjusted for best visibility.
Adjust the mirrors before you start driving.
2 Front Seats P. 188
Controls
Daytime
Position
Down
Night Position
■ Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror * and Power Door
Mirrors *
Sensor
Up
Down
Auto Button
186
1Adjusting the Mirrors
* Not available on all models
When you are driving after dark, the
automatic dimming rearview mirror and
power door mirror reduce the glare from
headlights behind you. Press the AUTO button
to turn this function on and off. When
activated, the AUTO indicator comes on.
1Automatic Dimming Rearview Mirror * and Power Door Mirrors *
The auto dimming function cancels when the
transmission is in (R .
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 187 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAdjusting the MirrorsuPower Door Mirrors
Power Door Mirrors
Folding
Button *
Selector
Switch
You can adjust the door mirrors when the
power mode is in ON.
Adjustment Switch
■ Folding door mirrors *
Controls
■ Mirror position adjustment
L/R selector switch: Select the left or right
mirror. After adjusting the mirror, return the
switch to the center position.
Mirror position adjustment switch: Press
the switch left, right, up, or down to move the
mirror.
Press the folding button to fold in and out the
door mirrors.
■ Reverse Tilt Door Mirror *
Selector
Switch
If activated, either side door mirror
automatically tilts downward when you put
the transmission into (R ; this improves closein visibility on the selected side of the vehicle
when backing up. The mirror automatically
returns to its original position when you take
the transmission out of (R .
To activate this feature, set the power mode
to ON, and slide the selector switch to the left
or right side.
* Not available on all models
187
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 188 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Adjusting the Seats
Front Seats
Allow sufficient
space.
Move back.
Controls
Adjust the driver’s seat as far back as possible
while allowing you to maintain full control of
the vehicle. You should be able to sit upright,
well back in the seat and be able to
adequately press the pedals without leaning
forward, and grip the steering wheel
comfortably. The passenger’s seat should be
adjusted in a similar manner, so that it is as far
back from the front airbag in the dashboard
as possible.
■ Adjusting the Seat Positions
Sitting too close to a front airbag can result
in serious injury or death if the front
airbags inflate.
Always sit as far back from the front
airbags as possible while maintaining
control of the vehicle.
Always make seat adjustments before driving.
Horizontal Position
Adjustment
Height Adjustment *
Seat-back Angle
Adjustment
* Not available on all models
3 WARNING
The National Highway Traffic Safety Administration
and Transport Canada recommend that drivers allow
at least 10 inches (25 cm) between the center of the
steering wheel and the chest.
■ Adjusting the front power seats *
188
1Adjusting the Seats
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 189 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuFront Seats
■ Lumbar Support Adjustment Switch *
Press the front: To increase the entire
lumbar support.
Press the rear: To decrease the entire lumbar
support.
Controls
Lumbar
Support
Adjustment
Switch
* Not available on all models
Continued
189
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 190 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuFront Seats
■ Adjusting the front manual seats *
1Adjusting the front manual seats *
Once a seat is adjusted correctly, rock it back and
forth to make sure it is locked in position.
Height Adjustment
(Driver side only)
Pull up or push down the lever
to raise or lower the seat.
Controls
Seat-back Angle
Adjustment
Horizontal Position
Adjustment
Pull up on the bar to move the
seat, then release the bar.
190
* Not available on all models
Pull up the lever to
change the angle.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 191 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuFront Seats
■ Adjusting the Seat-Backs
1Adjusting the Seat-Backs
Adjust the driver’s seat-back to a comfortable,
upright position, leaving ample space
between your chest and the airbag cover in
the center of the steering wheel.
Reclining a seat-back so that the shoulder part of the belt no longer rests against the
occupant’s chest reduces the protective capability of the belt. It also increases the
chance of sliding under the belt in a crash and being seriously injured. The farther a
seat-back is reclined, the greater the risk of injury.
Reclining the seat-back too far can result in
serious injury or death in a crash.
Adjust the seat-back to an upright position,
and sit well back in the seat.
Do not put a cushion, or other object, between the
seat-back and your back.
Controls
The front seat passenger should also adjust
their seat-back to a comfortable, upright
position.
3 WARNING
Doing so may interfere with proper seat belt or airbag
operation.
If you cannot get far enough away from the steering
wheel and still reach the controls, we recommend
that you investigate whether some type of adaptive
equipment may help.
191
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 192 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuRear Seats
Rear Seats
■ Adjusting the Seat Positions
1Adjusting the Seat Positions
Once a seat is adjusted correctly, rock it back and
forth to make sure it is locked in position.
Controls
Horizontal Position
Adjustment
Pull up the bar to move the
seat, then release the bar.
192
Seat-back Angle
Adjustment
Pull up the lever to change
the angle.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 193 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuRear Seats
■ Folding Down the Rear Seat
Separately fold down the left and right halves of the rear seat to make room for
cargo.
1. Store the center seat belt first. Insert the latch plate into the slot on the side of the
anchor buckle.
2. Retract the seat belt into the holder on the ceiling.
2 Seat Belt with Detachable Anchor P. 42
To return the seat to the original position, pull
up the seat-back in the upright position.
Make sure that the folded seat-back does not press
against the front passenger seat, as this can cause the
weight sensors in the front passenger seat to work
improperly.
2 Passenger Front Airbag Off Indicator P. 56
The front seats must be far enough forward so they
do not interfere with the rear seats as they fold
down.
To lock the seat-back upright, push it backwards until
it locks.
Controls
3. Lower the center head restraint to its lowest position. Put the armrest back into
the seat-back.
4. Pull up on the seat-back angle adjustment
lever.
1Folding Down the Rear Seat
Make sure the seat-back, head restraints and seat
cushion are securely latched back into place before
driving. Make sure the center shoulder belt is repositioned in the holding slot.
Lever
193
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 194 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuHead Restraints
Head Restraints
Your vehicle is equipped with head restraints in all seating positions.
■ Adjusting the Front and Rear Outer Seat Head Restraint
Positions
Controls
Head restraints are most effective for
protection against whiplash and other rearimpact crash injuries when the center of the
back of the occupant’s head rests against the
center of the restraint. The tops of the
occupant’s ears should be level with the
center height of the restraint.
Position head in the center
of the head restraint.
To raise the head restraint: Pull it upward.
To lower the head restraint: Push it down
while pressing the release button.
194
1Adjusting the Front and Rear Outer Seat Head Restraint Positions
3 WARNING
Improperly positioning head restraints
reduces their effectiveness and increases
the likelihood of serious injury in a crash.
Make sure head restraints are in place and
positioned properly before driving.
In order for the head restraint system to work
properly:
• Do not hang any items on the head restraints, or
from the restraint legs.
• Do not place any objects between an occupant and
the seat-back.
• Install each restraint in its proper location.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 195 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuHead Restraints
■ Changing the Rear Center Seat Head Restraint Position
■ Removing and Reinstalling the Head Restraints
Head restraints can be removed for cleaning or repair.
To remove a head restraint:
Front and rear outer seat head restraint
Pull the restraint up as far as it will go. Then push the release button, and pull the
restraint up and out.
Rear center seat head restraint
Controls
A passenger sitting in the rear center seating
position should adjust the height of their head
restraint to an appropriate position before the
vehicle begins moving.
To raise the head restraint:
Pull it upward.
To lower the head restraint:
Push it down while pressing the release
button(s).
1Removing and Reinstalling the Head Restraints
3 WARNING
Failure to reinstall, or correctly reinstall, the
head restraints can result in severe injury
during a crash.
Always replace the head restraints before
driving.
Pull the restraint up as far as it will go. Then push the release buttons which are
located on the both legs at the same time, and pull the restraint up and out.
To reinstall a head restraint:
Insert the legs back in place, then adjust the head restraint to an appropriate height
while pressing the release button(s). Pull up on the restraint to make sure it is locked
in position.
195
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 196 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuMaintain a Proper Sitting Position
Maintain a Proper Sitting Position
After all occupants have adjusted their seats and head restraints, and put on their
seat belts, it is very important that they continue to sit upright, well back in their
seats, with their feet on the floor until the vehicle is safely parked and the engine is
off.
Sitting improperly can increase the chance of injury during a crash. For example, if
an occupant slouches, lies down, turns sideways, sits forward, leans forward or
sideways, or puts one or both feet up, the chance of injury during a crash is greatly
increased.
Controls
196
In addition, an occupant who is out of position in the front seat can be seriously or
fatally injured in a crash by striking interior parts of the vehicle or being struck by an
inflating front airbag.
1Maintain a Proper Sitting Position
3 WARNING
Sitting improperly or out of position can
result in serious injury or death in a crash.
Always sit upright, well back in the seat,
with your feet on the floor.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 197 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAdjusting the SeatsuArmrest
Armrest
■ Using the Front Seat Armrest
Pull down the armrest.
Models with adjustable armrest
pull the armrest all the way down, then pull it
up to the desired angle.
Controls
■ Using the Rear Seat Armrest
Pull down the armrest of the center backrest.
197
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 198 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Interior Lights/Interior Convenience Items
Interior Lights
■ Interior Light Switches
1Interior Light Switches
■ ON
Door Activated Position
Off
Controls
On
The interior lights come on regardless of
whether the tailgate and doors are open or
closed.
■ Door activated
The interior lights come on in the following
situations:
• When tailgate or any doors are opened.
• You unlock the driver’s door.
• When the power mode is set to VEHICLE
OFF (LOCK).
■ OFF
The interior lights remain off regardless of
whether the tailgate or the doors are open or
closed.
In the door activated position, the interior lights fade
out and go off about 30 seconds after the doors are
closed.
The lights go off after about 30 seconds in the
following situations:
• When you unlock the driver’s door but do not open
it.
• When you set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK) but do not open a door.
You can change the interior lights dimming time.
Models without Display Audio
2 Vehicle Customization P. 119
Models with Display Audio
2 Customized Features P. 359
The interior lights go off immediately in the following
situations:
• When you lock the driver’s door.
• When you close the driver’s door in ACCESSORY
mode.
• When you set the power mode to ON.
If you leave the tailgate or doors open in VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK) mode, the interior lights go off after about 15
minutes.
To avoid draining the battery, do not leave the
interior light on for an extended length of time when
the engine or power system is off.
198
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 199 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Lights
■ Map Lights
1Map Lights
■ Front
The map lights can be turned on and off by
pressing the lenses.
Continued
Controls
■ Rear
The map lights can be turned on and off by
pressing the lenses when the front interior
light switch is in the door activated position.
When the front interior light switch is in the door
activated position and any door is open, the map
light will not go off when you press the lens.
199
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 200 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Lights
■ Cargo Area Light
■ ON
The light comes on regardless of whether the
tailgate is open or closed.
Off
On
■ Tailgate activated
The light comes on when you open the
tailgate, and goes off when closed.
Controls
200
Tailgate Activated Position
■ OFF
The light stays off with or without opening the
tailgate.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 201 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
Interior Convenience Items
■ Glove Box
1Glove Box
Pull the lever to open the glove box. You can
lock the glove box with the built-in key.
To Lock
3 WARNING
An open glove box can cause serious injury
to your passenger in a crash, even if the
passenger is wearing the seat belt.
Always keep the glove box closed while
driving.
Controls
Glove Box
■ Console Compartment
To open the console compartment, press the
button to unlock the lid, and then slide it
rearward.
Button
Continued
201
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 202 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Console Tray
Slide the tray when you use the console
compartment.
Controls
202
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 203 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Beverage Holders
1Beverage Holders
■ Front seat beverage holders
NOTICE
Are located in the console between the front
seats.
Spilled liquids damage the upholstery, carpeting, and
electrical components in the interior.
Be careful when you are using the beverage holders.
Hot liquid can scald you.
■ Door side beverage holders
Are located on the both of front and rear door
side pockets.
Controls
Front
Rear
Continued
203
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 204 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Rear seat beverage holders
Fold the armrest down to use the rear seat
beverage holders.
Controls
204
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 205 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Accessory Power Sockets
1Accessory Power Sockets
The accessory power sockets can be used when the power mode is in ACCESSORY
or ON.
■ Console panel
Open the lid and the cover to use it.
Do not insert an automotive type cigarette lighter
element.
This can overheat the power socket.
The accessory power socket is designed to supply
power for 12-volt DC accessories that are rated 180
watts (15 amps) or less.
Controls
To prevent battery drain, only use the power socket
with the engine running.
■ Console compartment
Pull the handle and open the cover to use it.
Continued
205
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 206 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Cargo area *
Open the cover to use it.
Controls
■ AC Power Outlet *
The AC power outlet can be used when the engine is running.
Open the cover to use it. Plug in the appliance
slightly, turn it 90° clockwise, then push it all
the way.
1AC Power Outlet *
NOTICE
Do not use the AC power outlet for electric
appliances that require high initial peak wattage,
such as cathode-ray tube type televisions,
refrigerators, electric pumps, etc. It is not suitable for
devices that process precise data, such as medical
equipment, and that require an extremely stable
power supply, such as microcomputer-controlled
electric blankets, touch sensor lamps, etc.
The AC power outlet is designed to supply power for
up to 115 volt appliances that are rated 150 watts or
less.
Continued use of any electric appliance/device
exceeding these ratings may result in damage to the
appliance/device.
206
* Not available on all models
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 207 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Wireless Charger *
1Wireless Charger *
* Not available on all models
Continued
In order to use safely:
• Remove any metal objects from the charge pad
before charging a device.
• Do not open the charger case.
• Do not use the charger if it malfunctions. Contact
your dealer.
3 CAUTION
Metal objects between the charge pad
and the device to be charged will get
hot and can burn you.
• Always remove foreign objects from
the charge pad before charging the
device.
• Be sure the surface is clear of dust and
other debris before charging.
• Do not spill liquids (i. e. water, drinks,
etc.) on the charger and the device.
• Do not use oil, grease, alcohol,
benzine or thinner for cleaning the
charge pad.
• Do not cover the system with towels,
clothing, or other objects while
charging etc.
• Avoid spraying aerosols which may
come in contact with the charge pad
surface.
Controls
To use the wireless charger, the power mode must be in ACCESSORY or ON.
Charge a compatible device on the area indicated by the
mark as follows:
1.
Place
the
device
you
want
to charge on the
Charging Area
charging area.
u The system will automatically start
Green
charging the device, and the green
Indicator
indicator light will come on.
u Make sure that the device is compatible
with the system and placed with the
chargeable side in the center of the
charging area.
2. When charging is completed, the green
indicator light will go off.
u If the device is not located on the charge
area correctly, the green indicator light
will blink.
207
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 208 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ When charging does not start
1Wireless Charger *
Perform one of the solutions in the following table.
Indicator
Cause
There is an obstacle(s) between
the charging area and the
device.
Remove the
obstacle(s).
The device is not within the
charging area.
Move the device to the
center of the charging
area where
is
located.
The wireless charger is faulty.
Turn the vehicle off
and back on. If the
indicator still blinks,
contact a dealer.
Slow Blink
Controls
Fast Blink
Solution
Using the audio/information screen, you can disable
the wireless charger function.
2 Customized Features P. 359
This system consumes a lot of power. Do not use the
system for a long time when the engine is not
running. This may weaken the battery, making it
difficult to start the engine.
When using the wireless charger, check the user’s
manual that came with the compatible device you
want to charge.
NOTICE
Do not place any magnetic recording media or
precision machines within the charging area while
charging.
The data on your cards such as credit cards can be
lost because of the magnetic effect. Also precision
machines such as watches can go wrong.
“Qi” and
marks are the registered trademarks
owned by Wireless Power Consortium (WPC).
In the following cases, charging may stop or not start:
• The device is already fully charged.
• The temperature of the device is extremely high
while charging.
• You are at a place that emits strong
electromagnetic waves or noises, such as a TV
station, electric power plant, or gas station.
208
* Not available on all models
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 209 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
1Wireless Charger *
A device may not charge if the size or shape of its
chargeable side is not appropriate for use with the
charging area.
Not all devices are compatible with the system.
During the charging phase, it is normal for the
charging area and device to heat up.
Controls
Charging may be briefly interrupted when:
• All the doors and the tailgate are closed
- to avoid interference with the proper functioning
of the smart entry system.
• The position of the device is altered.
Do not charge more than one device at a time on a
charging area.
■ Coat Hooks
1Coat Hooks
There is a coat hook on the rear grab handle
of both sides. Pull it down to use it.
* Not available on all models
Continued
The coat hooks are not designed for large or heavy
items.
209
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 210 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Sunglasses Holder
1Sunglasses Holder
To open the sunglasses holder, push and
release the indent. To close, push it again until
it latches.
You can store eyeglasses and other small
items in this holder.
Push
Controls
■ Integrated Sunshades *
Tab
Hook
210
Keep the holder closed while driving except when
accessing stored items.
* Not available on all models
1Integrated Sunshades *
Pull the tab and roll up the sunshade all the
way. Use the hooks to hang it.
Use the sunshades only when the windows are fully
closed. Using the shade while a window is open can
unhook and blow off the shade, hitting and hurting
anyone sitting near the window.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 211 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Front Seat Heaters *
1Front Seat Heaters *
The power mode must be in ON to use the
seat heaters.
3 WARNING
Heat induced burns are possible when
using seat heaters.
Press the seat heater button:
Once - The HI setting (three indicators on)
Twice - The MID setting (two indicators on)
Three times - The LO setting (one indicator on)
Four times - The OFF setting (no indicators on)
Controls
Persons with a diminished ability to sense
temperature (e.g., persons with diabetes,
lower-limb nerve damage, or paralysis) or
with sensitive skin should not use seat
heaters.
Do not use the seat heaters even in LO when the
engine is off. Under such conditions, the battery may
be weakened, making the engine difficult to start.
After a certain period of time, the strength setting for
the seat heaters will automatically be reduced by one
level at a time until the seat heater shuts off. The
elapsed time varies according to the interior
environment.
* Not available on all models
Continued
211
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 212 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Front Seat Heaters and Seat Ventilation *
The power mode must be in ON to use the
seat heaters or ventilation.
3 WARNING
Heat induced burns are possible when
using seat heaters.
Persons with a diminished ability to sense
temperature (e.g., persons with diabetes,
lower-limb nerve damage, or paralysis) or
with sensitive skin should not use seat
heaters.
Controls
212
1Front Seat Heaters and Seat Ventilation *
Press the seat heater or the seat ventilation
button:
Once - The HI setting (three indicators on)
Twice - The MID setting (two indicators on)
Three times - The LO setting (one indicator
on)
Four times - The OFF setting (no indicators on)
* Not available on all models
Do not use the seat heaters and the seat ventilation
even in LO when the engine is off. Under such
conditions, the battery may be weakened, making
the engine difficult to start.
After a certain period of time, the strength setting for
the seat heaters will automatically be reduced by one
level at a time until the seat heater shuts off. The
elapsed time varies according to the interior
environment.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 213 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Rear Outer Seat Heaters *
1Rear Outer Seat Heaters *
The power mode must be in ON to use the
seat heaters.
Heat induced burns are possible when
using seat heaters.
Persons with a diminished ability to sense
temperature (e.g., persons with diabetes,
lower-limb nerve damage, or paralysis) or
with sensitive skin should not use seat
heaters.
Controls
There is no heater in the rear center seating
position.
Press the seat heater button:
Once - The HI setting (three indicators on)
Twice - The MID setting (two indicators on)
Three times - The LO setting (one indicator on)
Four times - The OFF setting (no indicators on)
3 WARNING
Do not use the seat heaters even in LO when the
engine is off. Under such conditions, the battery may
be weakened, making the engine difficult to start.
After a certain period of time, the strength setting for
the rear seat heaters will automatically be reduced by
one level at a time until the rear seat heater shuts off.
The elapsed time varies according to the interior
environment.
* Not available on all models
Continued
213
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 214 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Heated Steering Wheel *
Heated Steering
Wheel Button
1Heated Steering Wheel *
The power mode must be in ON to use the
heated steering wheel.
Press the button on the right side of the
steering wheel.
Indicator
Controls
214
When a comfortable temperature is reached,
press the button again to turn it off.
The heated steering wheel is turned off every
time you start the engine, even if you turned it
on the last time you drove the vehicle.
* Not available on all models
Do not use the heated steering wheel continuously
when the engine is off. Under such conditions, the
battery may be weakened, making the engine
difficult to start.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 215 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Tie-down Anchors
The tie-down anchors on the cargo area floor
can be used to install a net for securing items.
Anchor
■ Cargo Hooks
1Cargo Hooks
The cargo hooks on both sides of the cargo
area can be used to hang a light items.
Controls
Anchor
Heavy objects may damage the hook. Make sure any
items put on this hook weigh less than 6.6 lbs (3 kg).
Distribute cargo evenly on the floor of the cargo area,
placing the heaviest items on the bottom and as far
forward as possible.
Continued
215
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 216 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuInterior Lights/Interior Convenience ItemsuInterior Convenience Items
■ Under-floor Storage Area
Pull the handle to open the cargo floor lid.
Controls
216
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 217 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Climate Control System
Using Automatic Climate Control
The automatic climate control system maintains the interior temperature you select.
The system also selects the proper mix of heated or cooled air that will as quickly as
possible, raise or lower the interior temperature to your preference.
Dashboard and
Dashboard and floor, Floor vents
back of the center and back of the
console vents
center console vents
Floor and
defroster
vents
A/C (Air Conditioning)
Button
Driver’s Side
Temperature
Control Switch
Passenger’s Side
Temperature Control
Switch
(On/Off) Button
SYNC (Synchronization) Button
Fan Control Button
(Windshield Defroster)
Button
(Recirculation) Button
Use the system when the engine is running.
1. Press the AUTO button.
2. Adjust the interior temperature using the driver’s side or passenger’s side
temperature control switch.
3. Press the
ON/OFF button to cancel.
Continued
If any buttons are pressed while using the climate
control system in auto, the function of the button
that was pressed will take priority.
The AUTO indicator will go off, but functions
unrelated to the button that was pressed will be
controlled automatically.
During Auto Idle Stop, air-conditioning is suspended,
and only the blower remains active.
If you do not want air-conditioning suspended, press
the Auto Idle Stop OFF button to cancel Auto Idle
Stop.
Controls
AUTO Button
1Using Automatic Climate Control
To prevent cold air from blowing in from outside, the
fan may operate at low speed for a while after the
AUTO button has been pressed.
While ECON mode is active, the climate control
system may have reduced cooling performance.
If the interior is very warm, you can cool it down
more rapidly by partially opening the windows,
turning the system on auto, and setting the
temperature to low. Change the fresh mode to
recirculation mode until the temperature cools down.
When you set the temperature to the lower or upper
limit, Lo or Hi is displayed.
217
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 218 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuClimate Control SystemuUsing Automatic Climate Control
■ Switching between the recirculation and fresh air modes
Press the
button and switch the mode depending on environmental conditions.
Recirculation Mode (indicator on): Recirculates air from the vehicle’s interior through
the system.
Fresh Air Mode (indicator off): Maintains outside ventilation. Keep the system in
fresh air mode in normal situations.
■ Defrosting the Windshield and Windows
Controls
Pressing the
button turns the air
conditioner system on and automatically
switches the system to fresh air mode.
Press the
button again to turn off, the
system returns to the previous settings.
1Using Automatic Climate Control
Pressing the
ON/OFF button switches the
climate control system between on and off. When
turned on, the system returns to your last selection.
1Defrosting the Windshield and Windows
For your safety, make sure you have a clear view
through all the windows before driving.
Do not set the temperature near the upper or lower
limit.
When cold air hits the windshield, the outside of the
windshield may fog up.
If you press the
button during Auto Idle Stop, the
engine restarts automatically.
If the side windows fog up, adjust the vents so that
the air hits the side windows.
218
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 219 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuClimate Control SystemuUsing Automatic Climate Control
■ To rapidly defrost the windows
1. Press the
2. Press the
1To rapidly defrost the windows
button.
button.
After defrosting or defogging the windows, switch
over to fresh air mode. If you keep the system in
recirculation mode, the windows may fog up from
humidity. This impedes visibility.
Controls
219
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 220 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuClimate Control SystemuSynchronization Mode
Synchronization Mode
1Synchronization Mode
When you press the
button, the system changes
to synchronization mode.
When the system is in synchronization mode off, the
temperature for the driver, front passenger, and rear
seats can be set separately.
Controls
You can set the temperature synchronously for the driver side, front passenger side
and rear seats in synchronization mode.
1. Press the SYNC button.
u The system will switch to synchronization mode.
2. Adjust the temperature using driver’s side temperature control switch.
Press the SYNC button to return to synchronization mode off.
220
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 221 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuClimate Control SystemuRear Climate Control System
Rear Climate Control System
■ Using the Rear Climate Control System From the Front Panel
Controls
(Rear On/Off) Button
RR SETTINGS Button
Use the system when the engine is running and the climate control system is
operating.
1. Press the REAR
(Rear On/Off) button.
2. Press the RR SETTINGS button.
u The system switches to the rear control mode for 10 seconds. The REAR
indicator appears on the display.
Continued
221
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 222 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuClimate Control SystemuRear Climate Control System
3. Press the AUTO button.
u The rear system changes to AUTO mode.
u The system automatically adjusts the fan speed and airflow levels to maintain
the set rear temperature. Change the temperature if necessary.
4. To turn off the rear climate control system, press the
(Rear On/Off) button.
■ Using the Rear Climate Control System From the Rear Panel *
Controls
Rear floor
vents
Rear Temperature
Control Buttons
Rear AUTO Button
Rear console
vents and
floor vents
Rear console
vents
/
(Rear Fan
Control) Buttons
(Rear On/Off) Button
Use the system when the engine is running and the climate control system is
operating.
1. Press the
(Rear On/Off) button.
2. Press the Rear AUTO button.
3. Adjust the interior temperature using the rear temperature control button.
4. To turn off the rear climate control system, press the
button.
222
* Not available on all models
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 223 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuClimate Control SystemuAutomatic Climate Control Sensors
Automatic Climate Control Sensors
Sensor
The automatic climate control system is
equipped with sensors. Do not cover or spill
any liquid on them.
Controls
Sensor
223
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 224 ページ
224
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 225 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Features
This chapter describes how to operate technology features.
Audio System
About Your Audio System................ 226
USB Ports ......................................... 227
Auxiliary Input Jack .......................... 228
Audio System Theft Protection ......... 229
Audio Remote Controls.................... 230
Models with color audio system
Audio System Basic Operation ........ 233
Models with Display Audio
Audio System Basic Operation ........ 251
Audio Error Messages
iPod/USB Flash Drive ........................ 327
* Not available on all models
Models with Display Audio
Android/Apps .................................. 329
General Information on the Audio
System
SiriusXM® Radio Service * ................. 330
Compatible iPod, iPad, iPhone, and USB
Flash Drives .................................... 331
Honda App License Agreement........ 332
Legal Information on Apple CarPlay/
Android Auto................................. 344
About Open Source Licenses............ 346
License Information * ........................ 347
Models with color audio system
Customized Features........................ 352
Models with Display Audio
Customized Features........................ 359
HomeLink® Universal Transceiver * .. 378
Models with color audio system
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®............. 381
Models with Display Audio
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®............. 406
225
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 226 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Audio System
About Your Audio System
The audio system features AM/FM radio and SiriusXM® Radio * service. It can also
play USB flash drives, and iPod, iPhone, iPad * and Bluetooth® devices.
You can operate the audio system from the buttons * and knobs on the panel, the
remote controls on the steering wheel, or the icons on the touchscreen interface *.
1About Your Audio System
SiriusXM® Radio is available on a subscription basis
only. For more information on SiriusXM® Radio,
contact a dealer. *
2 General Information on the Audio System
P. 330
SiriusXM® Radio is available in the United States and
Canada, except Hawaii, Alaska, and Puerto Rico. *
SiriusXM® is a registered trademark of SiriusXM
Radio, Inc. *
*1
Features
iPod, iPad, iPhone and iTunes are trademarks of
Apple Inc.
iPod
*2
USB Flash Drive
Remote Controls
226
* Not available on all models
*1 : Models with color audio system
*2 : Models with Display Audio
State or local laws may prohibit the operation of
handheld electronic devices while operating a
vehicle.
Models with Display Audio
After you set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF, you
can use the audio system for up to 30 minutes per
driving cycle, or until opening the driver's door.
However, whether you can continue using the audio
system depends on the battery condition. Repeatedly
using this feature may drain the battery.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 227 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio SystemuUSB Ports
USB Ports
Models
with
color
audio
system
Models
with
Display
Audio
1USB Ports
• Do not leave the iPod or USB flash drive in the
■ On the console panel
Models with color audio system
•
u The USB port (1.0A) is for playing audio
files on the USB flash drive, connecting a
cell phone, and charging devices.
Models with Display Audio
•
•
•
u The USB port (2.5A) is for charging
devices, playing audio files and
connecting compatible phones with
Apple CarPlay or Android Auto.
u To prevent any potential issues, be sure
to use an Apple MFi Certified Lightning
Connector for Apple CarPlay, and for
Android Auto, the USB cables should be
certified by USB-IF to be compliant with
USB 2.0 Standard.
■ In the console compartment
The USB port (2.5A) is only for charging
devices.
•
vehicle. Direct sunlight and high temperatures may
damage it.
We recommend using an extension cable with the
USB port.
Do not connect the iPod or USB flash drive using a hub.
Do not use a device such as a card reader or hard disk
drive, as the device or your files may be damaged.
We recommend backing up your data before using
the device in your vehicle.
Displayed messages may vary depending on the
device model and software version.
If the audio system does not recognize the iPod, try
reconnecting it a few times or reboot the device. To
reboot, follow the manufacturer’s instructions
provided with the iPod or visit www.apple.com/ipod.
Features
In the console compartment
Install the iPod USB connector or the USB flash
drive to the USB port.
USB charge
The USB port can supply up to 1.0A/2.5A of power. It
does not output 1.0A/2.5A unless the device
requests.
For amperage details, read the operating manual of
the device that needs to be charged.
Set the power mode to ACCESSORY or ON first.
In the console compartment
This port is for battery charge only. You cannot play
music even if you have connected a music player to it.
Continued
227
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 228 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio SystemuAuxiliary Input Jack
On the back of the console
compartment
USB Ports
■ On the back of the console
compartment *
The USB ports (2.5A) are only for charging
devices.
1USB Ports
On the back of the console compartment
This port is for battery charge only. You cannot play
music even if you have connected a music player to it.
Under certain conditions, a device connected to the port
may generate noise in the radio you are listening to.
Features
Auxiliary Input Jack
Use the jack to connect devices.
1Auxiliary Input Jack
Models with color audio system
1. Open the cover.
2. Connect a device to the input jack using a
1/8 inch (3.5 mm) stereo miniplug.
u The audio system automatically switches
to the AUX mode.
To switch to another mode, press the RADIO or
MEDIA button.
To return to the AUX mode, press the MEDIA
button.
Models with Display Audio
To switch to another mode or return to the AUX
mode, select the audio source icon.
You cannot use the auxiliary input jack if you replace
the audio system.
228
* Not available on all models
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 229 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio SystemuAudio System Theft Protection
Audio System Theft Protection
The audio system is disabled when it is disconnected from the power source, such as
when the battery is disconnected or goes dead. In certain conditions, the system
may display a code entry screen. If this occurs, reactivate the audio system.
■ Reactivating the audio system
1. Set the power mode to ON.
2. Turn on the audio system.
3. Press and hold the audio system power button for more than two seconds.
u The audio system is reactivated when the audio control unit establishes a
connection with the vehicle control unit. If the control unit fails to recognize
the audio unit, you must go to a dealer and have the audio unit checked.
Features
229
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 230 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio SystemuAudio Remote Controls
Audio Remote Controls
Models with color audio system
1Audio Remote Controls
Allow you to operate the audio system while driving.
SOURCE Button
/
(+ / (Cycles through the audio modes as follows:
Buttons
Bar
FM1FM2AMUSB/iPodBluetooth®
AudioAUX
SOURCE Button
Features
230
(+ / (- (Volume) Bar
Press (+ : To increase the volume.
Press (- : To decrease the volume.
/
Buttons
• When listening to the radio
Press
: To select the next preset radio station.
Press
: To select the previous preset radio station.
Press and hold
: To select the next strong station.
Press and hold
: To select the previous strong station.
• When listening to an iPod, USB flash drive, or Bluetooth® Audio
Press
: To skip to the next song.
Press
: To go back to the beginning of the current or previous song.
• When listening to a USB flash drive, or Bluetooth® Audio
Press and hold
: To skip to the next folder.
Press and hold
: To go back to the previous folder.
Some modes appear only when an appropriate
device or medium is used.
Depending on the Bluetooth® device you connect,
some functions may not be operated.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 231 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio SystemuAudio Remote Controls
Models with Display Audio
1Audio Remote Controls
Allow you to operate the audio system while driving. The information is shown on
the driver information interface.
(+ / (- (Volume) Bar
/
(+ / (3/4/
Press (+ : To increase the volume.
Buttons
Bar
Press (- : To decrease the volume.
Some modes appear only when an appropriate
device or medium is used.
Depending on the Bluetooth® device you connect,
some functions may not be operated.
Press the
(back) button to go back to the
previous screen or cancel a command.
Press the
(home) button to go back to the home
screen of the driver information interface.
ENTER Button
Continued
Features
You can show or hide the audio mode icons, or
change the order of the icons.
2 Show/Hide Apps P. 116
2 Arrange Apps P. 117
231
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 232 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio SystemuAudio Remote Controls
3/4/
/
/ENTER Buttons
• When selecting the audio mode
Press 3 or 4 to select Now Playing on the home screen of the driver
information interface, and then press the ENTER button.
Features
232
Press 3 or 4 : To cycles through the audio modes as follows:
Android Auto/Apple CarPlaySiriusXM® *AUX InputAM
Bluetooth® AudioSocial PlaylistFMMy Honda MusicUSB/iPod
• When listening to the radio
Press
: To select the next preset radio station.
Press
: To select the previous preset radio station.
• When listening to an iPod, USB flash drive, My Honda Music, or Bluetooth® Audio
Press
: To skip to the next song.
Press
: To go back to the beginning of the current or previous song.
* Not available on all models
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 233 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Audio System Basic Operation
Models with color audio system
1Audio System Basic Operation
To use the audio system, the power mode must be in ACCESSORY or ON.
Use the selector knob or MENU/CLOCK
(Day/Night) Button
button to access some audio functions.
(Sound) Button
Press
to switch between the normal and
extended display for some functions.
Menu Display
(Back) button: Press to go back to the previous display.
(Sound) button: Press to select the sound setting mode.
(Day/Night) button: Press to change the audio/information screen
brightness.
Press the
button, then adjust the brightness using
.
u Each time you press the
button, the mode switches between the daytime
mode, nighttime mode and off mode.
Rotate
Press
to select.
to enter.
Menu Items
2 Adjusting the Clock P. 130
2 Wallpaper Setup P. 236
2 Adjusting the Sound P. 238
2 Display Setup P. 239
2 Scan P. 241, 247
2 Play Mode P. 244, 247
2 RDS Settings P. 241
2 Bluetooth P. 353
One of the operating systems used in this unit is
eCos.
For software license terms and condition, visit their
website (eCos license URL:
http://ecos.sourceware.org/license-overview.html)
For source code disclosure and other details
regarding eCos, visit:
http://www.hondaopensource2.com
Features
(Back) Button
MENU/CLOCK Button
Selector Knob
Selector knob: Rotate left or right to scroll
through the available choices. Press
to set
your selection.
MENU/CLOCK button: Press to select any
mode.
The available modes include wallpaper,
display, clock, language setup, and play
modes. Play mode choices include scan,
random, repeat, and so on.
These indications are used to show how to operate
the selector knob.
or
button on the
Press the SOURCE, (+ , (- ,
steering wheel to change any audio setting.
2 Audio Remote Controls P. 230
233
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 234 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
Audio/Information Screen
Displays the audio status and wallpaper. From this screen, you can go to various
setup options.
■ Switching the Display
Audio/Information Screen
Audio
Features
Clock/Wallpaper
234
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 235 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Audio
Shows the current audio information.
■ Clock/Wallpaper
Shows a clock screen or an image you import.
■ Change display
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Settings, then press .
3. Rotate
to select Display Change, then press .
4. Rotate
to select Wallpaper, then press .
u If you want to return to the audio/information screen, select Audio.
Features
Continued
235
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 236 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Wallpaper Setup
1Wallpaper Setup
You can change, store, and delete the wallpaper on the audio/information screen.
■ Import wallpaper
You can import up to three images, one at a time, for wallpaper from a USB flash
drive.
1. Connect the USB flash drive to the USB
port.
• When importing wallpaper files, the image must be
•
•
•
•
2 USB Ports P. 227
Features
236
2. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
3. Rotate
to select Settings, then press
.
4. Rotate
to select Wallpaper, then press
.
5. Rotate
to select Import, then press .
u The picture name is displayed on the list.
6. Rotate
to select a desired picture, then
press .
u The selected picture is displayed.
7. Press
to save the picture.
8. Press
to select OK.
9. Rotate
to select a location to save the
picture, then press .
u The display will return to the wallpaper
setting screen.
•
•
in the USB flash drive’s root directory. Images in a
folder cannot be imported.
The file name must be fewer than 64 characters.
The file format of the image that can be imported
is BMP (bmp) or JPEG (jpg).
The individual file size limit is 2 MB.
The maximum image size is 1,920 x 936 pixels. If
the image size is less than 480 × 234 pixels, the
image is displayed in the middle of the screen with
the extra area appearing in black.
Up to 255 files can be selected.
If the USB flash drive does not have any pictures,
the No files detected message appears.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 237 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Select wallpaper
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Settings, then press .
3. Rotate
to select Wallpaper, then press .
4. Rotate
to select Select, then press .
u The screen changes to the wallpaper list.
5. Rotate
to select a desired wallpaper, then press
1Wallpaper Setup
To go back to the previous screen, press the
(Back) button.
When the file size is large, it takes a while to be
previewed.
.
Features
■ To view wallpaper once it is set
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Settings, then press .
3. Rotate
to select Display Change, then press .
4. Rotate
to select Wallpaper, then press .
u The screen changes to the wallpaper list.
5. Rotate
to select a wallpaper that you want to set, then press
.
■ Delete wallpaper
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Settings, then press .
3. Rotate
to select Wallpaper, then press .
4. Rotate
to select Delete, then press .
u The screen changes to the wallpaper list.
5. Rotate
to select a wallpaper that you want to delete, then press
6. Rotate
to select Yes, then press .
u The display will return to the wallpaper setting screen.
.
237
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 238 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAdjusting the Sound
Adjusting the Sound
(Sound) Button
Press the
(sound) button, and rotate
to scroll through the following choices:
Selector Knob
TRE is selectable.
Features
BAS
Bass
TRE
Treble
FAD
Fader
BAL
Balance
SUBW
SVC
Sub woofer
Speed-sensitive
Volume Compensation
Rotate
to adjust the sound setting, then
press .
238
1Adjusting the Sound
The SVC has four modes: Off, Low, Mid, and High.
SVC adjusts the volume level based on the vehicle
speed. As you go faster, audio volume increases. As
you slow down, audio volume decreases.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 239 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuDisplay Setup
Display Setup
You can change the brightness or color theme of the audio/information screen.
■ Changing the Screen Brightness
■ Changing the Screen’s Color Theme
You can change the Contrast and Black Level
settings in the same manner.
Features
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Settings, then press
.
3. Rotate
to select Display Adjustment,
then press .
4. Rotate
to select Brightness, then press
.
5. Rotate
to adjust the setting, then press
.
1Changing the Screen Brightness
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Settings, then press
.
3. Rotate
to select Color Theme, then
press .
4. Rotate
to select the setting you want,
then press .
239
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 240 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
Playing AM/FM Radio
Audio/Information Screen
RADIO Button
Press to select a band.
Features
VOL/
(Volume/Power) Knob
Press to turn the audio system
on and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
/
(Seek/Skip) Buttons
Press
or
to search up and
down the selected band for a station
with a strong signal.
Preset Buttons (1-6)
To store a station:
1. Tune to the selected station.
2. Pick a preset button and hold it until you hear a beep.
To listen to a stored station, select a band, then press the preset button.
240
Selector Knob
Turn to tune the radio frequency.
Press, and then turn to select an
item. After that, press again to
make your selection.
MENU/CLOCK Button
Press to display the menu items.
(Back) Button
Press to go back to the previous
display or cancel a setting.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 241 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
■ Radio Data System (RDS)
1Playing AM/FM Radio
Provides text data information related to your selected RDS capable FM station.
■ To find an RDS station from Station List
1. Press
while listening to an FM station.
2. Rotate
to select the station, then press .
■ Update List
Updates your available station list at any time.
1. Press
while listening to an FM station.
2. Rotate
to select Update List, then press
The ST indicator appears on the display indicating
stereo FM broadcasts.
Stereo reproduction in AM is not available.
You can store 6 AM stations and 12 FM stations into
reset button memory. FM1 and FM2 let you store 6
stations each.
Switching the Audio Mode
Press the SOURCE button on the steering wheel.
2 Audio Remote Controls P. 230
.
1Radio Data System (RDS)
When you select an RDS-capable FM station, the RDS
automatically turns on, and the frequency display
changes to the station name. However, when the
signals of that station become weak, the display
changes from the station name to the frequency.
Features
■ Radio text
Displays the radio text information of the selected RDS station.
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Settings, then press .
3. Rotate
to select RDS Settings, then press .
4. Rotate
to select Radio Text, then press .
■ Scan
Samples each of the strongest stations on the selected band for 10 seconds.
1. Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
2. Rotate
to select Scan, then press .
To turn off scan, press
.
241
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 242 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
Playing an iPod
Connect the iPod using your USB connector to the USB port, then press the MEDIA
button.
2 USB Ports P. 227
Audio/Information Screen
USB Indicator
Appears when an iPod is connected.
Features
MEDIA Button
Press to select iPod (if connected).
VOL/
(Volume/Power) Knob
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
/
(Seek/Skip) Buttons
Press
or
to change songs.
Press and hold to move rapidly within a song.
Album Art
Play Mode Buttons
Press to select a play mode.
242
Selector Knob
Turn to change songs.
Press, and then turn to select an
item. After that, press again to
make your selection.
MENU/CLOCK Button
Press to display the menu items.
(Back) Button
Press to go back to the previous
display or cancel a setting.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 243 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
■ How to Select a Song from the iPod Music List with the
Selector Knob
1. Press
to display the iPod music list.
1Playing an iPod
Available operating functions vary on models or
versions. Some functions may not be available on the
vehicle’s audio system.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 327
Item
Selection
2. Rotate
to select a category.
Features
Category
Selection
3. Press
to display a list of items in the
category.
4. Rotate
to select an item, then press .
u Press
and rotate
repeatedly until a
desired item you want to listen to is
displayed.
Continued
243
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 244 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
■ How to Select a Play Mode
You can select repeat and shuffle modes when playing a song.
Available mode icons appear above the play
mode buttons.
Press the button corresponding to the mode
you want to select.
Play Mode Buttons
Features
244
■ To turn off a play mode
Press the selected button.
1How to Select a Play Mode
Play Mode Menu Items
Shuffle Albums: Plays all available albums in
a selected category (playlists, artists, albums, songs,
genres, or composers) in random order.
Shuffle: Plays all available songs in a selected
category (playlists, artists, albums, songs, genres, or
composers) in random order.
Repeat One Track: Repeats the current
song.
You can also select a play mode by pressing the
MENU/CLOCK button.
Rotate
to select Play Mode, then press
.
Rotate
to select a mode, then press
.
To turn it off, rotate
to select Normal Play, then
press
.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 245 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
Playing a USB Flash Drive
Your audio system reads and plays sound files on a USB flash drive in either MP3,
WMA or AAC*1 format.
Connect your USB flash drive to the USB port, then press the MEDIA button.
2 USB Ports P. 227
USB Indicator
Appears when a USB flash drive
is connected.
/
(Seek/Skip) Buttons
Press
or
to change files.
Press and hold to move rapidly within a file.
Play Mode Buttons (1-6)
Press to select a play mode.
Selector Knob
Turn to change folders.
Press, and then turn to select an
item. After that, press again to
make your selection.
Features
MEDIA Button
Press to select USB flash drive
(if connected).
VOL/
(Volume/Power) Knob
Press to turn the audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
Audio/Information Screen
MENU/CLOCK Button
Press to display the menu items.
(Back) Button
Press to go back to the previous
display.
*1: Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes are playable on this unit.
Continued
245
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 246 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
■ How to Select a File from a Folder with the Selector Knob
1. Press
to display a folder list.
1Playing a USB Flash Drive
Use the recommended USB flash drives.
2 General Information on the Audio System
P. 330
Files in WMA and AAC format protected by digital
rights management (DRM) are not played.
The audio system displays Unplayable File, and then
skips to the next file.
Folder
Selection
2. Rotate
to select a folder.
Features
Track
Selection
246
3. Press
to display a list of files in that
folder.
4. Rotate
to select a file, then press .
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 327
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 247 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
■ How to Select a Play Mode
You can select repeat, random, and scan modes when playing a file.
Available mode icons appear above the play
mode buttons.
Press the button corresponding to the mode
you want to select.
Play Mode Buttons
Play Mode Menu Items
Repeat
Repeat One Folder: Repeats all files in the
current folder.
Repeat One Track: Repeats the current file.
Random
Random in Folder: Plays all files in the
current folder in random order.
Random All: Plays all files in random order.
Scan
Scan Folders: Provides 10-second sampling
of the first file in each of the main folders.
Scan Tracks: Provides 10-second sampling of
all files in the current folder.
Features
■ To turn off a play mode
Press the selected button.
1How to Select a Play Mode
You can also select a play mode by pressing the
MENU/CLOCK button.
Rotate
to select Play Mode, then press
.
Rotate
to select a mode, then press
.
To turn it off, rotate
to select Normal Play, then
press
.
247
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 248 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
Playing Bluetooth® Audio
Your audio system allows you to listen to music from your Bluetooth-compatible
phone.
This function is available when the phone is paired and connected to the vehicle’s
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® (HFL) system.
2 Phone Setup P. 387
Bluetooth Indicator
Appears when your phone
is connected to HFL.
Features
MEDIA
Button
Press to select
the Bluetooth
Audio mode
(if
connected).
MENU/CLOCK
Button
Press to
display the
menu items.
Pause Button (Preset 2)
Press to pause playing a file.
Play Button (Preset 1)
Press to resume playing a file.
/
Press
Not all Bluetooth-enabled phones with streaming
audio capabilities are compatible with the system.
For a list of compatible phones, visit
automobiles.honda.com/handsfreelink/, or call 1888-528-7876.
In some states, it may be illegal to perform some data
device functions while driving.
Only one phone can be used with HFL at a time.
When there are more than two paired phones in the
vehicle, the first paired phone the system finds is
automatically connected.
If more than one phone is paired to the HFL system,
there may be a delay before the system begins to
play.
VOL/
(Volume/
Power) Knob
Press to turn
the audio
system on
and off.
Turn to adjust
the volume.
248
Audio/Information Screen
Selector Knob
Turn to change groups.
Press to display a music search list. Press,
and then turn to select an item. After
that, press again to make your selection.
1Playing Bluetooth® Audio
(Seek/Skip) Buttons
or
to change files.
(Back) Button
Press to go back to
the previous
display.
In some cases, the name of the artist, album, or track
may not appear correctly.
Some functions may not be available on some
devices.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 249 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
■ To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files
MEDIA Button
Pause Button
Play Button
1To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files
1. Make sure that your phone is paired and
connected to HFL.
2. Press the MEDIA button until the
Bluetooth® Audio mode is selected.
If the phone is not recognized, another HFLcompatible phone, which is not compatible
for Bluetooth® Audio, may already be
connected.
To play the audio files, you may need to operate your
phone. If so, follow the phone maker's operating
instructions.
The pause function may not be available on some
phones.
If any audio device is connected to the auxiliary input
jack or USB port, you may need to press the MEDIA
button repeatedly to select the Bluetooth® Audio
system.
■ To pause or resume a file
Press a Play or Pause button to select a mode.
Continued
Features
Switching to another mode pauses the music playing
from your phone.
249
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 250 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
■ How to Select a Song from the Music Search List with the
Selector Knob
1. Press
Features
Category
Selection
Item
Selection
250
2. Rotate
to display the music search list.
to select a category.
3. Press
to display a list of items in the
category.
4. Rotate
to select an item, then press .
u Press
and rotate
repeatedly until a
desired item you want to listen is
displayed.
1How to Select a Song from the Music Search List with the Selector
Knob
Depending on the Bluetooth® device you connect,
some or all of the categories may not be displayed.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 251 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Audio System Basic Operation
Models with Display Audio
To use the audio system function, the power mode must be in ACCESSORY or ON.
: Select to go to the home screen.
(Back) Icon
(Home) Icon
2 Switching the Display P. 252
: Select to go back to the previous display
when it is displayed.
: Select to change the audio/information
screen brightness.
Select
once and select
or
to make
an adjustment.
u Each time you select
, the mode
switches among the daytime mode,
nighttime mode and off mode.
Features
(Day/Night) Icon
251
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 252 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
Audio/Information Screen
Displays the audio status and wallpaper. From this display, you can go to various
setup options.
■ Switching the Display
■ Using the audio/information screen
Home Screen
Models without
navigation system
(Home) Icon
1Audio/Information Screen
Touchscreen Operation
• Use simple gestures - including touching, swiping,
and scrolling - to operate certain audio functions.
• Some items may be grayed out during driving to
reduce the potential for distraction.
• You can select them when the vehicle is stopped or
use voice commands.
• Wearing gloves may limit or prevent touchscreen
response.
You can change the touchscreen sensitivity setting.
2 Customized Features P. 359
Features
Models with
navigation system
All Apps
Select
to go to the home screen.
Select the following icons on the home screen or after selecting
252
All Apps.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 253 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Phone
Displays the HFL information.
2 Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® P. 406
■ Trip Computer
Displays the trip computer information.
• Current Drive tab: Displays the current trip information.
• Trip A/Trip B tab: Displays information for the current and three previous drives.
The information is stored every time you reset Trip A/B.
To reset Trip A/B, select Reset.
To change the setting of how to reset Trip A/B, select Settings, then select Trip
A Reset Method or Trip B Reset Method.
Features
■ Clock
Displays the clock.
■ System Updates
Updates the software version of the audio system.
2 System Updates P. 265
■ FM/AM/Sirius XM */USB/Bluetooth Audio/AUX Input/My Honda Music/
Social Playlist
Displays the each audio information.
■ Settings
Enters the customizing menu screen.
2 Customized Features P. 359
* Not available on all models
Continued
253
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 254 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Navigation *
Displays the navigation screen.
2 Refer to the Navigation System Manual
■ HondaLink
Displays the HondaLink® screen.
2 HondaLink® P. 312
■ Apple CarPlay/Android Auto
Displays the Apple CarPlay or Android Auto.
2 Apple CarPlay P. 320
2 Android Auto P. 323
Features
■ Messages
Displays the text message screen.
2 Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® P. 406
■ AT&T Hotspot *
Displays the AT&T Hotspot screen.
■ File Manager
Displays the file manager screen.
2 File Manager P. 271
254
* Not available on all models
午後3時29分
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 255 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Wallpaper Setup
1Wallpaper Setup
You can change, store, and delete the wallpaper on the audio/information screen.
■ Import wallpaper
1. Connect the USB flash drive to the front
USB port.
2 USB Ports P. 227
6. Import a desired picture.
Features
2. Select Clock.
3. Select Settings.
4. Select Clock Faces.
5. Select Add More.
u The File Manager screen is displayed.
The wallpaper you set up on Clock Faces cannot be
displayed on the driver information interface.
• The file name must be fewer than 255 characters.
• The file format of the image that can be imported
is BMP, GIF, JPEG, PNG, or WebP.
• If the USB flash drive does not have any pictures,
the No Data message appears.
2 How to Transfer a File P. 271
u The display will return to the Clock Faces
screen.
Continued
255
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 256 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Select wallpaper
1. Select Clock.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Clock Faces.
4. Select a desired wallpaper.
u The preview is displayed on the screen.
5. Select Save.
u The display will return to the clock screen.
■ To view wallpaper once it is set
1. Select
.
2. Select Clock.
Features
■ Delete wallpaper
1. Select Clock.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Clock Faces.
4. Select Delete Photos.
u The File Manager screen is displayed.
5. Delete a picture.
2 How to Delete a File P. 274
u The display will return to the Clock Faces screen.
256
午後3時29分
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 257 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Home Screen
1Home Screen
The home screen has 5 pages. You cannot add any
more pages.
■ To change to a next screen
Select
to go directly back to the first page of the
home screen from any page.
Swipe
> Icon
< Icon
Current page position
Continued
Features
Selecting < or > , or swiping the screen left or right changes to the next screen.
257
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 258 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ To add app icons on the home screen
App icons can be added on the home screen.
1. Select
.
2. Select
All Apps.
3. Check the box of the app you want to add.
u The app icon will be added on the home
screen.
Pre-installed apps may not start up normally. If this
occurs, you need to reset the system.
2 Defaulting All the Settings P. 377
If you perform Factory Data Reset, it may reset all
the settings to their factory default.
2 Defaulting All the Settings P. 377
In case those apps still do not startup normally even
after Factory Data Reset, contact your dealer.
All Apps
Icon
Features
There is a possibility that a browser is shut down in
the situation of the use. In that situation, the screen
will return to before the browser startup.
Check Box
258
1To add app icons on the home screen
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 259 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ To move icons on the home screen
You can change location on the home screen.
1. Select and hold an icon.
u The screen switches to the customization
screen.
2. Drag and drop the icon to where you want
it to be.
Select and hold.
3. Select Done.
u The screen will return to the home
screen.
1To move icons on the home screen
Select Tips to show tips. To hide them, select it again.
Features
Drag and drop.
Continued
259
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 260 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ To remove icons on the home screen
You can delete the icons on the home screen.
1. Select and hold an icon.
u The screen switches to the customization
screen.
2. Drag and drop the icon you want to remove
to the Hide icon.
Select and hold.
u The icon is removed from the home
screen.
3. Select Done.
u The screen will return to the home
screen.
Features
Drag and drop to
Hide icon.
260
1To remove icons on the home screen
Apps will not be deleted by deleting the icon on the
home screen.
Select Tips to show tips. To hide them, select it again.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 261 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ To create shortcuts for apps displayed on the home screen
1To create shortcuts for apps displayed on the home screen
Select Tips to show tips. To hide them, select it again.
Features
Three shortcut icons for accessing apps displayed on the home screen are displayed
in the upper left area of the screen. You can replace any of these shortcut icons with
an icon of your preference.
1. From the home screen, select and hold the
icon that you want to store in the upper left
of the screen.
u The screen will switch to the
customization screen.
2. Drag the icon over to the upper left of the
Select and hold.
screen and drop it over the icon that you
Preset
want to replace.
Icons
u The new icon will appear in place of the
old icon.
3. Select Done.
u The screen will return to the home
screen.
Drag and
drop to preset
icon.
Continued
261
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 262 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Status Area
1. Select the system status icon.
u The status area appears.
2. Select an item to see the details.
3. Select
or the system status icon to close
the area.
System
Status Icon
Features
Status Area
262
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 263 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
■ Updating Apps
1Updating Apps
Some of the audio system’s apps can be updated wirelessly when connected via WiFi, or Bluetooth® in conjunction with the HondaLink® app installed on a compatible
iOS or Android device. If an update is available, a notification is displayed at the top
of the screen with the respective app’s update icon.
The wireless updates are for the apps on the audio
system only.
To update compatible apps on your iPhone or
Android phone, please visit the App Store or Google
Play Store, respectively.
■ To update an app:
1. A notification appears and notifies you of a
update message on the header area.
Features
2. Select the system status icon, and then
select the software update notification
from the list.
Continued
263
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 264 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAudio/Information Screen
3. Select Download.
Features
264
4. Select OK.
u A notification appears on the screen if
the update is successful. Select OK.
u Restart the engine for the update to be
applied.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 265 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuSystem Updates
System Updates
The audio system’s firmware can be updated with a Wi-Fi connection or with a USB
device.
■ How to Update Wirelessly
■ Wireless connection mode setup
1Wireless connection mode setup
1. Select
.
2. Select System Updates.
3. Select Settings.
4. Select Connection Setup.
If your vehicle has a telematics control unit (TCU), you
do not need the wireless connection mode setup.
Continued
Features
5. Select Change Mode.
6. Select Network, then Save.
u The display returns to the network list.
7. Select an access point from the network list,
then Connect.
u If the audio system requires a password,
enter a password.
265
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 266 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuSystem Updates
■ How to update
When the audio system update is available, the notification is shown on the audio/
information screen. Use the following procedure to update the system.
1. Select
.
2. Select System Updates.
Notification
Features
266
3. Select via Wireless.
4. Select Download Now.
u A notification appears on the screen.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 267 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuSystem Updates
5. Select Install Now or Install while
Vehicle OFF.
u A notification appears on the screen if
the update is successful.
1How to update
If Install while Vehicle OFF is selected and the user
turns the vehicle back on after the update has been
completed, for 3 to 5 minutes the system will rebuild
the applications, during which time the Honda logo
will be displayed.
Features
Continued
267
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 268 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuSystem Updates
■ Automatic download settings
Use the following procedure to change to the automatic download setting.
1. Select
.
2. Select System Updates.
3. Select Settings.
4. Select Auto Download.
5. Select the access point, then Allow.
Features
268
■ View an update result
Use the following procedure to confirm the update result.
1. Select
.
2. Select System Updates.
3. Select Settings.
4. Select Update Result.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 269 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuSystem Updates
■ How to Update with a USB Device
1How to Update with a USB Device
■ Download the update files from the server
1. Select
.
2. Select System Updates.
3. Select via USB.
u A notification appears on the screen.
4. Connect a USB device into the front USB
port.
u The inventory data is copied into the USB
device.
A USB device with a minimum of 8 GB of free space
or more is recommended.
Be sure to delete any previous inventory or update
files from the USB before starting the USB update
process.
2 USB Ports P. 227
Continued
Features
5. Remove the USB device from the USB port.
6. Connect the USB device into your
computer, and then download the update
files.
u Follow the link to download the required
software update files. Refer to
https://usb.honda.com for instructions.
269
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 270 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuSystem Updates
■ Update the audio system
1. Select
.
2. Select System Updates.
3. Select via USB.
u A notification appears on the screen.
4. Connect the USB device with the update
files into the USB port.
u A notification appears on the screen.
2 USB Ports P. 227
Features
270
5. Select Install Now or Install while
Vehicle OFF.
u A notification appears on the screen if
the update is successful.
1Update the audio system
If Install while Vehicle OFF is selected and the user
turns the vehicle back on after the update has been
completed, for 3 to 5 minutes the system will rebuild
the applications, during which time the Honda logo
will be displayed.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 271 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuFile Manager
File Manager
Allows you to transfer image or audio files to the audio system with a USB device.
■ How to Transfer a File
1. Connect a USB device into the USB port.
2 USB Ports P. 227
2. Select
, then select
All Apps.
3. Select File Manager.
4. Select Transfer Content.
Features
To transfer a selected file:
5. Select Select Files to Transfer.
Continued
271
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 272 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuFile Manager
6. Select the file or folder you want to
transfer.
7. Select OK.
Features
272
8. Select Transfer.
u A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Select Continue.
u A notification appears on the screen if
the transfer is successful. Then, the
display will return to the File Manager
screen.
1How to Transfer a File
To switch the view method, select List or Thumbnail
on the upper right of the screen.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 273 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuFile Manager
To transfer all files:
5. Select Transfer All Content.
Continued
1How to Transfer a File
To switch the view method, select List or Thumbnail
on the upper right of the screen.
Features
6. Select Transfer.
u A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Select Continue.
u A notification appears on the screen if
the transfer is successful. Then, the
display will return to the File Manager
screen.
273
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 274 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuFile Manager
■ How to Delete a File
1. Select
, then select
2. Select File Manager.
3. Select Delete Content.
Features
274
All Apps.
To delete a selected file:
4. Select Select Files to Delete.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 275 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuFile Manager
5. Select the file or folder you want to delete.
6. Select OK.
Continued
To switch the view method, select List or Thumbnail
on the upper right of the screen.
Features
7. Select Delete.
u A notification appears on the screen if
the deletion is successful. Then, the
display will return to the File Manager
screen.
1How to Transfer a File
275
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 276 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuFile Manager
To delete all files:
4. Select Delete All Content.
Features
276
5. Select Delete.
u A notification appears on the screen if
the transfer is successful. Then, the
display will return to the File Manager
screen.
1How to Transfer a File
To switch the view method, select List or Thumbnail
on the upper right of the screen.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 277 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAdjusting the Sound
Adjusting the Sound
1. Select
.
2. Select an audio source icon.
3. Select Sound.
1Adjusting the Sound
SVC adjusts the volume level based on the vehicle
speed. As you go faster, audio volume increases. As
you slow down, audio volume decreases.
You can also adjust the sound the following
procedure.
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Sound.
* Not available on all models
To reset each setting for Bass / Treble, Center /
Subwoofer Volume and Balance / Fader, select
Reset.
Features
Select an item from the following choices:
• Bass / Treble: Treble, Midrange, Bass
• Center / Subwoofer Volume: Center *,
Subwoofer
• Balance / Fader: Balance, Fader
• Audio Zones *: Driver Only, Front Only,
Rear Only, Full Vehicle
• Speed Volume Compensation: Speed
Volume Compensation (SVC)
• DTS Neural Surround *: DTS Neural
SurroundTM
277
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 278 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuDisplay Setup
Display Setup
You can change the brightness of the audio/information screen.
■ Changing the Screen Brightness
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Display.
4. Select Day Mode or Night Mode.
5. Select the setting you want.
6. Select Save.
Features
278
1Changing the Screen Brightness
You can change the Contrast and Black Level
settings in the same manner.
To reset the settings, select Reset.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 279 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuDisplay Setup
■ Selecting an Audio Source
Select the source icon
Source Select Screen
Source List Icons
■ Limitations for Manual Operation
Features
Select the current source icon, then select an icon on the source list to switch the
audio source.
Certain manual functions are disabled or inoperable while the vehicle is in motion.
You cannot select a grayed-out option until the vehicle is stopped.
279
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 280 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuVoice Control Operation
Voice Control Operation
Features
280
Your vehicle has a voice control system that allows hands-free operation.
The voice control system uses the
(talk) and
(back) buttons on the steering
wheel and a microphone near the map lights on the ceiling.
1Voice Control Operation
■ Voice Recognition
1Voice Recognition
To achieve optimum voice recognition when using the voice control system:
• Make sure the correct screen is displayed for the voice command that you are
using.
The system recognizes only certain commands.
Available voice commands.
2 Voice Portal Screen P. 281
• Close the windows and moonroof *.
• Adjust the dashboard and side vents so air does not blow onto the microphone
on the ceiling.
• Speak clearly in a clear, natural speaking voice without pausing between words.
• Reduce any background noise if possible. The system may misinterpret your
command if more than one person is speaking at the same time.
* Not available on all models
When you press the
button, a helpful prompt asks
what you would like to do. Press and release the
button again to bypass this prompt and give a
command.
The voice control system can only be used from the
driver’s seat because the microphone unit removes
noises from the front passenger’s side.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 281 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuVoice Control Operation
■ Voice Portal Screen
The system only recognizes the commands
on the following pages, at certain screens.
Free form voice commands are not
recognized.
■ Navigation*1
This can be only used when the phone is
connected. When the system recognizes the
Phone command, the screen will change
the dedicated screen for the voice
recognition of the phone.
• Call
• Call
• Call
Phone commands are not available if using
Apple CarPlay.
The screen changes the navigation screen.
2 Refer to the Navigation System Manual
■ Voice Help
Readout voice guidance for Help on current
screen.
■ Audio
When the system recognizes the Audio
command, the screen will change the
dedicated screen for the voice recognition
of the audio.
• FM
• AM
• USB
• Sirius XM *
• My Honda Music
Features
When the
(talk) button is pressed,
available voice commands appear on the
screen.
For a complete list of commands, say “Voice
Help” after the beep.
■ Phone
*1: Models with navigation system
* Not available on all models
Continued
281
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 282 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuVoice Control Operation
■ Phone Commands
■ Audio Commands
The system accepts these commands on the
dedicated screen for the voice recognition
of the phone.
• Call
• Call
• Call
The system accepts these commands on the
dedicated screen for the voice recognition
of the audio.
■ FM Commands
• Tune to <87.7-107.9> FM
■ AM Commands
• Tune to <530-1710> AM
Features
■ Sirius XM Commands *
• Channel <1-999>
• Channel
■ USB/My Honda Music Commands
•
•
•
•
•
•
282
* Not available on all models
Play Artist
Play Album
Play Genre
Play Playlist
Play Music
Play Song
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 283 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
Playing AM/FM Radio
Audio/Information Screen
Settings Icon
Select whether to tune to
HD RadioTM* automatically.
(Back) Icon
Select to go back to the previous
display.
Seek Icons
Select
or
to search up and down
the selected band for a station with a
strong signal.
Features
VOL/ AUDIO (Volume/Power)
Knob
Push to turn the audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
Preset Icons
Tune the radio frequency for preset memory.
Select and hold the preset icon to store that
station. Select > to display preset 5 onwards.
Tune Icon
Select to use the on-screen keyboard for
entering the radio frequency directly.
Scan Icon
Select to scan each station with a strong
signal.
* Not available on all models
Continued
283
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 284 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
■ Preset Memory
To store a station:
1. Tune to the selected station.
2. Select and hold the preset number for the station you want to store.
■ Station List
Lists the strongest stations on the selected band.
1. Select Station List to display a list.
2. Select the station.
Features
284
■ Manual update
Updates your available station list at any time.
1. Select Station List to display a list.
2. Select Refresh.
1Preset Memory
The ST indicator appears on the display indicating
stereo FM broadcasts.
Stereo reproduction in AM is not available.
Switching the Audio Mode
Press the 3 or 4 button on the steering wheel or
select the audio source icon on the screen.
2 Audio Remote Controls P. 230
You can store 12 AM/FM stations into preset
memory.
Models with HD RadioTM feature
HD Radio Technology manufactured under license
from iBiquity Digital Corporation. U.S. and Foreign
Patents. HD RadioTM and the HD, HD Radio, and
“Arc” logos are proprietary trademarks of iBiquity
Digital Corp.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 285 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
■ Scan
Samples each of the strongest stations on the selected band for 10 seconds. To turn
off scan, select Stop or
.
■ Radio Data System (RDS)
1Radio Data System (RDS)
Provides text data information related to your selected RDS-capable FM station.
■ To find an RDS station from Station List
1. Select Station List to display a list while listening to an FM station.
2. Select the station.
When you select an RDS-capable FM station, the RDS
automatically turns on, and the frequency display
changes to the station name. However, when the
signals of that station become weak, the display
changes from the station name to the frequency.
Features
■ Manual update
Updates your available station list at any time.
1. Select Station List to display a list while listening to an FM station.
2. Select Refresh.
■ Scan
Samples each of the strongest stations on the selected band for 10 seconds. To turn
off scan, select Stop or
.
Continued
285
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 286 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying AM/FM Radio
Models with HD RadioTM feature
■ HD Subchannel
Displays the subchannel list when an HD RadioTM station is selected while listening to
an FM station.
1. Select HD Radio Channels.
2. Select the channel number.
Features
286
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 287 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying SiriusXM® Radio *
Playing SiriusXM® Radio *
Album Art
Station Art
VOL/ AUDIO (Volume/Power)
Knob
Push to turn the audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
Channel Icons
Select
or
to the previous or next channel.
Select and hold to rapidly skip 10 channels at a time.
Category Icons
Select
or
to display and select a
SiriusXM® Radio category.
* Not available on all models
Features
(Back) Icon
Select to go back to the previous
display.
Audio/Information Screen
Preset Icons
Tune the radio frequency for
preset memory. Select and hold
the preset icon to store that
station. Select > to display
preset 5 onwards.
Continued
287
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 288 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying SiriusXM® Radio *
■ To Change the Tune Mode
1. Select Settings.
2. Select Tune Mode.
3. Select All Channels or Within Category.
1Playing SiriusXM® Radio *
In the channel mode, all available channels are
selectable. In the category mode, you can select a
channel within a category (Jazz, Rock, Classical, etc.).
There may be instances when SiriusXM® Radio does
not broadcast all the data fields (artist name, title).
This does not indicate a problem with your audio
system.
Features
SiriusXM® Radio stations load in ascending order,
which can take about a minute. Once they have
loaded you will be able to scroll up or down to make
your selections.
Switching the Audio Mode
Press the 3 or 4 button on the steering wheel or
select the audio source icon on the screen.
2 Audio Remote Controls P. 230
Tune Start:
When you change to a preset channel, a song being
played on that channel restarts from the beginning
with this function. This can be turned on or off by the
following procedure.
1. Select Settings.
2. Select Tune Start.
3. Select ON or OFF.
To change a category, select Category icons, or
select More and then select Category List.
288
* Not available on all models
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 289 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying SiriusXM® Radio *
■ Preset Memory
1Preset Memory
You can store 12 SiriusXM® channels into the preset
memory.
To store a channel:
1. Tune to the selected channel.
2. Select and hold the preset number for the station you want to store.
Continued
1Multi-channel preset (for music channels only)
TuneMix:
The multi-channel preset function can be turned on
or off by the following procedure.
1. Select Settings.
2. Select TuneMix.
3. Select ON or OFF.
When you want to replace the channel, select
Replace Preset.
If you want to delete a channel, select Edit TuneMix,
and then select the channel you want to delete.
Features
■ Multi-channel preset (for music channels only)
You can store up to 10 of your preferred music channels per preset.
1. Tune a station.
2. Select and hold the preset number you
want to add a music channel.
3. Select Add to TuneMix or Create
TuneMix.
u A message appears if there are no
available presets.
289
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 290 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying SiriusXM® Radio *
■ Listening to Featured Channels
Suggested channel listing received from SiriusXM® can be displayed and selected.
1. Select Channel List.
2. Select the featured channel list title you want to listen to.
u The selected channel list of the title is displayed.
3. Select the channel.
1Listening to Featured Channels
Up to three featured channels by SiriusXM® can be
displayed.
Featured channel lists are at the top of the channel
list.
To switch the sorting method, select Number, Name
or Category on the upper right of the screen.
Select Keypad to use the on-screen keyboard for
entering the channel number directly.
Features
290
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 291 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying SiriusXM® Radio *
■ Replay Function
1Replay Function
The system can record up to the last 60 minutes broadcast of your currently tuned
channel as well as the last 30 minutes broadcast of preset channels, starting from
the moment you turn the vehicle on. If you tuned to preset channel, the system
records up to 60 minutes of a broadcast instead of up to 30 minutes. You can
rewind and replay the last 30 or 60 minutes of a broadcast.
Move the position you want to replay by selecting
or
.
You can no longer replay any program once the
power mode is turned off as it erases memory.
You can check how long the program has been
stored in memory from the audio/information screen.
After 30 or 60 minutes of recording the system will
automatically start deleting the oldest data.
To play or pause on playback mode, select the play/pause icon.
Audio/Information Screen
.
(C)
(D)
(A)
Features
■ Returning to real-time broadcast
Select and hold
The system starts storing broadcast in memory when
the power mode is turned ON. You can go back to
the program from that point.
(B)
(A): Shows how much time the replayed segment is
behind the real-time broadcast
(B): Replayed segment
(C): Length stored in memory
(D): Play/Pause icon
Continued
291
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 292 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying SiriusXM® Radio *
■ Live Sports Alert
1Live Sports Alert
While listening to other channel, you can receive sports alerts such as scores from
your favorite teams.
■ To set up a favorite team
1To set up a favorite team
1. Select Settings.
2. Select Sports Notifications Setup.
3. Select Favorite Teams.
4. Select + Add Favorite Team.
5. Select a team.
Features
■ To set up an alert message
1. Select Settings.
2. Select Sports Notifications Setup.
3. Select Notifications.
4. Select Game Notifications or SportsFlash Game Play Notifications.
5. Select Notifications.
6. Select On.
7. Select a favorite team.
292
The sports alert function is active during SiriusXM®
mode only.
Sports alerts cut in only when SiriusXM® mode is on.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 293 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying SiriusXM® Radio *
■ Traffic and Weather Information
1Traffic and Weather Information
You can receive traffic and weather information.
1. Select Settings.
2. Select Traffic & Weather Setup.
3. Select Selected City.
4. Select the region.
u When you do not want to receive the information, select Reset Location.
The traffic and weather information function is active
during SiriusXM® mode only.
Features
Continued
293
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 294 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying SiriusXM® Radio *
■ Channel Schedule
1Channel Schedule
You can view a channel schedule or receive an alert when your favorite program is
about to start.
Select Keypad to use the on-screen keyboard for
entering the channel number directly.
■ To view a channel schedule
1. Select More.
2. Select Channel Schedule.
Features
■ To set up an alert message
1. Select More.
2. Select Channel Schedule.
3. Select a program.
4. Select Set Program Alert.
5. Select Just Once or Every Time.
1To set up an alert message
The alert function is active during SiriusXM® mode
only.
Selecting Just Once disables the alert feature next
time you turn the power mode to ON.
If you want to delete the alert, select Remove Alert.
294
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 295 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying SiriusXM® Radio *
■ Manage Program Alert
You can change settings for the alert function.
■ To enable the alert function
1. Select Settings.
2. Select Manage Program Alerts.
3. Select Notifications.
4. Select ON or OFF.
Features
■ To remove an alert
1. Select Settings.
2. Select Manage Program Alerts.
3. Select Alerts Set.
4. Select
on the alert you want to delete.
u A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Select Delete.
Continued
295
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 296 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying SiriusXM® Radio *
■ Scan
Sample each channel on the selected mode for 10 seconds.
1. Select More.
2. Select Scan.
You can change a scan mode by the following procedure.
1. Select Settings.
2. Select Scan Mode.
3. Select Channel or Preset.
To turn off scan, select Stop.
Features
296
1Scan
The “Scan Songs in Presets” function is based on
TuneScanTM technology of SiriusXM®.
The “Featured Channels” function is based on
Featured FavoritesTM technology of SiriusXM®.
TuneScanTM and Featured FavoritesTM are registered
trademarks of SiriusXM® Radio, Inc.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 297 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
Playing an iPod
Connect the iPod using your USB connector to the USB port, then select the USB
mode.
2 USB Ports P. 227
Cover Art
Features
(Back) Icon
Select to go back to the previous
display.
Audio/Information Screen
VOL/ AUDIO (Volume/Power) Knob
Push to turn the audio system on and
off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
Track Icons
Select
or
to change songs.
Select and hold to move rapidly
within a song.
Play/Pause Icon
Continued
297
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 298 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
■ How to Select a Song from the Music Search List
1. Select Browse.
2. Select the items on that menu.
1Playing an iPod
Available operating functions vary on models or
versions. Some functions may not be available on the
vehicle’s audio system.
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 327
Features
298
If you operate the music app on your iPhone/iPod
while the phone is connected to the audio system,
you may no longer be able to operate the same app
on the audio/information screen.
Reconnect the device if necessary.
If an iPhone is connected via Apple CarPlay, the iPod/
USB source will be unavailable and audio files on the
phone will be playable only within Apple CarPlay.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 299 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying an iPod
■ How to Select a Play Mode
You can select shuffle and repeat modes when playing a file.
Select
or
.
Play Mode Menu Items
Shuffle All Songs: Plays all available files in a
selected list (playlists, artists, albums, songs,
podcasts, genres, composers, or audiobooks) in
random order.
Repeat Song: Repeats the current track.
Features
■ To turn off a play mode
Select the mode you want to turn off.
1How to Select a Play Mode
299
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 300 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
Playing a USB Flash Drive
Your audio system reads and plays audio files on a USB flash drive in either MP3,
WMA, or AAC*1 format.
Connect your USB flash drive to the USB port, then select the USB mode.
2 USB Ports P. 227
Features
(Back) Icon
Select to go back to the previous
display.
Audio/Information Screen
VOL/ AUDIO (Volume/Power) Knob
Push to turn the audio system on and
off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
Play/Pause Icon
Track Icons
Select
or
to change files.
Select and hold to move rapidly
within a track.
*1: Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes are playable on this unit.
300
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 301 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
■ How to Select a File from the Music Search List
1Playing a USB Flash Drive
Use the recommended USB flash drives.
2 General Information on the Audio System
P. 330
1. Select Browse.
2. Select the items on that menu.
WMA files protected by digital rights management
(DRM) cannot be played.
The audio system displays The selected file cannot
be played on this system, then skips to the next
file.
Continued
Features
If there is a problem, you may see an error message
on the audio/information screen.
2 iPod/USB Flash Drive P. 327
301
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 302 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying a USB Flash Drive
■ How to Select a Play Mode
You can select repeat and random modes when playing a file.
■ Random/Repeat
Select
or
.
Features
302
■ To turn off a play mode
Select the mode you want to turn off.
1How to Select a Play Mode
Play Mode Menu Items
Random/Repeat
Random in Category: Plays all files in the
current category in random order.
Repeat Track: Repeats the current file.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 303 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying My Honda Music
Playing My Honda Music
My Honda Music plays audio files that have been imported from a USB flash drive.
Your audio system supports audio files in either MP3, WMA, or AAC*1 format.
2 File Manager P. 271
Features
(Back) Icon
Select to go back to the previous
display.
Audio/Information Screen
VOL/ AUDIO (Volume/Power) Knob
Push to turn the audio system on and
off.
Turn to adjust the volume.
Play/Pause Icon
Track Icons
Select
or
to change files.
Select and hold to move rapidly
within a track.
*1: Only AAC format files recorded with iTunes are playable on this unit.
Continued
303
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 304 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying My Honda Music
■ How to Transfer an Audio File
1. Connect a USB device into the USB port.
2 USB Ports P. 227
2. Select More.
3. Select Import Files to My Honda Music.
u The File Manager screen is displayed.
4. Transfer an audio file to your audio system.
2 How to Transfer a File P. 271
Features
■ How to delete an audio file
1. Select More.
2. Select Delete Files from My Honda Music.
u The File Manager screen is displayed.
3. Delete an audio file.
2 How to Delete a File P. 274
304
1How to Transfer an Audio File
If there is no audio file in your audio system, the
system will automatically proceed to step 3 after
connecting a USB device.
Use the recommended USB flash drives.
2 General Information on the Audio System
P. 330
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 305 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying My Honda Music
■ How to Select a File from the Music Search List
1Playing My Honda Music
WMA files protected by digital rights management
(DRM) cannot be played.
The audio system displays The selected file cannot
be played on this system, then skips to the next
file.
1. Select Browse.
2. Select the items on that menu.
Features
Continued
305
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 306 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying My Honda Music
■ How to Select a Play Mode
You can select repeat and random modes when playing a file.
■ Random/Repeat
Select
or
.
Features
306
■ To turn off a play mode
Select the mode you want to turn off.
1How to Select a Play Mode
Play Mode Menu Items
Random/Repeat
Random in Category: Plays all files in the
current category in random order.
Random All Tracks: Plays all files in random order.
Repeat Track: Repeats the current file.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 307 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
Playing Bluetooth® Audio
Your audio system allows you to listen to music from your Bluetooth-compatible
phone.
This function is available when the phone is paired and connected to the vehicle’s
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® (HFL) system.
2 Phone Setup P. 411
Audio/Information
Screen
Bluetooth Indicator
Appears when your
phone is connected
to HFL.
VOL/ AUDIO
(Volume/Power)
Knob
Push to turn the
audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust
the volume.
Not all Bluetooth-enabled phones with streaming
audio capabilities are compatible.
To check if your phone is compatible,
• U.S.: Visit automobiles.honda.com/handsfreelink/,
or call 1-888-528-7876.
• Canada: For more information on smartphone
compatibility, call 1-855-490-7351.
It may be illegal to perform some data device
functions while driving.
Only one phone can be used with HFL at a time.
When there are more than two paired phones in the
vehicle, the first paired phone the system finds is
automatically connected.
Features
(Back) Icon
Select to go back to
the previous display.
1Playing Bluetooth® Audio
The connected phone for Bluetooth® Audio can be
different.
Random Icon*1
Select to play all files in
the current category in
random order.
Repeat Icon*1
Select to repeat the current
file.
Play/Pause Icon
Track Icons
Select
or
to change tracks.
If more than one phone is paired to the HFL system,
there may be a delay before the system begins to
play.
In some cases, the name of the artist, album, or track
may not appear correctly.
Some functions may not be available on some
devices.
*1: Depending on the Bluetooth® device you connect, this function may not be displayed.
Continued
307
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 308 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
1Playing Bluetooth® Audio
If a phone is currently connected via Apple CarPlay or
Android Auto, Bluetooth® Audio from that phone
will be unavailable. However, you can have a second
previously paired phone stream Bluetooth® Audio by
selecting
from the Bluetooth® device list.
2 Phone Setup P. 411
■ To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files
1. Make sure that your phone is paired and
connected to the system.
1To Play Bluetooth® Audio Files
To play the audio files, you may need to operate your
phone. If so, follow the phone maker’s operating
instructions.
2 Phone Setup P. 411
Features
■ To pause or resume a file
Select the play/pause icon.
308
2. Select the Bluetooth® Audio mode.
Switching to another mode pauses the music playing
from your phone.
If the phone is not recognized, another HFLcompatible phone, which is not compatible
for Bluetooth® Audio, may already be
connected.
You can change the connected phone by selecting
Change Device.
2 Phone Setup P. 411
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 309 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Bluetooth® Audio
■ Searching for Music
1Searching for Music
1. Select Browse.
2. Select a search category (e.g., Albums).
3. Select an item.
u The selection begins playing.
Depending on the Bluetooth® device you connect,
some or all of the lists may not be displayed.
Features
309
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 310 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Social Playlist
Playing Social Playlist
The Honda CabinControlTM smartphone app allows users to share audio files from
their devices to Social Playlist.
Unfortunately, the driver cannot select the audio files from the audio/information
screen. The driver can play in order of their choice only if they individually select each
song in the queue. The driver cannot rearrange the order of the playlist.
2 Wi-Fi Connection P. 317
Audio/Information
Screen
Features
(Back) Icon
Select to go back to
the previous display.
VOL/ AUDIO
(Volume/Power)
Knob
Push to turn the
audio system on
and off.
Turn to adjust
the volume.
Remove Icon
Select to remove
the file from the
playlist.
Random Icon
Select to play all files in
random order.
Repeat Icon
Select to repeat the current
file.
Play/Pause Icon
Track Icons
Select
or
310
to change files.
1Playing Social Playlist
For more information, check the Honda
CabinControl smartphone app instruction manual.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 311 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuPlaying Social Playlist
■ How to Edit the Playlist
Features
1. Select
.
2. Select Social Playlist.
3. Select Queue.
To play a file on the playlist:
u Select the file.
To remove a file from the playlist:
u Select
on the file.
To clear the playlist:
u Select Clear, and then select Request
Songs to reload a playlist.
To check the connected device:
u Select Device List.
311
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 312 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuHondaLink®
HondaLink®
HondaLink® connects you to the latest information from Honda. You can connect
your phone wirelessly through Wi-Fi or Bluetooth®.
2 Wi-Fi Connection P. 317
2 Phone Setup P. 411
■ To Connect to HondaLink® Service
Use the following procedure to connect to HondaLink® service.
Features
312
■ To enable the HondaLink® service
You need to allow the consent of the location service to enable the HondaLink®
service.
Disable: Does not allow this consent.
Enable Once: Allows only one time. (Shows
again next time.)
Always Enable: Allows anytime. (Never
show again.)
1HondaLink®
The HondaLink® connect app is compatible with most
iPhone and Android phones.
Some cell phone carriers charge for tethering and
smartphone data use. Check your phone’s data
subscription package.
When Apple CarPlay or Android Auto is connected to
the audio system, HondaLink® can be accessed even
without a Wi-Fi connection.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 313 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuHondaLink®
■ To link with HondaLink®
You may see the connection guide screen
after launching HondaLink® when there is no
connection available.
■ HondaLink® Menu
Features
■ Vehicle
Displays instruction messages when the vehicle needs service.
■ Help & Support
Displays tips for vehicle usage, and get support via road side or customer service
center.
Continued
313
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 314 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuHondaLink®
■ Messages from Honda
Displays helpful and important information from Honda.
■ Vehicle Information and Message from Honda Tips
You can check the messages that are received quickly in the shortcut operation.
1. A notification appears and notifies you of a
new message on the header area.
Features
Notification
2. A notification is continuously displayed in
the header area until the new message is
read.
314
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 315 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuHondaLink®
3. Select the system status icon to see the
messages.
4. Select a new message to open.
Features
Continued
315
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 316 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuHondaLink®
■ Operator Assistance *
Connect to the HondaLink® operator when trying to find a destination or for
roadside assistance.
1. Press the LINK button.
u Connection to the operator begins.
LINK
2. Talk to the operator.
Button
u To disconnect, select Hang Up on the
audio/information screen or press the
button on the steering wheel.
Features
Audio/information screen
when connected to the
HondaLink® operator.
316
* Not available on all models
1Operator Assistance *
Remain attentive to road conditions and driving
during operator assistance.
If you want to add or renew a subscription, call the
Operator Assistance.
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select System.
4. Select Subscription.
5. Select HondaLink Subscription Status.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 317 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuWi-Fi Connection
Wi-Fi Connection
You can connect the audio system to the Internet using Wi-Fi and browse websites
or use online services on the audio/information screen. If your phone has cell
hotspot capabilities, the system can be tethered to the phone. Use the following
steps to setup.
■ Wi-Fi mode (setting for the first time)
1Wi-Fi Connection
Wi-Fi and Wi-Fi Direct a registered trademark of Wi-Fi
Alliance®.
1Wi-Fi mode (setting for the first time)
Continued
You cannot go through the setting procedure while a
vehicle is moving. Park in a safe place to setup the
Wi-Fi connection.
Some cell phone carriers charge for tethering and
smartphone data use. Check your phone’s data
subscription package.
Features
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Connections.
4. Select Wi-Fi.
5. Select Change Mode.
6. Select Network or HotSpot, then Save.
u To change the Wi-Fi settings, select
Network Options or HotSpot
Options.
u Select the access point you want to
connect to the system.
7. Select Connect.
u Enter a password for the access point,
and select OK.
u When the connection is successful, the
icon is displayed on the list.
8. Select
to go back to the home screen.
Check your phone manual to find out if the phone
has Wi-Fi connectivity.
You can confirm whether Wi-Fi connection is on or
off with the
icon on the Wi-Fi network list.
Transmission speed and others will not be displayed
on this screen.
In case of Wi-Fi connection with your phone, make
sure your phone’s Wi-Fi setting is in access point
(tethering) mode.
317
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 318 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuWi-Fi Connection
■ Wi-Fi mode (after the initial setting has been made)
Make sure your phone’s Wi-Fi setting is in access point (tethering) mode.
Features
318
1Wi-Fi mode (after the initial setting has been made)
iPhone users
You may need to go through an initial setup for Wi-Fi
connection again after you boot your phone.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 319 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuSiri Eyes Free
Siri Eyes Free
You can talk to Siri using the
(Talk) button on the steering wheel when your
iPhone is paired to the Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® (HFL) system.
1Siri Eyes Free
Siri is a trademark of Apple Inc.
2 Phone Setup P. 411
Check Apple Inc. website for features available for
Siri.
While driving we recommend only using Siri through
the
button on the steering wheel (Siri Eyes Free).
■ Using Siri Eyes Free
1Using Siri Eyes Free
Some commands work only on specific phone
features or apps.
Appears when Siri is
activated in Siri Eyes Free
(Talk) Button
Press and hold until the display
changes as shown.
Features
(Back) Button
Press to deactivate Siri.
While in Siri Eyes Free:
The display remains the same.
No feedback or commands
appears.
319
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 320 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuApple CarPlay
Apple CarPlay
If you connect an Apple CarPlay-compatible iPhone to the system via the front USB
port, you can use the audio/information screen, instead of the iPhone display, to
make a phone call, listen to music, view maps (navigation), and access messages.
1Apple CarPlay
Only iPhone 5 or newer versions with iOS 8.4 or later
are compatible with Apple CarPlay.
2 USB Ports P. 227
Park in a safe place before connecting your iPhone to
Apple CarPlay and when launching any compatible
apps.
■ Apple CarPlay Menu
Home screen
Features
Apple CarPlay icon
Apple CarPlay menu screen
Select the Honda icon
to go back to the
home screen
Go back to the Apple
CarPlay menu screen
■ Phone
Access the contact list, make phone calls, or listen to voice mail.
■ Messages
Check and reply to text messages, or have messages read to you.
■ Music
Play music stored on your iPhone.
320
* Not available on all models
To use Apple CarPlay, connect the USB cable to the
USB port located on the console panel. The USB ports
located in the console compartment and on the back
of the console compartment * will not enable Apple
CarPlay operation.
2 USB Ports P. 227
While connected to Apple CarPlay, calls are only
made through Apple CarPlay. If you want to make a
call with HandsFreeLink, turn Apple CarPlay OFF or
detach the USB cable from your iPhone.
2 Setting Up Apple CarPlay P. 321
When your iPhone is connected to Apple CarPlay, it is
not possible to use the Bluetooth® Audio or
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®. However, other
previously paired phones can stream audio via
Bluetooth® while Apple CarPlay is connected.
2 Phone Setup P. 411
For details on countries and regions where Apple
CarPlay is available, as well as information pertaining
to function, refer to the Apple homepage.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 321 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuApple CarPlay
■ Maps
Display Apple Maps and use the navigation function just as you would on your
iPhone.
Models with navigation system
Only one navigation system (pre-installed navigation or Apple CarPlay) can give
directions at a time. When you are using one system, directions to any prior
destination set on the other system will be canceled, and the system you are
currently using will direct you to your destination.
After you have connected your iPhone to the system via the front USB port, use the
following procedure to set up Apple CarPlay. Use of Apple CarPlay will result in the
transmission of certain user and vehicle information (such as vehicle location, speed,
and status) to your iPhone to enhance the Apple CarPlay experience. You will need
to consent to the sharing of this information on the audio/information screen.
■ Enabling Apple CarPlay
Enable: Allows this consent.
Disable: Does not allow this consent.
You may change the consent settings under
the Connections settings menu.
Continued
Apple CarPlay Operating Requirements &
Limitations
Apple CarPlay requires a compatible iPhone with an
active cellular connection and data plan. Your
carrier’s rate plans will apply.
Changes in operating systems, hardware, software,
and other technology integral to providing Apple
CarPlay functionality, as well as new or revised
governmental regulations, may result in a decrease or
cessation of Apple CarPlay functionality and services.
Honda cannot and does not provide any warranty or
guarantee of future Apple CarPlay performance or
functionality.
It is possible to use 3rd party apps if they are
compatible with Apple CarPlay. Refer to the Apple
homepage for information on compatible apps.
Features
■ Setting Up Apple CarPlay
1Apple CarPlay
1Setting Up Apple CarPlay
You can also use the method below to set up Apple
CarPlay:
Select HOMESettingsConnectionsApple
CarPlay
Use of user and vehicle information
The use and handling of user and vehicle information
transmitted to/from your iPhone by Apple CarPlay is
governed by the Apple iOS terms and conditions and
Apple’s Privacy Policy.
321
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 322 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuApple CarPlay
■ Operating Apple CarPlay with Siri
Press and hold the
(Talk) button to activate Siri.
1Operating Apple CarPlay with Siri
Below are examples of questions and commands for
Siri:
• What movies are playing today?
• Call dad at work.
• What song is this?
• How’s the weather tomorrow?
• Read my latest email.
• Find a table for four tonight in Chicago.
For more information, please visit
www.apple.com/ios/siri.
Features
322
(Talk) Button:
Press and hold to activate Siri.
Press again to deactivate Siri.
Press and release to activate standard voice recognition system.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 323 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAndroid Auto
Android Auto
When you connect an Android phone to the audio system via the front USB port,
Android Auto is automatically initiated. When connected via Android Auto, you can
use the audio/information screen to access the Phone, Google Maps (Navigation),
Google Play Music, and Google Now functions. When you first use Android Auto, a
tutorial will appear on the screen.
We recommend that you complete this tutorial while safely parked before using
Android Auto.
2 USB Ports P. 227
2 Auto Pairing Connection P. 325
1Android Auto
To use Android Auto, you need to download the
Android Auto app from Google Play to your
smartphone.
Only Android 5.0 (Lollipop) or later versions are
compatible with Android Auto.
Bluetooth A2DP cannot be used with Android Auto
phone.
Park in a safe place before connecting your Android
phone to Android Auto and when launching any
compatible apps.
Features
To use Android Auto, connect the USB cable to the
USB port located on the console panel. The USB ports
located in the console compartment and on the back
of the console compartment * will not enable Android
Auto operation.
2 USB Ports P. 227
To directly access the Android Auto phone function,
press Phone on the home screen.
2 Auto Pairing Connection P. 325
When your Android phone is connected to Android
Auto, it is not possible to use the Bluetooth® Audio.
However, other previously paired phones can stream
audio via Bluetooth® while Android Auto is
connected.
2 Phone Setup P. 411
* Not available on all models
Continued
323
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 324 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAndroid Auto
■ Android Auto Menu
1Android Auto
For details on countries and regions where Android
Auto is available, as well as information pertaining to
function, refer to the Android Auto homepage.
: Go back to the
home screen
Android Auto icon
Features
a Maps (Navigation)
Display Google Maps and use the navigation function just as you would with your
Android phone. When the vehicle is in motion, it is not possible to make keyboard
entries. Stop the vehicle in a safe location to undertake a search or provide other
inputs.
Models with navigation system
Only one navigation system (pre-installed navigation or Android Auto) can give
directions at a time. When you are using one system, directions to any prior
destination set on the other system will be canceled, and the system you are
currently using will direct you to your destination.
The audio/information screen shows you turn-by-turn driving directions to your
destination.
b Phone (Communication)
Make and receive phone calls as well as listen to voicemail.
c Google Now (Home screen)
Display useful information organized by Android Auto into simple cards that appear
just when they’re needed.
324
Android Auto Operating Requirements &
Limitations
Android Auto requires a compatible Android phone
with an active cellular connection and data plan.
Your carrier’s rate plans will apply.
Changes in operating systems, hardware, software,
and other technology integral to providing Android
Auto functionality, as well as new or revised
governmental regulations, may result in a decrease or
cessation of Android Auto functionality and services.
Honda cannot and does not provide any warranty or
guarantee of future Android Auto performance or
functionality.
It is possible to use 3rd party apps if they are
compatible with Android Auto. Refer to the Android
Auto homepage for information on compatible apps.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 325 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAndroid Auto
d Music and audio
Play Google Play Music and music apps that are compatible with Android Auto.
To switch between music apps, press this icon.
e Go back to the Home Screen.
f Voice
Operate Android Auto with your voice.
■ Auto Pairing Connection
When you connect an Android phone to the unit via the front USB port, Android
Auto is automatically initiated.
1Enabling Android Auto
Enable: Allows this consent.
Disable: Does not allow this consent.
You may change the consent settings under
the Connections settings menu.
Only initialize Android Auto when you safely parked.
When Android Auto first detects your phone, you will
need to set up your phone so that auto pairing is
possible. Refer to the instruction manual that came
with your phone.
Features
■ Enabling Android Auto
You can use the method below to change Android
Auto settings after you have completed the initial
setup:
Select HOMESettingsConnectionsAndroid
Auto
Use of user and vehicle information
The use and handling of user and vehicle information
transmitted to/from your phone by Android Auto is
governed by the Google’s Privacy Policy.
Continued
325
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 326 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio System Basic OperationuAndroid Auto
■ Operating Android Auto with Voice Recognition
Press and hold the
(Talk) button to operate Android Auto with your voice.
1Operating Android Auto with Voice Recognition
Below are examples of commands you can give with
voice recognition:
• Reply to text.
• Call my wife.
• Navigate to Honda.
• Play my music.
• Send a text message to my wife.
• Call flower shop.
For more information, please refer to the Android
Auto homepage.
Features
326
(Talk) Button:
Press and hold to operate Android Auto with your voice.
Press and release to activate standard voice recognition system.
You can also activate the voice recognition function
by pressing the
icon in the upper-right corner of
the screen.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 327 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Audio Error Messages
iPod/USB Flash Drive
If an error occurs while playing an iPod or USB flash drive, you may see the following
error messages. If you cannot clear the error message, contact a dealer.
Error Message
Solution
Appears when there is a problem with the audio system. Check if the device is
compatible with the audio system.
Bad USB Device*1
Problem reading connected device. See
Owner’s Manual for a list of compatible
devices. If device is compatible, try
reconnecting device.
If this error remains, contact Honda
dealer.*2
Appears when an incompatible device is connected. Disconnect the device. Then turn
the audio system off, and turn it on again. Do not reconnect the device that caused the
error.
Unsupported Ver*1
Problem reading connected device. See
Owner’s Manual for a list of compatible
devices. If device is compatible, try
reconnecting device.
If this error remains, contact Honda
dealer.*2
• Appears when an unsupported iPod is connected. If it appears when a supported
iPod is connected, update the iPod software to the newer version.
• Appears when an unsupported device is connected. If it appears when a supported
device is connected, reconnect the device.
Features
USB Error*1
Problem reading connected device. See
Owner’s Manual for a list of compatible
devices. If device is compatible, try
reconnecting device.
If this error remains, contact Honda
dealer.*2
*1:Models with color audio system
*2:Models with Display Audio
Continued
327
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 328 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio Error MessagesuiPod/USB Flash Drive
Error Message
Problem reading connected device. See
Owner’s Manual for a list of compatible
devices. If device is compatible, try
reconnecting device.
If this error remains, contact Honda
dealer.*2
Appears when the system does not acknowledge the iPod. Reconnect the iPod.
Unplayable File*1
The selected file cannot be played on this
system*2
Appears when the files in the USB flash drive are DRM or an unsupported format. This
error message appears for about three seconds, then plays the next song.
Features
iPod
Appears when the iPod is empty.
No Data
The connected device does not contain any USB flash drive
files that can be played on this system. See Appears when the USB flash drive is empty or there are no MP3, WMA, or AAC files in
Owner’s Manual for a list of compatible file the USB flash drive.
types.*2
iPod and USB flash drive
Check that compatible files are stored on the device.
*1
*1:Models with color audio system
*2:Models with Display Audio
328
Solution
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 329 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAudio Error MessagesuAndroid/Apps
Models with Display Audio
Android/Apps
If an error occurs while using the audio system or apps, you may see the following
error messages. If you cannot clear the error message, contact a dealer.
Error Message
Unfortunately, **** has
stopped.*1
**** is not responding.
Would you like to close
it?*1
Solution
Error has occurred within app, select OK on the screen to close the app.
App is not responding.
Select Wait if you can wait for a response from app a little longer. If it does not respond even if you keep
waiting, select OK to close the app and start it up. If the error message continues, perform Factory Data
Reset.
*1:****part is variable characters, and will change depending upon where an error
occurs.
Features
2 Defaulting All the Settings P. 377
329
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 330 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
General Information on the Audio System
SiriusXM® Radio Service *
■ Subscribing to SiriusXM® Radio
1. You need your radio ID ready before registering for subscription. To see the ID in
the screen, select Channel to 0.
2. Have your radio ID ready, and either call or visit the SiriusXM® website to
subscribe.
■ Receiving SiriusXM® Radio
Features
Switch to the SiriusXM® mode by using the audio remote controls on the steering
wheel, or through the audio/information screen, and stay in this mode for about 30
minutes until the service is activated. Make sure your vehicle is in an open area with
good reception.
■ SiriusXM® Radio Display Messages
Channel not subscribed. Call SiriusXM to subscribe.:
You are not subscribed to the channel selected.
Subscription Update:
SiriusXM® radio is receiving information update from the network.
Channel Not Available:
No such channel exits, or the artist or title information is unavailable.
No Signal:
The signal is too weak in the current location.
Check Tuner:
There is a problem with the SiriusXM® tuner. Contact a dealer.
Check Antenna:
There is a problem with the SiriusXM® antenna. Contact a dealer.
330
* Not available on all models
1Subscribing to SiriusXM® Radio
Contact Information for SiriusXM® Radio:
• US: SiriusXM® Radio at
www.siriusxm.com/subscribenow or
1-866-635-2349
• Canada: SiriusXM® Canada at
www.siriusxm.ca/subscribe-now or
1-877-209-0079
1Receiving SiriusXM® Radio
The SiriusXM® satellites are in orbit over the equator;
therefore, objects south of the vehicle may cause
satellite reception interruptions. Satellite signals are
more likely to be blocked by tall buildings and
mountains the farther north you travel from the
equator.
You may experience reception problems under the
following circumstances:
• In a location with an obstruction to the south of
your vehicle.
• In tunnels
• On the lower level of a multi-tiered road
• Large items carried on the roof rack
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 331 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuCompatible iPod, iPad, iPhone, and USB Flash Drives
Compatible iPod, iPad, iPhone, and USB Flash Drives
■ iPod, iPad, and iPhone Model Compatibility
Model
1iPod, iPad, and iPhone Model Compatibility
This system may not work with all software versions
of these devices.
■ USB Flash Drives
•
•
•
•
•
A USB flash drive of 256 MB or higher is recommended.
Some digital audio players may not be compatible.
Some USB flash drives (e.g., a device with security lockout) may not work.
Some software files may not allow for audio play or text data display.
Some versions of MP3, WMA, or AAC formats may be unsupported.
Features
iPod (5th generation)
iPod classic 80GB/160GB (launch in 2007)
iPod classic 120GB (launch in 2008)
iPod classic 160GB (launch in 2009)
iPod nano (1st to 6th generation) released between 2005 and 2010*2
iPod nano (1st to 7th generation) released between 2005 and 2012*1
iPod touch (1st to 4th generation) released between 2007 and 2010*2
iPod touch (1st to 5th generation) released between 2007 and 2012*1
iPhone*1/iPhone 3G/iPhone 3GS/iPhone 4/iPhone 4s/iPhone 5/iPhone 5c/iPhone 5s/
iPhone 6/iPhone 6 Plus/iPhone 7*2/iPhone 7 Plus*2
iPad*1/iPad 2*1/iPad (3rd generation)*1/iPad (4th generation)*1
iPad Air*1/iPad Air 2*1
iPad mini*1/iPad mini 2*1/iPad mini 3*1
1USB Flash Drives
Files on the USB flash drive are played in their stored
order. This order may be different from the order
displayed on your PC or device.
*1: Models with Display Audio
*2: Models with color audio system
331
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 332 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuHonda App License Agreement
Honda App License Agreement
■ END USER LICENSE AGREEMENT
PLEASE CAREFULLY READ THIS END USER LICENSE AGREEMENT (THIS “AGREEMENT”) WHICH GOVERNS YOUR USE OF THE SOFTWARE
INSTALLED ON YOUR HONDA OR ACURA VEHICLE (YOUR “VEHICLE”) AS WELL AS THE APPLICATIONS, SERVICES, FUNCTIONS, AND
CONTENT PROVIDED THROUGH THE SOFTWARE (COLLECTIVELY, THE “SERVICES”). YOUR USE OF THE SOFTWARE OR SERVICES WILL
SERVE AS YOUR CONSENT TO THE TERMS OF THIS AGREEMENT. THE SOFTWARE IS OWNED (OR LICENSED), PROVIDED, AND/OR
OPERATED BY AMERICAN HONDA MOTOR CO. INC., (“HONDA,” “US,” “WE,” OR “OUR”), WITH ITS BUSINESS ADDRESS AT 1919
TORRANCE BLVD., TORRANCE, CA 90501. REFERENCE TO “HONDA” IN THIS AGREEMENT INCLUDES HONDA’S PARENT COMPANY AND
ITS AFFILIATES AND DESIGNATED AGENTS. THE SERVICES ARE OWNED (OR LICENSED), PROVIDED, AND/OR OPERATED BY HONDA OR A
THIRD-PARTY SERVICE PROVIDER (A “PROVIDER”). REFERENCE TO A “PROVIDER” IN THIS AGREEMENT INCLUDES SUCH PROVIDER’S
PARENT COMPANY, AFFILIATES, AND DESIGNATED AGENTS.
Features
A. Description of the Software. The SOFTWARE includes the software, firmware and the like, installed and executing on your VEHICLE
during manufacture, and thereafter updated from time to time by HONDA, you or an authorized HONDA dealer (a “DEALER”). The
SOFTWARE allows you to access and use a variety of SERVICES, including but not limited to: (a) HONDA applications, services, and content
provided through the SOFTWARE (together, “HONDA SERVICES”); and (b) PROVIDER applications, services, and content provided through
the SOFTWARE (together, “PROVIDER SERVICES”), each of which may provide access to various information, media, content, and services.
B. SOFTWARE Licensing and Intellectual Property.
1. SOFTWARE. This AGREEMENT grants you a non-exclusive, limited, and revocable license to use the SOFTWARE and SERVICES solely (a)
as installed on your VEHICLE by HONDA, (b) as updated on your Vehicle by HONDA, you (but only as and when directed by HONDA), or a
DEALER and (c) as permitted under the terms of this AGREEMENT.
2. HONDA Services. The SOFTWARE may provide you with access to various HONDA SERVICES. Installation, activation, or use of HONDA
SERVICES may require your consent to additional terms, conditions, and privacy policies applicable to those HONDA SERVICES (the
“HONDA TERMS”). You acknowledge and agree that any collection, use, sharing of data generated by your VEHICLE or your use of your
VEHICLE, and your use of the HONDA SERVICES shall be subject to this AGREEMENT and any additional HONDA TERMS that may be
specifically applicable to such HONDA SERVICES or data generation. The HONDA SERVICES may collect, use, and share such data while
you are using the SOFTWARE.
332
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 333 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuHonda App License Agreement
3. Open-Source Software. The SOFTWARE and SERVICES may incorporate software licensed to HONDA under free or open-source
licenses which govern HONDA’s distribution and your use of such software. HONDA and the third-party authors, licensors, and distributors
of such software disclaim all warranties and all liability arising from any and all use or distribution of the software. To the extent such
software is provided under terms that differ from the applicable free or open-source licenses, those terms are offered by HONDA alone.
Additional information regarding free and open-source software incorporated in the SOFTWARE and SERVICES is available in this manual
or within the SOFTWARE.
Features
4. Provider Services. The SOFTWARE may provide you with access to various PROVIDER SERVICES. Installation or use of such PROVIDER
SERVICES may require your consent to additional terms, conditions, and privacy policies of the applicable PROVIDER (the “PROVIDER
TERMS”). This AGREEMENT restricts the manner in which you can install and use PROVIDER SERVICES but does not grant you a license or
permission to use such PROVIDER SERVICES. Your permission to use PROVIDER SERVICES is limited and subject to any license grants,
conditions, and limitations included in the PROVIDER TERMS. You acknowledge that any collection, use, sharing of your information,
targeted advertising practices by PROVIDERS, and your use of the PROVIDER SERVICES shall be subject to both this AGREEMENT and any
applicable PROVIDER TERMS. The PROVIDER SERVICES may collect, use, and share such information while you are using the SOFTWARE.
5. License Limitations and Restrictions on Use.
(a) Limited License. You understand and agree that the SOFTWARE and SERVICES are licensed, not sold, to you solely for use in accordance
with this AGREEMENT and any applicable PROVIDER TERMS, and any documentation for the VEHICLE made available to you by HONDA
(any “DOCUMENTATION”). HONDA and its licensors reserve all rights in the SOFTWARE and HONDA SERVICES not expressly granted to
you under this AGREEMENT. PROVIDERS and their licensors reserve all rights in the PROVIDER SERVICES not expressly granted to you under
the applicable PROVIDER TERMS.
Continued
333
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 334 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuHonda App License Agreement
Features
(b) Restrictions on Use. The licenses granted under this AGREEMENT do not permit you to use the SOFTWARE or SERVICES on a device
other than your VEHICLE. As a condition of using the SOFTWARE and SERVICES, you agree that you may not and will not:
(1) copy, download, distribute, modify, publish, sell, rent, lease, lend, license, sublicense, reuse, or create derivative works of the
SOFTWARE or SERVICES or any of the content or other material within the SOFTWARE or SERVICES, including without limitation,
HONDA or PROVIDER names, logos, or any other trademarks of HONDA or PROVIDERS or used in association with the SOFTWARE or
any SERVICES, except as required to use the SOFTWARE or SERVICES in accordance with this AGREEMENT, any applicable PROVIDER
TERMS, and the DOCUMENTATION;
(2) access or use the SOFTWARE or SERVICES in any manner intended to damage or impair the operation of the SOFTWARE or SERVICES
or interfere with anyone else’s use and enjoyment of the SOFTWARE or SERVICES;
(3) access or attempt to access any system or server on which the SOFTWARE or SERVICES is hosted or modify or alter the SOFTWARE
or SERVICES in any way;
(4) use the SOFTWARE or SERVICES for any unlawful purpose, or in violation of any third party rights;
(5) use the SOFTWARE or SERVICES in violation of any applicable traffic regulations, rules or laws, including but not limited to any driver
distraction laws, rules or regulations;
(6) violate the terms of this AGREEMENT, any HONDA TERMS, any PROVIDER TERMS or other applicable third-party terms, conditions,
and privacy policies; or
(7) reverse engineer, decompile, disassemble, attempt to derive the source code of, nor permit others to reverse engineer, decompile,
or disassemble, or attempt to derive the source code of the SOFTWARE or SERVICES, except and only to the extent that such activity is
expressly permitted (a) by applicable law notwithstanding this limitation or (b) the terms of applicable free or opensource software
licenses.
6. Intellectual Property Rights. All title and intellectual property rights in and to the SOFTWARE and SERVICES, the accompanying
DOCUMENTATION, and all copies of the SOFTWARE or SERVICES are owned by HONDA, PROVIDERS, or their suppliers or licensors. This
AGREEMENT does not grant you any rights in connection with any trademarks or service marks of HONDA, PROVIDERS, or their licensors,
affiliates, or suppliers.
334
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 335 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuHonda App License Agreement
7. Export Restrictions: You acknowledge that the SOFTWARE and SERVICES are subject to U.S., European Union, and other export
jurisdictions. You agree to comply with all applicable international and national laws that apply to the SOFTWARE and SERVICES, including
the U.S. Export Administration Regulations, as well as end-user, end-use, and destination restrictions issued by the U.S. and other
governments.
C. SOFTWARE Operation
1. HONDA reserves the right to suspend or terminate your access to and use of the SOFTWARE or SERVICES if you are found to be in
violation of this AGREEMENT or as reasonably deemed necessary by HONDA.
Features
2. Eligibility/Registration/Activation. The SOFTWARE is intended for and available to individuals who (a) are of legal age of majority in their
jurisdiction of residence (and at least 18 years of age), or are younger than 18 years of age and possess a valid driver’s license issued by
their jurisdiction of residence, and (b) own or have permissive access to a compatible VEHICLE. We do not knowingly collect any
information, including personal information, from children under 13. If we learn or are notified that we have collected personal
information of a child under 13, we will immediately take steps to delete such information.
3. Use of PROVIDER SERVICES through the SOFTWARE. Certain PROVIDER SERVICES made available through the SOFTWARE may require
that you register or otherwise have an account with the PROVIDER and agree to PROVIDER TERMS. Any use of any of such PROVIDER
SERVICES within the SOFTWARE is subject to this AGREEMENT and the applicable PROVIDER TERMS. HONDA does not exercise control
over such PROVIDER SERVICES and is not responsible or liable for the availability, security, or content of such PROVIDER SERVICES, and the
inclusion of any PROVIDER SERVICES does not imply a referral from, the approval of, or the endorsement by HONDA of such PROVIDER
SERVICES. HONDA is not responsible or liable, directly or indirectly, for any damage relating to or resulting from your use of the PROVIDER
SERVICES.
4. Links to Third Party Sites: The SOFTWARE may provide you with the ability to access third-party sites and content through the use of the
SOFTWARE or SERVICES. The third-party sites and content are not under the control of HONDA. HONDA is not responsible or liable,
directly or indirectly, for such third-party websites and their content or for any damage relating to or resulting from your access or use of
such websites and content.
Continued
335
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 336 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuHonda App License Agreement
5. Unauthorized Use and Abuse. You are responsible for ensuring your (and any authorized third parties’) use of the SOFTWARE and
SERVICES remains in compliance with this AGREEMENT and all other applicable HONDA TERMS and PROVIDER TERMS. You acknowledge
and agree that any use of the SOFTWARE or SERVICES occurring through your VEHICLE will be deemed your actions and that HONDA and
PROVIDERS may rely upon such actions. You agree to immediately notify us if you suspect fraudulent or abusive activity involving the
SOFTWARE or SERVICES. If you so notify us or if we otherwise suspect fraudulent or abusive activity, you agree to cooperate with us in any
fraud investigation and to use any fraud prevention measures we prescribe. Your failure to immediately notify us or cooperate to use such
measures will result in your liability for all fraudulent usage or abusive activity associated with your VEHICLE.
Features
6. SOFTWARE Updates. The SOFTWARE and SERVICES may be updated when your VEHICLE is serviced by a DEALER or remotely, over-theair, by HONDA from time to time; such updates may occur with or without further notice or your future consent. The SOFTWARE may be
updated at HONDA’s discretion and for any purpose including, without limitation, to patch or otherwise improve the SOFTWARE or
SERVICES functionality, security, or stability. All updates to the SOFTWARE and SERVICES are subject to this AGREEMENT and any other
applicable HONDA TERMS and PROVIDER TERMS.
7. Uninstalling, Removing, and Replacing the SOFTWARE. Replacing SOFTWARE or HONDA SERVICES with software or firmware not
provided and installed by HONDA or a DEALER will render all representations and warranties for the SOFTWARE, HONDA SERVICES, and
VEHICLE functionality reliant upon the SOFTWARE or HONDA SERVICES null and void.
D. SOFTWARE Operational Notices and Warnings
1. Vehicle Geolocation Information. You acknowledge that your VEHICLE may be equipped with certain traffic and map features. The
traffic feature will automatically collect and transmit, through GPS technology, your Vehicle’s current location (longitude and latitude),
travel direction and speed (“VEHICLE GEOLOCATION INFORMATION”) to HONDA and PROVIDERS. The VEHICLE GEOLOCATION
INFORMATION is used by HONDA and PROVIDERS to provide traffic and navigation-related information to you, but may also be used to
provide other SERVICES or offers to you. HONDA will not use such VEHICLE GEOLOCATION INFORMATION for its own marketing efforts,
or provide such information to unaffiliated third parties for their own purposes, without your express consent.
336
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 337 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuHonda App License Agreement
2. Potential Map Inaccuracy and Route Safety. Maps used by this system may be inaccurate because of changes in roads, traffic controls,
routing, or driving conditions. Always use good judgment and common sense when following suggested routes. Do not follow the route
suggestions if doing so would result in an unsafe or illegal driving maneuver, if you would be placed in an unsafe situation, or if you would
be directed into an area that you consider unsafe. Do not rely on any navigation features included in the system to route you to emergency
services. Not all emergency services such as police, fire stations, hospitals, or clinics are likely to be contained in the map database for such
navigation features. Ask local authorities or an emergency services operator for such locations and routes. The driver is ultimately
responsible for the safe operation of the vehicle and therefore, must evaluate whether it is safe to follow the suggested directions. Any
navigation features are provided only as an aid. Make your driving decisions based on your observations of local conditions and existing
traffic regulations. Navigation features are not a substitute for your personal judgment. Any route suggestions made by the SOFTWARE or
SERVICES should never replace any local traffic regulations or your personal judgment or knowledge of safe driving practices.
Features
3. Speech Recognition: You acknowledge and understand that HONDA and PROVIDERS may record, retain, and use voices commands
when you use the speech recognition components of the SOFTWARE or SERVICES. You and all VEHICLE operators and passengers (a)
consent to the recording and retention of voice commands in support of providing speech recognition components and (b) release HONDA
and PROVIDERS from all claims, liabilities, and losses that may result from any use of such recorded voice commands. Recognition errors
are inherent in speech recognition. It is your responsibility to monitor any speech recognition functions included in the system and address
any errors. Neither HONDA nor PROVIDERS will be liable for any damages arising out of errors in the speech recognition process.
4. Distraction Hazards. Navigation features may require manual (non-verbal) input or setup. Attempting to perform such set-up or insert
data while driving can seriously distract your attention and could cause a crash or other serious consequences; the ability to undertake such
interactions may also be limited by state or local law, which laws you are responsible to know and follow. Even occasional short scans of
the screen may be hazardous if your attention has been diverted away from your driving at a critical time. Pull over and stop the vehicle in
a safe and legal manner before attempting to access a function of the system requiring prolonged attention. Do not raise the volume
excessively. Keep the volume at a level where you can still hear outside traffic and emergency signals while driving. Driving while unable
to hear these sounds could result in a crash.
Continued
337
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 338 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuHonda App License Agreement
E. Information Collection and Storage
1. Information Collection, Use, Transmission and Storage of Data. Consent to Use of Data: You agree that HONDA and PROVIDERS may
collect and use your information gathered in any manner as part of product support services related to the SOFTWARE or related services.
HONDA may share such information with third parties, including, without limitation, PROVIDERS, third party software and services
suppliers, their affiliates and/or their designated agents, solely to improve their products or to provide services or technologies to you.
HONDA, third party software and systems suppliers, their affiliates and/or their designated agent may disclose this information to others,
but not in a form that personally identifies you.
2. Information Storage. Depending on the type of multimedia system you have in your VEHICLE, certain information may be stored for ease
of use of the SOFTWARE including, without limitation, search history, location history in certain applications, previous and saved
destinations, map locations within certain applications, and device numbers and contact information.
Features
(a) Vehicle Health Information. Your VEHICLE may remotely transmit information regarding the status and health of your VEHICLE
(“VEHICLE INFORMATION”) to HONDA without notification to you. VEHICLE INFORMATION may contain VEHICLE maintenance and
malfunction status that is derived from VEHICLE diagnostic data and includes, but is not limited to, status of powered doors and windows,
battery life data, battery charging data, VEHICLE speed, coolant temperature, air compressor revolution, output power, warning codes,
diagnostic trouble codes, fuel injection volume, and engine rotations per minute. VEHICLE HEALTH INFORMATION may be used by HONDA
for research and development, to deliver HONDA SERVICES and information to you, and to contact you, and is retained only for a period
of time necessary to fulfill these goals.
(b) VEHICLE Geolocation Data (non-navigation/map based). If you opt-in to geolocation-based SERVICES, your vehicle’s geolocation data
(latitude and longitude) will be automatically sent from your VEHICLE to HONDA and PROVIDERS.
(c) You understand that the inputting or uploading of information to your VEHICLE’s multimedia system or the SOFTWARE or SERVICES is
at your own risk and that HONDA is not responsible for unauthorized access to or use of any personal or other information. All information
uploaded to the SOFTWARE and SERVICES may be stored on your VEHICLES’s multimedia system and you understand that the security and
safety of your VEHICLE’s multimedia system is your sole responsibility.
338
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 339 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuHonda App License Agreement
Features
F. NO WARRANTY. You understand and agree that your use of the SOFTWARE and SERVICES are solely at your own risk and that you
will be solely responsible for any damage to your VEHICLE’s multimedia system or any other equipment or any loss of data that may result
from your use of the SOFTWARE or SERVICES. THE SOFTWARE AND SERVICES ARE PROVIDED ON AN “AS IS” AND “AS AVAILABLE” BASIS
WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, EXPRESSED, IMPLIED OR STATUTORY. WE SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIM ANY IMPLIED WARRANTIES
OF MERCHANTABILITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, AND NON-INFRINGEMENT. HONDA makes no warranties that the
SOFTWARE or SERVICES will meet your requirements, or that the SOFTWARE or SERVICES will be uninterrupted, timely, secure, noninfringing or error free. You understand and agree that you are responsible for any and all charges, costs or expenses associated with your
use of the SOFTWARE or SERVICES. Advice or information, whether oral or written, obtained by you from us or through the SOFTWARE
or SERVICES are provided for informational purposes only and will not create any warranty not expressly made herein. You should not rely
on any such information or advice. We assume no liability or responsibility for any errors or omissions in the SOFTWARE or SERVICES. We
do not make any warranty or representation that your use of the material displayed on, or obtained through, the SOFTWARE or SERVICES
is non-infringing of any rights of any third party. Any decision or action taken by you on the basis of information or content provided via
the application is at your sole discretion and risk. HONDA and PROVIDERS are not responsible or liable for any such decision, or for the
accuracy, completeness, usefulness, or availability of any content or information displayed, transmitted, or otherwise made available via
the SOFTWARE or SERVICES. To the extent jurisdictions do not allow the exclusion of certain warranties, some of the above exclusions may
not apply to you.
G. LIMITATIONS ON LIABILITY. You and HONDA are each waiving important rights.
1. Limitations on YOUR liability. HONDA cannot recover from you any consequential, indirect, incidental, or special damages, or attorney’s
fees in connection with your use of the SOFTWARE or HONDA SERVICES. HONDA WAIVES TO THE FULLEST EXTENT ALLOWED BY LAW
ANY CLAIM FOR DAMAGES OTHER THAN DIRECT, COMPENSATORY DAMAGES AS LIMITED IN THIS AGREEMENT.
Continued
339
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 340 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuHonda App License Agreement
2. Limitation on HONDA and PROVIDER liability. Neither HONDA nor PROVIDERS will be liable to you or any other party for consequential,
indirect, incidental, special, or punitive damages (including without limitation lost profits) in connection with your use of the SOFTWARE
or SERVICES, even if HONDA or PROVIDERS are aware of the possibility of such damages. These limitations apply to all claims, including,
without limitation, claims in contract and tort (such as negligence, product liability and strict liability). To the extent that a jurisdiction does
not permit the exclusion or limitation of liability as set forth herein our liability is limited to the maximum extent permitted by law in such
states. If HONDA or PROVIDERS are found liable to you for any reason, you agree that the aggregate liability of all these parties to you for
any claim is limited to ten U.S. dollars (US $10.00). Neither HONDA nor any PROVIDER would have agreed to provide the SOFTWARE or
SERVICES to you if you did not agree to this limitation. This amount is the sole and exclusive liability of HONDA and PROVIDERS to you,
and is payable as liquidated damages and not as a penalty. Except where prohibited by law, you may not bring any claim against HONDA
or any third-party beneficiary more than two (2) years after the claim arises. We do not have any liability for SOFTWARE or SERVICES
interruptions of any length.
Features
(a) Release of HONDA and PROVIDERS For yourself and anyone else claiming under you, you agree to release and discharge HONDA,
PROVIDERS, their respective officers, directors, and employees, and each third-party beneficiary from all claims, liabilities and losses in
connection with the SOFTWARE or SERVICES, including, but not limited to claims for personal injury or property damage arising from the
total or partial failure of performance of the SOFTWARE or SERVICES, even if caused by or based upon the negligence, gross negligence,
strict products liability, Deceptive Trade Practices Act violations, bad faith, or breach of warranty of us or the malfunction of the SOFTWARE
or SOFTWARE SERVICES. YOU AGREE TO WAIVE TO THE FULLEST EXTENT ALLOWED BY LAW, ANY CLAIM FOR DAMAGES OTHER THAN
DIRECT, COMPENSATORY DAMAGES AS LIMITED IN THIS AGREEMENT. YOU HEREBY RELEASE AND DISCHARGE HONDA AND ITS
LICENSORS AND CONTRACTORS (INCLUDING ANY THIRD PARTIES PROVIDING ALL OR PART OF THE SOFTWARE OR SERVICES) FROM AND
AGAINST ANY CLAIMS, DAMAGES, EXPENSES AND LIABILITY ARISING FROM OR RELATED TO ANY INJURIES, DAMAGES, OR LOSSES TO
ANY PERSON (INCLUDING DEATH) OR PROPERTY OF ANY KIND RESULTING IN WHOLE OR PART, DIRECTLY OR INDIRECTLY, FROM YOUR
USE OF THE SOFTWARE OR SERVICES.
H. Survival. You agree that the limitations of liability and indemnities in this AGREEMENT will survive even after the AGREEMENT has
ended. These limitations of liability apply not only to you, but to anyone using the SOFTWARE or SERVICES via your VEHICLE, to anyone
making a claim on your behalf, and to any claims made by your family, employees, customers, or others arising out of or relating to your
VEHICLE, the SOFTWARE, or SERVICES.
340
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 341 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuHonda App License Agreement
I. Availability/Interruption. The SOFTWARE and certain SERVICES are made available through your VEHICLE’s compatible multimedia
system when the VEHICLE is turned on. Certain SERVICES may be available only through your compatible mobile device when it is within
the operating range of the VEHICLE and a wireless carrier. The availability of the SOFTWARE and SERVICES may be subject to transmission
limitation or interruption, including but not limited to technical obsolesce or sunsetting of the hardware, software or firmware, inside of
or external to the Vehicle, required for data transmission or receipt. HONDA does not guarantee that the SOFTWARE, SERVICES, or any
portion thereof will be available at all times or in all areas. You acknowledge and agree that HONDA is not responsible for performance
degradation, interruption or delays. You acknowledge that HONDA shall not be liable to you if the SOFTWARE or SERVICES in a given
location are not available. If the SOFTWARE or SERVICES are not available within your intended location, you agree that your sole remedy
shall be to cease using the SOFTWARE and SERVICES.
K. Termination and Transfer.
1. Termination. This AGREEMENT is effective until terminated by you or US. WE may terminate this AGREEMENT for any or no reason,
and with or without notice to you. Your rights under this AGREEMENT will terminate automatically without notice from US if you fail to
comply with any term of this AGREEMENT. Upon termination of this AGREEMENT, you shall cease all use of the SOFTWARE and SERVICES.
Features
J. PRODUCT SUPPORT: Product support for the SOFTWARE is provided by HONDA. For product support, please refer to HONDA
instructions provided in the DOCUMENTATION. Should you have any questions concerning this AGREEMENT, or if you desire to contact
HONDA for any other reason, please refer to the HONDA contact information provided in the DOCUMENTATION.
2. Transfer: You may permanently transfer your rights under this AGREEMENT only as part of a sale or transfer of the VEHICLE, provided
you retain no copies, you transfer all of the SOFTWARE and HONDA SERVICES (including all component parts, the media and printed
materials, and any upgrades), and the recipient agrees to the terms of this AGREEMENT. You agree to notify HONDA upon the sale or
transfer of the VEHICLE. To contact HONDA, please refer to the HONDA contact information provided in the DOCUMENTATION.
Continued
341
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 342 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuHonda App License Agreement
L. Changes to the SOFTWARE or SERVICES. WE may change, modify, or update the SOFTWARE or SERVICES from time to time. Unless
explicitly stated otherwise, any new features or services that augment or enhance the SOFTWARE or SERVICES in the future shall
respectively be considered part of the SOFTWARE or SERVICES and subject to this AGREEMENT. WE reserve the right at any time and from
time to time to interrupt, restrict, modify, suspend, discontinue, temporarily or permanently, the SOFTWARE or SERVICES (or any portion
thereof), with or without notice to you, and you agree that HONDA shall not be liable to you or to any third party for any modification,
suspension or discontinuance of the SOFTWARE or SERVICES.
Features
342
M. ARBITRATION:
PLEASE READ THIS ARBITRATION PROVISION CAREFULLY TO UNDERSTAND YOUR RIGHTS. YOU AGREE THAT ANY CLAIM THAT YOU
MAY HAVE IN THE FUTURE MUST BE RESOLVED THROUGH BINDING ARBITRATION. YOU WAIVE THE RIGHT TO HAVE YOUR DISPUTE
HEARD IN COURT AND WAIVE THE RIGHT TO BRING CLASS CLAIMS. YOU UNDERSTAND THAT DISCOVERY AND APPEAL RIGHTS ARE
MORE LIMITED IN ARBITRATION.
Arbitration is a method of resolving a claim, dispute or controversy without filing a lawsuit. By agreeing to arbitrate, the right to go to
court is waived and instead claims, disputes or controversies are submitted to binding arbitration. This provision sets forth the terms and
conditions of our agreement. YOU and HONDA agree and acknowledge that this Agreement affects interstate commerce and the
Federal Arbitration Act (“FAA”) applies. By using the Software, Vehicle, or Services, YOU elect to have disputes resolved by arbitration.
YOU, HONDA or any involved third party may pursue a Claim. “Claim” means any dispute between YOU, HONDA, or any involved third
party relating to your use of the Software, the Vehicle, or the Services, this Agreement, or our relationship, including any
representations, omissions or warranties. “Claim” does not include personal injury or wrongful death claims. YOU or HONDA may seek
remedies in small claims court or provisional judicial remedies without arbitrating. In addition, notwithstanding anything herein to the
contrary, YOU or HONDA may seek equitable relief in a court of competent jurisdiction.
YOU or HONDA may select arbitration with American Arbitration Association, JAMS or National Arbitration and Mediation. Contact
these sponsors for their rules. The hearing will be in the federal district where YOU reside. If agreed, it may be by telephone or written
submissions. Filing and arbitrator fees to be paid per the sponsor rules. You may contact the sponsor for a fee waiver. If no fee waivers,
HONDA will pay filing and arbitrator fees up to $5,000, unless law requires more. Each party is responsible for other fees. Arbitrator
may award costs or fees to prevailing party, if permitted by law. HONDA will not seek fees, unless the claims are frivolous.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 343 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuHonda App License Agreement
Arbitrator shall be an attorney or current or retired judge familiar with automotive or consumer software. The arbitrator shall follow
substantive law, statute of limitations and decide all issues relating to the interpretation, construction, enforceability and applicability of
this provision. The arbitrator may order relief permitted by law. This provision is governed and enforceable by the FAA. An award shall
include a written opinion and be final, subject to appeal by the FAA.
This provision survives termination of this Agreement or relationship, bankruptcy, assignment or transfer. If part of this provision is
unenforceable, the remainder remains in effect. If unenforceability allows arbitration as a class action, then this provision is entirely
unenforceable. YOU may opt out within 30 days of your initial use of the Software by sending a signed, written notice to HONDA at
Honda Financial Services, P.O. Box 165007, Irving, TX 75016. HONDA reserves the right to make changes to this provision after
providing written notice and an opportunity to opt out.
Features
N. Miscellaneous: You may not assign this AGREEMENT without HONDA’s prior written consent. This AGREEMENT and any additional
HONDA TERMS and PROVIDER TERMS represents the entire agreement between you and US. HONDA may amend the terms of this
AGREEMENT by providing you with notices of such updated terms. If you do not consent to be bound by the updated terms, your sole
remedy will be to cease using the SOFTWARE and SERVICES. If any part of this AGREEMENT is found invalid, void, or unenforceable, the
balance of the AGREEMENT will remain valid and enforceable according to its terms. To the fullest extent permitted by law, and except as
explicitly provided otherwise, this AGREEMENT and any disputes arising out of or relating to it will be governed by the laws of the State of
California, except that California laws concerning choice of law or conflicts shall not apply if they would cause the substantive law of
another jurisdiction to apply. Notwithstanding the foregoing, Section M shall be governed by the Federal Arbitration Act and the laws of
the State of California, as applicable, as set forth therein. The failure to enforce any term of this AGREEMENT on one occasion shall not
prevent enforcement on any other occasion or the enforcement of any other term. Headings and captions shall not be considered included
for purposes of interpretation or application hereof, but are for convenience only.
343
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 344 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuLegal Information on Apple CarPlay/Android Auto
Models with Display Audio
Legal Information on Apple CarPlay/Android Auto
■ OWNER’S MANUAL LICENSE/LIABILITY STATEMENTS
USE OF APPLE CARPLAY IS SUBJECT TO YOUR AGREEMENT TO THE CARPLAY TERMS OF USE, WHICH ARE INCLUDED AS PART OF THE
APPLE iOS TERMS OF USE. IN SUMMARY, THE CARPLAY TERMS OF USE DISCLAIM APPLE AND ITS SERVICE PROVIDERS’ LIABILITY IF THE
SERVICES FAIL TO PERFORM CORRECTLY OR ARE DISCONTINUED, STRICTLY LIMIT APPLE AND ITS SERVICE PROVIDERS’ OTHER
LIABILITIES, DESCRIBE THE KINDS OF USER INFORMATION (INCLUDING, FOR EXAMPLE, VEHICLE LOCATION, VEHICLE SPEED, AND
VEHICLE STATUS) BEING GATHERED AND STORED BY APPLE AND ITS SERVICE PROVIDERS, AND DISCLOSE CERTAIN POSSIBLE RISKS
ASSOCIATED WITH THE USE OF CARPLAY, INCLUDING THE POTENTIAL FOR DRIVER DISTRACTION. SEE APPLE’S PRIVACY POLICY FOR
DETAILS REGARDING APPLE'S USE AND HANDLING OF DATA UPLOADED BY CARPLAY.
Features
344
USE OF ANDROID AUTO IS SUBJECT TO YOUR AGREEMENT TO THE ANDROID AUTO TERMS OF USE WHICH MUST BE AGREED TO WHEN
THE ANDROID AUTO APPLICATION IS DOWNLOADED TO YOUR ANDROID PHONE. IN SUMMARY, THE ANDROID AUTO TERMS OF USE
DISCLAIM GOOGLE AND ITS SERVICE PROVIDERS’ LIABILITY IF THE SERVICES FAIL TO PERFORM CORRECTLY OR ARE DISCONTINUED,
STRICTLY LIMIT GOOGLE AND ITS SERVICE PROVIDERS’ OTHER LIABILITIES, DESCRIBE THE KINDS OF USER INFORMATION (INCLUDING,
FOR EXAMPLE, VEHICLE LOCATION, VEHICLE SPEED, AND VEHICLE STATUS) BEING GATHERED AND STORED BY GOOGLE AND ITS
SERVICE PROVIDERS, AND DISCLOSE CERTAIN POSSIBLE RISKS ASSOCIATED WITH THE USE OF ANDROID AUTO, INCLUDING THE
POTENTIAL FOR DRIVER DISTRACTION. SEE GOOGLE’S PRIVACY POLICY FOR DETAILS REGARDING GOOGLE’S USE AND HANDLING OF
DATA UPLOADED BY ANDROID AUTO.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 345 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuLegal Information on Apple CarPlay/Android Auto
■ DISCLAIMER OF WARRANTIES; LIMITATION ON LIABILITY
Features
YOU EXPRESSLY ACKNOWLEDGE AND AGREE THAT USE OF APPLE CARPLAY OR ANDROID AUTO (“THE APPLICATIONS”) IS AT YOUR
SOLE RISK AND THAT THE ENTIRE RISK AS TO SATISFACTORY QUALITY, PERFORMANCE, ACCURACY AND EFFORT IS WITH YOU TO THE
MAXIMUM EXTENT PERMITTED BY APPLICABLE LAW, AND THAT THE APPLICATIONS AND INFORMATION ON THE APPLICATIONS IS
PROVIDED “AS IS” AND “AS AVAILABLE,” WITH ALL FAULTS AND WITHOUT WARRANTY OF ANY KIND, AND HONDA HEREBY
DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES AND CONDITIONS WITH RESPECT TO THE APPLICATIONS AND INFORMATION ON THE APPLICATIONS,
EITHER EXPRESS, IMPLIED OR STATUTORY, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES AND/OR CONDITIONS OF
MERCHANTABILITY, SATISFACTORY QUALITY, FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE, ACCURACY, QUIET ENJOYMENT, AND NONINFRINGEMENT OF THIRD PARTY RIGHTS. NO ORAL OR WRITTEN INFORMATION OR ADVICE GIVEN BY HONDA OR AN AUTHORIZED
REPRESENTATIVE SHALL CREATE A WARRANTY. AS EXAMPLES, AND WITHOUT LIMITATION, HONDA DISCLAIMS ANY WARRANTY
REGARDING THE ACCURACY OF DATA PROVIDED BY THE APPLICATIONS, SUCH AS THE ACCURACY OF DIRECTIONS, ESTIMATED
TRAVEL TIME, SPEED LIMITS, ROAD CONDITIONS, NEWS, WEATHER, TRAFFIC, OR OTHER CONTENT PROVIDED BY APPLE, GOOGLE, THEIR
AFFILIATES, OR THIRD PARTY PROVIDERS; HONDA DOES NOT GUARANTEE AGAINST LOSS OF APPLICATION DATA, WHICH MAY BE LOST
AT ANY TIME; HONDA DOES NOT GUARANTEE THAT THE APPLICATIONS OR ANY SERVICES PROVIDED THROUGH THEM WILL BE
PROVIDED AT ALL TIMES OR THAT ANY OR ALL SERVICES WILL BE AVAILABLE AT ANY PARTICULAR TIME OR LOCATION. FOR EXAMPLE,
SERVICES MAY BE SUSPENDED OR INTERRUPTED WITHOUT NOTICE FOR REPAIR, MAINTENANCE, SECURITY FIXES, UPDATES, ETC.,
SERVICES MAY BE UNAVAILABLE IN YOUR AREA OR LOCATION, ETC. IN ADDITION, YOU UNDERSTAND THAT CHANGES IN THIRD PARTY
TECHNOLOGY OR GOVERNMENT REGULATION MAY RENDER THE SERVICES AND/OR APPLICATIONS OBSOLETE AND/OR UNUSABLE.
TO THE EXTENT NOT PROHIBITED BY LAW, IN NO EVENT SHALL HONDA OR ITS AFFILIATES BE LIABLE FOR PERSONAL INJURY, OR ANY
INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES WHATSOEVER, INCLUDING, WITHOUT LIMITATION, DAMAGES FOR
LOSS OF PROFITS, CORRUPTION OR LOSS OF DATA, FAILURE TO TRANSMIT OR RECEIVE ANY DATA, BUSINESS INTERRUPTION OR ANY
OTHER COMMERCIAL DAMAGES OR LOSSES, ARISING OUT OF OR RELATED TO THE APPLICATIONS OR YOUR USE OF OR INABILITY TO
USE THE APPLICATIONS OR INFORMATION ON THE APPLICATIONS, HOWEVER CAUSED, REGARDLESS OF THE THEORY OF LIABILITY
(CONTRACT, TORT OR OTHERWISE) AND EVEN IF HONDA WERE ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGES. SOME STATES AND
JURISDICTIONS DISALLOW THE EXCLUSION OR LIMITATION OF LIABILITY FOR DAMAGES, SO THESE LIMITATIONS AND EXCLUSIONS MAY
NOT APPLY TO YOU. IN NO EVENT SHALL HONDA’S TOTAL LIABILITY TO YOU FOR ALL DAMAGES (OTHER THAN AS MAY BE REQUIRED
BY APPLICABLE LAW IN CASES INVOLVING PERSONAL INJURY) EXCEED THE AMOUNT OF FIVE DOLLARS ($5.00). THE FOREGOING
LIMITATIONS WILL APPLY EVEN IF THE ABOVE STATED REMEDY FAILS OF ITS ESSENTIAL PURPOSE.
345
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 346 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuAbout Open Source Licenses
About Open Source Licenses
Models with Display Audio
To see the open source license information, follow these steps.
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select System.
4. Select About.
5. Select Legal Information.
Models with color audio system
Features
346
Project/Component Name: BT module/eCos
Homepage URL: http://ecos.sourceware.org/
License: GPL-2.0
License Link: http://ecos.sourceware.org/license-overview.html
License Text: http://www.hondaopensource2.com/
Notices: http://www.hondaopensource2.com/
Location of Corresponding Source: http://www.hondaopensource2.com/
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 347 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuLicense Information *
License Information *
■ DOLBY DIGITAL
Manufactured under license from Dolby Laboratories. Dolby, Dolby Audio, Pro
Logic, and the double-D symbol are trademarks of Dolby Laboratories.
Features
■ DTS
For DTS patents, see http://patents.dts.com. Manufactured under license from DTS
Licensing Limited. DTS, DTS-HD, the Symbol, & DTS and the Symbol together are
registered trademarks of DTS, Inc.©DTS, Inc. All Rights Reserved.
* Not available on all models
Continued
347
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 348 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuLicense Information *
■ Bluetooth
The Bluetooth® word mark and logos are registered trademarks owned by Bluetooth
SIG, Inc. and any use of such marks by DENSO CORPORATION is under license.
Other trademarks and trade names are those of their respective owners.
■ Windows Media
Features
348
This product is protected by certain intellectual property rights of Microsoft. Use or
distribution of such technology outside of this product is prohibited without a
license from Microsoft.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 349 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuLicense Information *
■ Apple
“Made for iPod,” “Made for iPhone,” and “Made for iPad” mean that an electronic
accessory has been designed to connect specifically to iPod, iPhone, or iPad,
respectively, and has been certified by the developer to meet Apple performance
standards. Apple is not responsible for the operation of this device or its compliance
with safety and regulatory standards. Please note that the use of this accessory with
iPod, iPhone, or iPad may affect wireless performance.
Apple, the Apple Logo, iPad, iPhone, iPod, iPod classic, iPod nano, and iPod touch
are trademarks of Apple Inc., registered in the U.S. and other countries. iPad Air,
iPad mini, iPad Pro, Apple CarPlay, and Lightning are trademarks of Apple Inc. App
Store is a service mark of Apple Inc.
Features
Continued
349
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 350 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuLicense Information *
■ MPEG
Features
Mpeg4 Visual
THIS PRODUCT IS LICENSED UNDER THE MPEG-4 VISUAL PATENT PORTFOLIO
LICENSE FOR THE PERSONAL AND NON-COMMERCIAL USE OF A CONSUMER FOR
(i) ENCODING VIDEO IN COMPLIANCE WITH THE MPEG-4 VISUALA STANDARD
(“MPEG-4 VIDEO”) AND/OR (ii) DECODING MPEG-4 VIDEO THAT WAS ENCODED
BY A CONSUMER ENGAGED IN A PERSONAL AND NONCOMMERCIAL ACTIVITY
AND/OR WAS OBTAINED FROM A VIDEO PROVIDER LICENSED BY MPEG LA TO
PROVIDE MPEG-4 VIDEO. NO LICENSE IS GRANTED OR SHALL BE IMPLIED FOR ANY
OTHER USE. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION INCLUDING THAT RELATING TO
PROMOTIONAL, INTERNAL AND COMMERCIAL USES AND LICENSING MAY BE
OBTAINED FROM MPEG LA, LLC.
SEE HTTP://WWW.MPEGLA.COM.
VC-1
This product is licensed under the AVC patent portfolio license and VC-1 patent
portfolio license for the personal use of a consumer or other uses in which it does
not receive remuneration to
(i) encode video in compliance with the AVC Standard and VC-1 Standard (“AVC/
VC-1 Video”) and/or
(ii) decode AVC/VC-1 Video that was encoded by a consumer engaged in a personal
activity and/or was obtained from a video provider licensed to provide AVC/VC-1
Video.
No license is granted or shall be implied for any other use.
Additional information may be obtained from MPEG LA, L.L.C.
See http://www.mpegla.com.
350
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 351 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuGeneral Information on the Audio SystemuLicense Information *
AVC/H.264
THIS PRODUCT IS LICENSED UNDER THE AVC PATENT PORTFOLIO LICENSE FOR THE
PERSONAL AND NONCOMMERCIAL USE OF A CONSUMER TO (i) ENCODE VIDEO IN
COMPLIANCE WITH THE AVC STANDARD (“AVC VIDEO”) AND/OR (ii) DECODE
AVC VIDEO THAT WAS ENCODED BY A CONSUMER ENGAGED IN A PERSONAL
AND NON-COMMERCIAL ACTIVITY AND/OR WAS OBTAINED FROM A VIDEO
PROVIDER LICENSED TO PROVIDE AVC VIDEO. NO LICENSE IS GRANTED OR SHALL
BE IMPLIED FOR ANY OTHER USE.
ADDITIONAL INFORMATION MAY BE OBTAINED FROM MPEG LA, L.L.C. SEE
HTTP://WWW.MPEGLA.COM.
microSDHC Logo is a trademark of SD-3C, LLC.
Features
■ SDHC Memory Card
351
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 352 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Customized Features
Models with color audio system
1Customized Features
Use the audio/information screen to customize certain features.
■ How to customize
While the vehicle is at a complete stop with the power mode in ON, press the
MENU/CLOCK button, then select Settings. To customize the phone settings,
press the
button, then select Phone Setup.
Audio/Information Screen
(Phone) Button
When you customize settings, make sure that the
vehicle is at a complete stop and shift to (P .
1How to customize
These indications are used to show how to operate
the selector knob.
Rotate
to select.
Press
to enter.
To customize other features, select Settings, rotate
, then press
.
2 List of customizable options P. 356
Features
MENU/CLOCK Button
Selector Knob
352
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 353 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCustomized Featuresu
■ Customization Flow
Press the MENU/CLOCK button.
Adjust Clock
Settings
RDS Settings
RDS Information
Radio Text
Bluetooth Setup
Add New Device
Connect an Audio Device
Features
Display Adjustment
Brightness
Contrast
Black Level
Rear Camera
Camera Guideline
Brightness
Contrast
Black Level
Color
Tint
Continued
353
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 354 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Display Change
Audio
Wallpaper
Wallpaper
Select
Import
Delete
Features
Color Theme
Blue
Red
Amber
Gray
Language
Clock Format
12h
24h
354
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 355 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Press the
button and rotate
to select Phone Setup, then press
Bluetooth Setup
.
Add New Device
Connect a Phone
Connect an Audio Device
Disconnect All Devices
Delete Device
Pass-Key
Ringtone
Features
Speed Dial
Fixed
Mobile Phone
Caller ID Info
Name Priority
Number Priority
System Clear
Continued
355
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 356 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCustomized Featuresu
■ List of customizable options
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
—
2 Clock P. 130
RDS
Settings
Bluetooth
Setup
RDS Information
Radio Text
Features
Add New Device
Connect an Audio
Device
Brightness
Display
Contrast
Adjustment
Black Level
Camera Guideline
Rear
Camera
Brightness
Contrast
Black Level
Color
Tint
*1:Default Setting
356
Selectable Settings
Adjusts clock.
Adjust Clock
Settings
Description
Selects whether the RDS information comes
on.
Displays the radio text information of the
selected RDS station.
On*1/Off
—
See Bluetooth Setup on P. 358
Changes the brightness of the audio/
information screen.
Changes the contrast of the audio/
information screen.
Changes the black level of the audio/
information screen.
Selects whether the guidelines come on the
audio/information screen.
—
—
—
On*1/Off
See Display Adjustment on P. 356
Changes the color of the audio/information
screen.
Changes the tint of the audio/information
screen.
—
—
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 357 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Display Change
Select
Wallpaper
Import
Delete
Settings
Color Theme
Language
Changes the display type.
Changes the wallpaper type.
Selectable Settings
Audio*1/Wallpaper
Clock*1/Image1/Image2/
Image3
Imports an image file for a new wallpaper.
—
2 Wallpaper Setup P. 236
Deletes an image file for a wallpaper.
Changes the background color of the audio/
information screen.
Changes the display language.
Selects the digital clock display from 12h to
24h.
Image1*1/Image2/Image3
Blue*1/Red/Amber/Gray
English*1/French/Spanish
12h*1/24h
Features
Clock Format
Description
*1:Default Setting
Continued
357
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 358 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Add New Device
Connect a Phone
Bluetooth
Setup
Phone
Setup
Features
Speed Dial
Ringtone
Caller ID Info
System Clear
*1:Default Setting
358
Description
Pairs a new phone to HFL.
2 Phone Setup P. 387
Pairs a new phone or connects a paired phone
to HFL.
Selectable Settings
—
—
2 Phone Setup P. 387
Connect an Audio
Device
Disconnect All Devices
Delete Device
Pass-Key
Connects a Bluetooth® Audio device to HFL.
—
Disconnects a paired phone from HFL.
Deletes a paired phone.
Changes a pairing code.
Edits, adds or deletes a speed dial entry.
—
—
—
2 Speed Dial P. 396
—
Selects the ring tone.
Fixed/Mobile Phone*1
Prioritizes the caller’s name or phone number Name Priority*1/Number
as the caller ID.
Priority
Cancels/Resets all customized items in the
—
Phone Setup group as default.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 359 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Customized Features
Models with Display Audio
1Customized Features
Use the audio/information screen to customize certain features.
■ How to customize
With the power mode in ON, select Settings, then select a setting item.
When you customize settings, make sure that the
vehicle is at a complete stop and shift to (P .
To customize other features, select Settings.
2 List of customizable options P. 366
Features
Audio/Information
Screen
Continued
359
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 360 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCustomized Featuresu
■ Customization flow
Select
.
Date & Time
Set Date & Time
Automatic Date &
Time
Set Date
Set Time
Set Time Zone
Automatic Time
Zone *
Select time zone
Select Settings.
Select Time Format
Features
System Volumes
Navigation Guidance *
System
Touch
Sensitivity
Subscriptions
Language
Factory Data
Reset
About
360
System Sounds
* Not available on all models
HondaLink Subscription Status
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 361 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Advanced
Options
App Manager
Recent Location
Request from Apps
Location Setting
Interruptions
Continued
Features
Interruption Mode
Events and
reminders
Calls
Messages
Calls/messages
from
361
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 362 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Bluetooth
+ Connect New Device
Saved Devices
Connections
Wi-Fi
Change Mode
Connected Devices
Android Auto
Apple CarPlay
CabinControl
Features
362
Options
(Device list)
CabinControl
Connection
Information
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 363 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Driving Position
Setup *
Seat Position Movement at Entry/Exit
Memory Position Link
Meter Setup
Adjust Outside Temp Display
Trip A Reset Timing
Trip B Reset Timing
Reverse Shift Position Beep
Auto Idle Stop Display
Vehicle
Power Tailgate
Setup *
Features
Adjust Alarm Volume
Turn by Turn Display
Fuel Efficiency Backlight
Power Tailgate Keyless Open Mode
Power Tailgate Open by Outer Handle
Hands Free Access Power Tailgate *
Keyless Access
Setup
Door Unlock Mode
Keyless Access Light Flash
Keyless Access Beep
Remote Start System On/Off
Walk Away Auto Lock
* Not available on all models
Continued
363
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 364 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Driver Assist
System Setup
Forward Collision Warning Distance
ACC Forward Vehicle Detect Beep
Road Departure Mitigation Setting
Lane Keeping Assist Suspend Beep
Blind Spot Information *
Door Setup
Auto Door Lock
Auto Door Unlock
Key and Remote Unlock Mode
Features
Keyless Lock Answer Back
Security Relock Timer
Lighting Setup
Interior Light Dimming Time
Headlight Auto Off Timer
Auto Interior Illumination Sensitivity
Auto Headlight On with Wiper On
Auto Light Sensitivity
Wireless
Charger *
Maintenance
Information
364
* Not available on all models
Oil Life
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 365 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Camera
Rear Camera
Default Camera View
Guidelines
Cross Traffic Monitor *
LaneWatch *
Show with Turn Signal
Show Reference Line
Display
Brightness
Contrast
Sound
Features
Black Level
Bass / Treble
Center /
Subwoofer
Volume *
Subwoofer
Volume *
Balance / Fader
Audio Zones *
Speed Volume
Compensation
DTS Neural
Surround *
Notifications
* Not available on all models
Continued
365
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 366 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCustomized Featuresu
■ List of customizable options
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Set
Date &
Time
Automatic
Date &
Time
Set Date
Set Time
Features
System
Date & Time
Set
Time
Zone
366
* Not available on all models
Selects ON to have the GPS automatically adjust
the clock. Select OFF to cancel this function.
Selectable Settings
ON*1/OFF
Adjusts date.
—
2 Adjusting the Clock P. 130
Adjusts clock.
—
2 Adjusting the Clock P. 130
Automatic
Time Zone *
Sets the navigation system to automatically adjust
the clock when driving through different time
zones.
Select time
zone
Changes the time zone manually.
Select Time Format
*1:Default Setting
Description
Selects the digital clock display from 12H to 24H.
ON*1/OFF
—
12H*1/24H
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 367 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
System
Volumes
Selectable Settings
System Sounds
Changes the system sounds volume.
—
Navigation
Guidance *
Changes the navigation guidance volume.
—
Touch
Sensitivity
Subscriptions
Description
HondaLink
Subscription Status
Sets the sensitivity of the touch panel screen.
High/Low*1
Lists subscriptions and subscription status for
HondaLink®.
—
Language
Changes the display language.
Factory Data
Reset
Resets all the settings to their factory default.
About
Displays the Android setting items.
2 Defaulting All the Settings P. 377
English (United
States)*1/English
(United Kingdom)/
Korean/French/
Spanish/Arabic
Features
System
Continue/Cancel
—
*1:Default Setting
* Not available on all models
Continued
367
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 368 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Features
System
Customizable Features
Displays the Android system memory and apps
information.
—
Recent Location
Request from Apps
Displays the recent location requests from apps.
—
Location Setting
Selects OFF not to allow apps including the
navigation system * to access the vehicle’s location.
ON*1/OFF
Interruption
Mode
Sets the interruption mode for allowing to notify
when calls and notifications arrive.
Always interrupt*1/
Don’t interrupt/
Allow only priority
interruptions
Events and
reminders
Sets priority interruptions of events and reminders.
ON*1/OFF
Calls
Sets priority interruptions of calls.
ON*1/OFF
Messages
Sets priority interruptions of messages.
ON*1/OFF
Sets priority interruptions of from who.
Anyone*1/Contacts
only/Starred
contacts only
Interruptions
Calls/
messages
from
368
* Not available on all models
Selectable Settings
App Manager
Advanced
Options
*1:Default Setting
Description
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 369 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Bluetooth
+ Connect New
Device
Saved Devices
Description
Selectable Settings
Pairs a new phone to HFL.
—
2 Phone Setup P. 411
Connects, disconnects, or deletes a paired phone.
—
2 Phone Setup P. 411
Network*1/HotSpot/
OFF
Change Mode
Changes the Wi-Fi mode.
Available Networks/
Connected Devices
Displays the available network(s) or current
connected device(s).
—
Android Auto
Sets up the Android Auto connection.
—
Apple CarPlay
Sets up the Apple CarPlay connection.
—
Wi-Fi
CabinControl
Turns the Honda CabinControl function on and off.
Connection
Information
Displays the Honda CabinControl connection
information.
—
Selects functions or deletes a device.
—
Features
Connections
ON*1/OFF
Options
CabinControl
(Device list)
*1:Default Setting
Continued
369
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 370 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Driving
Position
Setup *
Features
Vehicle
Meter Setup
*1:Default Setting
370
* Not available on all models
Description
Selectable Settings
Seat Position
Movement at Entry/
Exit
Moves the seat rearward when you get in/get out
of the vehicle. Changes the setting for this feature.
ON*1/OFF
Memory Position
Link
Turns the driving position memory system on and
off.
ON*1/OFF
Adjust Outside Temp
Display
Adjusts the temperature reading by a few degrees.
-5°F ~ ±0°F*1 ~ +5°F
(U.S.)
-3°C ~ ±0°C*1 ~ +3°C
(Canada)
Trip A Reset Timing
Changes the setting of how to reset trip meter A
and average fuel economy A.
With Refuel/IGN
Off/Manually
Reset*1
Trip B Reset Timing
Changes the setting of how to reset trip meter B
and average fuel economy B.
With Refuel/IGN
Off/Manually
Reset*1
Reverse Shift
Position Beep
Turns the reverse alert tone on and off.
ON/OFF*1
Auto Idle Stop
Display
Selects whether the Auto Idle Stop display comes
on or not.
ON*1/OFF
Adjust Alarm Volume
Changes the alarm volume, such as the buzzers,
warnings, turn signal sound, and so on.
High/Mid*1/Low
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 371 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Description
Selectable Settings
Turn by Turn Display
Selects whether the turn-by-turn display comes on
during the route guidance.
ON*1/OFF
Fuel Efficiency
Backlight
Turns the ambient meter feature on and off.
ON*1/OFF
Power Tailgate
Keyless Open Mode
Changes the keyless setting for when the power
tailgate opens.
Anytime*1/When
Unlocked
Power Tailgate Open
by Outer Handle
Changes the setting to open power tailgate by
tailgate outer handle.
Off (Manual only)/
On (Power/
Manual)*1
Hands Free Access
Power Tailgate *
Changes the setting to open power tailgate by a
swift forward in and out kicking motion under the
rear bumper.
ON*1/OFF
Door Unlock Mode
Changes which doors unlock when you grab the
driver’s door handle.
Driver Door or
Tailgate*1/All Doors
Keyless Access Light
Flash
Causes some exterior lights to flash when you
unlock/lock the doors.
ON*1/OFF
Keyless Access Beep
Causes the beeper to sound when you unlock/lock
the doors.
ON*1/OFF
Meter Setup
Keyless Access
Setup
Features
Vehicle
Power
Tailgate
Setup *
*1:Default Setting
* Not available on all models
Continued
371
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 372 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Keyless Access
Setup
Features
Vehicle
Driver Assist
System Setup
*1:Default Setting
372
* Not available on all models
Description
Selectable Settings
Remote Start System
On/Off
Turns the remote engine start feature on and off.
ON*1/OFF
Walk Away Auto
Lock
Changes the settings for the automatic locking the
doors when you walk away from the vehicle while
carrying the remote.
Enable/Disable*1
Forward Collision
Warning Distance
Changes at which distance CMBSTM alerts.
Long/Normal*1/
Short
ACC Forward Vehicle
Detect Beep
Causes the system to beep when the system
detects a vehicle, or when the vehicle goes out of
the ACC range.
ON/OFF*1
Road Departure
Mitigation Setting
Changes the setting for the road departure
mitigation system.
Normal*1/Wide/
Warning Only
Lane Keeping Assist
Suspend Beep
Causes the system to beep when the LKAS is
suspended.
ON/OFF*1
Blind Spot
Information *
Changes the setting for the blind spot information.
Audible and Visual
Alert*1/Visual Alert/
OFF
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 373 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Selectable Settings
With Vehicle
Speed*1/Shift from
P/OFF
Auto Door Unlock
Changes the setting for when the doors unlock
automatically.
All Doors with
Driver’s Door
Opens*1/All Doors
with Shift to P/All
Doors with IGN Off/
OFF
Key and Remote
Unlock Mode
Sets up either the driver’s door or all doors to
unlock on the first push of the remote or built-in
key.
Driver Door*1/All
Doors
Keyless Lock Answer
Back
LOCK/UNLOCK- The exterior lights flash.
LOCK (2nd push)- The beeper sounds.
ON*1/OFF
Security Relock Timer
Changes the time it takes for the doors to relock
and the security system to set after you unlock the
vehicle without opening any door.
90 sec/60 sec/30
sec*1
Door Setup
Features
Changes the setting for the automatic locking
feature.
Auto Door Lock
Vehicle
Description
*1:Default Setting
Continued
373
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 374 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Lighting
Setup
Features
Vehicle
*1:Default Setting
374
* Not available on all models
Selectable Settings
Interior Light
Dimming Time
Changes the length of time the interior lights stay
on after you close the doors.
60 sec/30 sec*1/15
sec
Headlight Auto Off
Timer
Changes the length of time the exterior lights stay
on after you close the driver’s door.
60 sec/30 sec/15
sec*1/0 sec
Auto Interior
Illumination
Sensitivity
Changes the sensitivity of the brightness of the
instrument panel when the headlight switch is in
the AUTO position.
Min/Low/Mid*1/
High/Max
Auto Headlight On
with Wiper On
Changes the settings for the wiper operation when
the headlights automatically come on while the
headlight switch is in the AUTO position.
ON*1/OFF
Auto Light
Sensitivity
Changes the timing for the headlights to come on.
Max/High/Mid*1/
Low/Min
Turns the wireless charger feature on and off.
ON*1/OFF
Wireless
Charger *
Maintenance
Information
Description
Oil Life
Resets the engine oil life display when you have
performed the maintenance service.
—
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 375 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Default Camera View
Description
Changes the camera view mode when the rear
camera monitor is turned on.
2 Multi-View Rear Camera P. 550
Rear Camera
Guidelines
Selects whether the guidelines come on the rear
camera monitor.
2 Multi-View Rear Camera P. 550
Camera
Contrast
Black Level
Dynamic/Fixed/
Both*1/OFF
Turns the cross traffic monitor on and off.
ON*1/OFF
Show with Turn
Signal
Selects whether the LaneWatch display comes on
when you move the turn signal lever to indicate a
right turn.
ON*1/OFF
Show Reference Line
Selects whether the reference lines come on the
LaneWatch monitor.
ON*1/OFF
Features
Display
Last Used/Normal
View/Wide View*1
Cross Traffic
Monitor *
LaneWatch *
Brightness
Selectable Settings
Adjusts the settings of the audio/information
screen.
2 Display Setup P. 278
*1:Default Setting
* Not available on all models
Continued
375
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 376 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCustomized Featuresu
Setup
Group
Customizable Features
Description
Selectable Settings
Bass / Treble
Center /
Subwoofer
Volume *
Subwoofer
Volume *
Sound
Adjusts the settings of the audio speakers’ sound.
2 Adjusting the Sound P. 277
Balance / Fader
Features
Audio Zones *
Speed Volume
Compensation
DTS Neural
Surround *
Notifications
*1:Default Setting
376
* Not available on all models
Changes the notification settings for apps.
—
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 377 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCustomized FeaturesuDefaulting All the Settings
Defaulting All the Settings
Reset all the menu and customized settings as the factory defaults.
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select System.
4. Select Factory Data Reset.
u A confirmation message appears on the
screen.
5. Select Continue to reset the settings.
6. Select Continue again to reset the settings.
u The system will reboot.
1Defaulting All the Settings
When you transfer the vehicle to a third party, reset
all settings to default and delete all personal data.
If you perform Factory Data Reset, it will reset the
preinstalled apps to their factory default.
If you perform Factory Data Reset, you cannot use
the HondaLink® because it becomes off line.
2 HondaLink® P. 312
Features
377
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 378 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
HomeLink® Universal Transceiver *
The HomeLink® Universal Transceiver can be programmed to operate up to three
remote controlled devices around your home, such as garage doors, lighting, or
home security systems.
■ Important Safety Precautions
Refer to the safety information that came with your garage door opener to test that
the safety features are functioning properly. If you do not have the safety
information, contact the manufacturer.
Before programming HomeLink, make sure that people and objects are out of the
way of the garage or gate to prevent potential injury or damage.
Features
378
When programming a garage door opener, park just outside the garage door’s path.
* Not available on all models
1HomeLink® Universal Transceiver *
Before programming HomeLink to operate a garage
door opener, confirm that the opener has an external
entrapment protection system, such as an “electronic
eye,” or other safety and reverse stop features. If it
does not, HomeLink may not be able to operate it.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 379 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHomeLink® Universal Transceiver * uTraining HomeLink
Training HomeLink
Indicator
I HomeLink
Button
III HomeLink
Button
If it is necessary to erase a previously entered
learned code:
• Press and hold the I and III HomeLink
buttons for about 10 seconds, until the
orange indicator blinks. Release the
buttons, and proceed to step 1.
• If you are training the second or third
button, go directly to step 1.
The instructions on the next page should work for most gate or garage openers, but
may not work for all. For detailed instructions about your specific remote opener,
visit http://www.homelink.com or call (800)355-3515.
Features
Continued
379
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 380 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHomeLink® Universal Transceiver * uTraining HomeLink
■ Programming a Button
1Training HomeLink
1. Position the remote transmitter you wish to link 1 to 3 inches (3 - 8 cm) from the
HomeLink® button you want to program.
2. Press and release the desired HomeLink button. Is the HomeLink indicator (LED) slowly
flashing orange?
NO
YES
Features
3a. Hold the button on the remote
transmitter. Does HomeLink indicator
(LED) change from slowly flashing
orange to rapidly flashing green or
continuously on green? The process
should take less than 60 seconds.
4. Press and hold the programmed HomeLink
button for about a second. Does the device
(garage door opener) work?
YES
3b. Canadian Garage Door Opener
A. Press and release the HomeLink
button. Press, hold and release the
button on the remote every 2 secs.
Does the HomeLink indicator (LED)
change from slowly flashing orange to
rapidly flashing or continuously on
green? The process should take less
than 60 seconds.
NO
5. Press and hold the HomeLink button again.
Training
Complete
HomeLink LED is
continuously on green.
6. Press and hold the HomeLink button
again.
The remote-controlled device should
operate.
Training Complete
380
HomeLink indicator rapidly flashes
green.
5a. The remote has a rolling code. Press the
“learn” button on the remote-controlled
device (e.g. garage door opener).
5b. Within 30 secs, press and hold the
programmed HomeLink button for 2
secs.
Reprogramming a Button
If you want to retrain a programmed button for a
new device, you do not have to erase all button
memory. You can replace the existing memory code
using this procedure:
1. Press and hold the desired HomeLink button until
the HomeLink indicator begins to slowly flash
orange. This should take about 20 seconds.
2. Release the HomeLink button and position the
remote transmitter you wish to link 1 - 3 inches
(3 - 8 cm) from the HomeLink button you want to
program, then follow steps 3 - 6 under
“programming a button.”
Erasing Button Memory
To erase programming from the buttons, press and hold
the two outside HomeLink buttons until the HomeLink
indicator changes from orange to rapidly flashing green.
This should take about 10 seconds. You should erase all
programming before selling the vehicle.
Operating
To operate, simply press and release the programmed
HomeLink button. Activation will now occur for the
trained device.
Questions
For questions or comments, visit
www.HomeLink.com, www.youtube.com/
HomeLinkGentex, or by calling the HomeLink Hotline
(North America only) at (800) 355-3515.
HomeLink® is a registered trademark of Gentex
Corporation.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 381 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®
Models with color audio system
1Using HFL
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® (HFL) allows you to place and receive phone calls using
your vehicle’s audio system, without handling your cell phone.
Place your phone where you can get good reception.
To use HFL, you need a Bluetooth-compatible cell
phone. For a list of compatible phones, pairing
procedures, and special feature capabilities, visit
automobiles.honda.com/handsfreelink/, or call 1888-528 -7876.
Using HFL
■ HFL Buttons
Microphone
Volume up
Volume down
(Talk) Button
(Hang-up/Back) Button
(Pick-up) Button
Selector Knob
(Pick-up) button: Press to go directly to the phone screen or to answer an
incoming call.
(Hang-up/Back) button: Press to end a call or to cancel a command.
(Talk) button: Press to call a number with a stored voice tag.
(Phone) button: Press to go directly to the phone screen.
Selector knob: Rotate
to select an item on the screen, then press .
Features
(Phone) Button
Voice control tips
• Aim the vents away from the ceiling and close the
windows, as noise coming from them may interfere
with the microphone.
• Press and release the
button when you want to
call a number using a stored voice tag. Speak
clearly and naturally after a beep.
• If the microphone picks up voices other than yours,
the command may be misinterpreted.
• To change the volume level, use the audio system's
volume knob or the remote audio controls on the
steering wheel.
State or local laws may prohibit the operation of
handheld electronic devices while operating a
vehicle.
If you receive a call while using the audio system, the
system resumes its operation after ending the call.
Up to 20 speed dial entries can be stored. If there is
no entry in the system, Speed Dial is disabled.
2 Speed Dial P. 396
Up to 20 call histories can be stored. If there is no call
history, Call History is disabled.
Continued
381
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 382 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uUsing HFL
■ HFL Status Display
Battery Level Status
1Using HFL
The audio/information screen notifies you
when there is an incoming call.
Signal Strength
Roaming Status
Bluetooth Indicator
Appears when your
phone is connected
to HFL.
HFL Mode
Caller's Name
HFL Limitations
An incoming call on HFL will interrupt the audio
system when it is playing. It will resume when the call
is ended.
Features
1HFL Status Display
The information that appears on the audio/
information screen varies between phone models.
■ Limitations for Manual Operation
Certain manual functions are disabled or inoperable while the vehicle is in motion.
You cannot select a grayed-out option until the vehicle is stopped.
Only previously stored speed dial entries can be called using voice commands while
the vehicle is in motion.
2 Speed Dial P. 396
382
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology
The Bluetooth® word mark and logos are registered
trademarks owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc., and any
use of such marks by Honda Motor Co., Ltd., is under
license. Other trademarks and trade names are those
of their respective owners.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 383 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
HFL Menus
The power mode must be in ACCESSORY or ON to use the system.
1HFL Menus
To use HFL, you must first pair your Bluetoothcompatible cell phone to the system while the vehicle
is parked.
or
Phone
Speed Dial*1
Add New
Some functions are limited while driving.
Call History*1
Select a phone number from the call history to
store as a speed dial number.
Phonebook
Select a phone number from the phonebook to
store as a speed dial number.
Phone Number
Enter a phone number to store as a speed dial
number.
Dialed Calls
Display the last 20 outgoing calls.
Received Calls
Display the last 20 incoming calls.
Missed Calls
Display the last 20 missed calls.
Phonebook*1
Display the paired phone’s phonebook.
Dial*1
Enter a phone number to dial.
Features
(Existing entry list)
Call History
*1: Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
Continued
383
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 384 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
Redial*1
Redial the last number dialed in the phone’s history.
Phone Setup
Bluetooth Setup
Features
Add New Device
Pair a phone to the system.
Connect a Phone
Connect a phone to the system.
Connect an Audio Device Connect a Bluetooth® Audio device to the
system.
Disconnect All Devices Disconnect a paired device from the system.
*1 : Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
384
Delete Device
Delete a previously paired device.
Pass-Key
Change a pairing code.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 385 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
Speed Dial*1
Add New
Call History
Phonebook
Select a phone number from the phonebook
to store as a speed dial number.
Phone Number
Enter a phone number to store as a speed dial
number.
Features
Existing entry list
Change Speed Dial
*1: Appears only when a phone is connected to HFL.
Select a phone number from the call history
to store as a speed dial number.
Change a previously stored speed dial
number.
Delete Speed Dial
Delete a previously stored speed dial number.
Store Voice Tag
Create a voice tag for a speed dial number.
Change Voice Tag
Change a voice tag for a speed dial number.
Delete Voice Tag
Delete a voice tag for a speed dial number.
Continued
385
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 386 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
Ringtone
Features
Caller ID Info
System Clear
386
Fixed
Select the ring tone stored in HFL.
Mobile Phone
Select the ring tone stored in the connected
cell phone.
Name Priority
Prioritize the caller’s name as the caller ID.
Number Priority
Prioritize the caller’s phone number as the
caller ID.
Clear the system of all paired phones, phonebook entries,
and security codes.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 387 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Phone Setup
1Phone Setup
■ To pair a cell phone (when there is no
Phone Pairing Tips:
• You cannot pair your phone while the vehicle is
moving.
• Up to six phones can be paired.
• Your phone’s battery may drain faster when it is
connected to HFL.
• If your phone is not ready for pairing or not found
by the system within three minutes, the system will
time out and return to idle.
Once you have paired a phone, you can see it
displayed on the screen with one or two icons on the
right side.
These icons indicate the following:
: The phone can be used with HFL.
: The phone is compatible with Bluetooth® Audio.
Features
phone paired to the system)
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Yes, then press .
3. Make sure your phone is in search or
discoverable mode, then press .
u HFL automatically searches for a
Bluetooth® device.
4. When your phone appears on the list, select
it by pressing .
u If your phone does not appear, select
Phone Not Found? and search for
Bluetooth® devices using your phone.
From your phone, select
HandsFreeLink.
Your Bluetooth-compatible phone must be paired to
HFL before you can make and receive hands-free
calls.
5. The system gives you a pairing code on the
audio/information screen.
u Confirm if the pairing code on the screen
and your phone match.
This may vary by phone.
6. A notification appears on the screen if
pairing is successful.
Continued
387
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 388 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To pair a cell phone (when a phone has
already been paired to the system)
1. Press the
button or the
button.
u If a prompt appears asking to connect to
a phone, select No and proceed with
step 2.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press
.
3. Rotate
to select Bluetooth Setup,
then press
.
Features
4. Rotate
to select Add New Device,
then press
.
u The screen changes to device list.
5. Rotate
.
388
to select Add New, then press
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 389 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
6. Make sure your phone is in search or
discoverable mode, then press
.
u HFL automatically searches for a
Bluetooth® device.
Features
7. When your phone appears on the list, select
it by pressing
.
u If your phone does not appear, select
Phone Not Found? and search for
Bluetooth® devices using your phone.
From your phone, select
HandsFreeLink.
8. The system gives you a pairing code on the
audio/information screen.
u Confirm if the pairing code on the screen
and your phone match.
This may vary by a phone.
Continued
389
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 390 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To change the currently paired phone
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Bluetooth Setup, then
press .
Features
4. Rotate
to select Connect a Phone,
then press .
u The screen changes to a device list.
5. Rotate
to select a desired device name,
then press .
u HFL disconnects the connected phone
and starts searching for another paired
phone.
390
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 391 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To change the pairing code setting
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Bluetooth Setup, then
press .
4. Rotate
.
to select Pass-Key, then press
Features
5. Input a new pairing code, then press
.
Continued
391
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 392 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To delete a paired phone
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Bluetooth Setup, then
press .
Features
4. Rotate
to select Delete Device, then
press .
u The screen changes to a device list.
5. Rotate
to select a phone you want to
delete, then press .
6. A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Rotate
to select Yes, then press
.
392
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 393 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Ring Tone
1Ring Tone
You can change the ring tone setting.
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Ringtone, then press
.
4. Rotate
to select Mobile Phone or
Fixed, then press .
1Caller’s ID Information
You can select a caller’s information to be displayed when you have an incoming
call.
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Caller ID Info, then
press .
4. Rotate
to select a mode you want, then
press .
Continued
Name Priority: A caller’s name is displayed if it is
stored in the phonebook.
Number Priority: A caller’s phone number is
displayed.
Features
■ Caller’s ID Information
Fixed: The fixed ring tone sounds from the speakers.
Mobile Phone: Depending on the make and model
of the cell phone, the ring tone stored in the phone
will sound if the phone is connected.
393
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 394 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To Clear the System
All speed dial entries, all imported phonebook data, all call history data, paired
phones, pairing codes, caller’s ID settings, and volume settings are reset as default.
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select System Clear, then
press .
4. Rotate
to select Yes, then press .
Features
5. A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Rotate
to select Yes, then press
.
6. A notification appears on the screen. Press
.
394
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 395 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Automatic Import of Cellular Phonebook and Call History
When your phone is paired, the contents of its phonebook and call history are
automatically imported to HFL.
1Automatic Import of Cellular Phonebook and Call History
When you select a name from the list in the cellular
phonebook, you can see up to three category icons.
The icons indicate what types of numbers are stored
for that name.
Pref
Fax
Home
Car
Mobile
Other
Work
Voice
If a name has four or more numbers, ... appears
instead of category icons.
Features
Pager
On some phones, it may not be possible to import the
category icons to HFL.
The phonebook is updated after every connection.
Call history is updated after every connection or call.
Continued
395
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 396 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Speed Dial
1Speed Dial
Features
Up to 20 speed dial numbers can be stored per phone.
To store a speed dial number:
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Speed Dial, then press
.
3. Rotate
to select Add New, then press
.
4. Rotate
to select a place to choose a
number from, then press .
From Call History:
u Select a number from the call history.
From Phonebook:
u Select a number from the connected cell
phone’s imported phonebook.
From Phone Number:
u Input the number manually.
5. When the speed dial is successfully stored,
you are asked to create a voice tag for the
number. Rotate
to select Yes or No,
then press .
6. Using the
button, follow the prompts to
say the name for the speed dial entry.
396
When a voice tag is stored, you can press the
button and call the number using voice commands.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 397 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To edit a speed dial
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Speed Dial, then press
.
4. Select an existing speed dial entry.
5. Rotate
to select Change Speed Dial,
then press .
6. Select a new speed dial number, then press
.
Features
Continued
397
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 398 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To add a voice tag to a stored speed
dial number
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Speed Dial, then press
.
4. Select an existing speed dial entry.
5. Rotate
to select Store Voice Tag, then
press .
6. Using the
button, follow the prompts to
complete the voice tag.
Features
398
■ To change a voice tag
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Speed Dial, then press
.
4. Select an existing speed dial entry.
5. Rotate
to select Change Voice Tag,
then press .
6. Using the
button, follow the prompts to
complete the voice tag.
1Speed Dial
Avoid using duplicate voice tags.
Avoid using “home” as a voice tag.
It is easier for HFL to recognize a longer name. For
example, use “John Smith” instead of “John.”
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 399 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
Continued
Features
■ To delete a voice tag
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Speed Dial, then press
.
4. Select an existing speed dial entry.
5. Rotate
to select Delete Voice Tag,
then press .
u A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Rotate
to select Yes, then
press .
■ To delete a speed dial number
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phone Setup, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Speed Dial, then press
.
4. Select an existing speed dial entry.
5. Rotate
to select Delete Speed Dial,
then press .
u A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Rotate
to select Yes, then
press .
399
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 400 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Making a Call
You can make calls by inputting any phone number, or by using the imported
phonebook, call history, speed dial entries, or redial.
1Making a Call
Any voice-tagged speed dial entry can be dialed by
voice from any screen.
Press the
button and follow the prompts.
Once a call is connected, you can hear the voice of
the person you are calling through the audio
speakers.
Features
400
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 401 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To make a call using the imported
■ To make a call using a phone number
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Dial, then press .
3. Rotate
to select a number, then press
.
4. Rotate
to select
, then press .
u Dialing starts automatically.
Continued
1To make a call using the imported phonebook
This function is disabled while the vehicle is moving.
However, you can call a stored voice-tagged speed
dial number using voice commands.
2 Limitations for Manual Operation P. 382
2 Speed Dial P. 396
Features
phonebook
When your phone is paired, the contents of its
phonebook are automatically imported to
HFL.
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Phonebook, then
press .
3. The phonebook is stored alphabetically.
Rotate
to select the initial, then press
.
4. Rotate
to select a name, then press .
5. Rotate
to select a number, then press
.
u Dialing starts automatically.
1To make a call using a phone number
This function is disabled while the vehicle is moving.
However, you can call a stored voice-tagged speed
dial number using voice commands.
2 Limitations for Manual Operation P. 382
2 Speed Dial P. 396
401
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 402 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To make a call using redial
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Redial, then press
u Dialing starts automatically.
1To make a call using redial
.
■ To make a call using the call history
Features
402
Call history is stored by Dialed Calls,
Received Calls, and Missed Calls.
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Call History, then
press .
3. Rotate
to select Dialed Calls, Received
Calls, or Missed Calls, then press .
4. Rotate
to select a number, then press
.
u Dialing starts automatically.
Press and hold the
button to redial the last
number dialed in your phone’s call history.
1To make a call using the call history
The call history appears only when a phone is
connected to HFL, and displays the last 20 dialed,
received, or missed calls. (Appears only when a
phone is connected to the system.)
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 403 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To make a call using a speed dial entry
1. Press the
button or the
button.
2. Rotate
to select Speed Dial, then press
.
3. Rotate
to select a number, then press
.
u Dialing starts automatically.
1To make a call using a speed dial entry
When a voice tag is stored, press the
button and
call the number using voice commands.
2 Speed Dial P. 396
Any voice-tagged speed dial entry can be dialed by
voice from any screen. Press the
button and
follow the prompts.
Features
Continued
403
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 404 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Receiving a Call
HFL Mode
1Receiving a Call
When there is an incoming call, an audible
notification sounds and the Incoming Call
screen appears.
Press the
Press the
call.
Caller’s Name
Features
404
button to answer the call.
button to decline or end the
Call Waiting
Press the
button to put the current call on hold
to answer the incoming call.
Press the
button again to return to the current
call.
Select Ignore to ignore the incoming call if you do
not want to answer it.
Press the
button if you want to hang up the
current call.
You can select the icons on the audio/information
screen instead of the
and
buttons.
Rotate
to select the icon, then press
.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 405 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Options During a Call
Dial Tones: Available on some phones.
Features
The following options are available during a call.
Swap Call: Put the current call on hold to answer the incoming call.
Mute: Mute your voice.
Transfer Call: Transfer a call from HFL to your phone.
Dial Tones: Send numbers during a call. This is useful when you call a menu-driven
phone system.
1. To view the available options, press the
button.
2. Rotate
to select the option, then press
.
u The check box is checked when Mute is
selected. Select Mute again to turn it off.
1Options During a Call
405
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 406 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®
Models with Display Audio
1Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® (HFL) allows you to place and receive phone calls using
your vehicle’s audio system, without handling your cell phone.
Using HFL
■ HFL Buttons
(Back) Button
Microphone
3/4/
/
Buttons
ENTER Button
Features
Volume up
Place your phone where you can get good reception.
To use HFL, you need a Bluetooth-compatible cell
phone. For a list of compatible phones, pairing
procedures, and special feature capabilities,
• U.S.: Visit automobiles.honda.com/handsfreelink/,
or call 1-888-528-7876.
• Canada: For more information on smartphone
compatibility, call 1-855-490-7351.
To use the system, the Bluetooth setting must be
ON.
2 Phone Setup P. 411
Volume down
Voice control tips
• Aim the vents away from the ceiling and close the
(Home) Button
(Talk) Button
(Hang-up) Button
(Pick-up) Button
windows, as noise coming from them may interfere
with the microphones.
• Press the
button when you want to call a
number using a phonebook name or a number.
Speak clearly and naturally after a beep.
• If the microphones pick up voices other than yours,
the command may be misinterpreted.
• To change the volume level, select the audio
system’s VOL (Volume) or use the remote audio
controls on the steering wheel.
If there is no speed dial entry in the system, the popup notification appears on the screen.
2 Favorite Contacts P. 416
If there is no call history, the call history is disabled.
406
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 407 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uUsing HFL
(Pick-up) button: Press to go directly to the phone screen of the driver
information interface, or to answer an incoming call.
(Hang-up) button: Press to end a call.
(Back) button: Press to go back to the previous screen, or cancel a command.
(Talk) button: Press to access Voice Portal.
3/4/
/
buttons: Press to select an item displayed on the phone screen
of the driver information interface.
ENTER button: Press to call a number listed in the selected item on the phone
screen of the driver information interface.
(Home) button: Press to go back to the home screen of the driver information
interface.
1Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink®
Bluetooth® Wireless Technology
The Bluetooth® word mark and logos are registered
trademarks owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc., and any
use of such marks by Honda Motor Co., Ltd., is under
license. Other trademarks and trade names are those
of their respective owners.
HFL Limitations
An incoming call on HFL will interrupt the audio
system when it is playing. It will resume when the call
is ended.
Features
To go to the phone screen of the driver information interface:
1. Press the
(home) button on the steering wheel.
2. Select Phone.
u You can select Favorite Contacts or Recent Calls.
Continued
407
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 408 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uUsing HFL
■ HFL Status Display
1HFL Status Display
The audio/information screen notifies you when there is an incoming call.
Bluetooth Indicator
Signal Strength
Appears when your phone is
connected to HFL.
Battery Level Status
HFL Mode
Caller’s Name
Caller’s Number
Features
■ Limitations for Manual Operation
Certain manual functions are disabled or inoperable while the vehicle is in motion.
You cannot select a grayed-out option until the vehicle is stopped.
Only previously stored phonebook names or numbers can be called using voice
commands while the vehicle is in motion.
2 Favorite Contacts P. 416
408
The information that appears on the audio/
information screen varies between phone models.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 409 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
HFL Menus
The power mode must be in ACCESSORY or ON to use the system.
1HFL Menus
To use HFL, you must first pair your Bluetoothcompatible cell phone to the system while the vehicle
is parked.
■ Phone settings screen
1. Select
.
2. Select Phone.
3. Select Settings.
+ Connect New Device
(Existing entry list)
Auto Sync Phone
Auto Phone Call Transfer
Ringtone
HondaLink Assist
Pair a new phone to the system.
Features
Change Connected Phone
Some functions are limited while driving.
Connect, disconnect, or delete a paired device.
Set phonebook and call history data to be automatically imported when a phone is paired to HFL.
Set calls to automatically transfer from your phone to HFL when you enter the vehicle.
Select the ring tone.
Turn HondaLink® Assist on and off.
Continued
409
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 410 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Phone menu screen
1. Select
.
2. Select Phone.
Recent Calls
All
Features
Dialed
Display the last outgoing calls.
Missed
Display the last missed calls.
Received
Favorite Contacts
410
Display the last outgoing, incoming and missed calls.
Display the last incoming calls.
(Existing entry list)
Dial the selected number in the speed dial list.
Contacts
Display the paired phone’s phonebook.
Keypad
Enter a phone number to dial.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 411 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Phone Setup
■ Bluetooth® setup
You can turn Bluetooth® function on and off.
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Connections.
4. Select Bluetooth.
5. Select Options.
6. Select Bluetooth, then ON.
Features
Continued
411
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 412 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To pair a cell phone (when there is no
Features
412
phone paired to the system)
1. Select
.
2. Select Phone.
3. Select Connect Phone.
4. Make sure your phone is in search or
discoverable mode, then select + Connect
New Device.
u HFL automatically searches for a
Bluetooth® device.
5. Select your phone when it appears on the
list.
u If your phone still does not appear,
search for Bluetooth® devices using your
phone.
From your phone, search for HandsFree
Link.
6. The system gives you a pairing code on the
audio/information screen.
u Confirm if the pairing code on the screen
and your phone match.
This may vary by phone.
7. Select desired functions and then select
Connect.
u A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Select Continue or Connect
without Internet.
1Phone Setup
Your Bluetooth-compatible phone must be paired to
the system before you can make and receive handsfree calls.
Phone Pairing Tips:
• You cannot pair your phone while the vehicle is
moving.
• Up to six phones can be paired.
• Your phone’s battery may drain faster when it is
paired to the system.
• If your phone is not ready for pairing or not found
by the system within three minutes, the system will
time out and return to idle.
Once you have paired a phone, you can see it
displayed on the screen with one or more icons on
the right side.
These icons indicate the following:
: The phone is compatible with Bluetooth® Audio.
: The phone can be used with HFL.
: The phone can be used with the internet
tethering.
If there is an active connection to Apple CarPlay or
Android Auto, pairing of additional Bluetooth
compatible devices is unavailable and + Connect
New Device is grayed out from the Bluetooth
screen.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 413 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To change the currently paired phone
1. Go to the phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 409
2. Select Change Connected Phone.
3. Select a phone to connect.
u HFL disconnects the connected phone
and starts searching for another paired
phone.
4. Select ,
or
.
5. Select Apply.
2 Phone settings screen P. 409
2. Select Change Connected Phone.
3. Select a phone you want to delete.
If no other phones are found or paired when trying to
switch to another phone, HFL will inform you that the
original phone is connected again.
To pair other phones, select + Connect New Device
from the Bluetooth screen.
Features
■ To delete a paired phone
1. Go to the phone settings screen.
1To change the currently paired phone
4. Select Delete Device.
5. A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Select Delete.
Continued
413
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 414 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Ring Tone
1Ring Tone
You can change the ring tone setting.
1. Go to the phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 409
2. Select Ringtone.
3. Select Vehicle or Phone.
Features
■ Automatic Transferring
If you get into the vehicle while you are on the phone, the call can be automatically
transferred to HFL.
1. Go to the phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 409
2. Select Auto Phone Call Transfer.
3. Select ON or OFF.
414
Vehicle: The fixed ring tone sounds from the
speakers.
Phone: Depending on the make and model of the
cell phone, the ring tone stored in the phone will
sound if the phone is connected.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 415 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Automatic Import of Cellular Phonebook and Call History
■ When Automatic Phone Sync is set to
On:
When your phone is paired, the contents of its
phonebook and call history are automatically
imported to the system.
■ Changing the Automatic Phone Sync
When you select a name from the list in the cellular
phonebook, you can see a category icon. The icons
indicate what types of numbers are stored for that
name.
Mobile
Work
Home
Other
On some phones, it may not be possible to import the
category icons to the system.
The phonebook is updated after every connection.
Call history is updated after every connection or call.
2 Phone settings screen P. 409
2. Select Auto Sync Phone.
3. Select ON or OFF.
Continued
Features
setting
1. Go to the phone settings screen.
1Automatic Import of Cellular Phonebook and Call History
415
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 416 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Favorite Contacts
To store a speed dial number:
1. Go to the phone menu screen.
Recent Calls Screen
2 Phone menu screen P. 410
2. Select the Recent Calls, Contacts, or
Keypad screen.
3. Select the star icon.
u A notification appears on the screen if
the speed dial is successfully stored.
u To remove the speed dial, select the star
icon again.
Star Icon
Contacts Screen
Features
Star Icon
Keypad Screen
Star Icon
416
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 417 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To edit a speed dial
1. Go to the phone menu screen.
2 Phone menu screen P. 410
2. Select Favorite Contacts.
3. Select Edit on the speed dial entry you
want to edit.
4. Select a setting you want.
■ To delete a speed dial
1. Go to the phone menu screen.
2 Phone menu screen P. 410
Continued
Features
2. Select Favorite Contacts.
3. Select Edit on the speed dial entry you
want to delete.
4. Select Remove Contact.
5. A confirmation message appears on the
screen. Select Continue.
417
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 418 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Making a Call
1Making a Call
You can make calls by inputting any phone
number, or by using the imported
phonebook, call history, or speed dial entries.
Once a call is connected, you can hear the voice of
the person you are calling through the audio
speakers.
While there is an active connection with Apple
CarPlay, phone calls cannot be made with
HandsFreeLink® and are only made from Apple
CarPlay.
Features
418
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 419 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To make a call using the imported
phonebook
1. Go to the phone menu screen.
2 Phone menu screen P. 410
2. Select Contacts.
3. Select a name.
u You can sort by First Name or Last
Name. Select the icon on the upper right
of the screen.
4. Select a number.
u Dialing starts automatically.
2 Phone menu screen P. 410
Features
■ To make a call using a phone number
1. Go to the phone menu screen.
2. Select Keypad.
3. Select a number.
u Use the keyboard on the touch screen for
entering numbers.
4. Select Call.
u Dialing starts automatically.
Continued
419
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 420 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To make a call using the call history
Call history is stored by All, Dialed, Missed,
and Received.
1. Go to the phone menu screen.
2 Phone menu screen P. 410
2. Select Recent Calls.
u You can sort by All, Dialed, Missed, or
Received. Select the icon on the upper
right of the screen.
3. Select a number.
u Dialing starts automatically.
Features
■ To make a call using a speed dial entry
1. Go to the phone menu screen.
2 Phone menu screen P. 410
2. Select Favorite Contacts.
u You can change the order of speed dial
entries by selecting Reorder.
3. Select a number.
u Dialing starts automatically.
420
1To make a call using the call history
The call history appears only when a phone is
connected to the system.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 421 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Receiving a Call
1Receiving a Call
When there is an incoming call, an audible
notification sounds (if activated) and the
Incoming Call... screen appears.
Press the
Press the
call.
button to answer the call.
button to decline or end the
Call Waiting
Press the
button to put the current call on hold to
answer the incoming call.
Press the
button again to return to the current
call.
Select Ignore to ignore the incoming call if you do
not want to answer it.
Press the
button if you want to hang up the
current call.
■ Options During a Call
1Options During a Call
The following options are available during a call.
Mute: Mute your voice.
Use Handheld: Transfer a call from the system to your phone.
Keypad: Send numbers during a call. This is useful when you call a menu-driven
phone system.
The available options are shown on the lower
Mute Icon
half of the screen.
Features
You can select the icons on the audio/information
screen instead of the
and
buttons.
Keypad: Available on some phones.
You can select the icons on the audio/information
screen.
Select the option.
u The mute icon appears when Mute is
selected. Select Mute again to turn it off.
Continued
421
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 422 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To Set Up Text Message Options
■ To turn on or off the text message
notice
1. Select
.
2. Select Messages.
3. Select Settings.
4. Select Notifications.
5. Select ON or OFF.
Features
422
1To Set Up Text Message Options
To use the text message function, it may be necessary
to set up on your phone.
1To turn on or off the text message notice
ON: A pop-up notification comes on every time you
receive a new message.
OFF: The message you receive is stored in the system
without notification.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 423 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Receiving a Text Message
1Receiving a Text Message
HFL can display newly received text messages as well as the last 20 messages
received on a linked cell phone. Each received message can be read aloud and
replied to using a fixed common phrase.
1. A pop-up appears and notifies you of a new
text message.
2. Select Open to display the message.
u The text message is displayed.
3. Select Play to listen to the message. To
discontinue the message read-out, select
Stop.
The system can only receive messages that are sent a
text (SMS) messages. The message sent using the
data services will not be displayed in the list.
With some phones, you may be able to display up to
20 of the last text messages received.
State or local laws may limit your use of the HFL text
message feature. Only use the text message feature
when conditions allow you to do so safely.
Features
Continued
The system does not display any received messages
while you are driving. You can only hear them read
aloud.
423
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 424 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Selecting a Phone
1Selecting a Phone
You can select one from the Bluetooth® device list to be active and receive
notifications.
1. Select
.
2. Select Messages.
3. Select Settings.
4. Select Change Connected Phone.
5. Change a desired phone.
2 To change the currently paired phone
P. 413
Features
424
You can only receive notifications from one phone at
a time.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 425 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Displaying Messages
Message List
1Displaying Messages
The
(blue) icon appears next to an unread
message.
1. Select
.
2. Select Messages.
u Select a phone if necessary.
3. Select a message.
u The text message is displayed.
If you delete a message on the phone, the message
will also be deleted from the system. If you send a
message from the system, the message goes to your
phone’s outbox.
To see the previous or next message, select
or Next
on the message screen.
Prev
Text Message
Features
Continued
425
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 426 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Read or Stop reading a message
1. Go to the text message screen.
2. Select Play.
u The system starts reading the message
aloud.
3. Select Pause to stop reading.
Select Play again to start reading the
message.
■ Reply to a message
Features
1. Go to the text message screen.
2. Select Reply.
3. Select the reply message.
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
4. Select Send to send the message.
u Message sent appears on the screen
when the reply message was successfully
sent.
1Reply to a message
The available fixed reply messages are as follows:
• Talk to you later, I’m driving.
• I’m on my way.
• I’m running late.
• OK
• Yes
• No
You can add a reply message by selecting + Create
New Message.
2 To edit a reply message P. 427
Only certain phones receive and send messages when
paired and connected. For a list of compatible
phones:
• U.S.: Visit automobiles.honda.com/handsfreelink/,
or call 1-888-528-7876.
• Canada: For more information on smartphone
compatibility, call 1-855-490-7351.
426
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 427 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To edit a reply message
1. Select
.
2. Select Messages.
3. Select Settings.
4. Select Edit System Replies.
5. Select the reply message you want to edit
or + Create New Message.
u The on-screen keyboard screen is
displayed.
6. Enter a reply message, and then select
Save.
Continued
You can change the order of reply messages by
selecting Reorder.
Features
■ To delete a reply message
1. Select
.
2. Select Messages.
3. Select Settings.
4. Select Delete System Replies.
5. Select
on the reply message you want to
delete.
u The pop-up menu appears on the screen.
6. Select Delete.
1To edit a reply message
427
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 428 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Making a call to a sender
1. Go to the text message screen.
2. Select Call.
Features
428
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 429 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ In Case of Emergency
1In Case of Emergency
■ Automatic collision notification
If your vehicle’s airbags deploy or if the unit
detects that the vehicle is severely impacted,
your vehicle automatically will attempt to
connect to the HondaLink® operator. If
connected, information about your vehicle, its
location, and its condition can be sent to the
operator*1; you also can speak to the operator
when connected.
Honda reserves the right to terminate HondaLink® Assist services at any time or for
any reason, and in the future may not be able to provide services due to changes in,
or obsolescence of, technology integral to the service or changes in governmental
regulation.
You cannot use this emergency service when:
• You travel outside the HondaLink® service coverage
areas.
• There is a problem with the connecting devices,
such as the microphones, speakers, or the unit
itself.
You cannot operate other phone-related functions
using the screen while talking to the operator.
Select Hang Up to terminate the connection to your
vehicle.
Features
IMPORTANT: For vehicles equipped with HondaLink® Assist, owner activation
constitutes authorization for Honda to collect information from your vehicle needed
to provide the service, and agreement to the Terms of Use at
www.hondalink.com/TermsAndConditions. In a crash, HondaLink® Assist will
attempt to notify emergency services but NEITHER HONDA NOR ITS SERVICE
PROVIDERS GUARANTEE THAT SUCH NOTIFICATION WILL OCCUR.
Your vehicle may not be able to connect to the
operator if the battery level is low, the line is
disconnected, or you do not have adequate cellular
coverage.
1Automatic collision notification
If the unit fails to connect to the operator, it
repeatedly tries until it succeeds.
*1: Depending on your phone and adequate cellular coverage, your vehicle’s location may not
be sent to the operator.
Continued
429
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 430 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ To enable notification
1To enable notification
1. Go to the phone settings screen.
2 Phone settings screen P. 409
2. Select HondaLink Assist.
3. Select ON or OFF.
Features
430
Setting options:
• ON: Notification is available.
• OFF: Disable the feature.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 431 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBluetooth® HandsFreeLink®uHFL Menus
■ Manual operator connection *
ASSIST Button
1Manual operator connection *
If you need to talk to the HondaLink® operator
in a situation where no airbag has deployed,
you can manually connect to them by pressing
the ASSIST button with the power mode in
ACCESSORY or ON.
1. Open the cover attached to the ceiling
console.
2. Press the ASSIST button.
u You are connected to the HondaLink®
operator.
Do not press the button while driving. When you
need to contact the operator, park the vehicle in a
safe place.
If the unit fails to connect to the operator, it
automatically cancels the action after three minutes.
If necessary, the cover can be broken to access the
ASSIST button.
Features
* Not available on all models
431
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 432 ページ
432
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 433 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Driving
This chapter discusses driving and refueling.
Before Driving................................... 434
Towing a Trailer................................ 440
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines ..... 450
When Driving
Starting the Engine .......................... 452
Automatic Transmission ................... 459
Shifting ............................................ 460
Auto Idle Stop.................................. 468
ECON Mode .................................... 474
Intelligent Traction Management * .... 475
Vehicle Stability Assist® (VSA®), aka Electronic
Stability Control (ESC), System............ 477
Agile Handling Assist ....................... 479
Blind spot information System * ........... 480
* Not available on all models
LaneWatchTM * .................................. 483
Intelligent Variable Torque Management (iVTM4TM) AWD System * ..................... 485
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
with Tire Fill Assist.......................... 486
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Required Federal Explanation ......... 488
Honda Sensing® ................................ 490
Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM
(CMBSTM) ....................................... 493
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)......... 505
Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) .. 518
Road Departure Mitigation (RDM)
System ....................................... 527
Front Sensor Camera ....................... 532
Radar Sensor.................................... 534
Braking
Brake System ................................... 535
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) ........... 537
Brake Assist System ......................... 538
Parking Your Vehicle
When Stopped ................................ 539
Parking Sensor System * ................... 541
Cross Traffic Monitor * ..................... 546
Multi-View Rear Camera.................. 550
Refueling
Fuel Information .............................. 552
How to Refuel ................................. 553
Fuel Economy and CO2 Emissions
Improving Fuel Economy and Reducing
CO2 Emissions................................ 555
433
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 434 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Before Driving
Driving Preparation
Check the following items before you start driving.
■ Exterior Checks
• Make sure there are no obstructions on the windows, door mirrors, exterior
lights, or other parts of the vehicle.
u Remove any frost, snow, or ice.
u Remove any snow on the roof, as this can slip down and obstruct your field of
vision while driving. If frozen solid, remove ice once it has softened.
u When removing ice from around the wheels, be sure not to damage the wheel
or wheel components.
• Make sure the hood is securely closed.
u If the hood opens while driving, your front view will be blocked.
• Make sure the tires are in good condition.
u Check air pressures, and check for damage and excessive wear.
Driving
434
2 Checking and Maintaining Tires P. 588
• Make sure there are no people or objects behind or around the vehicle.
u There are blind spots from the inside.
1Exterior Checks
NOTICE
When doors are frozen shut, use warm water around
the door edges to melt any ice. Do not try to force
them open, as this can damage the rubber trim
around the doors. When done, wipe dry to avoid
further freezing.
Do not pour warm water into the key cylinder.
You will be unable to insert the key if the water
freezes in the hole.
Heat from the engine and exhaust can ignite
flammable materials left under the hood, causing a
fire. If you’ve parked your vehicle for an extended
period, inspect and remove any debris that may have
collected, such as dried grass and leaves that have
fallen or have been carried in for use as a nest by a
small animal. Also check under the hood for leftover
flammable materials after you or someone else has
performed maintenance on your vehicle.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 435 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBefore DrivinguDriving Preparation
■ Interior Checks
1Interior Checks
• Store or secure all items on board properly.
u Carrying too much cargo, or improperly storing it, can affect your vehicle’s
handling, stability, stopping distance, and tires, and make it unsafe.
2 Maximum Load Limit P. 437
2 Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the Inside P. 144
• Adjust your seating position properly.
u Adjust the head restraint, too.
Driving
• Do not pile items higher than the seat height.
u They can block your view and may be thrown forward in the event of sudden
braking.
• Do not place anything in the front seat footwells. Make sure to secure the floor
mat.
u An object or unsecured floor mat can interfere with your brake and accelerator
pedal operation while driving.
• If you have any animals on board, do not let them move around in the vehicle.
u They may interfere with driving and a crash could occur.
• Securely close and lock all doors and the tailgate.
The headlight aim is set by the factory, and does not
need to be adjusted. However, if you regularly carry
heavy items in the cargo area or tow a trailer, have
the aiming readjusted at a dealer or by a qualified
technician.
2 Adjusting the Seats P. 188
2 Adjusting the Front and Rear Outer Seat Head Restraint Positions P. 194
• Adjust the mirrors and steering wheel properly.
u Adjust them while sitting in the proper driving position.
2 Adjusting the Steering Wheel P. 185
2 Adjusting the Mirrors P. 186
Continued
435
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 436 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBefore DrivinguDriving Preparation
• Be sure items placed on the floor behind the front seats cannot roll under the
seats.
u They can interfere with the driver’s ability to operate the pedals, the operation
of the seats, or the operation of the sensors under the seats.
• Everyone in the vehicle must fasten their seat belt.
2 Fastening a Seat Belt P. 40
• Make sure that the indicators in the instrument panel come on when you start the
vehicle, and go off soon after.
u Always have a dealer check the vehicle if a problem is indicated.
2 Indicators P. 76
Driving
436
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 437 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBefore DrivinguMaximum Load Limit
Maximum Load Limit
The maximum load for your vehicle is 948 lbs (430 kg).
1Maximum Load Limit
See the Tire and Loading Information label attached to the driver’s
doorjamb.
Label Example
3 WARNING
Overloading or improper loading
can affect handling and stability
and cause a crash in which you
can be hurt or killed.
Follow all load limits and other
loading guidelines in this manual.
Steps for Determining Correct Load Limit (1) Locate the statement “The combined weight of occupants and
cargo should never exceed XXX kg or XXX lbs.” on your
vehicle’s placard.
(2) Determine the combined weight of the driver and passengers
that will be riding in your vehicle.
(3) Subtract the combined weight of the driver and passengers
from XXX kg or XXX lbs.
(4) The resulting figure equals the available amount of cargo and
luggage load capacity. For example, if the “XXX” amount
equals 1,400 lbs. and there will be five 150 lb. passengers in
Continued
Gross Axle Weight Rating (GAWR):
The maximum allowable weight of the vehicle axle.
2 Specifications P. 642
Driving
This figure includes the total weight of all occupants, cargo, and
accessories, and the tongue load if you are towing a trailer.
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR):
The maximum allowable weight of the vehicle, all
occupants, all accessories, all cargo, and the tongue
load.
2 Specifications P. 642
437
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 438 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBefore DrivinguMaximum Load Limit
your vehicle, the amount of available cargo and luggage load
capacity is 650 lbs.
(1,400 - 750 (5 x 150) = 650 lbs.)
(5) Determine the combined weight of luggage and cargo being
loaded on the vehicle. That weight may not safely exceed the
available cargo and luggage load capacity calculated in step 4.
(6) If your vehicle will be towing a trailer, load from your trailer will
be transferred to your vehicle. Consult this manual to
determine how this reduces the available cargo and luggage
load capacity of your vehicle.
Driving
438
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 439 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBefore DrivinguMaximum Load Limit
In addition, the total weight of the vehicle, all occupants,
accessories, cargo, and trailer tongue load must not exceed the
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating (GVWR) or the Gross Axle Weight
Rating (GAWR). Both are on a label on the driver’s doorjamb.
1Maximum Load Limit
Towing a Trailer:
See Towing a Trailer to determine whether your
vehicle is designed to tow a tailer.
2 Towing a Trailer P. 440
Load Limits Example
Example1
Max Load
948 lbs
(430 kg)
Passenger Weight
150 lbs x 2 = 300 lbs
(68 kg x 2 = 136 kg)
Cargo Weight
648 lbs
(294 kg)
Max Load
948 lbs
(430 kg)
Passenger Weight
150 lbs x 5 = 750 lbs
(68 kg x 5 = 340 kg)
Cargo Weight
198 lbs
(90 kg)
Example2
Driving
439
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 440 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Towing a Trailer
Towing Preparation
■ Towing Load Limits
1Towing Load Limits
Your vehicle can tow a trailer if you carefully observe the load limits, use the proper
equipment, and follow the towing guidelines. Check the load limits before driving.
■ Total trailer weight
Do not exceed the maximum allowable
weight of the trailer, cargo, and everything in
or on it shown in the table.
Towing loads in excess of this can seriously
affect vehicle handling and performance and
can damage the engine and drivetrain.
Total Load
Driving
Number of
occupants
2
3
4
5
AWD models with
ATF cooler
5,000 lbs (2,268 kg)
4,750 lbs (2,155 kg)
4,500 lbs (2,041 kg)
4,250 lbs (1,928 kg)
AWD models
without ATF cooler
3,500 lbs (1,588 kg)
3,250 lbs (1,474 kg)
3,000 lbs (1,361 kg)
2,750 lbs (1,247 kg)
2WD models
3,500 lbs (1,588 kg)
3,250 lbs (1,474 kg)
3,000 lbs (1,361 kg)
2,750 lbs (1,247 kg)
Each weight limit is calculated based on the following conditions:
• Occupants fill seats from the front of the vehicle to the back.
• Each occupant weights 150 lbs (68 kg).
• Each occupant has 17.6 lb (8 kg) cargo in the cargo area.
Any additional weight, cargo or accessories reduce the maximum trailer weight and
maximum tongue load.
440
3 WARNING
Exceeding any load limit or improperly
loading your vehicle and trailer can cause a
crash in which you can be seriously hurt or
killed.
Check the loading of your vehicle and
trailer carefully before starting to drive.
Check if all loads are within limits at a public scale.
If a public scale is not available, add the estimated
weight of your cargo load to the weight of your
trailer (as quoted by the manufacturer), and then
measure the tongue load with an appropriate scale or
tongue gauge or estimate it based on cargo
distribution.
Refer to the trailer owner’s manual for additional
information.
Break-in Period
Avoid towing a trailer during your vehicle’s first 600
miles (1,000 km).
Never exceed the gross weight ratings.
Gross weight information
2 Vehicle Specifications P. 642
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 441 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuTowing a TraileruTowing Preparation
■ Tongue load
The weight of the tongue with a fully loaded
trailer on the hitch should be approximately:
Boat trailers: 5 – 15% of the total trailer
weight
Other trailers: 10 – 15% of total trailer weight
Tongue Load
AWD models with or without
ATF cooler
500 lbs (227 kg)
475 lbs (215 kg)
450 lbs (204 kg)
425 lbs (193 kg)
2WD models
350 lbs (159 kg)
325 lbs (147 kg)
300 lbs (136 kg)
275 lbs (125 kg)
Driving
Number of
occupants
2
3
4
5
Continued
441
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 442 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuTowing a TraileruTowing Preparation
■ How to weigh the trailer loads using the public scale
Check each weight in the order indicated as shown.
Refer to the table on the right for each weight’s limit except for the tongue load.
2 Tongue load P. 441
1. Front gross axle weight.
4. Gross combined weight.
2. Gross vehicle weight.
3. Rear gross axle weight.
Driving
442
5. Hitched trailer weight.
6. Unhitched trailer weight.
• If you cannot weigh the rear axle, subtract 1 from 2.
• The maximum gross combined weight (4) decreases by 2% for every 1,000 feet
(305 meters) of elevation.
• To calculate the tongue load, subtract 5 from 6.
• Refer to the trailer owner’s manual for additional information.
1How to weigh the trailer loads using the public scale
Fully load the vehicle and trailer. An attendant who
watches the scale is needed as all occupants should
stay in the vehicle.
Weight limit for 2WD models
2,734 lbs
Front gross axle
(1,240 kg)
5,291 lbs
Gross vehicle
(2,400 kg)
2,965 lbs
Rear gross axle
(1,345 kg)
8,025 lbs
Gross combined
(3,640 kg)
AWD models
2,855 lbs
(1,295 kg)
5,291 lbs
(2,400 kg)
3,141 lbs
(1,425 kg)
9,755 lbs
(4,425 kg)
If a public scale is not available, add the estimated
weight of your cargo load to the weight of your
trailer (as quoted by the manufacturer), and then
measure the tongue load with an appropriate scale or
tongue gauge or estimate it based on cargo
distribution.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 443 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuTowing a TraileruTowing Preparation
■ Towing Equipment and Accessories
1Towing Equipment and Accessories
Towing generally requires a variety of supplemental equipment.
To ensure the best quality, we recommend that you purchase Honda equipment
whenever possible.
Ground (Black)
Consult your trailer maker for proper installation and
setup of the equipment.
Improper installation and setup can affect the
handling, stability, and braking performance of your
vehicle.
Consult your trailer sales or rental agency if any other
items are recommended or required for your towing
situation.
The lighting and wiring of trailers can vary by type
and brand. If a connector is required, it should only
be installed by a qualified technician.
Trailer packages and products:
• Ball mount, hitch plug, hitch pin etc.
• Wiring harness kit
• Trailer hitch kit (jumper harness included)
2 Trailer brakes P. 443
• Automatic transmission cooler
Are available at a dealer.
Driving
■ Trailer brakes
Recommended for any trailer with a total weight of 1,000 lbs (450 kg) or more:
There are two common types of trailer brakes: surge and electric. Surge brakes are
common for boat trailers, since the brakes will get wet.
If you choose electric brakes, be sure they are electronically actuated. Do not
attempt to attach trailer brakes to your vehicle’s hydraulic system, as it will lower
braking effectiveness and create a potential hazard.
The 4-pin gray connector installed in your vehicle has all of the circuits required to
install most electric trailer brake controllers.
Have a qualified mechanic install your trailer
Trailer brake controller
connector’s terminals:
brake controller following the trailer brake
Electric Brake +B (Light Green)
controller manufacturer’s instructions. Failure
(Brown)
(20A)
to properly install the trailer brake controller
may increase the distance it takes for you to
stop your vehicle when towing a trailer.
Make sure that all equipment is properly installed and
maintained, and that it meets federal, state, province/
territory, and local regulations.
1Trailer brakes
Stop (Violet)
The 4-pin gray connector is located under the
instrument panel near the top of the parking brake
pedal.
Continued
443
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 444 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuTowing a TraileruTowing Preparation
Electric Brake
(Brown)
Ground
(Black)
Brake (20A)
(Blue)
2 Engine Compartment Fuse Box Type B
P. 632
Brake Lights
(Sky Blue)
Driving
444
The trailer hitch harness is used to install the
controller for the electric trailer brakes.
Insert the trailer brake fuse into the engine
compartment sub fuse box.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 445 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuTowing a TraileruTowing Preparation
■ Trailer light
Trailer lights and equipment must comply with federal, state, province/territory, and
local regulations. Check with your local trailer sales or rental agency for the
requirements in the area where you plan to tow.
Pins’ wiring color codes and their purposes:
+B Trailer Main (Red)
1Trailer light
The trailer lighting connector is located behind the
left side panel in the cargo area.
Even if you are planning to use the non-Honda trailer
lighting harness and converter, ask a dealer for the
correct connector and pins.
+B ELEC Brake (Brown)
+B Trailer Charge
(Sky Blue)
Trailer Small Light (Red)
Back Light (Brown)
Stop Light (Beige)
IG2 HAC (Light Green)
Right Turn Signal (Green)
Left Turn Signal (Blue)
Driving
We recommend that you have a dealer install a Honda wiring harness and converter.
They are designed for your vehicle.
■ Hitches
Read the trailer manufacturer’s instructions, and select the appropriate draw bar for
the height of the trailer you will be towing.
■ Weight distribution hitches
Your vehicle is designed to tow without the need for a load distributing hitch. If you
wish to use one, please consult your trailer maker for proper installation and set-up.
Improper set-up could degrade the handling, stability, and braking performance of
your vehicle.
Continued
445
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 446 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuTowing a TraileruTowing Preparation
■ Safety chains
Always use safety chains when you tow a trailer. Leave enough slack to allow the
trailer to turn corners easily, but do not allow the chains to drag on the ground.
■ Sway control
This device can be used if your trailer tends to sway. Your trailer maker can tell you
what kind of sway control you need and how to install it. Improper installation could
degrade the handling and stability of your vehicle.
■ Trailer mirrors
Many states, provinces and territories require special exterior mirrors when towing a
trailer. Install special mirrors whenever you cannot clearly see behind you, or if the
trailer creates a blind spot.
■ Automatic transmission cooler
Driving
446
AWD models
An additional ATF (automatic transmission fluid) cooler is required to keep the
transmission from overheating when towing more than 3,500 lbs (1,588 kg). You
can get the additional ATF cooler at a dealer.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 447 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuTowing a TraileruTrailer Stability Assist
Trailer Stability Assist
Helps to stabilize the vehicle and trailer when the trailer severely sways.
■ How trailer stability assist works
When the vehicle and trailer become unstable while driving, trailer stability assist
determines the cause. If the trailer oscillation is detected as the cause, and the
swaying increases, the system applies the brakes or controls engine output to reduce
vehicle speed.
Both the vehicle and trailer brake lights come on automatically if you brake to
reduce vehicle speed.
1Trailer Stability Assist
Trailer stability assist is not a function that prevents
the vehicle and trailer from swaying. Avoid high
speeds, abrupt steering, improper trailer load, and
sudden braking to keep the trailer from swaying.
When swayed too severely, the system becomes
ineffective, and you may lose control of your vehicle,
causing the trailer to roll over or get damaged.
2 Driving Safely with a Trailer P. 448
Trailer towing sway is caused by:
• Crosswinds
• Improper towbar down load
• Excessive Speed
Driving
The VSA® system indicator blinks during the trailer
stability assist operation.
2 VSA® Operation P. 477
447
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 448 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuTowing a TraileruDriving Safely with a Trailer
Driving Safely with a Trailer
■ Things You Need To Know Before Towing a Trailer
• Have the trailer properly serviced and keep it in good condition.
• Make sure that all the weights and load in the vehicle and trailer are within limits.
2 Towing Load Limits P. 440
Driving
• When towing more than 3,500 lbs (1,588 kg), use of gasoline with a pump
octane number of 87 or higher is recommended.
u Towing performance can be affected by high altitude, high temperature, or
steep uphill.
• Securely attach the hitch, safety chains, and other necessary parts to the trailer.
• Securely store all the items in and on the trailer so that they do not shift while
driving.
• Check if the lights and brakes on the trailer are working properly.
• Check the pressures of the trailer tires.
• Turn off the Auto Idle Stop system using the Auto Idle Stop OFF button. The
trailer weight can affect your vehicle's brake effectiveness if Auto Idle Stop is
activated on a hill while towing a trailer.
■ Towing Speeds and Gears
• Drive slower than normal.
• Obey posted speed limits for vehicles with trailers.
• Use the (D position when towing a trailer on level roads.
■ Turning and Braking
• Turn more slowly and with a wider turning arc than normal.
• Allow more time and distance for braking.
• Do not brake or turn suddenly.
448
1Driving Safely with a Trailer
Operating speed when towing a trailer must not
exceed 62 mph (100 km/h).
Parking
In addition to the normal precautions, place wheel
chocks at each of the trailer’s tires.
1Towing Speeds and Gears
When towing a fixed-sided trailer (e.g., camper), do
not exceed 55 mph (88 km/h).
At higher speeds, the trailer may sway or affect
vehicle handling.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 449 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuTowing a TraileruTowing Your Vehicle
■ Driving in Hilly Terrain
• Monitor your temperature gauge. If it nears the white (Hot) mark, turn off the
climate control system and reduce speed. Pull to the side of the road safely to cool
down the engine if necessary.
• Change the gear position to (S position if the transmission shifts frequently.
■ Retrieving a Boat
If the vehicle tires slip when retrieving a boat from the water, keep the transmission
in (D and do not use the sequential shift mode in (S . This prevents damage to the
transmission.
Towing Your Vehicle
2 Emergency Towing P. 636
Driving
Your vehicle is not designed to be towed behind a motor home. If your vehicle needs
to be towed in an emergency, refer to the emergency towing information.
449
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 450 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines
General Information
Your vehicle has been designed primarily for use on pavement, however, its higher
ground clearance allows you to occasionally travel on unpaved roads. It is not
designed for trail-blazing, or other challenging off-highway activities.
If you decide to drive on unpaved roads, you will find that it requires somewhat
different driving skills and that your vehicle will handle somewhat differently than it
does on pavement. Pay attention to the precautions and tips in this section, and get
acquainted with your vehicle before leaving the pavement.
Important Safety Precautions
To avoid loss of control or rollover, be sure to follow all precautions and
recommendations:
• Be sure to store cargo properly and do not exceed your cargo load limits.
2 Maximum Load Limit P. 437
Driving
450
• Whenever you drive, make sure you and your passengers always wear seat belts.
• Keep your speed low, and never go faster than the conditions allow.
• It’s up to you to continually assess the situation and drive within the limits.
1Off-Highway Driving Guidelines
3 WARNING
Improperly operating this vehicle on or off
pavement can cause a crash or rollover in
which you and your passengers could be
seriously injured or killed.
• Follow all instructions and guidelines in
this owner’s manual.
• Keep your speed low, and don’t drive
faster than conditions permit.
Failure to operate your vehicle correctly might result
in a crash or a rollover.
2 Important Handling Information P. 34
2 Precautions While Driving P. 458
Spinning the tires excessively can also damage the
Intelligent VTM4 (i-VTM4TM) system.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 451 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOff-Highway Driving GuidelinesuAvoiding Trouble
Avoiding Trouble
Driving
• Check Out Your Vehicle before you leave the pavement and make sure that all
scheduled maintenance has been completed. Pay special attention to the
condition of the tires, and check the tire pressures.
• Remember the route you choose presents limits (too steep or bumpy), you have
limits (driving skill and comfort), and your vehicle has limits (traction, stability, and
power). Failing to recognize these limits will likely put you and your passengers in
a hazardous situation.
• Accelerating and Braking should be done slowly and gradually. Trying to start
or stop too fast can cause a loss of traction and you could lose control.
• Avoiding Obstacles and Debris in the road reduces the likelihood of a rollover
or damage to your suspension or other components.
• Driving on Slopes increases your risk of a rollover, particularly if you attempt to
drive across a slope that is too steep. Going straight up or down a slope is usually
the safest. If you can’t clearly see all conditions or obstacles on a slope, walk it
before you drive it. If there is any doubt whether you can safely pass, don’t try it.
Find another route. If you get stuck when climbing, do not try to turn around.
Back down slowly following the same route you took up the hill.
• Crossing a Stream - Avoid driving through deep water. If you encounter water
in your route (a small stream or large puddle, for example), evaluate it carefully
before going ahead. Make sure it is shallow, flowing slowly, and has firm ground
underneath. If you are not sure of the depth or the ground, turn around and find
another route. Driving through deep water can also damage your vehicle. The
water can get into the transmission and differential, diluting the lubricant and
causing an eventual failure. It can also wash the grease out of the wheel bearings.
• If You Get Stuck, carefully go in the direction that you think will get you
unstuck. Do not spin the tires as this will only make things worse and could
damage the transmission. If you are unable to free yourself, your vehicle will need
to be towed. Front and rear tow hooks are provided for this purpose.
451
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 452 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
When Driving
Starting the Engine
1. Make sure the parking brake is applied.
1Starting the Engine
Keep your foot firmly on the brake pedal when
starting the engine.
The engine is harder to start in cold weather and in
thinner air found at altitudes above 8,000 feet
(2,400 meters).
2. Depress the brake pedal.
When starting the engine in cold weather, turn off all
electrical accessories such as the lights, climate
control system and rear defogger in order to reduce
battery drain.
If you live in a region where winter is extremely cold,
an engine block heater will improve starting and
warming of the engine. Consult a dealer for details.
Driving
If the exhaust system sounds abnormal or you can
smell exhaust gas inside the vehicle, have your vehicle
checked by a dealer. There may be a problem with
the engine or exhaust system.
Brake Pedal
3. Press the ENGINE START/STOP button
without depressing the accelerator pedal.
452
Bring the smart entry remote close to the ENGINE
START/STOP button if the battery in the smart entry
remote is weak.
2 If the Smart Entry Remote Battery is Weak
P. 620
The engine may not start if the smart entry remote is
subjected to strong radio waves.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 453 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguStarting the Engine
■ Stopping the Engine
1Starting the Engine
Do not hold the ENGINE START/STOP button to
start the engine.
If the engine does not start, wait at least 30 seconds
before starting the engine again.
You can turn the engine off when the vehicle is completely stopped.
1. Put the transmission into (P .
2. Press the ENGINE START/STOP button.
The immobilizer system protects your vehicle from
theft.
If an improperly coded device is used, the engine’s
fuel system is disabled.
2 Immobilizer System P. 158
Driving
Continued
453
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 454 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguStarting the Engine
■ Remote Engine Start
1Remote Engine Start
You can remotely start the engine on using the smart entry remote.
■ To start the engine
Press the
button, then press and
hold the
button.
Some exterior lights flash once.
Go within the range,
and try again.
LED: Blinks when any button is pressed.
Driving
Some exterior lights
flash six times if the
engine runs successfully.
Some exterior lights will
not flash if the engine
runs unsuccessfully.
When started remotely, the engine automatically shuts off after 10 minutes of idling
and/or the brake pedal and ENGINE START/STOP button have not been pressed
simultaneously.
454
3 WARNING
Carbon monoxide gas is toxic and can
rapidly accumulate in closed or even partly
enclosed areas.
Breathing it can cause unconsciousness and
even kill you.
Never use the remote engine starter with
the vehicle parked in a garage or other
areas with limited ventilation.
If there are buildings and obstacles between your
vehicle and the remote, the range will be reduced.
This distance may vary by external electrical
interference.
The engine may not start by the remote engine start
if:
• You have disabled a remote engine start setting
using the driver information interface.
• The power mode is not in VEHICLE OFF (LOCK).
• The transmission is in a position other than (P .
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 455 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguStarting the Engine
To extend the run time for another 10 minutes during the first run, press the
button, then press and hold the
button.
u Some exterior lights flash six times if a 10-minute extension request was
transmitted successfully.
1Remote Engine Start
• The hood is open, or any door or the tailgate is
unlocked.
• You have already used the remote twice to start
the engine.
• Another registered smart entry remote is in the
■ To stop the engine
vehicle.
• There is any antenna failure.
• The door is unlocked with the built-in key.
• The engine oil pressure is low.
• The engine coolant temperature is extremely high.
• The telematics unit malfunctions.
• The security system alarm is not set.
Go within the range, and try again.
The exterior lights will not flash when the
remote is out of the smart entry system range.
The engine will not stop.
The engine may stop while it is running if:
• You do not start the vehicle within 10 minutes of
remote.
• There is any antenna failure.
• The security system alarm is not set.
• The door is unlocked with the built-in key.
• The hood is open, or any door, or the tailgate is
Press and hold the
button for
The exterior lights flash once if the engine stops successfully.
one second.
* Not available on all models
Continued
Driving
starting the engine with the smart entry remote.
• The engine is stopped by using the smart entry
unlocked.
• Any door is open.
• The telematics unit * malfunction.
• The engine coolant temperature is extremely high.
• The battery is low.
455
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 456 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguStarting the Engine
1Remote Engine Start
• The engine oil pressure is low.
• The Malfunction Indicator Lamp (MIL) comes on if
there is a problem with the emissions control
systems.
• The transmission is in a position other than (P .
Driving
While the engine is running, the vehicle will
automatically precondition inside the vehicle.
When it is warm outside:
• The climate control system is activated in
recirculation mode.
• The seat ventilation is activated *.
When it is cold outside:
• The defroster is activated at a moderately warm
temperature.
• The rear defogger and door mirror heaters * are
activated.
• The seat heaters * and heated steering wheel * are
activated.
2 Heated Steering Wheel * P. 214
2 Front Seat Heaters and Seat
Ventilation * P. 212, 213
456
* Not available on all models
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 457 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguStarting the Engine
■ Starting to Drive
When the engine was started using the smart entry remote
1. Depress the brake pedal and press the ENGINE START/STOP button
simultaneously.
When the engine was started in any case
2. Keeping your right foot on the brake pedal, release the parking brake. Check that
the parking brake and brake system indicator has gone off.
1Starting to Drive
When the engine was started using the smart entry
remote
The engine stops when the transmission position is
changed from (P before the ENGINE START/STOP
button is pressed. Follow step 1 when starting to
drive.
2 Parking Brake P. 535
3. Put the transmission into (D . Select (R when reversing.
4. Gradually release the brake pedal and gently depress the accelerator pedal to pull
away.
Put the transmission into (D or (S when facing uphill, or (R when facing downhill,
then release the brake pedal.
1Hill start assist system
Hill start assist may not prevent the vehicle from
rolling downhill on a very steep or slippery slope, and
will not operate on small inclines.
Driving
■ Hill start assist system
Hill start assist keeps the brake engaged briefly to help prevent the vehicle from
rolling on inclines as you move your foot from the brake pedal to the accelerator.
Hill start assist is not a replacement for the parking
brake.
Hill start assist will operate even when VSA® is
switched off.
457
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 458 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguPrecautions While Driving
Precautions While Driving
■ Driving Guidelines for Your Utility Vehicle
Utility vehicles have a significantly higher rollover rate than other types of vehicles.
To prevent rollovers or loss of control:
• Take corners at slower speeds than you would with a passenger vehicle.
• Avoid sharp turns and abrupt maneuvers whenever possible.
• Do not modify your vehicle in any way that you would raise the center of gravity.
• Do not carry heavy cargo on the roof.
Never carry more than 165 lbs (75 kg) of cargo on the roof rack (Honda accessory).
■ In Rain
Avoid driving in deep water and on flooded roads. This can damage the engine,
driveline, or cause electrical component failure.
Driving
■ Other Precautions
If there is a strong impact with something under the vehicle, stop in a safe location.
Check the underside of the vehicle for damage or any fluid leaks.
1Precautions While Driving
NOTICE
Do not change the gear position while pressing the
accelerator pedal. You could damage the
transmission.
NOTICE
If you repeatedly turn the steering wheel at an
extremely low speed, or hold the steering wheel in
the full left or right position for a while, the electric
power steering (EPS) system heats up. The system
goes into a protective mode, and limits its
performance. The steering wheel becomes harder
and harder to operate. Once the system cools down,
the EPS system is restored. Repeated operation under
these conditions can eventually damage the system.
If the power mode is set to ACCESSORY while
driving, the engine will shut down and all steering
and brake power assist functions will stop, making it
difficult to control the vehicle.
Do not change the gear position to (N , as you will
lose engine braking (and acceleration) performance.
During the first 600 miles (1,000 km) of operation,
avoid sudden acceleration or full throttle operation so
as not to damage the engine or powertrain.
Avoid hard braking for the first 200 miles (300 km).
You should also follow this when the brake pads are
replaced.
458
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 459 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguAutomatic Transmission
Automatic Transmission
■ Creeping
The engine runs at a higher idle speed and creeping increases.
Keep the brake pedal firmly depressed when stopped.
1Driving Guidelines for Your Utility Vehicle
Failure to operate your vehicle correctly might result
in a crash or a rollover.
2 Important Handling Information P. 34
2 Precautions While Driving P. 458
■ Kickdown
Quickly depressing the accelerator pedal while driving uphill may cause the
transmission to drop to a lower gear, unexpectedly increasing vehicle speed. Depress
the accelerator pedal carefully, especially on slippery roads and curves.
Driving
459
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 460 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
Shifting
Change the gear position in accordance with your driving needs.
1Shifting
3 WARNING
■ Shift button positions
Park
Used when parking or starting the engine
Reverse
Used when reversing
Neutral
Transmission is not locked
Driving
Drive/S Position
Each time you press the D/S button, the mode
switches between Drive and S position mode
Used for:
Drive
●
●
Normal driving (gears change between 1st
and 9th automatically)
Temporarily driving in the sequential mode
S Position
●
●
Automatically changing gears between 1st
and 8th (8th gear is used only at high speed)
Driving in the sequential mode
The vehicle can roll away if left unattended
without confirming that Park is engaged.
A vehicle that rolls away could cause a crash
resulting in serious injury or death.
Always keep your foot on the brake pedal
until you have confirmed that (P is shown
on the gear position Indicator.
To prevent malfunction and unintended
engagement:
• Do not spill any liquids on or around shift buttons.
• Do not place or drop any objects on or around shift
buttons.
• Do not let passengers or children operate the shift
buttons.
The beeper sounds and a message appears on the
driver information interface when you depress the
accelerator pedal with the gear position in (N .
Change the gear position to (D or (R with the brake
pedal depressed.
When shifting gears in extremely low temperatures
(−22°F/−30°C), there may be a short delay before the
shift is indicated in the display. Always confirm you
are in the correct gear before driving.
460
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 461 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
■ (P (parking) button
(P Button
Park your vehicle in a safe place with the
power mode in ON, then apply the brakes and
press the (P button to put the transmission in
Park.
The indicators on the sides of the (P button
come on.
Driving
Continued
461
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 462 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
■ Shift Operation
1Shift Operation
NOTICE
M (sequential mode) Indicator
Tachometer’s Red Zone
Sequential Mode Gear Selection Indicator
Gear Position Indicator
Driving
Press the (P button.
462
Use the gear position indicator and the shift button
indicator to check the gear position before selecting
a shift button.
If the indicator of the currently selected gear position,
or all the gear position indicators are blinking
simultaneously, there is a problem with the
transmission.
Avoid sudden acceleration and have the transmission
checked by a dealer as soon as possible.
Press the (N button.
The fuel supply may be cut off if you drive at engine
speeds in or over the tachometer’s red zone (engine
speed limit). If this happens, you may experience a
slight jolt.
Press the D/S button.
Each time you press the button,
the mode switches between Drive
and S position mode.
When the engine speed is increased while the
transmission is in (N , (P or (R , the fuel supply may
be cut off even without the engine speed entering
the tachometer’s red zone.
Pull back the (R button.
Shift Button
Indicator
When you change (D to (R and visa versa, depress
the brake pedal to come to a complete stop, then
select the intended gear position while maintaining
brake pressure.
From the driver information interface or audio/
information screen, you can choose to have the
system activate a beeper when you change to (R .
2 Vehicle Customization P. 119
2 Customized Features P. 359
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 463 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
In freezing or sub-freezing conditions, the electronic gear selector response may be
slow.
Always depress the brake pedal before changing the gear position to (P , and
confirm that (P is shown on the gear position indicator before releasing the brake.
■ When opening the driver’s door
If you open the driver’s door under the following conditions, the gear position
automatically changes to (P .
• The vehicle is stationary with the engine running, or moving at 1 mph (2 km/h) or
slower.
• The transmission is in other than (P .
• You have unfastened the driver side seat belt.
■ When turning off the power mode
If you turn the engine off while the vehicle is stationary, and the transmission is in
other than (P , the gear position automatically changes to (P .
Continued
You should always select (P before opening the
driver’s door.
Make sure to park the vehicle in a safe place.
2 When Stopped P. 539
If you want to drive the vehicle after the gear position
has automatically changed to (P under the described
conditions, close the door, fasten the seat belt,
depress the brake pedal, then change the gear
position.
If you leave the vehicle, turn off the engine and lock
the doors.
Driving
u If you manually change the gear position from (P with the brake pedal
depressed, the gear position will automatically return to (P once you release
the brake pedal.
1When opening the driver’s door
463
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 464 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
Driving
464
■ If you want to keep the transmission in (N position [car wash mode]
With the engine running:
1. Press and hold the brake pedal.
2. Select (N , then release the button to display (Neutral) (N hold mode on the driver
information interface.
3. Press and hold (N again for two seconds.
u This puts the vehicle in car wash mode which must be used when your vehicle
is pulled through a conveyor type automatic car wash where you or an
attendant do not remain in the vehicle.
If the ENGINE STOP/START button is pressed
after car wash mode has been activated, the
power mode will change to ACCESSORY and a
message will be displayed on the driver
information interface.
u For 15 minutes the gear position remains
in (N with the power mode in
ACCESSORY. After that, the position
automatically changes to (P and the
power mode changes to OFF.
u Manually changing to (P cancels
ACCESSORY mode. The (P indicator
comes on and the power mode changes
to OFF. You must always shift to (P
when car wash mode is no longer
needed.
1 If you want to keep the transmission in (N position [car wash mode]
To keep the vehicle (N position, you can also follow
this procedure:
While the power mode is on, select (N , and then
within five seconds, press the ENGINE STOP/START
button.
Note that the transmission may not stay in (N
position while any of the following indicators is on:
• Transmission system indicator.
• Malfunction indicator lamp.
• Charging system indicator.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 465 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
■ Restriction on selecting a gear position
You cannot select a gear position under certain circumstances that may lead to a crash.
When the
transmission is in:
1. Under the circumstances
of that:
2. You cannot select:
3. The gear position
How to change the
remains in/changes to: gear position
The brake pedal is not
depressed.
(P
(P
The accelerator pedal is
depressed.
The vehicle is moving at low
speed without the brake pedal
depressed.
Release the accelerator
pedal and depress the
brake pedal.
Other gear position
(N
(N
(N , (D or (S
The vehicle is moving forward.
(R
(R or (N
The vehicle is moving backward.
(D , (S
(R , (N , (D or (S
The vehicle is moving.
(P
Stop your vehicle in a
safe place, keep the
brake pedal pressed,
and select the
appropriate gear
position.
Continued
Driving
The vehicle is moving at low
speed with the accelerator
pedal depressed.
465
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 466 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
■ Sequential Mode
Use the paddle shifters to change between 1st and 9th gears without removing your
hands from the steering wheel. The transmission will switch to the sequential mode.
■ When the transmission is in (D :
The vehicle will go into the sequential mode momentarily, and the sequential mode
gear selection indicator will come on.
Once you start traveling at a constant speed, the sequential mode will automatically
switch off, and the sequential mode gear selection indicator will go off.
Hold the (+ paddle shifter for two seconds or push D/S button to return to normal
drive.
■ When the transmission is in (S
Driving
466
The vehicle will go into the sequential mode, and the M (sequential mode) indicator
and sequential mode gear selection indicator will come on.
If the vehicle speed increases and the engine speed reaches near the tachometer’s
red zone, the transmission automatically shifts up to the next gear.
You can cancel this mode by holding the (+ paddle shifter for two seconds or push
D/S button. When the sequential mode is canceled, the sequential mode indicator
and sequential mode gear selection indicator go off.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 467 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguShifting
■ Sequential Mode Operation
Paddle Shifter
(Shift down)
1Sequential Mode Operation
Paddle Shifter
(Shift up)
Each paddle shift operation makes a single gear
change.
To change gears continuously, release the paddle
shifter before pulling it again for the next gear.
If the sequential mode gear selection indicator blinks
when you try to shift up or down, this means your
vehicle speed is not in its allowable gear range or the
protection of transmission system is necessary.
Slightly accelerate to shift up and decelerate to shift
down while the indicator is blinking.
Sequential
Mode Gear
Selection
Indicator
Driving
Downshifting when pulling
the
paddle shifter.
(Changes to a lower gear)
Upshifting when pulling
the
paddle shifter.
(Changes to a higher gear)
467
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 468 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguAuto Idle Stop
Auto Idle Stop
To help maximize fuel economy, the engine automatically stops when the vehicle
comes to a stop, depending on environmental and vehicle operating conditions. The
indicator (green) comes on at this time.
The engine then restarts once the vehicle is
about to move again, or depending on
environmental and vehicle operating
conditions, and the indicator (green) goes off.
2 The Engine Automatically Restarts When
P. 472
A message associated with Auto Idle Stop
appears on the driver information interface.
2 Indicators P. 76
2 Vehicle Customization P. 119
2 Customized Features P. 359
Driving
468
If the driver’s door is opened while the
indicator (green) comes on, a buzzer sounds
to notify you that the Auto Idle Stop function
is in operation.
1Auto Idle Stop
The 12-volt battery installed in this vehicle is
specifically designed for a model with Auto Idle Stop.
Using a 12-volt battery other than this specified type
may shorten the 12-volt battery life, and prevent
Auto Idle Stop from activating. If you need to replace
the 12-volt battery, make sure to select the specified
type. Ask a dealer for more details.
The duration of the Auto Idle Stop operation:
• Increases in the ECON mode, compared to when
the ECON mode is off, with climate control in use.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 469 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguAuto Idle Stop
■ Auto Idle Stop System ON/OFF
Auto Idle
Stop
System
Indicator
(Amber)
1Auto Idle Stop System ON/OFF
To turn the Auto Idle Stop system off, press
this button. The Auto Idle Stop system stops.
u Auto Idle Stop system will stop and the
indicator (Amber) will come on.
The Auto Idle Stop system is turned on every
time you start the engine, even if you turned it
off the last time you drove the vehicle.
■ Auto Idle Stop Activates When:
Press the Auto Idle Stop OFF button to restart the
engine from the idling stop.
1Auto Idle Stop Activates When:
■ Auto Idle Stop does not activate when:
•
•
•
•
•
The Auto Idle Stop OFF button is pressed.
The driver’s seat belt is not fastened.
The engine coolant temperature is low or high.
The transmission fluid temperature is low or high.
The vehicle comes to a stop again before the vehicle speed reaches 3 mph (5
km/h) after the engine starts.
• Stopped on a steep incline.
• A gear position other than (D .
Continued
Do not open a hood, during idling stop. If the hood is
opened, the engine will not restart automatically.
In this case, restart the engine with the ENGINE
START/STOP button.
2 Starting the Engine P. 452
Driving
The vehicle stops with the gear position in (D and the brake pedal depressed.
When you put the transmission into (P , the Auto Idle Stop continues to operate,
even if the brake pedal is released.
u If you change the gear position, the engine may automatically restarts.
Pressing the ENGINE START/STOP button changes
the power mode to ACCESSORY even while Auto Idle
Stop is in operation. Once in ACCESSORY, the engine
no longer restarts automatically. Follow the standard
procedure to start the engine.
2 Starting the Engine P. 452
469
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 470 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguAuto Idle Stop
• The engine is started with the hood open.
u Turn off the engine. Close the hood before you restart the engine to activate
Auto Idle Stop.
• The battery charge is low.
• The internal temperature of the battery is 14°F (−10°C) or less.
• The climate control system is in use, and the outside temperature is below −4°F
(−20°C) or over 104°F (40°C).
• The climate control system is in use, and the temperature is set to Hi or Lo.
•
is ON (indicator on).
• The rear fan is set to maximum speed.
u Auto Idle Stop may not activate under other conditions when the rear climate
control system */rear cooling * is in use.
• When the Intelligent Traction Management is set to Snow, Mud *, or Sand *.
Driving
470
* Not available on all models
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 471 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguAuto Idle Stop
■ Auto Idle Stop may not activate when:
•
•
•
•
•
The vehicle is stopped by braking suddenly.
The steering wheel is operated.
The fan speed is high.
Altitude is high.
The climate control system is in use, and there is a significant difference between
the set temperature and the actual interior temperature.
• The climate control system is in use, and humidity in the interior is high.
• The rear fan is set to maximum speed.
u Auto Idle Stop may not activate under other conditions when the rear climate
control system */rear cooling * is in use.
Driving
* Not available on all models
Continued
471
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 472 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguAuto Idle Stop
■ The Engine Automatically Restarts When
The brake pedal is released.
■ The engine restarts even if the brake pedal is depressed when:
Driving
472
• The Auto Idle Stop OFF button is pressed.
• When a steering wheel is operated.
• The transmission is put into (R or (S , or when it is set from (N to (D .
u If you put the transmission into (P after the Auto Idle Stop activates, the Auto
Idle Stop continues to operate. In this case, the engine restarts when you
change the gear position other than (P . When changing the gear position, the
brake pedal must be firmly depressed.
• The pressure on the brake pedal is reduced and the vehicle starts moving while
stopped on an incline.
• The pressure on the brake pedal is repeatedly applied and released slightly during
a stop.
• The battery charge becomes low.
• The accelerator pedal is depressed.
• The driver’s seat belt is unlatched.
•
is ON (indicator on).
• The climate control system is in use, and the difference between the set
temperature and actual interior temperature becomes significant.
• The climate control system is being used to dehumidify the interior.
• The rear fan is set to maximum speed.
u Auto Idle Stop may not activate under other conditions when the rear climate
control system is in use.
• When the Intelligent Traction Management is set to Snow, Mud *, or Sand *.
* Not available on all models
1The Engine Automatically Restarts When
If you are using an electronic device during Auto Idle
Stop, the device may temporarily be turned off when
the engine restarts.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 473 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguAuto Idle Stop
■ Starting Assist Brake Function
Briefly keeps the brake applied after releasing the brake pedal to restart the engine.
This can keep your vehicle from unexpectedly moving while on an incline.
Driving
473
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 474 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguECON Mode
ECON Mode
The ECON button turns the ECON mode on
and off.
The ECON mode helps you improve your fuel
economy by adjusting the performance of the
engine, air conditioning system, and cruise
control.
Driving
474
1ECON Mode
While in ECON mode, the climate control system has
greater temperature fluctuations.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 475 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguIntelligent Traction Management *
Intelligent Traction Management *
The Intelligent Traction Management optimizes vehicle performance to help you
drive on various surfaces. The system has available modes to select from: Normal,
Snow, Mud *, and Sand *.
Press the mode button to select the appropriate mode. The mode you select appears
on the driver information interface. When the vehicle is turned off and restarted,
Intelligent Traction Management mode will revert to Normal.
1Intelligent Traction Management *
Refer to the Off-Highway Driving section for driving
tips and safety precautions.
2 Off-Highway Driving Guidelines P. 450
AWD models
Normal
Provides balanced
driving performance
on most road surfaces.
Driving
Snow
Use when driving on
snowy road surfaces.
Mud
Use when driving on
muddy road or offroad surfaces.
Mode Button
* Not available on all models
Sand
Use when driving on
soft, sandy road or
off-road surfaces.
475
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 476 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguIntelligent Traction Management *
2WD models
Normal
Provides balanced
driving performance
on most road surfaces.
Snow
Use when driving on
snowy road surfaces.
Snow Button
Driving
476
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 477 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguVehicle Stability Assist® (VSA®), aka Electronic Stability Control (ESC), System
Vehicle Stability Assist® (VSA®), aka Electronic
Stability Control (ESC), System
VSA® helps to stabilize the vehicle during cornering if the vehicle turns more or less
than what was intended. It also assists in maintaining traction on slippery surfaces.
It does so by regulating engine output and selectively applying the brakes.
■ VSA® Operation
When VSA® activates, you may notice that the
engine does not respond to the accelerator.
You may also notice some noise from the
hydraulic system. You will also see the
indicator blink.
1Vehicle Stability Assist® (VSA®), aka Electronic Stability Control
(ESC), System
The VSA® may not function properly if tire type and
size are mixed. Make sure to use the same size and
type of tire, and the air pressures as specified.
When the VSA® system indicator comes on and stays
on while driving, there may be a problem with the
system. While this may not interfere with normal
driving, have your vehicle checked by a dealer
immediately.
VSA® System
Indicator
Driving
VSA® cannot enhance stability in all driving situations
and does not control the entire braking system. You
still need to drive and corner at speeds appropriate
for the conditions and always leave a sufficient
margin of safety.
The main function of the VSA® system is generally
known as Electronic Stability Control (ESC). The
system also includes a traction control function.
Continued
477
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 478 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguVehicle Stability Assist® (VSA®), aka Electronic Stability Control (ESC), System
■ VSA® On and Off
This button is on the driver side control panel.
To partially disable VSA® functionality/
features, press and hold it until you hear a
beep.
VSA® OFF Indicator
The traction control stops fully functioning,
allowing the wheels to spin more freely at low
speed. The VSA® OFF indicator will also come
on and a message on the driver information
interface informs you that the mode is
changed.
AWD models
Driving
Traction control mode can not be changed
during Mud or Sand modes. If you are driving
on mud or sand, Mud or Sand Intelligent
Traction Management modes can also be
used to free a stuck vehicle. On other road
surfaces, change to Normal or Snow mode,
then press and hold the
(VSA® OFF) button.
To restore VSA® functionality/features, press
the
(VSA® OFF) button until you hear a
beep.
VSA® is turned on every time you start the
engine, even if you turned it off the last time
you drove the vehicle.
478
1Vehicle Stability Assist® (VSA®), aka Electronic Stability Control
(ESC), System
With the
button pressed, your vehicle will have
normal braking and cornering ability, but VSA®
traction and stability enhancement becomes less
effective.
In certain unusual conditions when your vehicle gets
stuck in shallow mud or fresh snow, it may be easier
to free it with the VSA® temporarily switched off.
When the
button is pressed, the traction control
function becomes less effective. This allows for the
wheels to spin more freely at low speed. You should
only attempt to free your vehicle with the VSA® off if
you are not able to free it when the VSA® is on.
Immediately after freeing your vehicle, be sure to
switch VSA® on again. We do not recommend driving
your vehicle with the VSA® system switched off.
You may hear a motor sound coming from the
engine compartment while system checks are being
performed immediately after starting the engine or
while driving. This is normal.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 479 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguAgile Handling Assist
Agile Handling Assist
Lightly brakes each of the front and rear wheels, as needed, when you turn the
steering wheel, and helps support the vehicle’s stability and performance during
cornering.
1Agile Handling Assist
The agile handling assist cannot enhance stability in
all driving situations. You still need to drive and
corner at speeds appropriate for the conditions and
always leave a sufficient margin of safety.
When the VSA® system indicator comes on and stays
on while driving, the agile handling assist does not
activate.
You may hear a sound coming from the engine
compartment while the agile handling assist is
activated. This is normal.
Driving
479
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 480 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguBlind spot information System *
Blind spot information System *
Is designed to detect vehicles in specified alert zones adjacent to your vehicle,
particularly in harder to see areas commonly known as “blind spots”.
When the system detects vehicles approaching from behind in adjacent lanes, the
appropriate indicator comes on for a few seconds, providing assistance when you
change lanes.
■ How the system works
●
Driving
480
Alert Zone
A
B
C
* Not available on all models
3 WARNING
Failure to visually confirm that it is safe to
change lanes before doing so may result in
a crash and serious injury or death.
Do not rely only on the blind spot
information system when changing lanes.
Always look in your mirrors, to either side
of your vehicle, and behind you for other
vehicles before changing lanes.
●
The transmission is in (D .
Your vehicle speed is
between 20 mph (32 km/h)
Radar Sensors:
and 100 mph (160 km/h)
underneath the
Alert zone range
rear bumper
corners
A: Approx. 1.6 ft. (0.5 m)
B: Approx. 10 ft. (3 m)
C: Approx. 10 ft. (3 m)
1Blind spot information System *
Important Safety Reminder
Like all assistance systems, blind spot information
system has limitations. Over reliance on blind spot
information system may result in a collision.
The system is for your convenience only. Even if an
object is within the alert zone, the following
situations may occur.
• The blind spot information system alert indicator
may not come on due to obstruction (splashes,
etc.) even without the Blind Spot Info Not
Available driver information interface appearing.
• The blind spot information system alert indicator
may come on even with the message appearing.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 481 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguBlind spot information System *
■ When the system detects a vehicle
Comes On
Blinks
1Blind spot information System *
Blind spot information System Alert Indicator:
Located near the piller on both sides.
Comes on when:
• A vehicle enters the alert zone from behind
to overtake you with a speed difference of
no more than 31 mph (50 km/h) from your
vehicle.
• You pass a vehicle with a speed difference
of no more than 12 mph (20 km/h).
Blinks and a beeper sounds when:
You move the turn signal lever in the direction
of the detected vehicle. The beeper sounds
three times.
The blind spot information system alert indicator may
not come on under the following conditions:
• A vehicle does not stay in the alert zone for more
than two seconds.
• A vehicle is parked in a side lane.
• The speed difference between your vehicle and the
vehicle you are passing is greater than 6 mph
(10 km/h).
• An object not detected by the radar sensors
approaches or passes your vehicle.
• A vehicle running in the adjacent lane is a
motorcycle or other small vehicle.
The system does not operate when in (R .
Driving
You can turn off the audible alert, or all the blind spot
information system alert using the audio/information
screen.
2 Customized Features P. 359
Turn the system off when towing a trailer.
The system may not work properly for the following
reasons:
• The added mass tilts the vehicle and changes the
radar coverage.
• The trailer itself can be detected by the radar
sensors, causing the blind spot information system
alert indicators to come on.
* Not available on all models
Continued
481
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 482 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguBlind spot information System *
1Blind spot information System *
Blind spot information system may be adversely
affected when:
• Objects (guard rails, poles, trees, etc,.) are detected.
• An object that does not reflect radio waves well,
such as a motorcycle, is in the alert zone.
• Driving on a curved road.
• A vehicle is moving from a far lane to the adjacent
lane.
• The system picks up external electrical interference.
• The rear bumper or the sensors have been improperly
repaired or the rear bumper has been deformed.
• The orientation of the sensors has been changed.
• In bad weather (Heavy rain, snow, and fog).
For a proper blind spot information system operation:
Driving
• Always keep the rear bumper corner area clean.
• Do not cover the rear bumper corner area with
labels or stickers of any kind.
• Take your vehicle to a dealer if you need the rear
bumper corner area or the radar sensors to be repaired,
or the rear bumper corner area is strongly impacted.
482
* Not available on all models
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 483 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguLaneWatchTM *
LaneWatchTM *
LaneWatch is an assistance system that allows you to check the passenger side rear
areas displayed on the audio/information screen when the turn signal is activated to
the passenger’s side. A camera in the passenger side door mirror monitors these
areas and allows you to check for vehicles, in addition to your visual check and use
of the passenger door mirror. You can also keep the system on for your convenience
while driving.
The system activates when you:
Move the turn signal
lever to the passenger
side.
Press the LaneWatch
button.
The passenger side view
display appears on the
audio/information screen.
* Not available on all models
Failure to visually confirm that it is safe to
change lanes before doing so may result in
a crash and serious injury or death.
Do not rely only on LaneWatch while
driving.
Always look in your mirrors, to either side
of your vehicle, and behind you for other
vehicles before changing lanes.
Driving
Press the LaneWatch
button again.
Audio/Information Screen
3 WARNING
Important Safety Reminder
Like all assistance systems, LaneWatch has
limitations. Over reliance on LaneWatch may result in
a collision.
The system deactivates when you:
Pull the turn signal
lever back.
1LaneWatchTM *
The LaneWatch function can be affected by weather,
lighting (including headlights and low sun angle),
ambient darkness, camera condition, and loading.
The LaneWatch may not provide the intended display
of traffic to the side and rear under the following
conditions:
• Your vehicle’s suspension has been altered,
changing the height of the vehicle.
• Your tires are over or under inflated.
• Your tires or wheels are of varied size or construction.
Camera
Continued
483
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 484 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguLaneWatchTM *
■ Customizing the LaneWatch settings
You can customize the following items using the audio/information screen.
• Show with Turn Signal: Selects whether LaneWatch monitor comes on when
you operate the turn signal light lever.
• Show Reference Line: Selects whether the reference lines appear on the
LaneWatch monitor.
• Display: Adjusts display settings.
1LaneWatchTM *
The LaneWatch camera view is restricted. Its unique
lens makes objects on the screen slightly look
different from what they are.
LaneWatch display does not come on when the gear
position is changed to (R .
For proper LaneWatch operation:
2 Customized Features P. 359
• The camera is located in the passenger side door
■ Reference Lines
Driving
Three lines that appear on the screen can give
an idea of how far the vehicles or objects on
the screen are from your vehicle, respectively.
If an object is near line 1 (in red), it indicates
that it is close to your vehicle whereas an
object near line 3 is farther away.
mirror. Always keep this area clean. If the camera
lens is covered with dirt or moisture, use a soft,
moist cloth to keep the lens clean and free of debris.
• Do not cover the camera lens with labels or stickers
of any kind.
• Do not touch the camera lens.
1Reference Lines
The area around the reference line 1 (red) is very close
to your vehicle. As always, make sure to visually
confirm the safety of a lane change before changing
lanes.
The distance between your vehicle and lines 1, 2 and
3 on the screen vary depending on road conditions
and vehicle loading. For example, the reference lines
on the screen may seem to appear closer than the
actual distances when the rear of your vehicle is more
heavily loaded.
Consult a dealer if:
• The passenger side door mirror, or area around it is
severely impacted, resulting in changing the
camera angle.
• The LaneWatch display does not come on at all.
484
* Not available on all models
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 485 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguIntelligent Variable Torque Management (i-VTM4TM) AWD System *
Intelligent Variable Torque Management (i-VTM4TM)
AWD System *
The intelligent variable torque management (i-VTM4TM) AWD system is a full time all
wheel drive system that automatically controls and transfers varying amount of
engine torque to all wheels independently according to the driving conditions.
You still need to exercise the same care when accelerating, steering, and braking
that you would in a two wheel drive vehicle.
Avoid continuously driving on slippery surfaces where a wheel is likely to spin out,
and do not drive if the AWD indicator starts blinking. Driving continuously under
such conditions can damage the system's torque distribution unit.
* Not available on all models
NOTICE
Do not continuously spin the front tires of your
vehicle. Continuously spinning the front tires can
cause transmission or rear differential damage.
The intelligent variable torque management
(i-VTM4TM) AWD system may not function properly if
tire type and size are mixed. Make sure to use the
same size and type of tire, and the air pressures as
specified.
2 Tire and Wheel Replacement P. 594
Driving
If the AWD indicator blinks while driving, it indicates the differential temperature is
too high. If this happens, pull to the side of the road when it is safe, shift to park, an
idle the engine idle until the indicator goes out. If the indicator does not go out, take
your vehicle to a dealer to have it checked.
1 Intelligent Variable Torque Management (i-VTM4TM) AWD System *
485
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 486 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguTire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) with Tire Fill Assist
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) with Tire
Fill Assist
Monitors the tire pressure while you are
driving. If your vehicle’s tire pressure becomes
significantly low, the Low Tire Pressure/TPMS
indicator comes on and a message appears on
the driver information interface.
1Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) with Tire Fill Assist
Conditions such as low ambient temperature and
altitude change directly affect tire pressure and can
trigger the Low Tire Pressure/TPMS indicator to come
on.
2 If the Low Tire Pressure/Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Indicator
Comes On or Blinks P. 630
Driving
Tire pressure checked and inflated in:
• Warm weather can become under-inflated in
colder weather.
• Cold weather can become over-inflated in warmer
weather.
The Low Tire Pressure/TPMS indicator will not come
on as a result of over inflation.
The TPMS audibly and visually informs you of
changes in tire pressure of the individual tire that you
are adjusting using audible and visual indications.
If a change in tire pressure has been significant, the
system beeps and the hazard lights flash continuously
for five seconds when the specified tire pressure is
reached. Stop filling the tire.
486
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 487 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguTire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) with Tire Fill Assist
■ Tire Pressure Monitor
1Tire Pressure Monitor
To select the tire pressure monitor, please follow
the following steps using the buttons on the
steering wheel.
1. Set the power mode to ON.
2. Press the
(home) button.
3. Press the 3 / 4 button repeatedly until
Maintenance appears.
4. Press the ENTER button and select Tire
Pressure by pressing the 3 / 4 button.
5. Press the ENTER button and the tire
pressure appears on the driver information
interface.
Tire Pressures Low is displayed when a tire
has significantly low pressure. The specific tire
is displayed on the screen.
Tire Pressure Monitor Problem may appear if you
drive with the compact spare tire, or there is a
problem with the TPMS.
Driving
The pressure for each tire is displayed in psi.
The pressure displayed on the driver information
interface can be slightly different from the actual
pressure as measured by a gauge. If there is a
significant difference between the two values, or if
the Low Tire Pressure/TPMS indicator and the
message on the driver information interface do not
go off after you have inflated the tire to the specified
pressure, have the system checked by a dealer.
487
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 488 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguTire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) - Required Federal Explanation
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) - Required
Federal Explanation
Each tire, including the spare (if provided), should be checked
monthly when cold and inflated to the inflation pressure
recommended by the vehicle manufacturer on the vehicle placard
or tire inflation pressure label.
(If your vehicle has tires of a different size than the size indicated
on the vehicle placard or tire inflation pressure label, you should
determine the proper tire inflation pressure for those tires.)
As an added safety feature, your vehicle has been equipped with
a tire pressure monitoring system (TPMS) that illuminates a low
tire pressure telltale
Driving
when one or more of your tires is significantly under-inflated.
Accordingly, when the low tire pressure telltale illuminates, you
should stop and check your tires as soon as possible, and inflate
them to the proper pressure.
Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire to
overheat and can lead to tire failure. Under-inflation also reduces
fuel efficiency and tire tread life, and may affect the vehicle’s
handling and stopping ability.
488
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 489 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWhen DrivinguTire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) - Required Federal Explanation
Please note that the TPMS is not a substitute for proper tire
maintenance, and it is the driver’s responsibility to maintain
correct tire pressure, even if under-inflation has not reached the
level to trigger illumination of the TPMS low tire pressure telltale.
Your vehicle has also been equipped with a TPMS malfunction
indicator to indicate when the system is not operating properly.
The TPMS malfunction indicator is combined with the low tire
pressure telltale. When the system detects a malfunction, the
telltale will flash for approximately one minute and then remain
continuously illuminated. This sequence will continue upon
subsequent vehicle start-ups as long as the malfunction exists.
TPMS malfunctions may occur for a variety of reasons, including
the installation of replacement or alternate tires or wheels on the
vehicle that prevent the TPMS from functioning properly.
Driving
When the malfunction indicator is illuminated, the system may
not be able to detect or signal low tire pressure as intended.
Always check the TPMS malfunction telltale after replacing one or
more tires or wheels on your vehicle to ensure that the
replacement or alternate tires and wheels allow the TPMS to
continue to function properly.
489
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 490 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Honda Sensing®
Honda Sensing® is a driver support system which employs the use of two distinctly
different kinds of sensors: a radar sensor located behind the emblem and a front
sensor camera mounted to the interior side of the windshield, behind the rearview
mirror.
Honda Sensing® has following functions.
■ The functions which do not require switch operations to activate
• Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBS)TM 2 P. 493
• Road Departure Mitigation (RDM) System 2 P. 527
■ The functions which require switch operations to activate
• Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) 2 P. 505
• Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) 2 P. 518
Driving
490
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 491 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®u
■ Operation Switches for the ACC/LKAS
CANCEL
Button
Interval
Button
■ MAIN Button
Press to activate standby mode for ACC and
LKAS. Or press to cancel these systems.
■ LKAS Button
Press to activate or cancel the LKAS.
MAIN button
RES/+ Button
LKAS Button
■ RES/+/−/SET Button
Press RES/+ to resume the ACC or increase
the vehicle speed.
Press −/SET to set the ACC or decrease the
vehicle speed.
−/SET Button
Driving
■ Interval Button
Press the (interval) button to change the
ACC following-interval.
■ CANCEL Button
Press to cancel ACC.
Continued
491
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 492 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®u
■ Multi-Information Display Content
You can see the current state of ACC and
LKAS.
a Indicates
that ACC and LKAS are ready to
be activated.
b Indicates
that LKAS is activated and
whether or not traffic lane lines are
detected.
c Indicates
whether or not a vehicle is
detected ahead.
Driving
492
d Shows
the set vehicle speed.
e Shows
the set vehicle interval.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 493 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
Can assist you when there is a possibility of your vehicle colliding with a vehicle or a
pedestrian detected in front of yours. The CMBSTM is designed to alert you when a
potential collision is determined, as well as to reduce your vehicle speed to help
minimize collision severity when a collision is deemed unavoidable.
■ How the system works
1Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
Important Safety Reminder
The CMBSTM is designed to reduce the severity of an
unavoidable collision. It does not prevent a collision nor
stop the vehicle automatically. It is still your
responsibility to operate the brake pedal and steering
wheel appropriately according to the driving conditions.
When to use
The CMBSTM may not activate or may not detect a
vehicle in front of your vehicle under certain conditions:
2 CMBSTM Conditions and Limitations P. 497
The camera is
located behind the
rearview mirror.
For directions on the proper handling of the radar
sensor, refer to the following page.
2 Radar Sensor P. 534
Driving
You can read about handling information for the
camera equipped with this system.
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 532
1How the system works
The radar sensor is
behind the emblem.
The system starts monitoring the roadway ahead when your vehicle speed is about
3 mph (5 km/h) and there is a vehicle in front of you.
The CMBSTM activates when:
● The speed difference between your vehicle and a vehicle or pedestrian
detected in front of you becomes about 3 mph (5 km/h) and over with a chance
of a collision.
● Your vehicle speed is about 62 mph (100 km/h) or less and there is a chance of a
collision with an oncoming detected vehicle or a pedestrian in front of you.
Continued
Rapid vibrations on the steering wheel alert you
when the your vehicle speed is between 19 and 62
mph (30 and 100 km/h) with an oncoming vehicle
detected in front of you.
When the CMBSTM activates, it may automatically
apply the brake. It will be canceled when your vehicle
stops or a potential collision is not determined.
493
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 494 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
■ When the system activates
1When the system activates
The system provides visual, audible and tactile alerts of a possible collision, and
stops if the collision is avoided.
u Take appropriate action to prevent a collision (apply the brakes, change
lanes, etc.)
Visual Alerts
The camera in the CMBSTM is also designed to detect
pedestrians.
However, this pedestrian detection feature may not
activate or may not detect a pedestrian in front of
your vehicle under certain conditions.
Refer to the ones indicating the pedestrian detection
limitations from the list.
2 CMBSTM Conditions and Limitations P. 497
Beep
Driving
Audible Alert
Tactile Alert
At system’s earliest collision alert stage, you can change the distance (Long/
Normal/Short) between vehicles at which alerts will come on through the driver
information interface or the audio/information screen setting options.
2 Vehicle Customization P. 119
2 Customized Features P. 359
■ Vibration alert on the steering wheel
When a potential collision to an oncoming detected vehicle is determined, the
system alerts you with rapid vibration on the steering wheel, in addition to visual and
audible alerts.
u Take appropriate action to prevent a collision (apply the brakes, operate the
steering wheel, etc.).
494
1Vibration alert on the steering wheel
Vibration alert function is disabled when the electric
power steering (EPS) system indicator comes on.
2 Driver Information Interface Warning and
Information Messages P. 91
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 495 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
■ Collision Alert Stages
The system has three alert stages for a possible collision. However, depending on circumstances, the CMBSTM may not go through all of
the stages before initiating the last stage.
CMBSTM
Distance between vehicles
Stage
one
Normal
Long Short
Vehicle
Ahead
Your Vehicle
Your
Vehicle
Vehicle
Ahead
Audible & Visual WARNINGS
When in Long, visual and
audible alerts come on at a
There is a risk of a collision
longer distance from a vehicle
with the vehicle ahead of
ahead than in Normal setting,
you.
and in Short, at a shorter
distance than in Normal.
The risk of a collision has
increased, time to respond
is reduced.
Steering Wheel
In case of an
oncoming vehicle
detected, rapid
vibration is
provided.
Braking
—
—
Lightly
applied
—
Forcefully
applied
Driving
Stage
two
The sensors detect a
vehicle
Visual and audible alerts.
Stage
three
Your
Vehicle
Vehicle
Ahead
The CMBS determines
that a collision is
unavoidable.
TM
Continued
495
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 496 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
■ CMBSTM On and Off
1Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
Press and hold the button until the beeper
sounds to switch the system on or off.
When the CMBSTM is off:
• The CMBSTM indicator in the instrument
panel comes on.
• A message on the driver information
interface reminds you that the system is off.
The CMBSTM is turned on every time you start
the engine, even if you turned it off the last
time you drove the vehicle.
Driving
496
The CMBSTM may automatically shut off, and the
CMBSTM indicator will come and stay on under certain
conditions:
2 CMBSTM Conditions and Limitations P. 497
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 497 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
■ CMBSTM Conditions and Limitations
The system may automatically shut off and the CMBSTM indicator will come on under
certain conditions. Some examples of these conditions are listed below. Other
conditions may reduce some of the CMBSTM functions.
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 532
■ Environmental conditions
Driving in bad weather (rain, fog, snow, etc.).
Sudden changes between light and dark, such as an entrance or exit of a tunnel.
There is little contrast between objects and the background.
Driving into low sunlight (e.g., at dawn or dusk).
Strong light is reflected onto the roadway.
Driving in the shadows of trees, buildings, etc.
Roadway objects or structures are misinterpreted as vehicles and pedestrians.
Reflections on the interior of the windshield.
Driving at night or in a dark condition such as a tunnel.
Driving
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
■ Roadway conditions
• Driving on a snowy or wet roadway (obscured lane marking, vehicle tracks,
reflected lights, road spray, high contrast).
• The road is hilly or the vehicle is approaching the crest of a hill.
• Driving on curvy, winding, or undulating roads.
Continued
497
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 498 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
■ Vehicle conditions
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Driving
498
Headlight lenses are dirty or the headlights are not properly adjusted.
The outside of the windshield is blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet snow, etc.
The inside of the windshield is fogged.
An abnormal tire or wheel condition (wrong sized, varied size or construction,
improperly inflated, compact spare tire, etc.).
When tire chains are installed.
The vehicle is tilted due to a heavy load or suspension modifications.
The camera temperature gets too high.
Driving with the parking brake applied.
When the radar sensor in the front grille gets dirty.
The vehicle is towing a trailer.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 499 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
Continued
Driving
■ Detection limitations
• A vehicle or pedestrian suddenly crosses in front of you.
• The distance between your vehicle and the vehicle or pedestrian ahead of you is
too short.
• A vehicle cuts in front of you at a slow speed, and it brakes suddenly.
• When you accelerate rapidly and approach the vehicle or pedestrian ahead of you
at high speed.
• The vehicle ahead of you is a motorcycle, bicycle, mobility scooter or other small
vehicle.
• When there are animals in front of your vehicle.
• When you drive on a curved, winding or undulating road that makes it difficult for
the sensor to properly detect a vehicle in front of you.
• The speed difference between your vehicle and a vehicle or pedestrian in front of
you is significantly large.
• An oncoming vehicle suddenly comes in front of you.
• Another vehicle suddenly comes in front of you at an intersection, etc.
• Your vehicle abruptly crosses over in front of an oncoming vehicle.
• When driving through a narrow iron bridge.
• When the lead vehicle suddenly slows down.
499
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 500 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
Limitations applicable to pedestrian detection only
• When there is a group of people in front of your vehicle walking together side by
side.
• Surrounding conditions or belongings of the pedestrian alter the pedestrian’s
shape, preventing the system from recognizing that the person is a pedestrian.
• When the pedestrian is shorter than about 3.3 feet (1 meter) or taller than about
6.6 feet (2 meters) in height.
• When a pedestrian blends in with the background.
• When a pedestrian is bent over or squatting, or when their hands are raised or
they are running.
• When several pedestrians are walking ahead in a group.
• When the camera cannot correctly identify that a pedestrian is present due to an
unusual shape (holding luggage, body position, size).
Driving
500
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 501 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
■ Automatic shutoff
CMBSTM may automatically shut itself off and the CMBSTM indicator comes and stays
on when:
• The temperature inside the system is high.
• You drive off-road or on a mountain road, or curved and winding road for an
extended period.
• An abnormal tire condition is detected (wrong tire size, flat tire, etc.).
• The camera behind the rearview mirror, or the area around the camera, including
the windshield, gets dirty.
Once the conditions that caused CMBSTM to shut off improve or are addressed (e.g.,
cleaning), the system comes back on.
Driving
Continued
501
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 502 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
■ With Little Chance of a Collision
The CMBSTM may activate even when you are aware of a vehicle ahead of you, or
when there is no vehicle ahead. Some examples of this are:
■ When Passing
Your vehicle approaches another vehicle ahead of you and you change lanes to pass.
■ At an intersection
Your vehicle approaches or passes another vehicle that is making a left or right turn.
Driving
502
1Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if you find any
unusual behavior of the system (e.g., the warning
message appears too frequently).
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 503 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
■ On a curve
When driving through curves, your vehicle comes to a point where an oncoming
vehicle is right in front of you.
Driving
■ Through a low bridge at high speed
You drive under a low or narrow bridge at high speed.
Continued
503
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 504 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uCollision Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM)
■ Speed bumps, road work sites, train tracks, roadside objects, etc.
You drive over speed bumps, steel road plates, etc., or your vehicle approaches train
tracks or roadside objects [such as a traffic sign and guard rail] on a curve or, when
parking, stationary vehicles and walls.
Driving
504
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 505 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
Helps maintain a constant vehicle speed and a set following-interval behind a vehicle
detected ahead of yours, without you having to keep your foot on the brake or the
accelerator.
1Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
3 WARNING
Improper use of ACC can lead to a crash.
Use ACC only when driving on expressways
or freeways and in good weather
conditions.
When to use
The camera is located
behind the rearview
mirror.
3 WARNING
ACC has limited braking capability.
Always be prepared to apply the brake
pedal when conditions require.
■ Vehicle speed for adaptive cruise control: Desired speed in a
ACC can not be activated if Intelligent Traction
Management setting is snow, sand * or mud *.
range above roughly 25 mph (40 km/h) ~
■ Gear positions for adaptive cruise control: In (D or (S
* Not available on all models
Driving
The radar sensor is behind
the emblem.
When your vehicle speed drops below
22 mph (35 km/h), ACC will automatically
cancel and no longer will apply your
vehicle's brakes.
Continued
505
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 506 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
■ How to activate the system
1Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
Important Reminder
As with any system, there are limits to ACC. Use the
brake pedal whenever necessary, and always keep a
safe interval between your vehicle and other vehicles.
How to use
ACC is on in the driver
information interface.
Adaptive cruise control is
ready to use.
You can read about handling information for the
camera equipped with this system.
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 532
The radar sensor for ACC is shared with the Collision
Mitigation Braking SystemTM (CMBSTM).
2 Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM
(CMBSTM) P. 493
■ Press the MAIN button on
Driving
506
the steering wheel.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 507 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
■ To Set the Vehicle Speed
1Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
–/SET Button
ACC may not work properly under certain conditions.
2 ACC Conditions and Limitations P. 510
When not using ACC: Turn off adaptive cruise by
pressing the MAIN button. This also will turn off the
Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS).
When the MAIN button is pressed, ACC and Lane
Keeping Assist System (LKAS) are both turned on or
off.
On when
adaptive cruise
control begins
Press and release
Continued
Do not use ACC under the following conditions:
• On roads with heavy traffic or while driving in
continuous stop and go traffic.
• On roads with sharp turns.
• On roads with steep downhill sections, as the set
vehicle speed can be exceeded by coasting. In such
cases, ACC will not apply the brakes to maintain
the set speed.
• On roads with toll collection facilities or other
objects between lanes of traffic, or in parking
areas, or facilities with drive through access.
Driving
Take your foot off the pedal and press the –/SET button when you reach the desired
speed. The moment you release the –/SET button, the set speed is fixed, and ACC
begins.
When ACC starts operating, the vehicle icon,
Set Vehicle
Set Vehicle
distance bars and set speed appear on the
Speed
Interval
driver information interface.
You can switch the displayed set speed
measurements on the driver information interface
between mph and km/h.
2 Units P. 114
507
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 508 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
■ When in Operation
1When in Operation
■ There is a vehicle ahead
ACC monitors if a vehicle ahead of you enters the ACC range. If a vehicle is detected
doing so, the ACC system maintains or decelerates your vehicle’s set speed in order
to keep the vehicle’s set following-interval from the vehicle ahead.
If the vehicle detected ahead of you slows down
abruptly, or if another vehicle is detected cutting in
front of you, the beeper sounds and a message
appears on the driver information interface.
2 To Set or Change Following-interval P. 513
ACC Range: 394 ft. (120 m)
Driving
When a vehicle whose speed is slower than
your set speed is detected in front of you, your
vehicle starts to slow down.
A vehicle icon appears on the
driver information interface.
508
Depress the brake pedal, and keep an appropriate
interval from the vehicle ahead.
Beep
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 509 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
■ There is no vehicle ahead
A vehicle icon with dotted-line
contour appears on the driver
information interface.
1When in Operation
Your vehicle maintains the set speed without
having to keep your foot on the brake or
accelerator pedal.
If there previously was a vehicle detected
ahead that kept your vehicle from traveling at
the set speed, ACC accelerates your vehicle to
the set speed, and then maintains it.
You can also set the system to beep when a vehicle in
front of you comes in and goes out of the ACC
detecting range. Change the ACC Forward Vehicle
Detect Beep setting.
2 Vehicle Customization P. 119
2 Customized Features P. 359
Limitations
You may need to use the brake to maintain a safe
interval when using ACC. Additionally, ACC may not
work properly under certain conditions.
2 ACC Conditions and Limitations P. 510
Continued
Driving
■ When you depress the accelerator pedal
You can temporarily increase the vehicle speed. In this case, there is no audible or
visual alerts even if a vehicle is in ACC range.
ACC stays on unless you cancel it. Once you release the accelerator pedal, the
system resumes the set speed.
Even if the interval between your vehicle and the
vehicle detected ahead is short, ACC may start
accelerating your vehicle under the following
circumstances:
• The vehicle ahead of you is going at almost the
same speed as, or faster than, your vehicle.
• A vehicle that cuts in front of you is going faster
than your vehicle, gradually increasing the interval
between the vehicles.
509
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 510 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
■ ACC Conditions and Limitations
The system may automatically shut off and the ACC indicator will come on under
certain conditions. Some examples of these conditions are listed below. Other
conditions may reduce some of the ACC functions.
1ACC Conditions and Limitations
If you need the radar sensor to be repaired, or
removed, or the radar sensor cover is strongly
impacted, turn off the system by pressing the MAIN
button and take your vehicle to a dealer.
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 532
■ Environmental conditions
Driving in bad weather (rain, fog, snow, etc.).
■ Roadway conditions
Driving on a snowy or wet roadway (obscured lane marking, vehicle tracks, reflected
lights, road spray, high contrast).
■ Vehicle conditions
Driving
510
• The outside of the windshield is blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet snow, etc.
• An abnormal tire or wheel condition (wrong sized, varied size or construction,
improperly inflated, compact spare tire, etc.).
• The camera temperature gets too high.
• The parking brake is applied.
• When the front grille is dirty.
• The vehicle is tilted due to a heavy load or suspension modifications.
• When tire chains are installed.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer if you find any
unusual behavior of the system (e.g., the warning
message appears too frequently).
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 511 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
■ Detection limitations
•
•
•
•
A vehicle suddenly crosses in front of you.
The interval between your vehicle and the vehicle ahead of you is too short.
A vehicle cuts in front of you at a slow speed, and it brakes suddenly.
When you accelerate rapidly and approach the vehicle ahead of you at high
speed.
• The vehicle ahead of you is a motorcycle, bicycle, mobility scooter, or other small
vehicle.
• When there are animals in front of your vehicle.
• When you drive on a curved or winding or undulating road that makes it difficult
for the sensor to properly detect a vehicle in front of you.
Driving
• The speed difference between your vehicle and a vehicle in front of you is
significantly large.
• An oncoming vehicle suddenly comes in front of you.
• Your vehicle abruptly crosses over in front of an oncoming vehicle.
Continued
511
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 512 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
• When driving through a narrow iron bridge.
• When the vehicle ahead of you brakes suddenly.
• When the vehicle ahead of you has a unique shape.
Radar detects upper section of
an empty carrier truck.
Panel truck,
tanker truck, etc.
Driving
• When your vehicle or the vehicle ahead of you is driving on one edge of the lane.
512
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 513 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
■ To Adjust the Vehicle Speed
1To Adjust the Vehicle Speed
Increase or decrease the vehicle speed using the RES/+ or −/SET buttons on the
steering wheel.
If a vehicle detected ahead is going at a speed slower
than your increased set speed, ACC may not
accelerate your vehicle. This is to maintain the set
interval between your vehicle and the vehicle ahead.
You can switch the displayed set speed
measurements on the driver information interface
between mph and km/h.
2 Units P. 114
To increase speed
You can set the vehicle speed using the −/SET button
on the steering wheel when adjusting the speed with
the accelerator and brake pedals.
To decrease speed
Driving
• Each time you press the button, the vehicle speed is increased or decreased by
about 1 mph or 1 km/h accordingly.
• If you keep the button pressed, the vehicle speed increases or decreases by about
5 mph or 5 km/h accordingly.
■ To Set or Change Following-interval
Interval Button
Press the
(Interval) button to change the
ACC following-interval.
Each time you press the button, the followinginterval (the interval behind a vehicle detected
ahead of you) setting cycles through short,
middle, long, and extra long followinginterval.
Continued
513
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 514 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
Determine the most appropriate following-interval setting based on your specific
driving conditions. Be sure to adhere to any following-interval requirements set by
local regulation.
The higher vehicle's following-speed is, the longer the short, middle, long or extra
long following-interval becomes. See the following examples for your reference.
When the Set Speed is:
Following-interval
Driving
514
50 mph (80 km/h)
65 mph (104 km/h)
Short
83 feet
25 meters
1.1 sec
100 feet
31 meters
1.1 sec
Middle
110 feet
33 meters
1.5 sec
137 feet
42 meters
1.5 sec
Long
154 feet
47 meters
2.1 sec
200 feet
61 meters
2.1 sec
Extra
Long
204 feet
62 meters
2.8 sec
265 feet
81 meters
2.8 sec
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 515 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
■ To Cancel
CANCEL
Button
1To Cancel
To cancel ACC, do any of the following:
• Press the CANCEL button.
• Press the MAIN button.
u ACC indicator goes off.
• Depress the brake pedal.
MAIN
Button
Continued
The set speed cannot be set or resumed when ACC
has been turned off using the MAIN button. Press
the MAIN button to activate the system, then set the
desired speed.
1Automatic cancellation
Even though ACC has been automatically canceled,
you can still resume the prior set speed. Wait until the
condition that caused ACC to cancel improves, then
press the RES/+ button.
Driving
■ Automatic cancellation
The beeper sounds and a message appears on the driver information interface when
ACC is automatically canceled. Any of these conditions may cause the ACC to
automatically cancel:
• Bad weather (rain, fog, snow, etc.).
• When the radar sensor behind the emblem gets dirty.
• The vehicle ahead of you cannot be detected.
• An abnormal tire condition is detected, or the tires are skidding.
• Driving on a mountainous road, or driving off road for extended periods.
• Abrupt steering wheel movement.
• When the ABS, VSA® or CMBSTM is activated.
• When the ABS or VSA® system indicator comes on.
• When you manually apply the parking brake.
• When the detected vehicle within the ACC range is too close to your vehicle.
• The camera behind the rearview mirror, or the area around the camera, including
the windshield, gets dirty.
Resuming the prior set speed: After you have
canceled ACC, you can resume the prior set speed
while it is still displayed. Press the RES/+ button
when driving at a speed of at least 25 mph (40 km/h)
or more.
515
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 516 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
■ To Switch ACC to Cruise Control
ACC ON
Cruise
Control ON
Press and hold the (interval) button for one
second. Cruise Mode Selected appears on
the driver information interface for two
seconds, and then the mode switches to
Cruise.
To switch back to ACC, press and hold the
button again for one second.
■ When to use
Desired speed in a range above roughly 25 mph (40 km/h) ~.
Driving
■ To Set the Vehicle Speed
Take your foot off the pedal and press the –/SET button when you reach the desired
speed.
The moment you release the –/SET button, the set speed is fixed, and cruise control
begins. The CRUISE CONTROL indicator comes on.
■ To Adjust the Vehicle Speed
Each time you press the RES/+ or –/SET button, the vehicle speed is increased or
decreased by about 1 mph (1.6 km/h).
If you keep the RES/+ or –/SET button pressed, the vehicle speed increases or
decreases until you release it. This speed is then set.
516
1To Switch ACC to Cruise Control
Always be aware which mode you are in. When you
are driving in Cruise mode, the system will not assist
you to maintain a following-interval from a vehicle
ahead of you.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 517 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uAdaptive Cruise Control (ACC)
■ To Cancel
To cancel cruise control, do any of the following:
• Press the CANCEL button.
• Press the MAIN button.
• Depress the brake pedal.
The CRUISE CONTROL indicator goes off.
1To Cancel
Resuming the prior set speed:
After cruise control has been canceled, you can still
resume the prior set speed by pressing the RES/+
button while driving at a speed of at least 25 mph (40
km/h) or more.
You cannot set or resume in the following situations:
• When vehicle speed is less than 25 mph (40 km/h).
• When the MAIN button is turned off.
At vehicle speeds of 22 mph (35 km/h) or less, cruise
control canceled automatically.
Driving
517
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 518 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
Provides steering input to help keep the vehicle in the middle of a detected lane and
provides tactile and visual alerts if the vehicle is detected drifting out of its lane.
■ Steering input assist
The system applies torque to the steering to keep the vehicle between the left and
right lane lines. The applied torque becomes stronger as the vehicle gets closer to
either of the lane lines.
■ Tactile and visual alerts
■ Front sensor camera Rapid vibrations on the steering wheel
and a warning display alert you that the
Monitors the lane
vehicle is drifting out of a detected
lines
lane.
1Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
Important Safety Reminders
The LKAS is for your convenience only. It is not a
substitute for your vehicle control. The system does
not work if you take your hands off the steering
wheel or fail to steer the vehicle.
2 Driver Information Interface Warning and
Information Messages P. 91
Do not place objects on the instrument panel.
Objects may reflect on the front windshield and
prevent correct detection of the traffic lanes.
Driving
The LKAS only alerts you when lane drift is detected
without a turn signal in use. The LKAS may not detect
all lane markings or lane departures; accuracy will
vary based on weather, speed, and lane marker
condition. It is always your responsibility to safely
operate the vehicle and avoid collisions.
The LKAS is convenient when it is used on freeways.
The LKAS may not work properly or may work
improperly under the certain conditions:
2 LKAS Conditions and Limitations P. 524
When you operate the turn signals to change lanes, the system is suspended, and
resumes after the signals are off.
If you make a lane change without operating the turn signals, the LKAS alerts
activate, and torque is applied to the steering.
The LKAS may not function as designed while driving
in frequent stop and go traffic, or on roads with
sharp curves.
You can read about handling information for the
camera equipped with this system.
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 532
518
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 519 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
■ Lane Keep Support Function
1Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
Provides assistance to keep the vehicle in the center of the lane. When the vehicle
nears a white or yellow line, steering force of the electric power steering will become
stronger.
When the vehicle enters the warning area, the LKAS alerts you with slight steering
wheel vibration as well as warning display.
Driving
■ Lane Departure Warning Function
When it fails to detect lanes, the system will
temporarily be canceled. When a lane is detected, the
system will recover automatically.
Warning Area
Warning Area
Continued
519
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 520 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
■ When the System can be Used
The system can be used when the following conditions are met.
• The lane in which you are driving has detectable lane markers on both sides, and
your vehicle is in the center of the lane.
• The vehicle speed is between 45 and 90 mph (72 and 145 km/h).
• You are driving on a straight or slightly curved road.
• The turn signals are off.
• The brake pedal is not depressed.
• The wipers are not in high speed operation.
■ How to activate the system
MAIN Button
Driving
LKAS Button
520
1. Press the MAIN button.
u The LKAS is on in the driver information
interface.
The system is ready to use.
2. Press the LKAS button.
u Lane outlines appear on the driver
information interface.
The system is activated.
1Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
If the vehicle drifts toward either left or right lane line
due to the system applying torque, turn off the LKAS
and have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 521 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
3. Keep your vehicle near the center of the
lane while driving.
u The dotted outer lines change to solid
ones once the system starts operating
after detecting the left and right lane
markings.
■ To Cancel
MAIN Button
1To Cancel
LKAS Button
Pressing the MAIN button also turns ACC on and off.
To cancel the LKAS:
Press the MAIN or LKAS button.
Continued
Driving
The LKAS is turned off every time you stop the
engine, even if you turned it on the last time
you drove the vehicle.
521
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 522 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
■ The system operation is suspended if
When the LKAS is suspended,
the lane lines on the driver
information interface change
to contour lines, and the
beeper sounds (if activated).
Driving
522
you:
• Set the wipers to HI.
u Turning the wipers off resumes the
LKAS.
• Decrease the vehicle speed to about 40
mph (64 km/h) or less.
u Increasing the vehicle speed to about 45
mph (72 km/h) or more resumes the
LKAS.
• Depress the brake pedal.
u The LKAS resumes and starts detecting
the lane lines again once you release the
brake pedal.
• Your vehicle is driving to the right or the left
of the lane.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 523 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
■ The LKAS may automatically be suspended when:
•
•
•
•
•
The system fails to detect lane lines.
The steering wheel is quickly turned.
You fail to steer the vehicle.
Driving through a sharp curve.
Driving at a speed in excess of approximately 90 mph (145 km/h).
Once these conditions no longer exist, the LKAS automatically resumes.
■ The LKAS may automatically be canceled when:
• The camera temperature gets extremely high or low.
• The camera behind the rearview mirror, or the area around the camera, including
the windshield, gets dirty.
• The ABS or VSA® system engages.
Driving
The beeper sounds if the LKAS is automatically canceled.
Continued
523
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 524 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
■ LKAS Conditions and Limitations
The system may not detect lane markings and therefore may not keep the vehicle in
the middle of a lane under certain conditions, including the following:
■ Environmental conditions
Driving
524
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Driving in bad weather (rain, fog, snow, etc.).
Sudden changes between light and dark, such as an entrance or exit of a tunnel.
There is little contrast between lane lines and the roadway surface.
Driving into low sunlight (e.g., at dawn or dusk).
Strong light is reflected onto the roadway.
Driving in the shadows of trees, buildings, etc.
Shadows of adjacent objects are parallel to lane markings.
Roadway objects or structures are misinterpreted as lane markers.
Reflections on the interior of the windshield.
Driving at night or in a dark condition such as a tunnel.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 525 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
■ Roadway conditions
• Driving on a snowy or wet roadway (obscured lane marking, vehicle tracks,
reflected lights, road spray, high contrast).
• Driving on a road with temporary lane markings.
• Faint, multiple, or varied lane markings are visible on the roadway due to road
repairs or old lane markings.
Faded lines
Duplicate lines
Tire tracks
• The roadway has merging, split, or crossing lines (e.g., such as at an intersection
or crosswalk).
• The lane markings are extremely narrow, wide, or changing.
Driving
Very wide or narrow traffic lane
•
•
•
•
The vehicle in front of you is driving near the lane lines.
The road is hilly or the vehicle is approaching the crest of a hill.
Driving on rough or unpaved roads, or over bumpy surfaces.
When objects on the road (curb, guard rail, pylons, etc.) are recognized as white
lines (or yellow lines).
Continued
525
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 526 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uLane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
• Driving on roads with double lines.
Lane void of lines at junction
■ Vehicle conditions
Driving
526
• Headlight lenses are dirty or the headlights are not properly adjusted.
• The outside of the windshield is streaked or blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet
snow, etc.
• The inside of the windshield is fogged.
• The camera temperature gets too high.
• An abnormal tire or wheel condition (wrong sized, varied size or construction,
improperly inflated, compact spare tire, etc.).
• The vehicle is tilted due to a heavy load or suspension modifications.
• The vehicle is towing a trailer.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 527 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uRoad Departure Mitigation (RDM) System
Road Departure Mitigation (RDM) System
Alerts and helps to assist you when the system detects a possibility of your vehicle
unintentionally crossing over detected lane markings and/or leaving the roadway
altogether.
■ How the System Works
The front camera behind the rearview mirror
monitors left and right lane markings (in white
or yellow). If your vehicle is getting too close to
detected lane markings without a turn signal
activated, the system, in addition to a visual
alert, applies steering torque and alerts you
with rapid vibrations on the steering wheel, to
help you remain within the detected lane.
As a visual alert, the Lane Departure message
appears on the driver information interface.
If the system determines that its steering input
is insufficient to keep your vehicle on the
roadway, it may apply braking.
u Braking is applied only when the lane
markings are solid continuous lines.
The system cancels assisting operations when you turn the steering wheel to avoid
crossing over detected lane markings.
Important Safety Reminder
Like all assistance systems, the RDM system has
limitations.
Over-reliance on the RDM system may result in a
collision. It is always your responsibility to keep the
vehicle within your driving lane.
The RDM system only alerts you when lane drift is
detected without a turn signal in use. The RDM
system may not detect all lane markings or lane or
roadway departures; accuracy will vary based on
weather, speed and lane marker condition. It is
always your responsibility to safely operate the
vehicle and avoid collisions.
You can read about handling information for the
camera equipped with this system.
2 Front Sensor Camera P. 532
Driving
2 Vehicle Customization P. 119
2 Customized Features P. 359
1Road Departure Mitigation (RDM) System
The RDM system may not work properly or may work
improperly under the certain conditions:
2 RDM Conditions and Limitations P. 530
There are times when you may not notice RDM
functions due to your operation of the vehicle, or
road surface conditions.
If the system operates several times without detecting driver response, the system
beeps to alert you.
Continued
527
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 528 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uRoad Departure Mitigation (RDM) System
■ How the System Activates
The system becomes ready to start searching for lane markings when all the
following conditions are met:
• The vehicle is traveling between about 45 and 90 mph (72 and 145 km/h).
• The vehicle is on a straight or slightly curved road.
• The turn signals are off.
• The brake pedal is not depressed.
• The wipers are not in continuous operation.
• The vehicle is not accelerating or braking, and the steering wheel is not being
turned.
• The system makes a determination that the driver is not actively accelerating,
braking or steering.
Driving
528
1How the System Activates
The RDM system may automatically shut off and the
indicator comes and stays on.
2 Indicators P. 76
RDM system function can be impacted when the
vehicle is:
• Not driven within a traffic lane.
• Driven on the inside edge of a curve, or outside of
a lane.
• Driven in a narrow lane.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 529 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uRoad Departure Mitigation (RDM) System
■ RDM On and Off
RDM Button
Indicator
1RDM On and Off
Press the RDM button to turn the system on
and off.
u The indicator in the button comes on and
the message appears on the driver
information interface when the system is
on.
When you have selected Warning Only from the
customized options using the driver information
interface or audio/information screen, the system
does not operate the steering wheel and braking.
2 Vehicle Customization P. 119
2 Customized Features P. 359
Driving
Continued
529
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 530 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uRoad Departure Mitigation (RDM) System
■ RDM Conditions and Limitations
The system may not properly detect lane markings and the position of your vehicle
under certain conditions. Some examples of these conditions are listed below.
■ Environmental conditions
Driving
530
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Driving in bad weather (rain, fog, snow, etc.).
Sudden changes between light and dark, such as an entrance or exit of a tunnel.
There is little contrast between lane lines and the roadway surface.
Driving into low sunlight (e.g., at dawn or dusk).
Strong light is reflected onto the roadway.
Driving in the shadows of trees, buildings, etc.
Shadows of adjacent objects are parallel to lane markings.
Roadway objects or structures are misinterpreted as lane markers.
Reflections on the interior of the windshield.
Driving at night or in a dark condition such as a tunnel.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 531 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uRoad Departure Mitigation (RDM) System
■ Roadway conditions
• Driving on a snowy or wet roadway (obscured lane marking, vehicle tracks,
reflected lights, road spray, high contrast).
• Driving on a road with temporary lane markings.
• Faint, multiple, or varied lane markings are visible on the roadway due to road
repairs or old lane markings.
• The roadway has merging, split, or crossing lines (e.g., such as at an intersection
or crosswalk).
• The lane markings are extremely narrow, wide, or changing.
• The vehicle in front of you is driving near the lane lines.
• The road is hilly or the vehicle is approaching the crest of a hill.
• Driving on rough or unpaved roads, or over bumpy surfaces.
• When objects on the road (curb, guard rail, pylons, etc.) are recognized as white
lines (or yellow lines).
• Driving on roads with double lines.
Driving
■ Vehicle conditions
• Headlight lenses are dirty or the headlights are not properly adjusted.
• The outside of the windshield is streaked or blocked by dirt, mud, leaves, wet
snow, etc.
• The inside of the windshield is fogged.
• The camera temperature gets too high.
• An abnormal tire or wheel condition (wrong sized, varied size or construction,
improperly inflated, compact spare tire, etc.).
• The vehicle is tilted due to a heavy load or suspension modifications.
• When tire chains are installed.
• The vehicle is towing a trailer.
531
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 532 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uFront Sensor Camera
Front Sensor Camera
The camera, used in systems such as LKAS, RDM, ACC, and CMBSTM, is designed to
detect an object that triggers any of the systems to operate its functions.
■ Camera Location and Handling Tips
Front Sensor
Camera
Driving
532
This camera is located behind the rearview
mirror.
To help reduce the likelihood that high interior
temperatures will cause the camera’s sensing
system to shut off, when parking, find a shady
area or face the front of the vehicle away from
the sun. If you use a reflective sun shade, do
not allow it to cover the camera housing.
Covering the camera can concentrate heat on
it.
1Front Sensor Camera
Never apply a film or attach any objects to the
windshield, the hood, or the front grille that could
obstruct the camera’s field of vision and cause the
system to operate abnormally.
Scratches, nicks, and other damage to the windshield
within the camera’s field of vision can cause the
system to operate abnormally. If this occurs, we
recommend that you replace the windshield with a
genuine Honda replacement windshield. Making
even minor repairs within the camera’s field of vision
or installing an aftermarket replacement windshield
may also cause the system to operate abnormally.
After replacing the windshield, have a dealer
recalibrate the camera. Proper calibration of the
camera is necessary for the system to operate
properly.
Do not place an object on the top of the instrument
panel. It may reflect onto the windshield and prevent
the system from detecting lane lines properly.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 533 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uFront Sensor Camera
1Front Sensor Camera
If the Some Driver Assist Systems Cannot
Operate: Camera Temperature Too High
message appears:
• Use the climate control system to cool down the
interior and, if necessary, also use defroster mode
with the airflow directed towards the camera.
• Start driving the vehicle to lower the windshield
temperature, which cools down the area around
the camera.
Driving
If the Some Driver Assist Systems Cannot
Operate: Clean Front Windshield
message
appears:
• Park your vehicle in a safe place, and clean the
windshield. If the message does not disappear after
you have cleaned the windshield and driven for a
while, have your vehicle checked by a dealer.
533
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 534 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuHonda Sensing®uRadar Sensor
Radar Sensor
The radar sensor is behind the emblem.
1Radar Sensor
Avoid strong impacts to the radar sensor cover.
For the CMBSTM to work properly:
The radar sensor
is located behind
the emblem.
Always keep the radar sensor cover clean.
Radar Sensor
Never use chemical solvents or polishing powder for
cleaning the sensor cover. Clean it with water or a
mild detergent.
Do not put a sticker on the radar sensor cover or
replace the radar sensor cover.
Driving
If you need the radar sensor to be repaired, or
removed, or the radar sensor cover is strongly
impacted, turn off the system by using the safety
support switch and take your vehicle to a dealer.
2 CMBSTM On and Off P. 496
If the vehicle is involved in any of the following
situations, the radar sensor may not work properly.
Have your vehicle checked by a dealer:
• Your vehicle is involved in a frontal collision
• Your vehicle drives through deep water or is
submerged in deep water
• Your vehicle strongly strikes a bump, curb, chock,
or embankment that could jar the radar sensor
534
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 535 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Braking
Brake System
■ Parking Brake
1Parking Brake
Use the parking brake to keep the vehicle stationary when parking.
To apply:
Depress the parking brake pedal down with
your foot.
NOTICE
Release the parking brake fully before driving. The
rear brakes and axle can be damaged if you drive
with the parking brake applied.
If you start driving without fully releasing the parking
brake, a buzzer sounds as a warning, and Release
Parking Brake appears on the driver information
interface.
Always apply the parking brake when parking.
To release:
1. Depress the brake pedal.
2. Depress the parking brake.
Driving
Continued
535
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 536 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBrakinguBrake System
■ Foot Brake
Your vehicle is equipped with disc brakes at all four wheels. A vacuum power assist
helps reduce the effort needed on the brake pedal. The brake assist system increases
the stopping force when you depress the brake pedal hard in an emergency
situation. The anti-lock brake system (ABS) helps you retain steering control when
braking very hard.
2 Brake Assist System P. 538
2 Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) P. 537
1Foot Brake
Check the brakes after driving through deep water,
or if there is a buildup of road surface water. If
necessary, dry the brakes by lightly depressing the
pedal several times.
If you hear a continuous metallic friction sound when
applying the brakes, this is caused by the brake wear
indicator rubbing on the brake rotor and indicates
that the brake pads need to be replaced. Have the
vehicle checked by a dealer. If you hear only an
occasional squeak or squeal when you initially apply
the brake pedal, this may be normal and caused by
high frequency vibration of the brake pads against
the rotating brake disc.
Driving
Constantly using the brake pedal while going down a
long hill builds up heat, which reduces the brake
effectiveness. Apply engine braking by taking your
foot off the accelerator pedal and downshifting to a
lower gear.
Do not rest your foot on the brake pedal while
driving, as it will lightly apply the brakes and cause
them to lose effectiveness over time and reduce pad
life. It will also confuse drivers behind you.
536
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 537 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBrakinguAnti-lock Brake System (ABS)
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)
■ ABS
Helps prevent the wheels from locking up, and helps you retain steering control by
pumping the brakes rapidly, much faster than you.
The electronic brake distribution (EBD) system, which is part of the ABS, also
balances the front-to-rear braking distribution according to vehicle loading.
You should never pump the brake pedal. Let the ABS work for you by always
keeping firm, steady pressure on the brake pedal. This is sometimes referred to as
“stomp and steer.”
ABS may activate when you depress the brake pedal when driving on:
• Wet or snow covered roads.
• Roads paved with stone.
• Roads with uneven surfaces, such as potholes, cracks, manholes, etc.
When the vehicle speed goes under 6 mph (10 km/h), the ABS stops.
NOTICE
The ABS may not function correctly if you use a tire of
the wrong size or type.
If the ABS indicator comes on while driving, there
may be a problem with the system.
While normal braking will not be affected, there is a
possibility that the ABS will not be operating. Have
your vehicle checked by a dealer immediately.
The ABS is not designed for the purpose of reducing
the time or distance it takes for a vehicle to stop: It is
designed to limit brake lockup which can lead to
skidding and loss of steering control.
In the following cases, your vehicle may need more
distance to stop than a vehicle without the ABS:
• You are driving on rough or uneven road surfaces,
such as gravel or snow.
• The tires are equipped with snow chains.
Driving
■ ABS operation
The brake pedal may pulsate slightly when the ABS is working. Depress the brake
pedal and keep holding the pedal firmly down. On dry pavement, you will need to
press on the brake pedal very hard before the ABS activates. However, you may feel
the ABS activate immediately if you are trying to stop on snow or ice.
1Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)
The following may be observed with the ABS system:
• Motor sounds coming from the engine
compartment when the brakes are applied, or when
system checks are being performed after the engine
has been started and while the vehicle accelerates.
• Brake pedal and/or the vehicle body vibration when
ABS activates.
These vibrations and sounds are normal to ABS
systems and are no cause for concern.
537
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 538 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBrakinguBrake Assist System
Brake Assist System
Designed to assist the driver by generating greater braking force when you depress
the brake pedal hard during emergency braking.
■ Brake assist system operation
Press the brake pedal firmly for more powerful braking.
When brake assist operates, the pedal may wiggle slightly and an operating noise
may be heard. This is normal. Keep holding the brake pedal firmly down.
Driving
538
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 539 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Parking Your Vehicle
When Stopped
1. Depress the brake pedal firmly.
2. Apply the parking brake.
3. Change the gear position to (P .
4. Turn off the engine.
1Parking Your Vehicle
3 WARNING
The vehicle can roll away if left unattended
without confirming that Park is engaged.
Always set the parking brake firmly, in particular if you are parked on an incline.
A vehicle that rolls away could cause a crash
resulting in serious injury or death.
Always keep your foot on the brake pedal
until you have confirmed that (P is shown
on the gear position Indicator.
1When Stopped
Driving
Do not park your vehicle near flammable objects,
such as dry grass, oil, or timber.
Heat from the exhaust can cause a fire.
NOTICE
The following can damage the transmission:
• Depressing the accelerator and brake pedals
simultaneously.
• Holding the vehicle in place when facing uphill by
depressing the accelerator pedal.
• Changing into (P before the vehicle stops
completely.
Continued
539
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 540 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuParking Your VehicleuWhen Stopped
1When Stopped
In extremely cold temperatures, the parking brake
may freeze up if applied. If such temperatures are
expected, do not apply the parking brake but, if
parking on a slope, either turn the front wheels so
they will contact the curb if the vehicle rolls down the
slope or block the wheels to keep the vehicle from
moving. If you do not take either precaution, the
vehicle may roll unexpectedly, leading to a crash.
Driving
540
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 541 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuParking Your VehicleuParking Sensor System *
Parking Sensor System *
The corner and center sensors monitor obstacles near your vehicle, and the beeper
and audio/information screen let you know the approximate distance between your
vehicle and the obstacle.
■ The sensor location and range
Front Corner Sensors
Rear Corner Sensors
Rear Center Sensors
1Parking Sensor System *
Even when the system is on, always confirm if there is
no obstacle near your vehicle before parking.
The system may not work properly when:
• The sensors are covered with snow, ice, mud or
dirt.
• The vehicle is on uneven surface, such as grass,
bumps, or a hill.
• The vehicle has been out in hot or cold weather.
• The system is affected by devices that emit
ultrasonic waves.
• Driving in bad weather.
The system may not sense:
or sponge.
Within about 26 in (65 cm) or less
Within about 45 in (115 cm) or less
• Objects directly under the bumper.
Driving
• Thin or low objects.
• Sonic-absorptive materials, such as snow, cotton,
Do not put any accessories on or around the sensors.
* Not available on all models
Continued
541
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 542 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuParking Your VehicleuParking Sensor System *
■ Parking sensor system on and off
With the power mode in ON, press the
parking sensor system button to turn on or off
the system. The indicator in the button comes
on when the system is on.
The front corner, rear center and rear corner
sensors start to detect an obstacle when the
transmission is in (R , and the vehicle speed is
less than 5 mph (8 km/h).
The front corner sensors start to detect an
obstacle when the transmission is not in (P ,
and the vehicle speed is less than 5 mph (8
km/h).
Driving
542
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 543 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuParking Your VehicleuParking Sensor System *
■ Screen Operation
1Screen Operation
You can switch between split view off and
split view on by touching the split screen tab.
Split View Off
The split screen tab disappears, and the split view
returns to the last camera view mode under the
following conditions:
• If the parking sensor system is turned off.
• If there is a malfunction in the system.
Split Screen
Tab
Split View On
Driving
Continued
543
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 544 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuParking Your VehicleuParking Sensor System *
■ When the distance between your vehicle and obstacles becomes shorter
Length of the
intermittent beep
Distance between the Bumper and Obstacle
Indicator
Corner Sensors
Center Sensors
Moderate
—
Rear: About 45-26 in
(115-65 cm)
Short
About 26-19 in
(65-50 cm)
About 26-19 in
(65-50 cm)
Very short
About 19-16 in
(50-40 cm)
About 19-16 in
(50-40 cm)
Continuous
About 16 in
(40 cm)
About 16 in
(40 cm)
Audio/information screen
Blinks in Yellow*1
Blinks in Amber
Driving
544
*1: At this stage, only the center sensors detect obstacles.
Indicators light where the
sensor detects an obstacle
Blinks in Red
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 545 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuParking Your VehicleuParking Sensor System *
■ Turning off All Rear Sensors
1. Make sure that the parking sensor system is not activated. Set the power mode to
VEHICLE OFF (LOCK).
2. Press and hold the parking sensor system button, and set the power mode to ON.
3. Keep pressing the button for 10 seconds. Release the button when the indicator
in the button flashes.
4. Press the button again. The indicator in the button goes off.
u The beeper sounds twice. The rear sensors are now turned off.
1Turning off All Rear Sensors
When you set the gear position to (R , the indicator
in the parking sensor system button blinks as a
reminder that the rear sensors have been turned off.
To turn the rear sensors on again, follow the above procedure. The beeper sounds
three times when the rear sensors come back on.
Driving
545
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 546 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuParking Your VehicleuCross Traffic Monitor *
Cross Traffic Monitor *
Monitors the rear corner areas using the radar sensors when reversing, and alerts
you if a vehicle approaching from a rear corner is detected.
The system is convenient when you are backing out of a parking space.
1Cross Traffic Monitor *
3 CAUTION
Cross Traffic Monitor cannot detect all
approaching vehicles and may not detect
an approaching vehicle at all.
Failure to visually confirm that it is safe to
back up the vehicle before doing so may
result in a collision.
Do not solely rely on the system when
reversing; always also use your mirrors, and
look behind and to the sides of your vehicle
before reversing.
Driving
546
* Not available on all models
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 547 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuParking Your VehicleuCross Traffic Monitor *
■ How the System Works
1Cross Traffic Monitor *
The system activates when:
• The power mode is in ON.
• The Cross Traffic Monitor is turned on.
2 Cross Traffic Monitor On and Off P. 549
• The transmission is in (R .
• Your vehicle is moving at 3 mph (5 km/h) or
lower.
Radar sensors:
Underneath the rear bumper
corners
The system will not detect a vehicle that approaches from directly behind your
vehicle, nor will it provide alerts about a detected vehicle when it moves directly
behind your vehicle.
The system does not provide alerts for a vehicle that is moving away from your
vehicle, and it may alert for pedestrians, bicycles, or stationary objects.
Driving
When a vehicle is detected approaching from a rear corner, Cross Traffic Monitor
alerts you with a buzzer and a displayed warning.
Cross Traffic Monitor may not detect or may delay
alerting an approaching vehicle, or may alert without
an approaching vehicle under the following
conditions:
• An obstacle, such as another vehicle and a wall,
near your vehicle's rear bumper, is blocking the
radar sensor's scope.
• Your vehicle is moving at the speed of about 3 mph
(5 km/h) or higher.
• A vehicle is approaching at the speed other than
between about 6 and 16 mph (10 and 25 km/h).
• The system picks up external interference such as
other radar sensors from another vehicle or strong
radio wave transmitted from a facility nearby.
• Either corner of the rear bumper is covered with
snow, ice, mud or dirt.
• When there is bad weather.
• Your vehicle is on an incline.
• Your vehicle is tilted due to a heavy load in the rear.
• Your vehicle is reversing towards a wall, a pole, a
vehicle, and so on.
The rear bumper or the sensors have been improperly
repaired or the rear bumper has been deformed.
Have a vehicle checked by a dealer.
For proper operation, always keep the rear bumper
corner area clean.
Do not cover the rear bumper corner area with labels
or stickers of any kind.
* Not available on all models
Continued
547
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 548 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuParking Your VehicleuCross Traffic Monitor *
■ When the System Detects a Vehicle
1When the System Detects a Vehicle
If the
on the lower right changes to
in amber
when the transmission is in (R , mud, snow or ice,
etc. may have accumulated in the vicinity of the
sensor. The system is temporarily canceled. Check the
bumper corners for any obstructions, and thoroughly
clean the area if necessary.
Arrow Icon
Normal View
Wide View
Top Down View
An arrow icon appears on the side a vehicle is approaching on the audio/information
screen.
Driving
548
If the
comes on when the transmission is in (R ,
there may be a problem with the Cross Traffic
Monitor system. Do not use the system and have your
vehicle checked by a dealer.
If the display remains the same with the transmission
in (R , there may be a problem with the rear camera
system and the Cross Traffic Monitor system.
Do not use the system and have your vehicle checked
by a dealer.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 549 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuParking Your VehicleuCross Traffic Monitor *
■ Cross Traffic Monitor On and Off
You can switch on and off the system using the audio/information screen.
1. Select
.
2. Select Settings.
3. Select Camera.
4. Select Rear Camera.
5. Select Cross Traffic Monitor.
6. Select ON or OFF.
The system can also be turned on and off on
the audio/information screen by pressing the
CTM icon.
Driving
Icon
549
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 550 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Multi-View Rear Camera
About Your Multi-View Rear Camera
The audio/information screen can display your vehicle’s rear view. The display
automatically changes to a rear view when the gear position is changed to (R .
■ Multi-View Rear Camera Display Area
Wide View Mode
Approx. 39
inches (1 m)
Approx. 20
inches (50 cm)
Tailgate Open
Range
The rear camera view is restricted. You cannot see
the corner ends of the bumper or what is underneath
the bumper. Its unique lens also makes objects
appear closer or farther than they actually are.
Visually confirm that it is safe to drive before backing up.
Certain conditions (such as weather, lighting, and high
temperatures) may also restrict the rear view. Do not rely
on the rearview display which does not give you all
information about conditions at the back of your vehicle.
Normal View Mode
If the camera lens is covered with dirt or moisture, use a
soft, moist cloth to keep the lens clean and free of debris.
Bumper
Driving
Guidelines
Camera
1About Your Multi-View Rear Camera
Models with color audio system
Top Down View Mode
You can change the Camera Guideline On or Off
settings.
2 Customized Features P. 352
Models with Display Audio
You can change the Fixed, Dynamic, Both and OFF
settings.
2 Customized Features P. 359
Fixed: Guidelines appear when you put the
transmission into (R .
Dynamic: Guidelines move according to the steering
wheel direction.
Both: Guidelines appear when you put the
transmission into (R and Guidelines move according
to the steering wheel direction.
OFF: Guidelines do not appear.
550
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 551 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuMulti-View Rear CamerauAbout Your Multi-View Rear Camera
You can view three different camera modes on the audio/information screen.
Models with color audio system
Press the selector knob to switch the angle.
Models with Display Audio
Select the appropriate icon to switch the angle.
: Wide view mode
: Normal view mode
: Top down view mode
Models with Display Audio
You can change the Last Used, Normal View and
Wide View settings.
2 Customized Features P. 359
Driving
• If you were last using Wide view mode or Normal view mode, the same view
mode will be activated the next time you put the transmission into (R .
• If you were using Top down view mode before you turned off the power system,
Wide view mode will be activated the next time you set the power mode to ON
and put the transmission into (R .
• If you were using Top down view mode and 10 seconds elapsed after you took
the transmission out of (R , Wide view mode will be activated the next time you
put the transmission into (R .
1About Your Multi-View Rear Camera
551
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 552 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Refueling
Fuel Information
■ Fuel recommendation
Unleaded gasoline, pump octane number 87 or higher
Use of a lower octane gasoline can cause a persistent, heavy metallic knocking noise
that can lead to engine damage.
■ Top tier detergent gasoline
Because the level of detergency and additives in gasoline vary in the market, Honda
endorses the use of “TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline” where available to help
maintain the performance and reliability of your vehicle. TOP TIER Detergent
Gasoline meets a new gasoline standard jointly established by leading automotive
manufacturers to meet the needs of today’s advanced engines.
Driving
Qualifying gasoline retailers will, in most cases, identify their gasoline as having met
“TOP TIER Detergent Gasoline” standards at the retail location. This fuel is
guaranteed to contain the proper level of detergent additives and be free of metallic
additives. The proper level of detergent additives, and absence of harmful metallic
additives in gasoline, help avoid build-up of deposits in your engine and emission
control system.
For further important fuel-related information for your vehicle, or on information on
gasoline that does not contain MMT, visit www.hondacars.com. In Canada, visit
www.honda.ca for additional information on gasoline. For more information on top
tier gasoline, visit www.toptiergas.com.
■ Fuel tank capacity: 19.5 US gal (73.8 L)
552
1Fuel Information
NOTICE
We recommend quality gasoline containing
detergent additives that help prevent fuel system and
engine deposits. In addition, in order to maintain
good performance, fuel economy, and emissions
control, we strongly recommend the use of gasoline
that does NOT contain harmful manganese-based
fuel additives such as MMT, if such gasoline is
available.
Use of gasoline with these additives may adversely
affect performance, and cause the malfunction
indicator lamp on your instrument panel to come on.
If this happens, contact a dealer for service. Some
gasoline today is blended with oxygenates such as
ethanol. Your vehicle is designed to operate on
oxygenated gasoline containing up to 15% ethanol
by volume. Do not use gasoline containing methanol.
If you notice any undesirable operating symptoms, try
another service station or switch to another brand of
gasoline.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 553 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuRefuelinguHow to Refuel
How to Refuel
Your fuel tank is not equipped with a fuel filler cap. You can insert the filler nozzle
directly into the filler neck. The tank seals itself again when you pull out the filler
nozzle.
1. Stop your vehicle with the service station
pump on the left side of the vehicle in the
Press
rear.
2. Turn off the engine.
3. Press the fuel fill door release button.
u The fuel fill door opens.
1How to Refuel
3 WARNING
Gasoline is highly flammable and explosive.
You can be burned or seriously injured
when handling fuel.
• Stop the engine, and keep heat, sparks,
and flame away.
• Handle fuel only outdoors.
• Wipe up spills immediately.
Driving
The fuel filler opening is designed to accept only
service station filler nozzles for refueling. Use of
smaller diameter tubes (e.g., those used to siphon
fuel for other uses) or other non-service station
devices can damage the area in and around the filler
opening.
The filler nozzle automatically stops to leave space in
the fuel tank so that fuel does not overflow as a result
of changes in air temperature.
Continued
553
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 554 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuRefuelinguHow to Refuel
4. Place the end of the filler nozzle on the
lower part of filler opening, then insert it
slowly and fully.
u Make sure that the end of the filler
nozzle goes down along with the filler
pipe.
u Keep the filler nozzle level.
u When the tank is full, the filler nozzle will
click off automatically.
u After filling, wait about five seconds
before removing the filler nozzle.
5. Shut the fuel fill door by hand.
Driving
554
1How to Refuel
If the filler nozzle keeps turning off when the tank is
not full, there may be a problem with the pump’s fuel
vapor recovery system. Try filling at another pump. If
this does not fix the problem, consult a dealer.
Do not continue to add fuel after the filler nozzle has
automatically stopped. Additional fuel can exceed
the full tank capacity.
If you have to refuel your vehicle from a portable
container, use the funnel provided with your vehicle.
2 Refueling From a Portable Fuel Container
P. 638
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 555 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Fuel Economy and CO2 Emissions
Improving Fuel Economy and Reducing CO2 Emissions
Achieving fuel economy and reducing CO2 emissions is dependent on several
factors, including driving conditions, load weight, idling time, driving habits, and
vehicle condition. Depending on these and other factors, you may not achieve the
rated fuel economy of this vehicle.
■ Maintenance and Fuel Economy
You can optimize your fuel economy with proper maintenance of your vehicle.
Always maintain your vehicle in accordance with the messages displayed on the
driver information interface.
• Use engine oil with the viscosity recommended.
2 Recommended Engine Oil P. 570
Direct calculation is the recommended method to
determine actual fuel consumed while driving.
Miles driven
Gallons of
fuel
Miles per
Gallon
100
Liter
Kilometers
L per 100 km
In Canada, posted fuel economy numbers are
established following a simulated test. For more
information on how this test is performed, please visit
http://oee.nrcan.gc.ca/
Driving
• Maintain the specified tire pressure.
• Do not load the vehicle with excess cargo.
• Keep your vehicle clean. A buildup of snow or mud on your vehicle’s underside
adds weight and increases wind resistance.
1Improving Fuel Economy and Reducing CO2 Emissions
555
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 556 ページ
556
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 557 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Maintenance
This chapter discusses basic maintenance.
Before Performing Maintenance
Inspection and Maintenance ............ 558
Safety When Performing Maintenance..... 559
Parts and Fluids Used in Maintenance
Service ........................................... 560
Maintenance MinderTM ..................... 561
Maintenance Under the Hood
Maintenance Items Under the Hood..... 567
Opening the Hood ........................... 568
Engine Compartment Cover............. 569
Recommended Engine Oil ................ 570
Oil Check ......................................... 571
Adding Engine Oil ............................ 572
Changing the Engine Oil and Oil Filter ..... 573
Engine Coolant ................................ 575
Transmission Fluid............................ 577
Brake Fluid....................................... 578
Refilling Window Washer Fluid......... 578
Replacing Light Bulbs ....................... 579
Checking and Maintaining Wiper
Blades .......................................... 584
Checking and Maintaining Tires
Checking Tires ................................. 588
Tire and Loading Information Label .. 589
Tire Labeling .................................... 589
Wear Indicators ............................... 593
Tire Service Life................................ 593
Tire and Wheel Replacement ........... 594
Tire Rotation.................................... 595
Winter Tires ..................................... 596
Battery............................................... 597
Remote Transmitter Care................. 599
Climate Control System Maintenance .....600
Cleaning
Interior Care .................................... 602
Exterior Care.................................... 604
Accessories and Modifications ........ 607
DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles) .. 591
557
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 558 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Before Performing Maintenance
Inspection and Maintenance
For your safety, perform all listed inspections and maintenance to keep your vehicle
in good condition. If you become aware of any abnormality (noise, smell, insufficient
brake fluid, oil residue on the ground, etc.), have your vehicle inspected by a dealer.
(Note, however, that service at a dealer is not mandatory to keep your warranties in
effect.)
■ Types of Inspection and Maintenance
■ Daily inspections
Perform inspections before long distance trips, when washing the vehicle, or when
refueling.
■ Periodic inspections
• Check the brake fluid level monthly.
2 Checking the Brake Fluid P. 578
• Check the tire pressure monthly. Examine the tread for wear and foreign objects.
2 Checking and Maintaining Tires P. 588
• Check the operation of the exterior lights monthly.
Maintenance
558
2 Replacing Light Bulbs P. 579
1Inspection and Maintenance
U.S. models
Maintenance, replacement, or repair of
emissions control devices and systems may be
done by any automotive repair establishment or
individuals using parts that are “certified” to
EPA standards.
According to state and federal regulations, failure to
perform maintenance on the maintenance main
items marked with # will not void your emissions
warranties. However, all maintenance services should
be performed in accordance with the intervals
indicated by the driver information interface.
2 Maintenance Service Items P. 564
If you want to perform complex maintenance tasks
that require more skills and tools, you can purchase a
subscription to the Service Express website at
www.techinfo.honda.com.
2 Authorized Manuals P. 651
• Check the condition of the wiper blades at least every six months.
2 Checking and Maintaining Wiper Blades P. 584
If you want to perform maintenance yourself, make
sure that you have the necessary tools and skills first.
After performing maintenance, update the records in
the separate maintenance booklet.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 559 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBefore Performing MaintenanceuSafety When Performing Maintenance
Safety When Performing Maintenance
Some of the most important safety precautions are given here. However, we cannot
warn you of every conceivable hazard that can arise in performing maintenance.
Only you can decide whether you should perform a given task.
■ Maintenance Safety
• To reduce the possibility of fire or explosion, keep cigarettes, sparks, and flames
away from the battery and all fuel related parts.
• Never leave rags, towels, or other flammable objects under the hood.
u Heat from the engine and exhaust can ignite them, causing a fire.
• To clean parts, use a commercially available degreaser or parts cleaner, not gasoline.
• Wear eye protection and protective clothing when working with the 12-volt
battery or compressed air.
• Engine exhaust contains carbon monoxide, which is poisonous and can kill you.
u Only operate the engine if there is sufficient ventilation.
■ Vehicle Safety
3 WARNING
Improperly maintaining this vehicle or
failing to correct a problem before driving
can cause a crash in which you can be
seriously hurt or killed.
Always follow the inspection and
maintenance recommendations according
to the schedules in this owner’s manual.
3 WARNING
Failure to properly follow maintenance
instructions and precautions can cause you
to be seriously hurt or killed.
Always follow the procedures and
precautions in this owner’s manual.
Maintenance
• The vehicle must be in a stationary condition.
u Make sure your vehicle is parked on level ground, the parking brake is set, and
the engine is off.
• Be aware that hot parts can burn you.
u Make sure to let the engine and exhaust system cool thoroughly before
touching vehicle parts.
• Be aware that moving parts can injure you.
u Do not start the engine unless instructed, and keep your hands and limbs away
from moving parts.
u Do not open the hood while the Auto Idle Stop function is activated.
1Safety When Performing Maintenance
559
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 560 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBefore Performing MaintenanceuParts and Fluids Used in Maintenance Service
Parts and Fluids Used in Maintenance Service
The use of Honda genuine parts and fluids is recommended when maintaining and
servicing your vehicle. Honda genuine parts are manufactured according to the
same high quality standards used in Honda vehicles.
Maintenance
560
1Parts and Fluids Used in Maintenance Service
Do not press the engine cover forcibly. This may
damage the engine cover and component parts.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 561 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Maintenance MinderTM
If the engine oil life is less than 15%, you will see the Maintenance Minder messages
appear on the driver information interface every time you set the power mode to
ON. The messages notify you when to change the engine oil, or when to bring your
vehicle to a dealer for indicated maintenance services.
Maintenance
561
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 562 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuMaintenance MinderTM uTo Use Maintenance MinderTM
To Use Maintenance MinderTM
■ Displaying the Maintenance Minder Information
Maintenance items, which should be serviced at the same time that you replace the
engine oil, appear on the driver information interface.
You can view them on the engine oil life screen at any time.
1. Set the power mode to ON.
2. Press the ENTER button repeatedly until home screen appears.
3. Select
Maintenance by pressing the 3 / 4 button repeatedly and press
ENTER.
4. Select Oil Life by pressing the 3 / 4 button and press ENTER.
5. The engine oil life appears on the screen.
Home Screen
Maintenance
562
Models with Display
Audio
3 Button
ENTER Button
4 Button
(Back)
Button
(Home)
Button
Models with color
audio system
3 Button
ENTER Button
4 Button
(Hangup/Back) Button
(Home)
Button
Engine Oil Life
1Displaying the Maintenance Minder Information
Based on the engine operating conditions, the
remaining engine oil life is calculated and displayed
as a percentage.
Displayed Engine Oil Calculated Engine Oil
Life (%)
Life (%)
100
100 to 91
90
90 to 81
80
80 to 71
70
70 to 61
60
60 to 51
50
50 to 41
40
40 to 31
30
30 to 21
20
20 to 16
15
15 to 11
10
10 to 6
5
5 to 1
0
0
There is a list of maintenance main and sub items you
can view on the driver information interface.
2 Maintenance Service Items P. 564
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 563 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuMaintenance MinderTM uTo Use Maintenance MinderTM
■ Maintenance Minder Messages on the Driver Information
Interface
Maintenance Message
Oil Life Display
Explanation
Information
Maintenance Due Soon
15%
The remaining engine oil life is 15 to 6
percent. Once you switch the display
*1/
*2, or
by pressing the
button, this message will go off.
The engine oil is approaching the end
of its service life, and the maintenance
items should be inspected and
serviced soon.
Maintenance Due Now
5%
The remaining engine oil life is 5 to 1
*1/
*2,
percent. Press the
or
button to switch to another
display.
The engine oil has almost reached the
end of its service life, and the
maintenance items should be
inspected and serviced as soon as
possible.
Maintenance Past Due
Negative Distance
Maintenance
The remaining engine oil life has
The engine oil life has passed.
passed its service life, and a negative The maintenance items must be
distance appears after driving over 10 inspected and serviced immediately.
miles (U.S. models) or 10 km
(Canadian models). Press the
*1
*2
/
, or
button to
switch to another display.
*1:Models with color audio system
*2:Models with Display Audio
The system message indicator ( ) comes on along with the Maintenance Minder message.
Continued
563
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 564 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuMaintenance MinderTM uTo Use Maintenance MinderTM
■ Maintenance Service Items
System Message
Indicator
1Maintenance Service Items
• Adjust the valves during services A, B, 1, 2, or 3 if
they are noisy.
Maintenance Minder Message
Main Item
Sub Items
U.S. models
CODE
A
B
●
●
●
●
Maintenance
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
Maintenance Main Items
Replace engine oil*1
Replace engine oil*1 and oil filter
Inspect front and rear brakes
Check parking brake adjustment
Inspect tie rod ends, steering gearbox, and boots
Inspect suspension components
Inspect driveshaft boots
Inspect brake hoses and lines (Including ABS/VSA®)
Inspect all fluid levels and condition of fluids
Inspect exhaust system#
Inspect fuel lines and connections#
*1: If the message Maintenance Due Now does not appear more than 12 months after the display
is reset, change the engine oil every year.
# : See information on maintenance and emissions warranty in the first column on page 649.
*2: If you drive in dusty conditions, replace every 15,000 miles (24,000 km).
*3: If you drive primarily in urban areas that have high concentrations of soot in the air from industry and
from diesel-powered vehicles, replace every 15,000 miles (24,000 km).
*4: If you drive regularly in very high temperatures (over 110°F, 43°C), in very low temperatures (under
-20°F, -29°C), replace every 60,000 miles (U.S.) /100,000 km (Canada).
564
* Not available on all models
CODE
1
2
●
●
●
●
3
4
●
●
●
●
5
6
7
●
●
●
Maintenance Sub Items
Rotate tires
Replace air cleaner element*2
Replace dust and pollen filter*3
Inspect drive belt
Replace transmission fluid and transfer fluid *
Replace spark plugs
Replace timing belt and inspect water pump*4
Inspect valve clearance
Replace engine coolant
Replace rear differential fluid *, *5
Replace brake fluid*6
*5: Driving in mountainous areas at very low vehicle speeds or trailer towing results in higher level of
mechanical (Shear) stress to fluid. This requires differential fluid changes more frequently than
recommended by the Maintenance Minder. If you regularly drive your vehicle under these conditions,
have the differential fluid changed at 7,500 miles (12,000 km), then every 15,000 miles (24,000 km).
*6: If a Maintenance Minder message does not appear more than 36 months after the display for item 7 is
reset, change the brake fluid every 3 years.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 565 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuMaintenance MinderTM uTo Use Maintenance MinderTM
Canadian models
1Maintenance Service Items
• Adjust the valves during services A, 0, 9, 1, 2, or 3
if they are noisy.
CODE
A
0
●
●
Maintenance Main Items
Replace engine oil*1
Replace engine oil*1 and oil filter
*1: If the message Maintenance Due Now does not appear more than 12 months after the display
is reset, change the engine oil every year.
*2: If you drive in dusty conditions, replace every 24,000 km (15,000 miles).
*3: If you drive primarily in urban areas that have high concentrations of soot in the air from industry and
from diesel-powered vehicles, replace every 24,000 km (15,000 miles).
*4: If you drive regularly in very high temperatures (over 43ºC, 110ºF), in very low temperatures (under
-29ºC, -20ºF), replace every 100,000 km (60,000 miles).
*5: Driving in mountainous areas at very low vehicle speeds or trailer towing results in higher level of
mechanical (Shear) stress to fluid. This requires differential fluid changes more frequently than
recommended by the Maintenance Minder. If you regularly drive your vehicle under these conditions,
have the differential fluid changed at 12,000km (7,500 miles), then every 24,000 km (15,000 miles).
*6: If a Maintenance Minder message does not appear more than 36 months after the display for item 7 is
reset, change the brake fluid every 3 years.
# : See information on maintenance and emissions warranty in the first column on page 649.
CODE
1
2
●
●
●
●
3
4
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
●
Continued
Maintenance
5
6
7
9
Maintenance Sub Items
Rotate tires
Replace air cleaner element*2
Replace dust and pollen filter*3
Inspect drive belt
Replace transmission fluid and transfer fluid
Replace spark plugs
Replace timing belt and inspect water pump*4
Inspect valve clearance
Replace engine coolant
Replace rear differential fluid*5
Replace brake fluid*6
Service front and rear brakes
Check parking brake adjustment
Inspect tie rod ends, steering gearbox, and boots
Inspect suspension components
Inspect driveshaft boots
Inspect brake hoses and lines (including ABS/VSA®)
Inspect all fluid levels and condition of fluids
Inspect exhaust system#
Inspect fuel lines and connections#
565
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 566 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuMaintenance MinderTM uTo Use Maintenance MinderTM
■ Resetting the Display
1Resetting the Display
Reset the maintenance minder information display if you have performed the
maintenance service.
NOTICE
Failure to reset the Maintenance MinderTM display
after a maintenance service results in the system
showing incorrect maintenance intervals, which can
lead to serious mechanical problems.
The dealer will reset the Maintenance MinderTM
display after completing the required maintenance
service. If someone other than a dealer performs
maintenance service, reset the Maintenance
MinderTM display yourself.
Models with Display Audio
3 Button
ENTER
Button
Maintenance
4 Button
1. Set the power mode to ON.
2. Display the engine oil life.
2 Displaying the Maintenance Minder Information P. 562
3. Press and hold the ENTER button for about 10 seconds to enter the reset mode.
4. Press the 3 / 4 button to select a maintenance item to reset, or to select All Due
Items (You can also select Cancel to end the process).
5. Press the ENTER button to reset the selected item.
6. Repeat from step 5 for other items you wish to reset.
566
You can also reset the Maintenance MinderTM display
using the audio/information screen.
2 Customized Features P. 359
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 567 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Maintenance Under the Hood
Maintenance Items Under the Hood
Engine Oil Fill Cap
Engine Oil Dipstick
(Orange)
Brake Fluid
(Black Cap)
Washer Fluid
Battery
Engine Coolant
Reserve Tank
Maintenance
Radiator Cap
567
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 568 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduOpening the Hood
Opening the Hood
1. Park the vehicle on a level surface, and set
the parking brake.
2. Pull the hood release handle under the
driver's side lower corner of the dashboard.
u The hood will pop up slightly.
Hood Release Handle
Pull
1Opening the Hood
NOTICE
Do not open the hood when the wiper arms are
raised.
The hood will strike the wipers, resulting in possible
damage to the hood and/or the wipers.
When closing the hood, check that the hood is
securely latched.
3. Pull up the hood latch lever (located under
the front edge of the hood to the center)
and raise the hood. Once you have raised
the hood slightly, you can release the lever.
Lever
If the hood latch lever moves stiffly, or if you can
open the hood without lifting the lever, the latch
mechanism should be cleaned and lubricated.
Do not open the hood while the Auto Idle Stop
function is activated.
Do not press the engine cover forcibly. This may
damage the engine cover and component parts.
Maintenance
Support Rod
Grip
Clamp
568
4. Remove the support rod from the clamp
using the grip. Mount the support rod in
the hood.
When closing, remove the support rod, and
stow it in the clamp, then gently lower the
hood. Remove your hand at a height of
approximately 12 inches (30 cm) and let the
hood close.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 569 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduEngine Compartment Cover
Engine Compartment Cover
The component parts in the engine compartment are protected by a cover.
You may need to remove the cover when you perform certain maintenance work.
Pull up on the engine compartment cover, remove it from the pins.
Engine Compartment Cover
Maintenance
569
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 570 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduRecommended Engine Oil
Recommended Engine Oil
Use a genuine engine oil or another commercial engine oil of suitable type and
viscosity (for the ambient temperature) as shown in the image that follows.
Oil is a major contributor to your engine’s performance and longevity. If you drive
the vehicle with insufficient or deteriorated oil, the engine may fail or be damaged.
Genuine Engine Oil
●
Honda Genuine Motor Oil
Maintenance
Ambient Temperature
Commercial Engine Oil
●
Premium-grade 0W-20 detergent oil
with an API Certification Seal on the
container.
Ambient Temperature
*1:Formulated to improve fuel economy.
■ Synthetic oil
You may also use synthetic motor oil if it is labeled with the API Certification Seal
and is the specified viscosity grade.
570
1Recommended Engine Oil
Engine Oil Additives
Your vehicle does not require oil additives. In fact,
they may adversely affect the engine performance
and durability.
The following seal indicates the oil is energy
conserving and that it meets the American Petroleum
Institute’s latest requirements.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 571 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduOil Check
Oil Check
We recommend that you check the engine oil level every time you refuel.
Park the vehicle on level ground.
Wait approximately three minutes after turning the engine off before you check the
oil.
1. Remove the dipstick (orange).
2. Wipe the dipstick with a clean cloth or
paper towel.
3. Insert the dipstick back all the way into its
hole.
1Oil Check
If the oil level is near or below the lower mark, slowly
add oil, being careful not to overfill.
4. Remove the dipstick again, and check the
level. It should be between the upper and
lower marks. Add oil if necessary.
Maintenance
Upper Mark
Lower Mark
571
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 572 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduAdding Engine Oil
Adding Engine Oil
1. Unscrew and remove the engine oil fill cap.
2. Add oil slowly.
3. Reinstall the engine oil fill cap, and tighten
it securely.
4. Wait for three minutes and recheck the
engine oil dipstick.
Engine Oil Fill Cap
Maintenance
572
1Adding Engine Oil
If any oil spills, wipe it away immediately. Spilled oil
may damage the engine compartment components.
NOTICE
Do not fill the engine oil above the upper mark.
Overfilling the engine oil can result in leaks and
engine damage.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 573 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduChanging the Engine Oil and Oil Filter
Changing the Engine Oil and Oil Filter
You must change the engine oil and oil filter regularly in order to maintain the
engine’s lubrication. The engine may be damaged if they are not changed regularly.
Change the oil and filter in accordance with the maintenance message on the driver
information interface.
1. Run the engine until it reaches normal
operating temperature, and then turn the
Drain Bolt
engine off.
2. Open the hood and remove the engine oil
fill cap.
3. Remove the drain bolt and washer from
the bottom of the engine, and drain the
Washer
oil into a suitable container.
1Changing the Engine Oil and Oil Filter
NOTICE
You may damage the environment if you do not
dispose of the oil in a suitable way. If you are
changing the oil by yourself, appropriately dispose of
the used oil. Put the oil in a sealed container and take
it to a recycling center. Do not throw the oil away
into a garbage can or onto the ground.
Maintenance
Continued
573
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 574 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduChanging the Engine Oil and Oil Filter
Oil Filter
Maintenance
574
4. Remove the oil filter and dispose of the
remaining oil.
5. Check that the filter gasket is not stuck to
the engine contact surface.
u If it is stuck, you must detach it.
6. Wipe away dirt and dust adhering to the
contact surface of the oil filter base, and
install a new oil filter.
u Apply a light coat of new engine oil to
the oil filter rubber seal.
7. Put a new washer on the drain bolt, then
reinstall the drain bolt.
u Tightening torque:
29 lbf∙ft (39 N∙m, 4.0 kgf∙m)
8. Pour the recommended engine oil into the
engine.
u Engine oil change capacity (including
filter):
5.7 US qt (5.4 L)
9. Reinstall the engine oil fill cap securely and
start the engine.
10. Run the engine for a few minutes, and
then check that there is no leak from the
drain bolt or oil filter.
11. Stop the engine, wait for three minutes,
and then check the oil level on the
dipstick.
u If necessary, add more engine oil.
1Changing the Engine Oil and Oil Filter
You will need a special wrench to replace the oil
filter. You can buy this wrench from a dealer.
When installing the new oil filter, follow the
instructions supplied with the oil filter.
Reinstall the engine oil fill cap. Start the engine. The
low oil pressure indicator should go off within five
seconds. If it does not, turn off the engine, and check
your work.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 575 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduEngine Coolant
Engine Coolant
1Engine Coolant
Specified coolant: Honda Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant Type 2
This coolant is premixed with 50% antifreeze and 50% water. Do not add any
straight antifreeze or water.
We recommend you check the engine coolant level every time you refuel. Check the
reserve tank first. If it is completely empty, also check the coolant level in the
radiator. Add the engine coolant accordingly.
3 WARNING
Removing the radiator cap while the
engine is hot can cause the coolant to spray
out, seriously scalding you.
Always let the engine and radiator cool
down before removing the radiator cap.
■ Reserve Tank
Reserve Tank
MAX
1. Make sure the engine and radiator are
cool.
2. Remove the engine compartment cover.
2 Engine Compartment Cover P. 569
If Honda antifreeze/coolant is not available, you may use
another major brand of non-silicate coolant as a
temporary replacement. Check that it is a high quality
coolant recommended for aluminum engines.
Continued use of any non-Honda coolant can result in
corrosion, causing the cooling system to malfunction or
fail. Have the cooling system flushed and refilled with
Honda antifreeze/coolant as soon as possible.
Maintenance
MIN
3. Check the amount of coolant in the reserve
tank.
u If the coolant level is below the MIN
mark, add the specified coolant until it
reaches the MAX mark.
4. Inspect the cooling system for leaks.
NOTICE
Genuine Honda engine coolant is a 50/50 mixture of
antifreeze and water that can withstand freezing at
temperatures as low as about -31°F (-35°C). If your
vehicle is consistently subjected to temperatures below
this, the concentration of antifreeze in the coolant
should be increased.Consult a dealer for details.
Do not add rust inhibitors or other additives to your
vehicle’s cooling system. They may not be compatible
with the coolant or with the engine components.
Continued
575
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 576 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduEngine Coolant
■ Radiator
Radiator
Cap
1Radiator
1. Make sure the engine and radiator are
cool.
2. Remove the engine compartment cover.
2 Engine Compartment Cover P. 569
3. Turn the radiator cap 1/8 turn counterclockwise and relieve any pressure in the
cooling system. Do not push the cap down
when turning.
4. Push down and turn the radiator cap
counter-clockwise to remove it.
5. The coolant level should be up to the base
of the filler neck. Add coolant if it is low.
6. Put the radiator cap back on, and tighten it
fully.
Maintenance
576
NOTICE
Pour the fluid slowly and carefully so you do not spill
any. Clean up any spills immediately; they can
damage components in the engine compartment.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 577 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduTransmission Fluid
Transmission Fluid
■ Automatic Transmission Fluid
Specified fluid: Honda Automatic Transmission Fluid ATF-TYPE 3.1 or
higher
Have a dealer check the fluid level and replace if necessary.
Do not attempt to check or change the automatic transmission fluid yourself.
1Automatic Transmission Fluid
Do not mix Honda ATF-TYPE 3.1 (or higher) with
other transmission fluids.
Using a transmission fluid other than Honda ATFTYPE 3.1 (or higher) may adversely affect the
operation and durability of your vehicle’s
transmission, and damage the transmission.
Any damage caused by using a transmission fluid that
is not equivalent to Honda ATF-TYPE 3.1 (or higher) is
not covered by Honda’s new vehicle limited warranty.
Maintenance
577
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 578 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuMaintenance Under the HooduBrake Fluid
Brake Fluid
Specified fluid: Honda Heavy Duty Brake Fluid DOT 3
NOTICE
■ Checking the Brake Fluid
The fluid level should be between the MIN
and MAX marks on the side of the reserve
tank.
Brake Reservoir
1Brake Fluid
MAX
Brake fluid marked DOT 5 is not compatible with your
vehicle’s braking system and can cause extensive
damage.
If the specified brake fluid is not available, you should
use only DOT 3 or DOT 4 fluid from a sealed
container as a temporary replacement.
Using any non-Honda brake fluid can cause corrosion
and decrease the longevity of the system. Have the
brake system flushed and refilled with Honda Heavy
Duty Brake Fluid DOT 3 as soon as possible.
MIN
If the brake fluid level is at or below the MIN mark,
have a dealer inspect the vehicle for leaks or worn
brake pads as soon as possible.
Maintenance
Refilling Window Washer Fluid
Models without washer level sensor
Open the cap and check the amount of
window washer fluid.
If the level is low, fill the washer reservoir.
Models with washer level sensor
If the washer fluid is low, a message appears
on the driver information interface.
Pour the washer fluid carefully. Do not overflow the reservoir.
578
1Refilling Window Washer Fluid
NOTICE
Do not use engine antifreeze or a vinegar/water
solution in the windshield washer reservoir.
Antifreeze can damage your vehicle’s paint. A
vinegar/water solution can damage the windshield
washer pump.
Use only commercially available windshield washer
fluid. Avoid prolonged use of hard water to prevent
lime scale build up.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 579 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Replacing Light Bulbs
Headlight Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
1Headlight Bulbs
High beam headlight: LED type
60 W (HB3 for halogen bulb type) *
Low beam headlight: LED type
*
NOTICE
Halogen bulbs get very hot when lit.
Oil, perspiration, or a scratch on the glass can cause
the bulb to overheat and shatter.
Models with halogen headlights
■ High Beam Headlights
Clips
Driver side
1. Remove the engine compartment cover.
The headlight aim is set by the factory, and does not
need to be adjusted. However, if you regularly carry
heavy items in the cargo area or tow a trailer, have
the aiming readjusted at a dealer or by a qualified
technician.
2 Engine Compartment Cover P. 569
2. Remove the clips.
3. Remove the air intake duct.
Low beam headlights are LED type. Have an
authorized Honda dealer inspect and replace the light
assembly.
Models with LED high beam headlights
High beam headlights are LED type. Have an
authorized Honda dealer inspect and replace the light
assembly.
Air Intake Duct
* Not available on all models
Continued
Maintenance
Models with halogen high beam headlights
When replacing a halogen bulb, handle it by its base,
and protect the glass from contact with your skin or
hard objects. If you touch the glass, clean it with
denatured alcohol and a clean cloth.
579
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 580 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuDaytime Running Lights and Parking Lights
Both sides
Bulb
Tab
Coupler
4. Push the tab to remove the coupler.
5. Rotate the old bulb counter-clockwise to
remove.
6. Insert a new bulb into the headlight
assembly and turn it clockwise.
7. Insert the coupler into the connector of the
bulb.
1Headlight Bulbs
Remove the clip using a Phillips-head screwdriver.
Center pin
Daytime Running Lights and Parking Lights
Daytime running lights and parking lights are LED type. Have an authorized Honda
dealer inspect and replace the light assembly.
Front Side Marker Lights
Maintenance
580
Front side marker lights are LED type. Have an authorized Honda dealer inspect and
replace the light assembly.
Insert the clip with the center pin raised, and push
until it is flat.
Push until the
pin is flat.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 581 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuFront Turn Signal Light Bulbs
Front Turn Signal Light Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
Front Turn Signal Light: 28/8W (Amber)
1. Remove the screws, pull the inner fender
back.
Screws
Bulb
2. Turn the socket counter-clockwise and
remove it.
3. Remove the old bulb and insert a new bulb.
Socket
Maintenance
Fog Lights *
Fog lights are LED type. Have an authorized Honda dealer inspect and replace the
light assembly.
* Not available on all models
581
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 582 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuSide Turn Signal/Emergency Indicator Lights *
Side Turn Signal/Emergency Indicator Lights *
Side turn lights are LED type. Have an authorized Honda dealer inspect and replace
the light assembly.
Brake/Taillight, Rear Side Marker Light, and Rear
Turn Signal Light Bulbs
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
Brake/Taillight: LED
Rear Side Marker Light: LED
Rear Turn Signal Light: 21W (Amber)
1. Use a Phillips-head screwdriver to remove
the bolts.
2. Pull the light assembly out of the rear pillar.
Bolts
Maintenance
3. Turn the socket counter-clockwise and
remove it. Remove the old bulb.
4. Insert a new bulb and turn clockwise.
5. Slide the light assembly onto the guide on
the body.
6. Align the pins with the body grommets,
then push in until they fully seat.
Bulb
582
Socket
* Not available on all models
1Brake/Taillight, Rear Side Marker Light, and Rear Turn Signal
Light Bulbs
Brake/taillights and rear side marker lights are LED
type. Have an authorized Honda dealer inspect and
replace the light assembly.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 583 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuReplacing Light BulbsuBack-Up Lights
Back-Up Lights
When replacing, use the following bulbs.
Back-Up Lights: 21 W
Socket
1. Turn the socket counter-clockwise and
remove it. Remove the old bulb.
2. Insert a new bulb and turn clockwise.
Bulb
Rear License Plate Lights
Rear license plate lights are LED type. Have an authorized Honda dealer inspect and
replace the light assembly.
High-mount brake light is LED type. Have an authorized Honda dealer inspect and
replace the light assembly.
Maintenance
High-Mount Brake Light
583
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 584 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Checking and Maintaining Wiper Blades
Checking Wiper Blades
If the wiper blade rubber has deteriorated, it will leave streaks and the hard surfaces
of the blade may scratch the window glass.
Changing the Front Wiper Blade Rubber
1. Lift the driver side wiper arm first, then the
passenger side.
1Changing the Front Wiper Blade Rubber
NOTICE
Avoid dropping the wiper arm onto the windshield, it
may damage the wiper arm and/or the windshield.
Lock Tab
Maintenance
584
2. Place a cloth on the edge of the lock tab.
Push the lock tab up with a flat-tip screw
driver.
3. Slide the blade from the wiper arm.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 585 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuChecking and Maintaining Wiper BladesuChanging the Front Wiper Blade Rubber
4. Slide the wiper blade out of the holder by
pulling the tabbed end out.
Blade
Blade
5. Remove the retainers from the wiper blade
that has been removed, and mount to a
new wiper blade.
u Correctly align the wiper blade
protrusion and the retainer grooves.
Retainer
Maintenance
6. Slide the new wiper blade onto the holder
from the bottom end.
u The tab on the holder should fit in the
indent of the wiper blade.
7. Slide the holder onto the wiper arm, then
push down the lock tab.
8. Lower the passenger side wiper arm first,
then the driver side.
585
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 586 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuChecking and Maintaining Wiper BladesuChanging the Rear Wiper Blade Rubber
Changing the Rear Wiper Blade Rubber
1. Raise the wiper arm off.
2. Pivot the bottom end of the wiper blade up
until it comes off from the wiper arm.
Wiper
Blade
Wiper Arm
3. Slide the blade out of the holder.
Blade
Maintenance
4. Remove the retainers from wiper blade and
mount it to a new rubber blade.
Retainer
Rubber
586
1Changing the Rear Wiper Blade Rubber
NOTICE
Avoid dropping the wiper arm, it may damage the
rear window.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 587 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuChecking and Maintaining Wiper BladesuChanging the Rear Wiper Blade Rubber
5. Slide the new wiper blade onto the holder.
u Make sure it is engaged correctly, then
install the wiper blade assembly onto the
wiper arm.
Maintenance
587
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 588 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Checking and Maintaining Tires
Checking Tires
To safely operate your vehicle, your tires must be of the proper type and size, in
good condition with adequate tread, and properly inflated.
■ Inflation guidelines
Properly inflated tires provide the best combination of handling, tread life, and comfort.
Refer to the driver’s doorjamb label or specifications page for the specified pressure.
Underinflated tires wear unevenly, adversely affect handling and fuel economy, and
are more likely to fail from overheating.
Overinflated tires make your vehicle ride harshly, are more prone to road hazards,
and wear unevenly.
Every day before you drive, look at each of the tires. If one looks lower than the
others, check the pressure with a tire gauge.
Maintenance
At least once a month or before long trips, use a gauge to measure the pressure in
all tires, including the spare. Even tires in good condition can lose 1-2 psi (10-20 kPa,
0.1-0.2 kgf/cm2) per month.
■ Inspection guidelines
Every time you check inflation, also examine the tires and valve stems.
Look for:
• Bumps or bulges on the side or in the tread. Replace the tire if you find any cuts,
splits, or cracks in the side of the tire. Replace it if you see fabric or cord.
• Remove any foreign objects and inspect for air leaks.
• Uneven tread wear. Have a dealer check the wheel alignment.
• Excessive tread wear.
2 Wear Indicators P. 593
• Cracks or other damage around valve stem.
588
1Checking Tires
3 WARNING
Using tires that are excessively worn or
improperly inflated can cause a crash in
which you can be seriously hurt or killed.
Follow all instructions in this owner’s
manual regarding tire inflation and
maintenance.
Measure the air pressure when tires are cold. This
means the vehicle has been parked for at least three
hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km). If
necessary, add or release air until the specified
pressure is reached.
If checked when hot, tire pressure can be as much as
4–6 psi (30–40 kPa, 0.3–0.4 kgf/cm2) higher than if
checked when cold.
Have a dealer check the tires if you feel a consistent
vibration while driving. New tires and any that have
been removed and reinstalled should be properly
balanced.
Check the spare tire pressure once a month or before
long trips.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 589 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuTire and Loading Information Label
Tire and Loading Information Label
The label attached to the driver’s doorjamb provides necessary tire and loading
information.
Label
Example
1Tire and Loading Information Label
The tire and loading information label attached to the
driver’s doorjamb contains:
a The number of people your vehicle can carry.
b The total weight your vehicle can carry. Do not
exceed this weight.
c The original tire sizes for front, rear, and spare.
d The proper cold tire pressure for front, rear, and
spare.
Tire Labeling
Example
Tire Size
Tire
Identification
Number (TIN)
The tires that came on your vehicle have a
number of markings. Those you should be
aware of are described as shown.
Maximum
Tire Pressure
Tire Size
■ Tire Sizes
Whenever tires are replaced, they should be replaced with tires of the same size.
Continued
Following is an example of tire size with an
explanation of what each component means.
P235/60R18 102V
P: Vehicle type (P indicates passenger vehicle).
235: Tire width in millimeters.
60: Aspect ratio (the tire’s section height as a
percentage of its width).
R: Tire construction code (R indicates radial).
18: Rim diameter in inches.
102: Load index (a numerical code associated with
the maximum load the tire can carry).
V: Speed symbol (an alphabetical code indicating the
maximum speed rating).
Maintenance
Maximum
Tire Load
1Tire Sizes
589
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 590 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuTire Labeling
■ Tire Identification Number (TIN)
The tire identification number (TIN) is a group of numbers and letters that look like
the example in the side column. TIN is located on the sidewall of the tire.
■ Glossary of Tire Terminology
Maintenance
590
Cold Tire Pressure – The tire air pressure when the vehicle has been parked for at
least three hours or driven less than 1 mile (1.6 km).
Load Rating – Means the maximum load that a tire is rated to carry for a given
inflation pressure.
Maximum Inflation Pressure – The maximum tire air pressure that the tire can
hold.
Maximum Load Rating – Means the load rating for a tire at the maximum
permissible inflation pressure for that tire.
Recommended Inflation Pressure – The cold tire inflation pressure recommended
by the manufacturer.
Treadwear Indicators (TWI) – Means the projections within the principal grooves
designed to give a visual indication of the degrees of wear of the tread.
1Tire Identification Number (TIN)
DOT B97R FW6X 2209
DOT: This indicates that the tire meets all
requirements of the U.S. Department of
Transportation.
B97R: Manufacturer’s identification mark.
FW6X: Tire type code.
22 09: Date of manufacture.
Year
Week
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 591 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuDOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
The tires on your vehicle meet all U.S. Federal Safety
Requirements. All tires are also graded for treadwear, traction,
and temperature performance according to Department of
Transportation (DOT) standards. The following explains these
gradings.
■ Uniform Tire Quality Grading
Quality grades can be found where applicable on the tire sidewall
between tread shoulder and maximum section width.
Continued
For example:
Treadwear 200
Traction AA
Temperature A
All passenger car tires must conform
to Federal Safety Requirements in
addition to these grades.
Maintenance
■ Treadwear
The treadwear grade is a comparative rating based on the wear
rate of the tire when tested under controlled conditions on a
specified government test course. For example, a tire graded 150
would wear one and one-half (1 1/2) times as well on the
government course as a tire graded 100. The relative performance
of tires depends upon the actual conditions of their use, however,
and may depart significantly from the norm due to variations in
driving habits, service practices and differences in road
characteristics and climate.
1Uniform Tire Quality Grading
591
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 592 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuDOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
Maintenance
592
■ Traction
The traction grades, from highest to lowest, are AA, A, B, and C.
Those grades represent the tire’s ability to stop on wet pavement
as measured under controlled conditions on specified
government test surfaces of asphalt and concrete. A tire marked
C may have poor traction performance.
1Traction
■ Temperature
The temperature grades are A (the highest), B, and C,
representing the tire’s resistance to the generation of heat and its
ability to dissipate heat when tested under controlled conditions
on a specified indoor laboratory test wheel. Sustained high
temperature can cause the material of the tire to degenerate and
reduce tire life, and excessive temperature can lead to sudden tire
failure. The grade C corresponds to a level of performance which
all passenger car tires must meet under the Federal Motor Vehicle
Safety Standard No. 109. Grades B and A represent higher levels
of performance on the laboratory test wheel than the minimum
required by law.
1Temperature
Warning: The traction grade
assigned to this tire is based on
straight-ahead braking traction tests,
and does not include acceleration,
cornering, hydroplaning, or peak
traction characteristics.
Warning: The temperature grade for
this tire is established for a tire that is
properly inflated and not
overloaded. Excessive speed,
underinflation, or excessive loading,
either separately or in combination,
can cause heat buildup and possible
tire failure.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 593 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuWear Indicators
Wear Indicators
Example of a Wear
Indicator mark
The groove where the wear indicator is
located is 1/16 inch (1.6 mm) shallower than
elsewhere on the tire. If the tread has worn so
that the indicator is exposed, replace the tire.
Worn out tires have poor traction on wet
roads.
Tire Service Life
The life of your tires is dependent on many factors, including driving habits, road
conditions, vehicle loading, inflation pressure, maintenance history, speed, and
environmental conditions (even when the tires are not in use).
Maintenance
In addition to regular inspections and inflation pressure maintenance, it is
recommended that you have annual inspections performed once the tires reach five
years old. All tires, including the spare, should be removed from service after 10
years from the date of manufacture, regardless of their condition or state of wear.
593
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 594 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuTire and Wheel Replacement
Tire and Wheel Replacement
Replace your tires with radials of the same size, load range, speed rating, and
maximum cold tire pressure rating (as shown on the tire's sidewall). Using tires of a
different size or construction can cause certain vehicle systems such as the ABS and
Vehicle Stability Assist® (VSA®) system to work incorrectly.
It is best to replace all four tires at the same time. If that isn’t possible, replace the
front or rear tires in pairs.
If you replace a wheel, only use TPMS specified wheels approved for your vehicle.
Make sure that the wheel’s specifications match those of the original wheels.
Maintenance
594
1Tire and Wheel Replacement
3 WARNING
Installing improper tires on your vehicle can
affect handling and stability. This can cause
a crash in which you can be seriously hurt or
killed.
Always use the size and type of tires
recommended in this owner’s manual.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 595 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuTire Rotation
Tire Rotation
Rotating tires according to the maintenance messages on the driver information
interface helps to distribute wear more evenly and increase tire life.
■ Tires without rotation marks
Rotate the tires as shown here.
Front
1Tire Rotation
Tires with directional tread patterns should only be
rotated front to back (not from one side to the other).
Directional tires should be mounted with the rotation
indication mark facing forward, as shown below.
Front
Rotation Mark
■ Tires with rotation marks
Rotate the tires as shown here.
Maintenance
Front
595
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 596 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuChecking and Maintaining TiresuWinter Tires
Winter Tires
If driving on snowy or frozen roads, mount all season marked M+S tires, snow tires,
or tire chains; reduce speed; and maintain sufficient distance between vehicles when
driving.
Be particularly careful when operating the steering wheel or brakes to prevent
skidding.
1Winter Tires
3 WARNING
Using the wrong chains, or not properly
installing chains, can damage the brake
lines and cause a crash in which you can be
seriously injured or killed.
Use tire chains, snow tires, or all season tires when necessary or according to the law.
When mounting, refer to the following points.
For winter tires:
• Select the size and load ranges that are the same as the original tires.
• Mount the tires to all four wheels.
For tire chains:
• Install them on the front tires only.
• Because your vehicle has limited tire clearance, we strongly recommend using the
chains listed below:
Maintenance
Models with 245/50R20 tires
Cable-type: SCC Super Z LT ZT735
Models with 265/45R20 tires
Cable-type: SCC Super Z6 SZ435
• Follow the chain manufacturer’s instruction when installing. Mount them as
tightly as you can.
• Check that the chains do not touch the brake lines or suspension.
• Drive slowly.
596
Follow all instructions in this owner’s
manual regarding the selection and use of
tire chains.
NOTICE
Traction devices that are the wrong size or improperly
installed can damage your vehicle’s brake lines,
suspension, body, and wheels. Stop driving if they are
hitting any part of the vehicle.
When tire chains are mounted, follow the chain
manufacturer’s instructions regarding vehicle
operational limits.
If your vehicle is equipped with summer tires, be
aware that these tires are not designed for winter
driving conditions. For more information, contact a
dealer.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 597 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Battery
Checking the Battery
The condition of the battery is monitored by a
sensor located on the negative terminal of the
battery. If there is a problem with this sensor,
the driver information interface will display a
warning message. If this happens, have your
vehicle inspected by a dealer.
1Battery
3 WARNING
The battery gives off explosive hydrogen
gas during normal operation.
A spark or flame can cause the battery to
explode with enough force to kill or
seriously hurt you.
Check the battery terminals for corrosion monthly.
To access the battery terminals:
1. Remove the engine compartment cover.
When conducting any battery
maintenance, wear protective clothing and
a face shield, or have a skilled technician do
it.
2 Engine Compartment Cover P. 569
2. Remove the clips using a Phillips-head screwdriver, then remove the air intake
duct.
2 High Beam Headlights P. 579
2 Audio System Theft Protection P. 229
• The clock resets *.
2 Clock P. 130
When you find corrosion, clean the battery terminals
by applying a baking powder and water solution.
Clean the terminals with a damp towel. Cloth/towel
dry the battery. Coat the terminals with grease to
help prevent future corrosion.
Maintenance
If your vehicle’s battery is disconnected or goes dead:
• The audio system is disabled.
WARNING: Battery post, terminals,
and related accessories contain lead
and lead compounds.
Wash your hands after handling.
When replacing the battery, the replacement must be
of the same specifications.
Consult a dealer for more information.
* Not available on all models
597
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 598 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuBatteryuCharging the AGM Battery
Charging the AGM Battery
AGM labeled batteries like those installed in your vehicle require a compatible
charger to be properly charged. Damage to the battery can result if the battery is
charged improperly or with the wrong equipment. For more information on how to
charge your vehicle’s AGM battery, consult a dealer.
Maintenance
598
1Battery
The battery installed in this vehicle is specifically
designed for a model with Auto Idle Stop.
Using a battery other than this specified type may
shorten the battery life, and prevent Auto Idle Stop
from activating. If you need to replace the battery,
make sure to select the specified type. Ask a dealer
for more details.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 599 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Remote Transmitter Care
Replacing the Button Battery
If the indicator does not come on when the button is pressed, replace the battery.
1Replacing the Button Battery
Battery type: CR2032
1. Remove the built-in key.
Battery
2. Remove the upper half of the cover by
carefully prying on the edge with a coin.
u Remove carefully to avoid losing the
buttons.
u Wrap a coin with a cloth to prevent
scratching the transmitter.
3. Make sure to replace the battery with the
correct polarity.
3 WARNING
CHEMICAL BURN HAZARD
The battery that powers the remote
transmitter can cause severe internal burns
and can even lead to death if swallowed.
Keep new and used batteries away from
children.
If you suspect that a child has swallowed
the battery, seek medical attention
immediately.
NOTICE
An improperly disposed of battery can damage the
environment. Always confirm local regulations for
battery disposal.
Maintenance
Replacement batteries are commercially available or
at a dealer.
599
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 600 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Climate Control System Maintenance
Air Conditioning
To ensure proper and safe operation, the Society of Automotive Engineers (SAE
J2845) recommends that the refrigerant system only be serviced by trained and
certified technicians.
1Climate Control System Maintenance
NOTICE
Never repair or replace the air conditioning evaporator (cooling coil) with one
removed from a used or salvaged vehicle.
Vented refrigerant is harmful to the environment.
To avoid refrigerant from venting, never replace the
evaporator with one removed from a used or
salvaged vehicle.
New replacement mobile air conditioning evaporators must be certified (and
labeled) as meeting SAE Standard J2842.
Refrigerant in your vehicle’s air conditioning system is
flammable and can be ignited during servicing if
proper procedures are not followed.
The air conditioner label is found under the hood:
2 Safety Labels P. 74
2 Specifications P. 642
Canadian models
: Caution
: Flammable Refrigerant
Maintenance
600
: Requires Registered
Technician to Service
: Air Conditioning
System
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 601 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuClimate Control System MaintenanceuDust and Pollen Filter
Dust and Pollen Filter
The climate control system is equipped with a dust and pollen filter that collects
pollen, dust, and other debris in the air. The Maintenance MinderTM messages will let
you know when to replace the filter.
We recommend that you replace the dust and pollen filter sooner when using your
vehicle in areas with high concentrations of dust.
1Dust and Pollen Filter
If the airflow from the climate control system
deteriorates noticeably, and the windows fog up
easily, the filter may need to be replaced. Please
contact a dealer for replacement.
Maintenance
601
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 602 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Cleaning
Interior Care
Use a damp cloth with a mixture of mild detergent and warm water to remove dirt.
Use a clean cloth to remove detergent residue.
■ Cleaning Seat Belts
Use a soft brush with a mixture of mild soap and warm water to clean the seat belts.
Let the belts air dry. Wipe the loops of the seat belt anchors using a clean cloth.
Loop
1Interior Care
Do not spill liquids inside the vehicle.
Electrical devices and systems may malfunction if
liquids are splashed on them.
Do not use silicone based sprays on electrical devices
such as audio devices and switches.
Doing so may cause the items to malfunction or
cause a fire inside the vehicle.
If a silicone based spray is inadvertently used on
electrical devices, consult a dealer.
Depending on their composition, chemicals and
liquid aromatics may cause discoloration, wrinkles,
and cracking to resin-based parts and textiles.
Do not use alkali solvents or organic solvents such as
benzene or gasoline.
Maintenance
After using chemicals, make sure to gently wipe them
away using a dry cloth.
Do not place used cloths on top of resin based parts
or textiles for long periods of time without washing.
■ Cleaning the Window
Wipe using a glass cleaner.
1Cleaning the Window
Wires are mounted to the inside of the rear window.
Wipe along the same direction as the wires with a
soft cloth so as not to damage them.
Be careful not to spill fluids, such as water or glass
cleaner, on or around the cover of both the front
sensor camera and the rainfall/light sensor *.
602
* Not available on all models
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 603 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCleaninguInterior Care
■ Floor Mats
Unlock
Lock
1Floor Mats
The front and rear floor mats hook over floor
anchors, which keep them from sliding
forward. To remove a mat for cleaning, turn
the anchor knobs to the unlock position.
When reinstalling the mat after cleaning, turn
the knobs to the lock position.
Do not put additional floor mats on top of
the anchored mats.
■ Maintaining Genuine Leather *
1Maintaining Genuine Leather *
It is important to clean or wipe away dirt or dust as
soon as possible. Spills can soak into leather resulting
in stains. Dirt or dust can cause abrasions in the
leather. In addition, please note that some dark
colored clothing can rub onto the leather seats
resulting in discoloration or stains.
Maintenance
To properly clean leather:
1. Use a vacuum or soft dry cloth first to remove any dirt or dust.
2. Clean the leather with a soft cloth dampened with a solution comprised of 90%
water and 10% neutral soap.
3. Wipe away any soap residue with a clean damp cloth.
4. Wipe away residual water and allow leather to air dry in the shade.
* Not available on all models
If you use any floor mats that were not originally
provided with your vehicle, make sure they are
designed for your specific vehicle, fit correctly, and
are securely anchored by the floor anchors.
Position the rear seat floor mats properly. If they are
not properly positioned, the floor mats can interfere
with the front seat functions.
603
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 604 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCleaninguExterior Care
Exterior Care
Dust off the vehicle body after you drive.
Regularly inspect your vehicle for scratches on painted surfaces. A scratch on a
painted surface can result in body rust. If you find a scratch, promptly repair it.
■ Washing the Vehicle
Wash the vehicle regularly. Wash more frequently when driving in the following
conditions:
• If driving on roads with road salt.
• If driving in coastal areas.
• If tar, soot, bird droppings, insects, or tree sap are stuck to painted surfaces.
1Washing the Vehicle
Do not spray water into the air intake vents. It can
cause a malfunction.
■ Using an Automated Car Wash
Maintenance
604
• Fold in the door mirrors.
• For models equipped with automatic intermittent wipers, turn the wipers off.
• Make sure to follow the instructions indicated on the automated car wash.
If you use a conveyor type automatic car wash, keep the transmission in (N position.
2 If you want to keep the transmission in (N position [car wash mode] P. 464
■ Using High Pressure Cleaners
• Keep sufficient distance between the cleaning nozzle and the vehicle body.
• Take particular care around the windows. Standing too close may cause water to
enter the vehicle interior.
• Do not spray high pressure water directly into the engine compartment. Instead,
use low pressure water and a mild detergent.
Air Intake Vents
Do not spray water onto the capless unit when the
fuel fill door is open. It can cause damage to the fuel
system or engine.
When using an automated car wash that pulls the
vehicle through with a conveyor, make sure vehicle is
in car wash mode.
2 If you want to keep the transmission in (N
position [car wash mode] P. 464
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 605 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCleaninguExterior Care
■ Applying Wax
1Applying Wax
A good coat of automotive body wax helps protect your vehicle’s paint from the
elements. Wax will wear off over time and expose your vehicle’s paint to the
elements, so reapply as necessary.
■ Maintaining the Bumpers and Other Resin Coated Parts
If you get gasoline, oil, engine coolant, or battery fluid on resin coated parts, they
may be stained or the coating may peel. Promptly wipe it away using a soft cloth and
clean water.
NOTICE
Chemical solvents and strong cleaners can damage
the paint, metal, and plastic on your vehicle. Wipe
away spills immediately.
1Maintaining the Bumpers and Other Resin Coated Parts
Ask a dealer about the correct coating material when
you want to repair the painted surface of the parts
made of resin.
■ Cleaning the Window
Wipe using a glass cleaner.
■ Maintaining Aluminum Wheels
Continued
Maintenance
Aluminum is susceptible to deterioration caused by salt and other road
contaminants. When necessary, as early as possible use a sponge and mild detergent
to wipe away these contaminants. Do not use a stiff brush or harsh chemicals
(including some commercial wheel cleaners). These can damage the protective finish
on aluminum alloy wheels, resulting in corrosion. Depending on the type of finish,
the wheels also may lose their luster or appear burnished. To avoid water stains,
wipe the wheels dry with a cloth while they are still wet.
605
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 606 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuCleaninguExterior Care
■ Fogged Exterior Light Lenses
The inside lenses of exterior lights (headlights, brake lights, etc.) may fog temporarily
if you have driven in the rain, or after the vehicle has been run through a car wash.
Dew condensation also may build up inside the lenses when there is a significant
enough difference between the ambient and inside lens temperatures (similar to
vehicle windows fogging up in rainy conditions). These conditions are natural
processes, not structural design problems in the exterior lights.
Lens design characteristics may result in moisture developing on the light lens frame
surfaces. This also is not a malfunction.
However, if you see large amounts of water accumulation, or large water drops
building up inside the lenses, have your vehicle inspected by a dealer.
Maintenance
606
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 607 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Accessories and Modifications
Accessories
When installing accessories, check the following:
• Do not install accessories on the windshield. They can obstruct your view and
delay your reaction to driving conditions.
• Do not install any accessories over areas marked SRS Airbag, on the sides or backs
of the front seats, on front or side pillars, or near the side windows.
Accessories installed in these areas may interfere with proper operation of the
vehicle’s airbags or may be propelled into you or another occupant if the airbags
deploy.
• Be sure electronic accessories do not overload electrical circuits or interfere with
proper operation of your vehicle.
2 Fuses P. 631
• Before installing any electronic accessory, have the installer contact a dealer for
assistance. If possible, have a dealer inspect the final installation.
1Accessories and Modifications
3 WARNING
Improper accessories or modifications can
affect your vehicle’s handling, stability, and
performance, and cause a crash in which
you can be seriously hurt or killed.
Follow all instructions in this owner’s
manual regarding accessories and
modifications.
Honda Genuine accessories are recommended to
ensure proper operation on your vehicle.
Maintenance
607
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 608 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuAccessories and ModificationsuModifications
Modifications
Do not modify your vehicle in a manner that may affect its handling, stability, or
reliability, or install non-genuine Honda parts or accessories that may have a similar
effect.
Even minor modifications to vehicle systems can affect overall vehicle performance.
Always make sure all equipment is properly installed and maintained, and do not
make any modification to your vehicle or its systems that might cause your vehicle
to no longer meet federal, state, province, territory, and local regulations.
The on-board diagnostic port (OBD-II/SAE J1962 connector) installed on this vehicle
is intended to be used with automobile system diagnostic devices or with other
devices that Honda has approved. Use of any other type of device may adversely
affect the vehicle's electronic systems or allow them to be compromised, possibly
resulting in a system malfunction, drained battery, or other unexpected problems.
Do not modify or attempt to repair any of the electrical components.
Maintenance
608
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 609 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Handling the Unexpected
This chapter explains how to handle unexpected troubles.
Tools
Types of Tools .................................. 610
If a Tire Goes Flat
Changing a Flat Tire ......................... 611
Engine Does Not Start
Checking the Engine ........................ 619
If the Smart Entry Remote Battery is
Weak..........................................620
Emergency Engine Stop ................... 621
Jump Starting.................................... 622
Overheating
How to Handle Overheating............. 625
Indicator, Coming On/Blinking
If the Low Oil Pressure Warning Appears......627
If the Charging System Indicator Comes
On ................................................. 627
If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes
On or Blinks ................................... 628
If the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes
On ................................................. 629
If the Electric Power Steering (EPS) System
Indicator Comes On ....................... 629
If the Low Tire Pressure/Tire Pressure
Monitoring System (TPMS) Indicator
Comes On or Blinks........................ 630
If the Transmission Indicator Blinks along
with the Warning Message ............ 630
Fuses
Fuse Locations ................................. 631
Inspecting and Changing Fuses........ 635
Emergency Towing........................... 636
When You Cannot Unlock the Fuel Fill
Door................................................. 637
Refueling
Refueling From a Portable Fuel
Container ...................................638
When You Cannot Open the Tailgate..639
609
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 610 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Tools
Types of Tools
1Types of Tools
The tools are stored in the cargo area.
Wheel Nut Wrench/Jack Handle
Jack Handle Bar
Handling the Unexpected
Spare Tire
Cargo Bin
Jack
Tool Case
Tool Case
Funnel
Cargo Bin
Storage Bag
610
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 611 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
If a Tire Goes Flat
Changing a Flat Tire
If a tire goes flat while driving, grasp the steering wheel firmly, and brake gradually
to reduce speed. Then, stop in a safe place. Replace the flat tire with a compact
spare tire. Go to a dealer as soon as possible to have the full-size tire repaired or
replaced.
1. Park the vehicle on firm, level, non-slippery surface and apply the parking brake.
2. Change the gear position to (P .
3. Turn on the hazard warning lights and set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK).
1Changing a Flat Tire
Follow compact spare precautions:
Periodically check the tire pressure of the compact
spare. It should be set to the specified pressure.
Specified Pressure: 60 psi (420 kPa, 4.2 kgf/cm2)
When driving with the compact spare tire, keep the
vehicle speed under 50 mph (80 km/h). Replace with
a full-size tire as soon as possible.
Do not mount tire chains on a compact spare tire.
If a chain-mounted front tire goes flat, remove one of
the full-size rear tires and replace it with the compact
spare tire. Remove the flat front tire and replace it
with the full-size tire that was removed from the rear.
Mount the tire chains on the front tire.
Handling the Unexpected
The compact spare tire and wheel in your vehicle are
specifically for this model. Do not use them with
another vehicle. Do not use another type of compact
spare tire or wheel with your vehicle.
Do not use a puncture-repairing agent on a flat tire,
as it can damage the tire pressure sensor.
Continued
611
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 612 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire
■ Getting Ready to Replace the Flat Tire
1. Push the rear edge of the handle on the
cargo floor lid and open the lid.
Handle
Handling the Unexpected
2. Lift the secondary lid, then remove the
hook from the bottom of the lid.
Hook
3. Attach the hook onto the weather seal lip.
Seal Lip
612
1Changing a Flat Tire
NOTICE
Do not use the jack if it doesn’t work properly. Call
your dealer or a professional towing service.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 613 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire
Locks
Jack Handle Bar
Jack
6. Pull out the wheel nut wrench, jack handle
bar, storage bag, and jack from the tool
case.
Handling the Unexpected
5. Unscrew the spare tire bolt and slide the
tire to the rear of the vehicle. Remove the
spare tire from vehicle.
Spare Tire Bolt
Wheel Nut Wrench/
Jack Handle
4. Unlock the cargo bin by turning the two
locks. Remove the cargo bin from the
vehicle.
Storage Bag
Continued
613
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 614 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire
7. Place a wheel block or rock in front and
rear of the wheel diagonal to the flat tire.
The tire to be replaced.
Handling the Unexpected
614
Wheel
Blocks
8. Place the compact spare tire (wheel side
up) under the vehicle body, near the tire
that needs to be replaced.
9. Loosen each wheel nut about one turn
using the wheel nut wrench.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 615 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire
■ How to Set Up the Jack
1How to Set Up the Jack
1. Place the jack under the jacking point
closest to the tire to be changed.
3 WARNING
The vehicle can easily roll off the jack,
seriously injuring anyone underneath.
Follow the directions for changing a tire
exactly, and never get under the vehicle
when it is supported only by the jack.
Jacking
Points
3. Raise the vehicle, using the jack handle bar
and the jack handle, until the tire is off the
ground.
Do not use the jack with people or luggage in the
vehicle.
Use the jack provided in your vehicle.
Other jacks may not support the weight (“load”) or
may not fit the jacking point.
The following instructions must be followed to use
the jack safely:
• Do not use while the engine is running.
• Use only where the ground is firm and level.
• Use only at the jacking points.
• Do not get in the vehicle while using the jack.
• Do not put anything on top of or underneath the
jack.
Handling the Unexpected
2. Turn the end bracket clockwise as shown in
the image until the top of the jack contacts
the jacking point.
u Make sure that the jacking point tab is
resting in the jack notch.
Jack Handle Bar
Wheel Nut Wrench as Jack Handle
Continued
615
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 616 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire
■ Replacing the Flat Tire
1Replacing the Flat Tire
1. Remove the wheel nuts and flat tire.
Handling the Unexpected
2. Wipe the mounting surfaces of the wheel
with a clean cloth.
3. Mount the compact spare tire.
4. Screw the wheel nuts until they touch the
lips around the mounting holes, then stop
rotating.
5. Lower the vehicle and remove the jack.
Tighten the wheel nuts in the order
indicated in the image. Go around,
tightening the nuts, two to three times in
this order.
Wheel nut torque:
94 lbf∙ft (127 N∙m, 13 kgf∙m)
616
Do not over tighten the wheel nuts by applying extra
torque using your foot or a pipe.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 617 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire
■ Storing the Flat Tire
1Storing the Flat Tire
1. Put the flat tyre in the storage bag provided
with your vehicle.
u The storage bag is in the tool case.
2. Knot the top of the storage bag.
3. Securely put the jack, jack handle bar and
wheel nut wrench back in the tool case.
Belt
Rear Anchor
Loose items can fly around the interior in a
crash and can seriously injure the
occupants.
Store the wheel, jack, and tools securely
before driving.
Handling the Unexpected
4. Bore through the bag, and pass the holding
belt through the hole of the bag and the
wheel of the flat tire as shown.
3 WARNING
5. Place the flat tire in the cargo area, and
thread the belt through the rear anchor as
shown.
6. Pass the belt through the ring, and tighten
the belt to secure the flat tire in place.
Continued
617
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 618 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIf a Tire Goes FlatuChanging a Flat Tire
■ TPMS with Tire Fill Assist and the Spare Tire
If you replace a flat tire with the spare tire, the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator
comes on while you are driving. After driving for a few miles (kilometers), the
indicator will start blinking for a short time and then stay on. Tire Pressure
Monitor Problem appears on the driver information interface, but this is normal.
If you replace the tire with a specified regular tire, the warning message on the
driver information interface and the low tire pressure/TPMS indicator will go off after
a few miles (kilometers).
Handling the Unexpected
618
1TPMS with Tire Fill Assist and the Spare Tire
The system cannot monitor the pressure of the spare
tire. Manually check the spare tire pressure to be sure
that it is correct.
Use the TPMS specific wheels. Each is equipped with
a tire pressure sensor mounted inside the tire behind
the valve stem.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 619 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Engine Does Not Start
Checking the Engine
If the engine does not start, check the starter.
1Checking the Engine
If you must start the vehicle immediately, use an
assisting vehicle or booster battery to jump start it.
2 Jump Starting P. 622
Checklist
Check for a message on the driver information interface.
● If the To Start, Hold Remote Near Start Button message appears
2 If the Smart Entry Remote Battery is Weak P. 620
uMake sure the smart entry remote is in its operating range.
2 ENGINE START/STOP Button Operating Range P. 165
Check the brightness of the interior lights.
Turn on the interior lights and check the brightness.
● If the interior lights are dim or do not come on at all
2 Battery P. 597
If the interior lights come on normally 2 Fuses P. 631
Review the engine start procedure.
Follow its instructions, and try to start the engine again. 2 Starting the Engine P. 452
Check the immobilizer system indicator.
When the immobilizer system indicator is blinking, the engine cannot be started.
●
The starter turns over normally
but the engine doesn’t start.
There may be a problem with a
fuse. Check each of the items on
the right and respond accordingly.
Handling the Unexpected
Starter condition
Starter doesn’t turn or turns
over slowly.
The battery may be dead. Check
each of the items on the right and
respond accordingly.
2 Immobilizer System P. 158
Check the fuel level.
There should be enough fuel in the tank. 2 Fuel Gauge P. 104
Check the fuses.
Check all fuses, or have the vehicle checked by a dealer.
2 Inspecting and Changing Fuses P. 635
If the problem continues:
2 Emergency Towing P. 636
619
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 620 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuEngine Does Not StartuIf the Smart Entry Remote Battery is Weak
If the Smart Entry Remote Battery is Weak
Handling the Unexpected
620
If the beeper sounds, the To Start, Hold Remote Near Start Button message
appears on the driver information interface, the ENGINE START/STOP button
flashes, and the engine won’t start, start the engine as follows:
1. Touch the center of the ENGINE START/
STOP button with the H logo on the smart
entry remote while the ENGINE START/
STOP button is flashing. The buttons on
the smart entry remote should be facing
you.
u The ENGINE START/STOP button
flashes for about 30 seconds.
2. Depress the brake pedal and press the
ENGINE START/STOP button within 10
seconds after the beeper sounds and the
ENGINE START/STOP button changes
from flashing to on.
u If you don’t depress the pedal, the mode
will change to ACCESSORY.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 621 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuEngine Does Not StartuEmergency Engine Stop
Emergency Engine Stop
The ENGINE START/STOP button may be used to stop the engine due to an
emergency situation even while driving. If you must stop the engine, do either of the
following operations:
• Press and hold the ENGINE START/STOP button for about two seconds.
• Firmly press the ENGINE START/STOP button three times.
U.S. models
The gear position automatically changes to (P after the vehicle comes to a complete
stop. Then, the power mode changes to VEHICLE OFF.
Canadian models
The gear position automatically changes to (P after the vehicle comes to a complete
stop. Then press the ENGINE START/STOP button twice without depressing the
brake pedal to change the mode VEHICLE OFF.
Do not press the ENGINE START/STOP button while
driving unless it is absolutely necessary for the engine
to be turned off.
If you press the ENGINE START/STOP button while
driving, the beeper sounds.
Handling the Unexpected
The steering wheel will not lock. However, because turning off the engine disables
the power assist the engine provides to the steering and braking systems, it will
require significantly more physical effort and time to steer and slow the vehicle. Use
both feet on the brake pedal to slow down the vehicle and stop immediately in a
safe place.
1Emergency Engine Stop
621
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 622 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Jump Starting
■ Jump Starting Procedure
1Jump Starting
Turn off the power to electric devices, such as audio and lights. Turn off the engine,
then open the hood.
1. Pull up on the engine compartment cover,
Engine Compartment Cover
remove it from the pins.
3 WARNING
A battery can explode if you do not follow
the correct procedure, seriously injuring
anyone nearby.
Keep all sparks, open flames, and smoking
materials away from the battery.
Handling the Unexpected
Pin
2. Remove the holding clips and the air intake
duct.
Battery performance degrades in cold conditions and
may prevent the engine from starting.
Clip
Air Intake Duct
622
Securely attach the jumper cables clips so that they
do not come off when the engine vibrates. Also be
careful not to tangle the jumper cables or allow the
cable ends to touch each other while attaching or
detaching the jumper cables.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 623 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuJump Startingu
Pin
Engine Cover
5. Connect the other end of the first jumper
cable to the booster battery + terminal.
u Use a 12-volt booster battery only.
u When using an automotive battery
charger to boost your 12-volt battery,
select a lower charging voltage than 15
volts. Check the charger manual for the
proper setting.
6. Connect the second jumper cable to the
booster battery - terminal.
7. Connect the other end of the second
jumper cable to the engine hanger as
shown. Do not connect this jumper cable to
any other part.
8. If your vehicle is connected to another
vehicle, start the assisting vehicle’s engine
and increase its rpm slightly.
9. Attempt to start your vehicle’s engine. If it
turns over slowly, check that the jumper
cables have good metal-to-metal contact.
Continued
Handling the Unexpected
Booster Battery
3. Pull up on the engine cover, remove it from
the pins.
u Start on the passenger side and lift the
outermost edge of the cover.
u Move towards the driver side while
applying uniform upward pressure.
4. Connect the first jumper cable to your
vehicle’s battery + terminal.
623
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 624 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuJump Startingu
■ What to Do After the Engine Starts
Once your vehicle’s engine has started, remove the jumper cables in the following
order:
1. Disconnect the jumper cable from your vehicle’s ground.
2. Disconnect the other end of the jumper cable from the booster battery terminal.
3. Disconnect the jumper cable from your vehicle’s battery + terminal.
4. Disconnect the other end of the jumper cable from the booster battery +
terminal.
Handling the Unexpected
624
Have your vehicle inspected by a nearby service station or a dealer.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 625 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Overheating
How to Handle Overheating
Overheating symptoms are as follows:
• The temperature gauge needle is at the H mark or the engine suddenly loses
power.
• Stop Driving When Safe. Engine Temperature Too Hot message appears on
the driver information interface.
• Steam or spray comes out of the engine compartment.
1How to Handle Overheating
3 WARNING
Steam and spray from an overheated
engine can seriously scald you.
Do not open the hood if steam is coming
out.
■ First thing to do
NOTICE
Continuing to drive with the temperature gauge
needle at the H mark may damage the engine.
Continuing to drive with the Stop Driving When
Safe. Engine Temperature Too Hot message on
the driver information interface may damage the
engine.
Continued
Handling the Unexpected
1. Immediately park the vehicle in a safe place.
2. Turn off all accessories and turn on the hazard warning lights.
u No steam or spray present: Keep the engine running and open the hood.
u Steam or spray is present: Turn off the engine and wait until it subsides.
Then, open the hood.
625
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 626 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuOverheatinguHow to Handle Overheating
■ Next thing to do
MIN
MAX
Reserve Tank
1How to Handle Overheating
Handling the Unexpected
1. Check that the cooling fan is operating and
stop the engine once the temperature
gauge needle comes down.
u If the cooling fan is not operating,
immediately stop the engine.
2. Once the engine has cooled down, inspect
the coolant level and check the cooling
system components for leaks.
u If the coolant level in the reserve tank is
low, remove the engine compartment
cover then add coolant until it reaches
the MAX mark.
2 Engine Compartment Cover P. 569
u If there is no coolant in the reserve tank,
check that the radiator is cool. Cover the
radiator cap with a heavy cloth and open
the cap. If necessary, add coolant up to
the base of the filler neck, and put the
cap back on.
■ Last thing to do
Once the engine has cooled sufficiently, restart it and check the temperature gauge.
If the temperature gauge needle has gone down, resume driving. If it has not gone
down, contact a dealer for repairs.
626
3 WARNING
Removing the radiator cap while the
engine is hot can cause the coolant to spray
out, seriously scalding you.
Always let the engine and radiator cool
down before removing the radiator cap.
If the coolant is leaking, contact a dealer for repairs.
Use water as an emergency/temporary measure only.
Have a dealer flush the system with proper antifreeze
as soon as possible.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 627 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Indicator, Coming On/Blinking
If the Low Oil Pressure Warning Appears
■ Reasons for the warning to appear
Appears when the engine oil pressure is low.
■ What to do as soon as the warning appears
1. Immediately park the vehicle on level ground in a safe place.
2. If necessary, turn the hazard warning lights on.
■ What to do after parking the vehicle
1. Stop the engine and let it sit for approximately three minutes.
2. Open the hood and check the oil level.
u Add oil as necessary.
1If the Low Oil Pressure Warning Appears
NOTICE
Running the engine with low oil pressure can cause
serious mechanical damage almost immediately.
2 Oil Check P. 571
If the Charging System Indicator Comes On
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on
Comes on when the battery is not being charged.
■ What to do when the indicator comes on
Turn off the climate control system, rear defogger, and other electrical
systems, and immediately contact a dealer for repairs.
1If the Charging System Indicator Comes On
If you need to stop temporarily, do not turn off the
engine. Restarting the engine may rapidly discharge
the battery.
Handling the Unexpected
3. Start the engine and check the low oil pressure warning.
u The warning disappears: Start driving again.
u The warning does not disappear within 10 seconds: Immediately
stop the engine and contact a dealer for repairs.
627
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 628 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicator, Coming On/BlinkinguIf the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes On or Blinks
If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes On or
Blinks
Handling the Unexpected
628
■ Reasons for the indicator lamp to come on or blink
• Comes on when there is a problem with the engine emissions control
system.
• Blinks when engine misfiring is detected.
■ What to do when the indicator lamp comes on
Avoid high speeds and immediately get your vehicle inspected at a
dealer.
■ What to do when the indicator lamp blinks
Park the vehicle in a safe place with no flammable items and wait at least
10 minutes or more with the engine stopped until it cools.
1If the Malfunction Indicator Lamp Comes On or Blinks
NOTICE
If you drive with the malfunction indicator lamp on,
the emissions control system and the engine could be
damaged.
If the malfunction indicator lamp blinks again when
restarting the engine, drive to the nearest dealer at
31 mph (50 km/h) or less. Have your vehicle
inspected.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 629 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicator, Coming On/BlinkinguIf the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes On
If the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes On
U.S.
Canada
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on
• The brake fluid is low.
• There is a malfunction in the brake system.
■ What to do when the indicator comes on while driving
Depress the brake pedal lightly to check pedal pressure.
• If normal, check the brake fluid level the next time you stop.
• If abnormal, take immediate action. If necessary, downshift the
transmission to slow the vehicle using engine braking.
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on
• Comes on when there is a problem with the EPS system.
• If you depress the accelerator pedal repeatedly to increase the engine
speed while the engine is idling, the indicator comes on, and
sometimes the steering wheel becomes harder to operate.
■ What to do when the indicator comes on
Stop the vehicle in a safe place and restart the engine.
If the indicator comes on and stays on, immediately have your vehicle
inspected by a dealer.
Have your vehicle repaired immediately.
It is dangerous to drive with low brake fluid. If there
is no resistance from the brake pedal, stop
immediately in a safe place. If necessary downshift
the gears.
If the brake system indicator and ABS indicator come
on simultaneously, the electronic brake distribution
system is not working. This can result in vehicle
instability under sudden braking.
Have your vehicle inspected by a dealer immediately.
Handling the Unexpected
If the Electric Power Steering (EPS) System Indicator
Comes On
1If the Brake System Indicator (Red) Comes On
629
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 630 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuIndicator, Coming On/BlinkinguIf the Low Tire Pressure/Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Indicator Comes On or Blinks
If the Low Tire Pressure/Tire Pressure Monitoring
System (TPMS) Indicator Comes On or Blinks
■ Reasons for the indicator to come on or blink
Handling the Unexpected
A tire pressure is significantly low. If there is a problem with the TPMS
with Tire Fill Assist or the compact spare tire is installed, the indicator
blinks for about one minute, and then stays on.
■ What to do when the indicator comes on
Stop your vehicle in a safe place. Check the tire pressure and adjust the
pressure to the specified level. The specified tire pressure is on a label on
the driver side doorjamb.
■ What to do when the indicator blinks, then remains on
Have the tire inspected by a dealer as soon as possible. If the compact
spare tire causes the indicator to blink, change the tire to a full-size tire.
The indicator goes off after driving for a few miles (kilometers).
If the Transmission Indicator Blinks along with the
Warning Message
■ Reasons for the indicator to blink
The transmission is malfunctioning.
■ What to do when the indicator blinks
• Immediately have your vehicle inspected by a dealer.
• Change the gear position to (N after starting the engine.
u Check if the (N position in the instrument panel and the indicator
on the (N button light/blink.
u The engine cannot be turned on unless the parking brake is set.
2 Starting the Engine P. 452
630
1If the Low Tire Pressure/Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Indicator Comes On or Blinks
NOTICE
Driving on an extremely underinflated tire can cause
it to overheat. An overheated tire can fail. Always
inflate your tires to the prescribed level.
TPMS with Tire Fill Assist provides visual and audible
assistance during tire pressure adjustment. With the
power mode in ON, while you adjust tire pressure up
or down, the system alerts you as follows:
Below recommended pressure: The beeper
sounds and exterior lights flash once every five
seconds.
At recommended pressure: The beeper sounds
and exterior lights flash rapidly for ~ five seconds.
Above recommended pressure: The beeper
sounds and lights flash twice every three seconds.
1If the Transmission Indicator Blinks along with the Warning
Message
You may not be able to start the engine.
Make sure to set the parking brake when parking
your vehicle.
Call a professional towing service if you need to tow
your vehicle.
2 Emergency Towing P. 636
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 631 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Fuses
Fuse Locations
If any electrical devices are not working, set
the power mode to VEHICLE OFF (LOCK)
and check to see if any applicable fuse is
blown.
■ Engine Compartment Fuse
Box Type A
■ Circuit protected and fuse rating
1
2
Tab
3
4
5
6
7
* Not available on all models
Amps
(70 A)
30 A
40 A
20 A
30 A
150 A
30 A
30 A
20 A
(20 A)
30 A
40 A
(30 A)
(30 A)
40 A
(30 A)
(20 A)
−
−
−
−
10 A
(7.5 A)
10 A
10 A
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
Circuit Protected
L H/L LO
−
R H/L LO
IGPS
INJECTOR
H/L LO MAIN
FI-ECU BACKUP
FR FOG *
HAZARD
PASSENGER P/
SEAT(RECLINE) *
PASSENGER P/SEAT(SLIDE) *
−
MG CLUTCH
MAIN RLY
FI SUB
IG COIL
DBW
SMALL/STOP MAIN
BACK UP
HTD STRG WHEEL *
HORN
RADIO/USB
Amps
10 A
−
10 A
7.5 A
20 A
20 A
10 A
(10 A)
15 A
(20 A)
(20 A)
−
7.5 A
15 A
15 A
15 A
15 A
20 A
10 A
(15 A)
10 A
15 A
Continued
Handling the Unexpected
Fuse locations are shown on the fuse box
cover. Locate the fuse in question by the
fuse number and box cover number.
Located near the passenger's side damper
house. Push the tabs to open the box.
Circuit Protected
−
RR BLOWER
ABS/VSA MTR
ABS/VSA FSR
MAIN FAN
MAIN FUSE
SUB FAN
WIP MTR
WASHER
PREMIUM AMP *
ENGINE MOUNT
FR BLOWER
A/C INVERTER *
STANDARD AMP *
RR DEF
−
PREMIUM AMP *
−
−
−
−
PARKING LIGHT
CRUISE CANCEL SW
STOP LIGHT
FI SUB VSS
631
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 632 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuFusesuFuse Locations
■ Engine Compartment Fuse
Box Type B
Fuse locations are shown on the fuse box
cover. Locate the fuse in question by the
fuse number and box cover number.
Located near the brake fluid reservoir. Push
the tabs to open the box.
Handling the Unexpected
Tab
■ Circuit protected and fuse rating
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
632
* Not available on all models
Circuit Protected
−
4WD *
IG MAIN
IG MAIN2
P/TAILGATE MOTOR *
F/B MAIN2
F/B MAIN
EPS
TRAILER MAIN
TRAILER E-BRAKE
BATTERY SENSOR
H/L HI MAIN
P/TAILGATE CLOSER *
CTR ACC SOCKET
RR ACC SOCKET *
FR WIPER DEICER *
ACC/IG2_MAIN
TRAILER CHARGE
IDLE STOP ST CUT
IDLE STOP
IDLE STOP
ELECTRONIC GEAR
SELECTOR
RR HEATED SEAT *
ST CUT FEED BACK
Amps
(40 A)
(20 A)
30 A
30 A
(40 A)
60 A
60 A
60 A
(30 A)
(20 A)
7.5 A
20 A
(20 A)
20 A
(20 A)
(15 A)
10 A
(20 A)
30 A
30 A
30 A
15 A
(20 A)
7.5 A
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 633 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuFusesuFuse Locations
■ Interior Fuse Box Type A
Located under the dashboard.
Fuse Box
Fuse locations are shown on the label on
the outer side of the side panel cover.
Locate the fuse in question by the fuse
number and label number.
* Not available on all models
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
Circuit Protected
DRIVER P/WINDOW
DOOR LOCK
SMART
PASSENGER P/WINDOW
FR ACC SOCKET
FUEL PUMP
ACG
FR WIPER
IG1 SMART
SRS
REAR L P/WINDOW
−
REAR R P/WINDOW
FUEL LID
DR P/SEAT(RECLINE) *
−
FR SEAT HEATER *
INTR LT
REAR L DOOR UNLOCK
R SIDE DOOR UNLOCK
DRL
KEY LOCK
A/C
IG1a FEED BACK
INST PANEL LIGHTS
Amps
20 A
20 A
7.5 A
20 A
20 A
20 A
15 A
7.5 A
7.5 A
10 A
20 A
−
20 A
20 A
(20 A)
−
(20 A)
7.5 A
10 A
10 A
7.5 A
7.5 A
7.5 A
7.5 A
7.5 A
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
Circuit Protected
LUMBAR SUPPORT *
PARKING LIGHTS
OPTION
BACK LT
REAR WIPER
ST MOTOR
SRS
PASSENGER DOOR LOCK
DRIVER DOOR LOCK
DRIVER DOOR UNLOCK
DRIVER P/SEAT(SLIDE) *
R H/L HI
L H/L HI
IG1b FEED BACK
ACC
REAR L DOOR LOCK
−
Amps
(10 A)
7.5 A
10 A
7.5 A
10 A
7.5 A
7.5 A
10 A
10 A
10 A
(20 A)
10 A
10 A
7.5 A
7.5 A
10 A
−
Continued
Handling the Unexpected
Fuse Label
■ Circuit protected and fuse rating
633
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 634 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuFusesuFuse Locations
■ Interior Fuse Box Type B
Located under the dashboard.
Fuse Box
Handling the Unexpected
634
Fuse Label
Fuse locations are shown on the image.
Locate the fuse in question by the fuse
number and label number.
■ Circuit protected and fuse rating
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
Circuit Protected
METER
ABS/VSA
ACG
MICU
AUDIO
BACK UP
ACC
Amps
10 A
7.5 A
7.5 A
7.5 A
15 A
10 A
7.5 A
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 635 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuFusesuInspecting and Changing Fuses
Inspecting and Changing Fuses
Blown Fuse
Combined
Fuse
1Inspecting and Changing Fuses
NOTICE
Replacing a fuse with one that has a higher rating
greatly increases the chances of damaging the
electrical system.
Replace fuse with a spare fuse of the same specified
amperage
Confirm the specified amperage using the charts on
P. 631 to P. 634.
There is a fuse puller in the engine compartment fuse
box.
Handling the Unexpected
Fuse Puller
1. Set the power mode to VEHICLE OFF
(LOCK). Turn headlights and all accessories
off.
2. Remove the fuse box cover.
3. Check the large fuse in the engine
compartment.
u If the fuse is blown, use a Phillips-head
screwdriver to remove the screw and
replace it with a new one.
4. Inspect the small fuses in the engine
compartment and the vehicle interior.
u If there is a blown fuse, remove it with
the fuse puller and replace it with a new
one.
635
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 636 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Emergency Towing
Call a professional towing service if you need to tow your vehicle.
All models
■ Flat bed equipment
The operator loads your vehicle on the back of a truck.
This is the best way to transport your vehicle.
2WD models
■ Wheel lift equipment
Handling the Unexpected
636
The tow truck uses two pivoting arms that go under the front tires and lift them off
the ground. The rear tires remain on the ground. This is an acceptable way to
tow your vehicle.
1Emergency Towing
NOTICE
Trying to lift or tow your vehicle by the bumpers will
cause serious damage. The bumpers are not designed
to support the vehicle’s weight.
Improper towing such as towing behind a
motorhome or other motor vehicle can damage the
transmission.
Never tow your vehicle with just a rope or chain.
It is very dangerous since ropes or chains may shift
from side to side or break.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 637 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
When You Cannot Unlock the Fuel Fill Door
■ What to Do When Unable to Unlock the Fuel Fill Door
If you cannot unlock the fuel fill door, use the following procedure:
1. Open the tailgate.
2. Wrap a cloth around the built-in key. Put it
Cover
into the cover slot as shown in the image,
and remove the cover.
3. Pull the release lever toward you.
u The release lever unlocks the fuel fill door
when it is pulled.
After taking these steps, contact a dealer to have the
vehicle checked.
Handling the Unexpected
Release Lever
1What to Do When Unable to Unlock the Fuel Fill Door
637
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 638 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Refueling
Refueling From a Portable Fuel Container
If you have run out of fuel and need to refuel your vehicle from a portable fuel
container, use the funnel provided with your vehicle.
1. Turn off the engine.
2. Press the fuel fill door release button.
u The fuel fill door opens.
3. Take the funnel out of the cargo bin in the
cargo area.
Funnel
2 Types of Tools P. 610
Cargo Floor Lid
Handling the Unexpected
4. Place the end of the funnel on the lower
part of filler opening, then insert it slowly
and fully.
u Make sure that the end of the funnel
goes down along with the filler pipe.
Funnel
5. Fill the tank with fuel from the portable fuel
container.
u Pour fuel carefully so you do not spill any.
6. Remove the funnel from the filler neck.
u Wipe up any fuel from the funnel before
storing it.
7. Shut the fuel fill door by hand.
638
1Refueling From a Portable Fuel Container
3 WARNING
Gasoline is highly flammable and explosive.
You can be burned or seriously injured
when handling fuel.
• Stop the engine, and keep heat, sparks,
and flame away.
• Handle fuel only outdoors.
• Wipe up spills immediately.
NOTICE
Do not insert the nozzle of a portable fuel container
or any funnel other than the one provided with your
vehicle. Doing so can damage the fuel system.
Do not try to pry open or push open the sealed fuel
tank with foreign objects. This can damage the fuel
system and its seal.
Make sure the fuel in the portable fuel container is
gasoline before you refuel.
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 639 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
When You Cannot Open the Tailgate
■ What to Do When Unable to Open the Tailgate
If you cannot open the tailgate, use the following procedure:
1. Use a flat-tip screwdriver and remove the
Cover
cover on the inside of the tailgate.
u Wrap the flat-tip screwdriver with a cloth
to prevent scratches.
2. To open the tailgate, push the tailgate
while pushing the lever to the right using a
flat-tip screw driver.
Following up:
After taking these steps, contact a dealer to have the
vehicle checked.
When you open the tailgate from inside, make sure
there is enough space around the tailgate, and it
does not hit anyone or any object.
Handling the Unexpected
Models with power tailgate
Screwdriver
1What to Do When Unable to Open the Tailgate
Lever
Models without power tailgate
Screwdriver
Lever
639
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 640 ページ
640
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 641 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Information
This chapter includes your vehicle’s specifications, locations of identification numbers, and other
information required by regulation.
Specifications .................................... 642
Identification Numbers
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN),
Engine Number, and Transmission
Number ......................................... 644
Devices that Emit Radio Waves ....... 645
Reporting Safety Defects ................. 646
Emissions Testing
Testing of Readiness Codes.............. 647
Warranty Coverages ........................ 649
Authorized Manuals......................... 651
Customer Service Information......... 652
641
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 642 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Specifications
■ Vehicle Specifications
■ Air Conditioning
■ Light Bulbs
Model
Passport
No. of Passengers:
Front
Rear
Total
Weights:
Gross Vehicle
Weight Rating
Gross Axle Weight
Rating (Front)
Gross Axle Weight
Rating (Rear)
Gross Combined Weight U.S.:
Rating
Canada:
Refrigerant Type
Charge Quantity
Lubricant Type
Quantity
Headlights (Low Beam)
2
3
5
See the certification label
on the driver's doorjamb
See the certification label
on the driver's doorjamb
See the certification label
on the driver's doorjamb
8,025 lbs (3,640 kg)*1
9,755 lbs (4,425 kg)*2
4,425 kg
*1: 2WD models
*2: AWD models
HFO-1234yf (R-1234yf)
21.3 – 23.1 oz (605 – 655 g)
RL85HM (POE)
7.75 – 9.33 cu-in (127 – 153 cm3)
■ Engine Specifications
Displacement
Spark Plugs
211.8 cu-in (3,471 cm3)
NGK
DILZKR7B11G
■ Fuel
Type
Fuel Tank Capacity
Unleaded gasoline, Pump octane number
of 87 or higher
19.5 US gal (73.8 L)
■ Washer Fluid
Tank Capacity
U.S.: 4 US qt (3.8 L)
Canada: 5.6 US qt (5.3 L)
Headlights (High Beam)
Information
Fog Lights *
Front Turn Signal Lights
Front Side Marker Lights
Parking/Daytime Running Lights
Side Turn Signal Lights
(on Door Mirrors) *
Brake/Taillights/Rear Side Marker Lights
Back-Up Lights
Rear Turn Signal Lights
High-Mount Brake Light
Rear License Plate Lights
Interior Lights
Front Map Lights
Rear Map Lights
Ambient Lights
Vanity Mirror Lights *
Door Courtesy Lights *
Door Inner Handle Lights *
Door Pocket Lights *
Beverage Holder Light *
Foot Lights *
Console Compartment Light
Glove Box Light
Cargo Area Lights
*1: Models without navigation system
*2: Models with navigation system
642
* Not available on all models
LED
60 W (HB3)*1
LED*2
LED
28/8 W (Amber)
LED
LED
LED
LED
21 W
21 W (Amber)
LED
LED
5W
5W
LED
1.4 W
3.8 W
LED
LED
LED
LED
1.4 W
1.4 W
8W
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 643 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuSpecificationsu
■ Brake Fluid
Specified
Honda Heavy Duty Brake Fluid DOT 3
■ Engine Oil
Recommended
■ Automatic Transmission Fluid
Specified
Capacity
Honda ATF Type-3.1
Change
3.5 US qt (3.3 L)
■ Rear Differential Fluid *
Specified
Capacity
Honda DPSF-II
Change
1.92 US qt (1.82 L)
■ Transfer Assembly Fluid *
Specified
Capacity
Honda HGO-1
Change
0.45 US qt (0.43 L)
Capacity
■ Tire
·Honda Genuine Motor Oil 0W-20
·API Premium-grade 0W-20 detergent oil
Change
5.4 US qt (5.1 L)
Change
including
5.7 US qt (5.4 L)
filter
■ Engine Coolant
Specified
Ratio
Capacity
Honda Long Life Antifreeze/Coolant Type 2
50/50 with distilled water
1.96 US gal (7.40 L)
(change including the remaining 0.22 US gal
(0.82 L) in the reserve tank)
Size*1
Regular
Compact
Spare
Wheel Size
Pressure
psi (kPa [kgf/cm2])
Size
Pressure
psi (kPa [kgf/cm2])
Regular
Compact Spare
245/50R20 102H
265/45R20 104H
35 (240 [2.4])*2
37 (255 [2.6])*3
T165/80D17 104M
60 (420 [4.2])
20 x 8J*2
20 x 8 1/2J*3
17 x 4T
*1: Original tire size is mentioned on the tire information label on
the driver’s doorjamb.
*2: Models with 245/50R20
*3: Models with 265/45R20
Information
* Not available on all models
643
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 644 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Identification Numbers
Vehicle Identification Number (VIN), Engine Number,
and Transmission Number
Your vehicle has a 17-digit vehicle identification number (VIN) used to register your
vehicle for warranty purposes, and for licensing and insuring your vehicle.
The locations of your vehicle’s VIN, engine number, and transmission number are
shown as follows:
1Vehicle Identification Number (VIN), Engine Number, and
Transmission Number
The interior vehicle identification number (VIN) is
located under the cover.
Vehicle Identification Number
Engine Number
Cover
Automatic Transmission
Number
Information
644
Certification Label/Vehicle Identification Number
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 645 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Devices that Emit Radio Waves
Each radio frequency device installed in the vehicle conforms to the requirements
and standards of the regulation listed below:
As required by the FCC:
This device complies with Part 15 of the FCC rules. Operation is
subject to the following two conditions: (1) This device may not
cause harmful interference, and (2) this device must accept any
interference received, including interference that may cause
undesired operation.
Changes or modifications not expressly approved by the party
responsible for compliance could void the user’s authority to
operate the equipment.
Information
This device complies with Industry Canada licence-exempt RSS standard(s).
Operation is subject to the following two conditions: (1) this device may not cause
interference, and (2) this device must accept any interference, including interference
that may cause undesired operation of the device.
645
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 646 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Reporting Safety Defects
In the U.S.
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you
should immediately inform the National Highway Traffic Safety Administration (NHTSA) in addition to
notifying American Honda Motor Co., Inc.
If NHTSA receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety defect exists
in a group of vehicles, it may order a recall and remedy campaign. However, NHTSA cannot become involved
in individual problems between you, your dealer, or American Honda Motor Co., Inc.
To contact NHTSA, you may call the Vehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at 1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-4249153); go to http://www.safercar.gov; or write to: Administrator, NHTSA, 1200 New Jersey Avenue, SE.,
Washington, DC 20590. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://
www.safercar.gov.
In Canada
If you believe that your vehicle has a defect which could cause a crash or could cause injury or death, you
should immediately inform Honda Canada Inc. and you may also inform Transport Canada.
Information
If Transport Canada receives similar complaints, it may open an investigation, and if it finds that a safety
defect exists in a group of vehicles, it may lead to a recall and remedy campaign. However, Transport Canada
cannot become involved in individual problems between you, your dealer, or Honda Canada Inc.
To contact Transport Canada’s Defect Investigations and Recalls Division, you may call 1-800-333-0510. For
more information on reporting safety defects or about motor vehicle safety, go to http://www.tc.gc.ca/
roadsafety.
646
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 647 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Emissions Testing
Testing of Readiness Codes
Your vehicle has readiness code as part of the onboard self diagnostic system.
Some States use these codes for testing to verify whether your vehicle’s emissions
components are working properly.
The codes may not be read properly if testing is performed just after the battery has
gone dead or been disconnected.
To check if they are set, set the power mode to ON, without starting the engine. The
malfunction indicator lamp will come on for several seconds. If it then goes off, the
readiness codes are set. If it blinks five times, the readiness codes are not set.
1Testing of Readiness Codes
The readiness codes are erased when the battery is
disconnected, and set again only after several days of
driving under a variety of conditions.
If a testing facility determines that the readiness
codes are not set, you may be requested to return at
a later date to complete the test.
If the testing facility determines the readiness codes
are still not set, see a dealer.
If you are required to have your vehicle tested before the readiness codes are ready,
prepare the vehicle for retesting by doing the following:
Continued
Information
1. Fill the gas tank to approximately 3/4 full.
2. Park the vehicle and leave the engine off for 6 hours or more.
3. Make sure the ambient temperature is between 40°F and 95°F (4°C and 35°C).
4. Start the engine without touching the accelerator pedal, and let it idle for 20
seconds.
5. Keep the vehicle in (P . Increase the engine speed to 2,000 rpm, and hold it there
for about 3 minutes.
6. Let the engine idle with your foot off the accelerator for 20 seconds.
647
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 648 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuEmissions TestinguTesting of Readiness Codes
7. Select a nearby, lightly traveled major highway where you can maintain a speed
of 50 to 60 mph (80 to 97 km/h) for at least 20 minutes. Drive on the highway in
(D . Do not use cruise control. When traffic allows, drive for 90 seconds without
moving the accelerator pedal. (Vehicle speed may vary slightly; this is okay.) If you
cannot do this for a continuous 90 seconds because of traffic conditions, drive for
at least 30 seconds, then repeat it two more times (for a total of 90 seconds).
8. Drive in city or suburban traffic for at least 10 minutes. When traffic conditions
allow, let the vehicle coast for several seconds without using the accelerator pedal
or the brake pedal.
9. Park the vehicle and leave the engine off for 30 minutes.
Information
648
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 649 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Warranty Coverages
■ U.S. Owners
Your new vehicle is covered by these warranties:
New Vehicle Limited Warranty – covers your new vehicle, except for the
emissions control systems and accessories, against defects in materials and
workmanship.
Emissions Control Systems Defects Warranty and Emissions Performance
Warranty – these two warranties cover your vehicle’s emissions control systems.
Time, mileage, and coverage are conditional. Please read your warranty booklet for
exact information.
Seat Belt Limited Warranty – a seat belt that fails to function properly is covered
by a limited warranty. Please read your warranty booklet for details.
Rust Perforation Limited Warranty – all exterior body panels are covered against
rusting from the inside out for the specified time period, regardless of mileage.
Information
Accessory Limited Warranty – Honda accessories are covered under this
warranty. Time and mileage limits depend on the type of accessory and other
factors. Please read your warranty booklet for details.
Replacement Parts Limited Warranty – covers all Honda replacement parts
against defects in materials and workmanship.
Continued
649
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 650 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
uuWarranty Coveragesu
Replacement Battery Limited Warranty – provides prorated coverage for a
replacement battery purchased from your dealer.
Replacement Muffler Lifetime Limited Warranty – provides coverage for as
long as the purchaser of the muffler owns the vehicle.
Restrictions and exclusions apply to all these warranties. Please read the Honda
warranty information booklet that came with your vehicle for precise information on
warranty coverages. Your vehicle’s original tires are covered by their manufacturer.
Tire warranty information is in a separate booklet.
■ Canadian Owners
Please refer to the warranty manual that came with your vehicle.
■ EPA Contact Information
An owner may obtain further information concerning emission warranties or report
violations of the terms of the emission warranties by contacting:
Information
650
U.S. Environmental Protection Agency
Office of Transportation and Air Quality
Compliance Division, Light-Duty Vehicle Group
Attn: Warranty Complaints
2000 Traverwood Drive
Ann Arbor, MI 48105
Email: [email protected]
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 651 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Authorized Manuals
■ Service Express
For electronic copies of service publications, you can purchase a subscription to
Service Express. Visit www.techinfo.honda.com for pricing and options.
■ For U.S. Owners
Manuals can be purchased from Helm Incorporated. You can order a manual by
phone at 1 (800) 782-4356 (credit card orders only), or online at www.helminc.com.
■ For Canadian Owners
Please contact a dealer to order any manuals that you may require.
Information
651
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 652 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Customer Service Information
Honda dealership personnel are trained professionals who should be able to deal
with any problems you may encounter with your vehicle. If, however, you are faced
with a problem that they cannot resolve to your satisfaction, contact Honda
Customer Services.
U.S. Owners
American Honda Motor Co., Inc.
Honda Automobile Customer Services
Mail Stop 100-5E-8A
1919 Torrance Blvd.
Torrance, CA 90501-2746
Tel: 1 (800) 999-1009
Information
652
In Puerto Rico and the U.S. Virgin
Islands
Bella International
P.O. Box 190816
San Juan, PR 00919-0816
Tel: 1 (787) 620-7546
Canadian Owners
Honda Canada Inc.
Customer Relations
180 Honda Boulevard
Markham, ON
L6C 0H9
Tel: 1-888-9-HONDA-9
Fax: 1-877-939-0909
E-mail: [email protected]
1Customer Service Information
When you call or write, please give us the following
information:
• Vehicle Identification Number
2 Vehicle Identification Number (VIN),
Engine Number, and Transmission
Number P. 644
• Date of purchase
• Odometer reading of your vehicle
• Your name, address, and telephone number
• A detailed description of the problem
• Name of the dealer who sold the vehicle to you
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 653 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
Index
Index
A
Display Setup .................................. 239, 278
Error Messages........................................ 327
File Manager ........................................... 271
General Information ................................ 330
HD Subchannel ....................................... 286
Home Screen........................................... 257
HondaLink® ........................................... 312
How to Delete a File ................................ 274
How to Transfer a File ............................. 271
How to Update Wirelessly ....................... 265
How to Update with a USB Device........... 269
iPod ................................................ 242, 297
Limitations for Manual Operation ............ 279
MP3/WMA/AAC...................... 245, 300, 303
My Honda Music ..................................... 303
Playing AM/FM Radio .............................. 283
Playing Bluetooth® Audio ................ 248, 307
Playing SiriusXM® Radio .......................... 287
Playing Social Playlist ............................... 310
Reactivating ............................................ 229
Remote Controls ..................................... 230
Security Code.......................................... 229
Selecting an Audio Source....................... 279
Siri Eyes Free ........................................... 319
Status Area ............................................. 262
System Updates....................................... 265
Theft Protection ...................................... 229
Updating Apps ........................................ 263
USB Flash Drives ...................... 245, 300, 331
USB Port.................................................. 227
Wallpaper Setup.............................. 236, 255
Index
AAC........................................... 245, 300, 303
ABS (Anti-lock Brake System).................. 537
AC Power Outlet ...................................... 206
Accessories and Modifications ................ 607
Accessory Power Sockets ......................... 205
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC)................ 505
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) Indicator
(Amber)..................................................... 88
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) Indicator
(Green)...................................................... 88
Additives
Coolant .................................................. 575
Engine Oil ............................................... 570
Washer ................................................... 578
Additives, Engine Oil ............................... 570
Adjusting
Armrest .................................................. 197
Front Seats.............................................. 188
Head Restraints............................... 194, 195
Mirrors.................................................... 186
Rear Seats............................................... 192
Steering Wheel ....................................... 185
Agile Handling Assist............................... 479
Air Conditioning System
(Climate Control System) ....................... 217
Changing the Mode................................ 217
Defrosting the Windshield and
Windows .............................................. 218
Dust and Pollen Filter .............................. 601
Recirculation/Fresh Air Mode................... 218
Sensor ..................................................... 223
Synchronization Mode ............................. 220
Using Automatic Climate Control ............ 217
Air Pressure ....................................... 589, 643
Airbags ........................................................ 45
Advanced Airbags ..................................... 51
After a Collision......................................... 49
Airbag Care ............................................... 57
Event Data Recorder .................................... 0
Front Airbags (SRS) .................................... 48
Indicator .............................................. 55, 80
Passenger Airbag Off Indicator .................. 56
Sensors...................................................... 45
Side Airbags .............................................. 52
Side Curtain Airbags .................................. 54
All-wheel drive (AWD) Indicator ............... 85
AM/FM Radio .................................... 240, 283
Android Auto............................................ 323
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) .................. 537
Indicator .................................................... 79
Apple CarPlay ........................................... 320
Armrest ..................................................... 197
Audio Remote Controls............................ 230
Audio System ............................ 226, 233, 251
Adjusting the Sound ........................ 238, 277
AM/FM Radio .................................. 240, 283
Android Auto .......................................... 323
Apple CarPlay .......................................... 320
Audio/Information Screen ................ 234, 252
Auxiliary Input Jack .................................. 228
Changing the Screen Brightness .............. 278
653
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 654 ページ
2020年2月20日
Wi-Fi Connection..................................... 317
Audio/Information Screen................ 234, 252
Authorized Manuals................................. 651
Auto Door Locking/Unlocking ................. 147
Customize ....................................... 125, 373
Auto High-Beam ....................................... 174
Indicator .................................................... 80
Auto Idle Stop........................................... 468
OFF Button .............................................. 469
Auto Idle Stop Indicator (Amber) .............. 85
Auto Idle Stop Indicator (Green) ............... 85
Automatic Intermittent Wipers ............... 178
Automatic Lighting .................................. 170
Automatic Transmission ........................... 459
Creeping ................................................. 459
Fluid ........................................................ 577
Kickdown ................................................ 459
Operating the Shift Button....................... 462
Shifting.................................................... 460
Auxiliary Input Jack .................................. 228
Average Fuel Economy............................. 110
B
Index
654
Back-Up Light............................................ 583
Battery....................................................... 597
Charging System Indicator ................. 77, 627
Jump Starting .......................................... 622
Maintenance (Checking the Battery) ........ 597
Belts (Seat) .................................................. 37
Beverage Holders...................................... 203
木曜日
午後3時29分
Blind Spot Information System................ 480
Bluetooth® Audio ............................. 248, 307
Bluetooth® HandsFreeLink® ........... 381, 406
Booster Seats (For Children) ...................... 72
Brake System ............................................ 535
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS)................... 537
Brake Assist System ................................. 538
Fluid........................................................ 578
Foot Brake............................................... 536
Indicator............................................ 76, 629
Parking Brake .......................................... 535
Brake System (Red)
Indicator.................................................. 629
Brightness Control (Instrument Panel).... 182
Bulb Replacement .................................... 579
Back-Up Lights ........................................ 583
Brake lights ............................................. 582
Daytime Running Lights........................... 580
Fog Lights ............................................... 581
Front Side Marker Lights.......................... 580
Front Turn Signal Lights........................... 581
Headlights............................................... 579
High-Mount Brake Light .......................... 583
Parking Lights.......................................... 580
Rear License Plate Lights.......................... 583
Rear Side Marker Lights........................... 582
Rear Turn Signal Lights ............................ 582
Side Turn Signal/Emergency Indicator
Lights .................................................... 582
Taillights.................................................. 582
Bulb Specifications ................................... 642
C
Car Wash Mode........................................ 464
Carbon Monoxide Gas ............................... 73
Carrying Cargo ................................. 435, 437
Certification Label ................................... 644
Changing Bulbs ........................................ 579
Charging System Indicator ................ 77, 627
Child Safety ................................................ 58
Childproof Door Locks ............................ 146
Child Seat ................................................... 58
Booster Seats ............................................ 72
Child Seat for Infants ................................ 60
Child Seat for Small Children .................... 61
Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder
Seat Belt ................................................. 66
Larger Children ......................................... 71
Rear-facing Child Seat............................... 60
Selecting a Child Seat ............................... 62
Childproof Door Locks............................. 146
Cleaning the Exterior............................... 604
Cleaning the Interior ............................... 602
Climate Control System ........................... 217
Changing the Mode................................ 217
Defrosting the Windshield and
Windows .............................................. 218
Dust and Pollen Filter .............................. 601
Recirculation and Fresh Air Mode ............ 218
Sensors ................................................... 223
Synchronization Mode ............................ 220
Using Automatic Climate Control............ 217
Clock ......................................................... 130
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 655 ページ
2020年2月20日
Coat Hook ................................................ 209
Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM
(CMBSTM) ................................................. 493
Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM
(CMBSTM) Indicator ............................. 88, 89
Compact Spare Tire.......................... 611, 643
Console Compartment............................. 201
Controls .................................................... 129
Coolant (Engine) ...................................... 575
Adding to the Radiator ........................... 576
Adding to the Reserve Tank .................... 575
Overheating............................................ 625
Temperature Gauge................................ 104
Creeping (Automatic Transmission)........ 459
Cross Traffic Monitor ............................... 546
Cup Holders.............................................. 203
Customer Service Information ................ 652
Customized Features ............... 119, 352, 359
D
午後3時29分
Dipstick (Engine Oil) ................................. 571
Directional Signals (Turn Signal) ............. 168
Door Mirrors ............................................. 187
Doors ......................................................... 133
Auto Door Locking .................................. 147
Auto Door Unlocking............................... 147
Door Open Message .................................. 36
Keys ........................................................ 133
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the
Inside..................................................... 144
Locking/Unlocking the Doors from the
Outside.................................................. 136
Lockout Prevention System ...................... 143
DOT Tire Quality Grading ........................ 591
Driver Information Interface ................... 105
Accessing Content................................... 107
Warning and Information Messages .......... 91
Driving....................................................... 433
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) ................ 505
Automatic Transmission........................... 459
Braking.................................................... 535
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines ............... 450
Shifting Gear ........................................... 460
Starting the Engine .................................. 452
Driving Position Memory System............. 183
Dust and Pollen Filter ............................... 601
E
Eco Assist® System ...................................... 10
ECON Button............................................. 474
Econ Mode
Indicator.................................................... 84
Electric Power Steering (EPS) System
Indicator............................................ 81, 629
Electronic Stability Control (ESC)............. 477
Emergency ................................................ 636
Emissions Testing (Readiness Codes)....... 647
Engine
Coolant................................................... 575
Jump Starting.......................................... 622
Number................................................... 644
Oil........................................................... 570
Remote Engine Start................................ 454
Starting ................................................... 452
Engine Compartment Cover .................... 569
Engine Coolant......................................... 575
Adding to the Radiator............................ 576
Adding to the Reserve Tank..................... 575
Overheating ............................................ 625
Temperature Gauge ................................ 104
Engine Oil ................................................. 570
Adding.................................................... 572
Checking................................................. 571
Displaying Maintenance Minder
Information ........................................... 562
Low Oil Pressure Symbol.......................... 627
Recommended Engine Oil ....................... 570
ENGINE START/STOP Button .................... 165
EPS (Electric Power Steering) System ...... 629
Exhaust Gas Hazard (Carbon Monoxide) .. 73
Exterior Care (Cleaning)........................... 604
Index
Daytime Running Lights .......................... 173
Dead Battery ............................................ 622
Defaulting All the Settings...................... 377
Defrosting the Windshield and
Windows................................................. 218
Detachable Anchor .................................... 42
Devices that Emit Radio Waves............... 645
Dimming
Headlights .............................................. 169
Rearview Mirror ...................................... 186
木曜日
655
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 656 ページ
2020年2月20日
Exterior Mirrors......................................... 187
F
Index
656
Features..................................................... 225
File Manager ............................................. 271
Filters
Dust and Pollen ....................................... 601
Oil ........................................................... 573
Flat Tire ..................................................... 611
Floor Mats ................................................. 603
Fluids
Automatic Transmission........................... 577
Brake....................................................... 578
Engine Coolant........................................ 575
Windshield Washer.................................. 578
FM/AM Radio .................................... 240, 283
Fog Light Indicator ..................................... 83
Fog Lights.................................................. 172
Folding Down the Rear Seat .................... 193
Foot Brake................................................. 536
Front Airbags (SRS) ..................................... 48
Front Seats ................................................ 188
Adjusting................................................. 188
Front Sensor Camera ................................ 532
Fuel ...................................................... 23, 552
Economy ................................................. 555
Gauge ..................................................... 104
Instant Fuel Economy............................... 110
Low Fuel Indicator ..................................... 79
Range...................................................... 110
木曜日
午後3時29分
Recommendation .................................... 552
Refueling................................................. 552
Fuel Economy ........................................... 555
Fuel Fill Cap .............................................. 554
Fuel Fill Door ...................................... 23, 553
Unable to Unlock .................................... 637
Fuses.......................................................... 631
Inspecting and Changing......................... 635
Locations......................... 631, 632, 633, 634
G
Gasoline (Fuel)
Economy ................................................. 555
Gauge..................................................... 104
Information ............................................. 552
Instant Fuel Economy .............................. 110
Low Fuel Indicator ..................................... 79
Refueling................................................. 552
Gauges ...................................................... 104
Gear Position Indicator ...................... 77, 462
Gear Shift Positions
Automatic Transmission .......................... 460
Glass (care)................................................ 605
Glove Box.................................................. 201
H
Handling the Unexpected ....................... 609
HandsFreeLink® (HFL) ...................... 381, 406
Automatic Import of Cellular Phonebook
and Call History............................. 395, 415
Automatic Transferring ........................... 414
Caller’s ID Information ............................ 393
Displaying Messages ............................... 425
Favorite Contacts .................................... 416
HFL Buttons .................................... 381, 406
HFL Menus...................................... 383, 409
HFL Status Display ........................... 382, 408
In Case of Emergency ............................. 429
Limitations for Manual Operation.... 382, 408
Making a Call ................................. 400, 418
Options During a Call...................... 405, 421
Phone Setup ................................... 387, 411
Receiving a Call............................... 404, 421
Receiving a Text Message........................ 423
Ring Tone ....................................... 393, 414
Selecting a Phone ................................... 424
Speed Dial .............................................. 396
To Clear the System ................................ 394
To Set Up a Text Message Options .......... 422
Hazard Warning Button .............................. 4
HD RadioTM ............................................... 286
Head Restraints ................................ 194, 195
Headlights ................................................ 169
Auto High-Beam ..................................... 174
Automatic Operation .............................. 170
Dimming......................................... 169, 173
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 657 ページ
2020年2月20日
Operating ............................................... 169
Heated Steering Wheel ........................... 214
Heated Windshield Button...................... 181
Heater (Steering Wheel).......................... 214
Heaters (Seat)........................... 211, 212, 213
HFL (HandsFreeLink®) ...................... 381, 406
High Beam Indicator.................................. 82
Hill Start Assist System............................. 457
HomeLink® Universal Transceiver ........... 378
Honda App License Agreement .............. 332
Honda Sensing® ........................................ 24
HondaLink® ............................................ 312
I
午後3時29分
Brake System (Red) .................................. 629
Charging System ............................... 77, 627
Collision Mitigation Braking SystemTM
(CMBSTM) ........................................... 88, 89
Econ Mode ................................................ 84
Electric Power Steering (EPS) System .. 81, 629
Fog Light ................................................... 83
Gear Position ............................................. 77
Hazard Warning ........................................ 82
High Beam ................................................ 82
Immobilizer System.................................... 83
Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) .......... 520
Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
(Amber) ................................................... 86
Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
(Green) .................................................... 86
Lights On................................................... 82
Low Fuel.................................................... 79
Low Oil Pressure Symbol .......................... 627
Low Tire Pressure/TPMS ..................... 82, 630
Malfunction Indicator Lamp ............... 77, 628
Parking Brake and Brake System .............. 629
Parking Brake and Brake System (Amber)... 76
Parking Brake and Brake System (Red) ....... 76
Road Departure Mitigation (RDM).............. 87
Seat Belt Reminder .............................. 38, 79
Security System Alarm ............................... 83
Supplemental Restraint System ............ 55, 80
System Message ........................................ 84
Turn Signal ................................................ 82
Vehicle Stability Assist® (VSA®) OFF .... 81, 478
Vehicle Stability Assist® (VSA®)
System ............................................ 80, 477
Information .............................................. 641
Instant Fuel Economy............................... 110
Instrument Panel ........................................ 75
Brightness Control................................... 182
Integrated Sunshades .............................. 210
Intelligent Traction Management
System ..................................................... 475
Intelligent VTM4 (i-VTM4TM).................... 485
Interior Lights ........................................... 198
Interior Rearview Mirror.......................... 186
iPad ........................................................... 331
iPhone ....................................................... 331
iPod ........................................... 242, 297, 331
J
Jack (Wheel Nut Wrench) ........................ 615
Jump Starting ........................................... 622
K
Key Number Tag.......................................
Keyless Lockout Prevention .....................
Keys ...........................................................
Lockout Prevention..................................
Number Tag ............................................
Rear Door Won’t Open............................
Remote Transmitter.................................
Types and Functions ................................
134
143
133
143
134
146
141
133
Index
Identification Numbers............................ 644
Engine and Transmission......................... 644
Vehicle Identification............................... 644
Illumination Control ................................ 182
Button .................................................... 182
Immobilizer System.................................. 158
Indicator ................................................... 83
Indicators.................................................... 76
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) (Amber) .... 88
Adaptive Cruise Control (ACC) (Green) ..... 88
All-wheel drive (AWD)............................... 85
Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) .................... 79
Auto High-Beam ....................................... 80
Auto Idle Stop (Amber) ............................. 85
Auto Idle Stop (Green) .............................. 85
Blind spot information ...................... 90, 481
木曜日
657
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 658 ページ
2020年2月20日
Kickdown (Automatic Transmission) ....... 459
L
Index
658
Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS) ......... 518
Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
Indicator (Amber) ..................................... 86
Lane Keeping Assist System (LKAS)
Indicator (Green)....................................... 86
LaneWatchTM ............................................. 483
LATCH (Child Seats) .............................. 63, 69
Legal Information on Apple CarPlay/
Android Auto .......................................... 344
License Information.................................. 347
Lights ................................................. 169, 579
Auto High-Beam...................................... 174
Automatic ............................................... 170
Bulb Replacement.................................... 579
Daytime Running Lights ........................... 173
High Beam Indicator .................................. 82
Interior .................................................... 198
Light Switches ......................................... 169
Lights On Indicator .................................... 82
Turn Signals............................................. 168
Load Limits ................................................ 437
Locking/Unlocking .................................... 133
Auto Door Locking/Unlocking .................. 147
Childproof Door Locks ............................. 146
From Inside.............................................. 144
From Outside........................................... 136
Keys ........................................................ 133
木曜日
午後3時29分
Using a Key ............................................. 142
Lockout Prevention System ..................... 143
Low Battery Charge ................................. 627
Low Fuel Indicator...................................... 79
Low Oil Pressure Symbol.......................... 627
Lower Anchors...................................... 63, 69
Lubricant Specifications Chart................. 643
Luggage (Maximum Load Limit) ............. 437
Lumbar Support ....................................... 189
Lumbar Support Adjustment Switch....... 189
M
Maintenance..................................... 112, 557
Battery .................................................... 597
Brake Fluid .............................................. 578
Cleaning ................................................. 602
Coolant................................................... 575
Maintenance MinderTM ............................ 561
Oil........................................................... 571
Precautions ............................................. 558
Radiator .................................................. 576
Remote Transmitter................................. 599
Replacing Light Bulbs .............................. 579
Safety...................................................... 559
Service Items ........................................... 564
Tires ........................................................ 588
Transmission Fluid ................................... 577
Under the Hood ...................................... 567
Malfunction Indicator Lamp.............. 77, 628
Map Lights ................................................ 199
Maximum Load Limit............................... 437
Meters, Gauges ........................................ 104
Mirrors ...................................................... 186
Adjusting ................................................ 186
Door ....................................................... 187
Exterior ................................................... 187
Interior Rearview ..................................... 186
Modifications (and Accessories) .............. 607
Moonroof ................................................. 164
MP3........................................... 245, 300, 303
MP3/WMA/AAC........................ 245, 300, 303
Multi-View Rear Camera ......................... 550
My Honda Music ...................................... 303
N
Navigation................................................ 111
Now Playing ............................................. 114
Numbers (Identification) ......................... 644
O
Odometer .................................................
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines .............
Oil (Engine) ..............................................
Adding ...................................................
Checking ................................................
Displaying Maintenance Minder
Information...........................................
Low Oil Pressure Symbol .........................
Oil Life ....................................................
106
450
570
572
571
562
627
112
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 659 ページ
2020年2月20日
Recommended Engine Oil .......................
Viscosity..................................................
Open Source Licenses ..............................
Opening/Closing
Hood ......................................................
Moonroof ...............................................
Power Windows......................................
Tailgate...................................................
Operating the Switches Around the
Steering Wheel.......................................
Outside Temperature Display .................
Overheating .............................................
570
570
346
568
164
161
148
165
106
625
P
午後3時29分
Power Windows........................................ 161
Precautions While Driving ....................... 458
Driving Guidelines for Your Utility
Vehicle .................................................. 458
Rain......................................................... 458
Pregnant Women ....................................... 43
Puncture (Tire) .......................................... 611
R
Radiator .................................................... 576
Radio (FM/AM).................................. 240, 283
Radio (SiriusXM®) ..................................... 287
Radio Data System (RDS).................. 241, 285
Range ........................................................ 110
RDS (Radio Data System).................. 241, 285
Readiness Codes (Emissions Testing) ....... 647
Rear Climate Control System
From the Rear Panel ................................ 222
Rear Defogger/Heated Door Mirror
Button ..................................................... 180
Rear Outer Seats Heaters ......................... 213
Rear Seat (Folding Down) ........................ 193
Rear Seats.................................................. 192
Rearview Mirror........................................ 186
Refueling................................................... 552
Fuel Gauge .............................................. 104
Gasoline .......................................... 552, 642
Low Fuel Indicator ..................................... 79
Regulations ............................... 488, 591, 645
Remote Engine Start ................................ 454
Remote Transmitter ................................. 141
Replacement
Battery .................................................... 599
Bulbs....................................................... 579
Front Wiper Blade Rubber ....................... 584
Fuses............................... 631, 632, 633, 634
Rear Wiper Blade Rubber......................... 586
Tires ........................................................ 594
Reporting Safety Defects ......................... 646
Reverse Tilt Door Mirror .......................... 187
Road Departure Mitigation (RDM) ......... 527
On and Off.............................................. 529
Road Departure Mitigation (RDM)
Indicator.................................................... 87
S
Safe Driving ................................................ 31
Safety Check ............................................... 36
Safety Labels............................................... 74
Safety Message............................................. 1
Seat Belts .................................................... 37
Adjusting the Shoulder Anchor.................. 41
Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners ................. 39
Checking................................................... 44
Detachable Anchor.................................... 42
Fastening .................................................. 40
Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder
Seat Belt.................................................. 66
Pregnant Women ...................................... 43
Reminder .................................................. 38
Index
Paddle Shifters (Sequential Mode) ... 22, 467
Panic Mode............................................... 160
Parking ..................................................... 539
Parking Brake........................................... 535
Parking Brake and Brake System
Indicator ................................................. 629
Parking Brake and Brake System
Indicator (Amber)..................................... 76
Parking Brake and Brake System
Indicator (Red).......................................... 76
Parking Sensor System............................. 541
Passenger Airbag Off Indicator................. 56
Passing Indicators..................................... 169
Phone........................................................ 113
Playing Bluetooth® Audio ............... 248, 307
Power Tailgate ......................................... 150
木曜日
659
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 660 ページ
Index
660
2020年2月20日
Warning Indicator................................ 38, 79
Seat Heaters .............................. 211, 212, 213
Seat Ventilation ........................................ 212
Seats .......................................................... 188
Adjusting................................................. 188
Driver’s Seat Lumbar Support................... 189
Folding Down the Rear Seat..................... 193
Front Seats .............................................. 188
Rear Seats................................................ 192
Seat Heaters ............................ 211, 212, 213
Seat Ventilation ....................................... 212
Security System ......................................... 158
Immobilizer System Indicator ..................... 83
Security System Alarm Indicator ................. 83
Select Button....................................... 21, 460
Operation .......................................... 21, 462
Selecting a Child Seat ................................. 62
Selector Knob (Audio) .............................. 233
Sequential Mode ...................................... 466
Sequential Mode Operation .................... 467
Setting the Clock ...................................... 130
Settings
Arrange Apps .......................................... 117
Show Tachometer.................................... 118
Shift Button......................................... 21, 460
Shifting (Transmission) ....................... 21, 460
Shoulder Anchor......................................... 41
Show Tachometer..................................... 118
Show/Hide Apps........................................ 116
Side Airbags ................................................ 52
Side Curtain Airbags................................... 54
木曜日
午後3時29分
Siri Eyes Free ............................................. 319
SiriusXM® Radio........................................ 287
Snow Tires................................................. 596
Social Playlist ............................................ 310
Spare Tire.......................................... 611, 643
Spark Plugs ............................................... 642
Specifications............................................ 642
Specified Fuel ................................... 552, 642
Speedometer ............................................ 105
SRS Airbags (Airbags)................................. 48
Starting Assist Brake Function................. 473
Starting the Engine .................................. 452
Does Not Start......................................... 619
Jump Starting.......................................... 622
Remote Engine Start................................ 454
Steering Wheel......................................... 185
Adjusting ................................................ 185
Heater..................................................... 214
Stopping ................................................... 539
Summer Tires ............................................ 596
Sunglasses Holder..................................... 210
Sunshades ................................................. 210
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS)........ 48
Switches
(Around the Steering Wheel) ........ 4, 5, 165
SYNC Mode............................................... 220
System Message Indicator.......................... 84
System Updates ........................................ 265
T
Tachometer .............................................. 105
Tailgate..................................................... 148
Unable to Open ...................................... 639
Temperature
Gauge .................................................... 104
Outside Temperature Display .................. 106
Temperature Gauge ................................ 104
Temperature Sensor ........................ 106, 223
Tie-down Anchors .................................... 215
Time (Setting)........................................... 130
Tire Fill Assist............................................ 630
Tire Pressure ............................................. 112
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Indicator ................................................... 82
Tires .......................................................... 588
Air Pressure..................................... 589, 643
Checking and Maintaining ...................... 588
Inspection ............................................... 588
Labeling.................................................. 589
Puncture (Flat Tire) .................................. 611
Regulations............................................. 591
Rotation.................................................. 595
Spare Tire ....................................... 611, 643
Summer.................................................. 596
Tire Chains.............................................. 596
Wear Indicators....................................... 593
Winter .................................................... 596
Tools ......................................................... 610
Towing a Trailer....................................... 440
Equipment and Accessories..................... 443
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 661 ページ
2020年2月20日
午後3時29分
U
Under-floor Storage Area ........................ 216
Units .......................................................... 114
Unlocking the Doors ................................ 136
Unlocking the Front Doors from the
Inside ....................................................... 144
USB Flash Drives........................ 245, 300, 331
USB Port .................................................... 227
V
Vanity Mirrors ............................................... 7
Vehicle Customization ............................. 119
Vehicle Identification Number ................ 644
Vehicle Stability Assist® (VSA®) ................ 477
Off Button ............................................... 478
System Indicator ................................ 80, 477
Ventilation............................................... 218
Viscosity (Oil) .................................... 570, 643
Voice Control Operation .......................... 280
Audio Commands ................................... 282
Phone Commands ................................... 282
Voice Portal Screen .................................. 281
Voice Recognition.................................... 280
W
Wallpaper ......................................... 236, 255
Warning and Information Messages ......... 91
Warning Indicator On/Blinking ............... 627
Warning Labels ........................................... 74
Warnings................................................... 111
Warranties (Warranty Manual provided
separately) .............................................. 649
Watts......................................................... 642
Wear Indicators (Tire) .............................. 593
Wheel Nut Wrench (Jack Handle) ........... 615
Wi-Fi Connection...................................... 317
Window Washers ..................................... 177
Adding/Refilling Fluid .............................. 578
Switch..................................................... 177
Windows (Opening and Closing) ............ 161
Windshield................................................ 177
Cleaning ......................................... 602, 605
Defrosting/Defogging.............................. 218
Washer Fluid ........................................... 578
Wiper Blades ........................................... 584
Wipers and Washers................................ 177
Winter Tires .............................................. 596
Snow Tires .............................................. 596
Tire Chains .............................................. 596
Wipers and Washers................................. 177
Automatic Intermittent Wipers ................ 178
Checking and Replacing Wiper Blades ..... 584
Front ....................................................... 177
Rear ........................................................ 179
Wireless Charger ...................................... 207
WMA ......................................... 245, 300, 303
Worn Tires ................................................ 588
Index
Load Limits ............................................. 440
Towing Your Vehicle ............................... 449
Emergency.............................................. 636
TPMS (Tire Pressure Monitoring System)
Indicator ................................................... 82
TPMS with Tire Fill Assist ......................... 486
Indicator ................................................. 630
Tire Fill Assist .......................................... 630
Trailer Stability Assist............................... 447
Transmission....................................... 21, 460
Automatic......................................... 21, 460
Fluid ....................................................... 577
Gear Position Indicator...................... 77, 462
Number .................................................. 644
Sequential Mode..................................... 466
Trip Computer.......................................... 109
Trip Meter ................................................ 110
Troubleshooting ...................................... 609
Blown Fuse ..................... 631, 632, 633, 634
Brake Pedal Vibrates ................................. 27
Buzzer Sounds When Opening Door ......... 28
Emergency Towing ................................. 636
Engine Won’t Start ................................. 619
Noise When Braking ................................. 28
Overheating............................................ 625
Puncture/Flat Tire .................................... 611
Rear Door Won’t Open ..................... 27, 146
Warning Indicators.................................... 76
Turn Signals.............................................. 168
Indicators (Instrument Panel) ..................... 82
木曜日
661
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 662 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 663 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
19 PASSPORT-31TGS6020.book 664 ページ
2020年2月20日
木曜日
午後3時29分
31TGS602
OM-14228
00X31-TGS-6020
owners.honda.com (U.S.)
honda.ca (Canada)
2019 Honda Passport Owner’s Manual
© 2020 Honda Motor Co., Ltd. — All Rights Reserved
Printed in U.S.A.